Contents Introduction Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Hydraulic-Magnetic and Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Switches Door Locking, Time Delay and Motor Protection Controls Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) Circuit Breakers and Control Products Electronic Products Approvals Worldwide Service Network Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 Contents Start Introduction 0 E-T-A circuit protection .............................. pages 3 - 10 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Product overview .................................. pages 104-... / 105-... / 106-... ........................ pages 110-P10 / 111-P10 ............................... pages 120-... / 124-... ...................................... pages 127-... ... ................................................ pages 129-L11-... ............................................ pages 157-... / 158-... ...................................... pages 1110-... .................................................. pages 1140-... .................................................. pages 1160-... .................................................. pages 1170-... .................................................. pages 1410-... .................................................. pages 1610-... .................................................. pages 1658-... .................................................. pages 3120-... .................................................. pages 3130-... .................................................. pages 2-4100-... .............................................. pages 2-5000-... / 2-5700-... ........................... pages 2-5200-... .............................................. pages 2-6200-... / 2-6400-... ........................... pages 1 11 23 27 29 31 35 37 41 43 47 49 53 57 61 65 77 81 83 87 89 - Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 22 26 28 30 33 36 39 42 46 48 51 56 59 63 76 80 82 86 88 92 2 Product overview .................................. pages 93 - 100 201 / 201-WA ........................................ pages 101 - 103 2210-S2.. .............................................. pages 105 - 108 E2210-... ............................................... pages 109 - 112 19"-rack ................................................ pages 113 - 114 19BGT2 Rack ........................................ pages 115 - 116 2210-S2.. for Distribution rail ............... pages 117 - 122 X2210-S06... Distribution rail ................ pages 123 - 124 X2210-K... Distribution rail .................... pages 125 - 129 2210-T2 ................................................. pages 131 - 134 2215-L1.. / 2215-G1.. ........................... pages 135 - 137 E2215-... ............................................... pages 139 - 140 2215-F1.. ............................................... pages 141 - 143 3120-....-..M1- ....................................... pages 145 - 148 3200 ...................................................... pages 149 - 151 3300-... / 3400-... .................................. pages 153 - 155 3500-... / 4000-... .................................. pages 157 - 160 3600-... / 3900-... .................................. pages 161 - 164 Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 3 Product overview .................................. pages 165 - 168 808 / 809 ............................................... pages 169 - 170 8330-... .................................................. pages 171 - 174 8340-G... ............................................... pages 175 - 178 8340-F... ................................................ pages 179 - 182 X8340-S02 ............................................ pages 183 - 184 X8340-S04 ............................................ pages 185 - 186 8340-T ................................................... pages 187 - 190 8350-... .................................................. pages 191 - 194 2 ☎ Order Form High Performance Circuit Breakers 4 Product overview .................................. pages 195 - 204 402-... .................................................... pages 205 - 206 410-... .................................................... pages 207 - 210 412-K... ................................................. pages 211 - 212 413-K... ................................................. pages 213 - 214 428-... .................................................... pages 215 - 217 433-... / 434-... ...................................... pages 219 - 222 437-K .................................................... pages 223 - 224 446 / 447 / 449-... ................................. pages 225 - 226 452-... .................................................... pages 227 - 229 482-... .................................................... pages 231 - 233 483-... .................................................... pages 235 - 238 4120-... .................................................. pages 239 - 240 4201-... .................................................. pages 241 - 242 4910-... (RCCB) .................................... pages 261 - 262 520-... / 530-... ...................................... pages 207 - 210 583-... .................................................... pages 243 - 246 911 / 912 / 913 / 914-.. ......................... pages 247 - 249 921 / 922-... .......................................... pages 251 - 252 E-1032-... .............................................. pages 253 - 256 E-1073-437 /- 921 / -922-... ................. pages 257 - 260 Door Locking, Time Delay and Motor Protection Controls 5 Product overview .................................. pages 263 - 266 664-... .................................................... pages 267 - 268 683-.. ..................................................... pages 269 - 270 3620-... .................................................. pages 277 - 278 6110-... .................................................. pages 271 - 272 6510-... .................................................. pages 273 - 274 2-6500 / 2-6700-... ............................... pages 275 - 276 2-7000-... .............................................. pages 279 - 280 Motor Start Switches ............................ page 281 Solid State Remove Power Controllers (SSRPCs) 6 Product overview .................................. pages 283 - 286 E-1048-600 ........................................... pages 287 - 289 E-1071-073 ........................................... pages 291 - 293 E-1071-128 ........................................... pages 295 - 297 E-1071-343 ........................................... pages 299 - 301 E-1071-353 ........................................... pages 303 - 305 E-1071-603/607 .................................... pages 307 - 309 E-1071-803 ........................................... pages 311 - 313 Electronic Products 7 Flow meters, flow monitors ................... pages 315 - 322 Level sensors ........................................ pages 323 - 326 Digital panel instruments ...................... pages 327 - 332 Sensors ................................................. pages 333 - 334 Current/voltage monitors, combi safety protection ....................... pages 335 - 340 Miscellaneous 8 Approvals .............................................. pages 341 - 342 Worldwide Service Network ................. pages 343 - 346 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection E-T-A Protection and Safety E-T-A were pioneers in the development of precision performance circuit breakers with characteristics specifically designed to protect equipment, sub-systems and components against the potentially catastrophic effects of electrical overload and short circuits. 0 Today we offer one of the widest product ranges of its type on the market including high performance models for aerospace, defence, and other applications whose requirements for performance, safety and reliability are uncompromising. We also manufacture battery isolation switches; door lock relays; solid state controllers with current limiting characteristics for use in electronic power management systems; and a comprehensive range of electronic control products and instrumentation. Older methods of protecting electrical and electronic systems from overloads and short circuits are no longer sufficient. Problems of large current rating steps, wide performance bands and premature ageing can cause serious difficulties in safety critical systems and equipment; furthermore, multi-phase circuitry requires disconnection of all poles. If fuses are used, comprehensive stocks of replacements are required to cover every eventuality. Professionals have long recognised the advantages of circuit breaker technology. Overcurrent protection ensures safe performance of all components, while circuit breakers offer convenience in operation and can confidently be reset by inexperienced personnel. E-T-A circuit breakers are far and away the preferred choice. E-T-A Total Quality Circuit breakers are safety-critical items. The same E-T-A products may be required to operate just occasionally or very often during the life of the equipment they are protecting. Either way, operation must be totally dependable immediately a fault occurs. Any failure to perform could have disastrous consequences - endangering people and property. We have been designing and manufacturing circuit protection products since 1948 and have responded to the performance requirements across a wide range of industries. Most importantly, we have gained expertise on the long term needs of circuit protection; the impact of ageing equipment, corrosion, deterioration of wiring insulation and loosening of connectors. All these place additional demands on circuit protection devices. Meeting these needs, E-T-A products are designed and manufactured for world class quality, to the most stringent standards. Quality is builtin at every stage of the manufacturing process and is verified by the latest automatic test equipment and SPC techniques. Our quality management system is accredited to ISO 9001/EN29001 and has been independently audited by many of the world’s leading manufacturers. E-T-A Support Our test laboratories are equipped to conduct comprehensive electrical and environmental qualification programmes and are approved for low voltage switchgear to EN 45000 requirements. Our substantial investment in research and development ensures that we remain at the forefront of technology. Our international standards committee work, covering many different industries, enables us to give up-to-the-minute advice on legislative demands and safety trends worldwide. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 3 An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection E-T-A Reliable Protection for Demanding Applications E-T-A Approvals Most E-T-A models are fully approved by leading authorities including VDE, CSA and UL (supplementary protectors in accordance with UL 1077). Furthermore approvals are also held from specialised agencies such as the UK Civil Aviation Authority, Lloyds Register of Shipping, Bureau Veritas and the American Bureau of Shipping. 0 76 RE aircraft automotive systems military vehicles boats semi-conductors domestic/household appliances commercial equipment business machines medical equipment ... and many others VE BU O Y D´S 937 LL ND D 1 E motors transformers solenoids printed circuit boards power supplies test equipment control instrumentation computers communications systems factory automation AS IT S H I PP I N G FO U AU E-T-A circuit breakers are designed for equipment, component and low voltage wiring protection. Their precision performance characteristics are ideally suited to applications for which other methods of protection are generally inadequate. These include: R OF RE G I S TE R 61120 0 E-T-A circuit protection products are designed according to IEC requirements for CBEs (IEC 934, EN 60934) - defined as circuit breakers for equipment where unrestricted short circuits either cannot occur or are limited by back-up protection elsewhere in the system. 1828 CE Mark Those products from the E-T-A programme which are subject to the European Union EMC Directive have been CE marked since early 1996 to demonstrate compliance. Declarations of conformity contain the necessary supporting evidence. In addition, from January 1997, models covered by the Low Voltage Directive have also been CE marked. CE marking is the responsibility of individual manufacturers and should not be confused with formal approval logos, the use of which is administered by recognised test authorities. 4 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection Current Ratings and Time/Current Characteristic Curves Key selection criteria are the trip time zones determined at 23 °C which are shown graphically for each E-T-A product on the relevant data sheet. Upper and lower curves show minimum and maximum adjustment tolerances. Unless otherwise stated, all thermal and thermal-magnetic circuit breakers will carry 100 % rated current continuously and trip within one hour at 140 % rating. Adjustment to closer tolerances is available to special order. 0 time thermal/magnetic time thermal current current current Issue C magnetic-hydraulic time time magnetic (no delay) (delayed magnetic curves available) ☎ current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 5 An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection E-T-A Catalogue Interrupting Capacity Icn The E-T-A catalogue describes the largest product range of its type, providing solutions to almost any requirement. It is divided into the following sections: 0 Introduction Thermal circuit breakers Thermal-magnetic circuit breakers Hydraulic-magnetic and magnetic circuit breakers High performance circuit breakers and battery switches Door lock, time delay and motor protection controls Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) Electronic products Approvals Each product section includes a quick selector chart and short form presentation of the range, followed by detailed specifications for individual product types or groups. Please contact us if you have any difficulty in matching a product to your requirements or have a special application - we have the flexibility to develop custom solutions tailored to specific needs: products that are both solution-oriented and cost effective. A separate catalogue fully describes E-T-A electronic sensors, control products and instrumentation. E-T-A Choice – Circuit Breakers to Ensure the Best Protection A number of factors arise in choosing a circuit breaker to protect against overloads and short circuits. E-T-A specialists can advise on your requirement, according to the specific field application. Four types of tripping operation cover most situations. 1.Thermal Circuit Breakers (TO) The tripping mechanism comprises a thermal actuator and mechanical latch, designed to discriminate between in-rush/temporary current surges and prolonged overloads to ensure effective overcurrent protection. Applications include motors, transformers, solenoids and low voltage wiring. 2. Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers (TM) Combining a solenoid in series with a bimetal thermal actuator, these provide time current characteristics with two distinct steps. A high overcurrent value causes the solenoid to trigger the release mechanism rapidly, the thermal mechanism responds to prolonged low value overloads. These circuit breakers are well suited to telecommunications, process control, and similar applications requiring precision performance. 3. Magnetic Circuit breakers (MO or HM) A well-proven design of solenoid coil with optional hydraulic delay provides tripping that is highly tolerant of changes in ambient temperature. A wide range of performance characteristics is available in single, double and three pole configurations. Overload and maximum interrupting capacities are specified for each series, defined as the maximum current levels that can be switched safely for a minimum of 40 operations, and a minimum of 3 operations respectively. For thermal circuit breakers back-up protection is advised if higher currents are possible. Please contact us for further advice on specific applications. IEC 934/EN 60934 defines interrupting capacity as the rated conditional short circuit current performance. According to category PC1, this is the value of rated conditional short circuit current (interrupting capacity) for which the prescribed conditions do not include fitness of the CBE for its further use. PC2 is defined as the value of rated conditional short circuit current for which the prescribed conditions do include fitness of the CBE for its further use. Switching Sequence The switching sequence for short circuit tests is normally abbreviated as follows, according to relevant international CBE standards. o: Break operation (open) The circuit breaker in the closed position is caused to open through a short circuit current applied by means of a separate switch. Referenced as co (closed open) in earlier specifications. co: Make operation with subsequent break operation (close open) The circuit breaker in the open condition is closed onto a sustained short circuit and must immediately re-open. This operating mode requires the circuit breaker to be fail-safe as the actuator cannot be released as quickly as the circuit breaker mechanism will open. Referenced as oco (open close open) in earlier specifications. t: Time period between switching operations Normally 3 minutes, or the period required before the circuit breaker can be re-set. Solderability of Silver-Plated Terminals E-T-A products with silver-plated terminals will not be adversely affected (e.g. by sulphur induced corrosion) by the packaging material. However, the solderability of silver-plated terminals can deteriorate with time. Provided these products are stored, solderability will be guaranteed for a period of six months from the date of delivery. If they are not required immediately, it is recommended that these products are packed and stored in polythene bags. No drying agents should be used as they may contain silicate gel which can impair solderability. Flux should be nonhalogenous. E-T-A Advantages Snap-Action Mechanism The snap-action mechanism featured in many E-T-A models ensures that the contact closing speed is independent of the speed of operation of the actuator (push button, rocker, toggle etc.). The moving contact is retained until the actuator causes a defined force to act in the closing direction of the contacts. Once this force is exceeded, the mechanical retention is overcome allowing the contacts to snap closed (tease free mechanism.) The closing speed is a function of this force alone. Snap-action mechanisms eliminate contact welding upon switching on to sustained short-circuits and minimise the risk of contact wear over the circuit breakers’ life. Trip Free Mechanism Series 808 and 809 are fast acting magnetic devices sensitive to small overload currents. Typical applications include printed circuit board and power semi-conductor protection. 4. High Performance Circuit Breakers Where ultimate operation under adverse conditions is required, E-T-A high performance circuit breakers provide high interrupting capacity and excellent environmental specifications. Available in thermal and thermal-magnetic versions, they offer current ratings up to 500 A. Special models are designed for aerospace, defence and similar heavy-duty applications. 6 ☎ R E-T-A circuit breakers cannot be held closed against an overload. This is achieved through the use of positively trip free designs in accordance with IEC 934/EN 60934 (with the exception of models 1610, 1658, 808 and 809 which are designed for specialised applications). Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection Manual Trip / On-Off Switches Dual Control Many models are available with a manual trip feature, either standard or as an option. Others are specifically designed as combined switch/circuit breakers with rocker, push button, or toggle actuation, styled for front panel mounting. Rocker types are available with illumination as an option. According to IEC 934/EN 60934: R = manual reset only M = with manual release but not intended for frequent use as a switch S = combined switch/CBE function Thermal-magnetic circuit breakers inherently have two separate protection elements: the thermal circuit for overload sensing and the magnetic coil for abnormal conditions such as short circuits. The main contacts are in series. Electrical separation of the thermal and the magnetic elements enables independent monitoring of two separate signals – Dual Control – by just one single pole circuit breaker. E-T-A Circuit Breakers with Advanced Features Terminals Most models are offered with either quick connect (also suitable for soldering) or screw terminals. Models with printed circuit board pins are also available. ● Nuisance-free operation when subject to high in-rush currents or transients, allowing ratings to be closely matched to the needs of the system and enabling the most efficient sizing of wiring and components. ● Wide selection of time/current operating characteristics ensure tailoring to many different applications. ● Quality design ensures resistance to premature failure through corrosion, fatigue, shock or vibration. ● Unlike fuses, no need for spares. Risks of using temporary inappropriate substitutes are eliminated, and warranty costs are reduced. ● Convenient resetting reduces down-time and service repair costs. ● Many types also function as on/off switches, simplifying installation - fewer components result in higher overall reliability. ● Internationally approved, avoiding the need for different models for different national standards. Auxiliary Contacts Electrically separate low current contacts can be included for use with alarm and control switching circuits. ● Positive physical interruption of the circuit is ensured. There is no risk of equipment remaining live. Low leakage currents are eliminated. N/C (Si1) = ● Fail-safe if operated beyond specified performance limits. Unlike PTC devices, such as resettable fuses, which may arc and flame; also they require power to be removed before they can be reset. N/O (Si 2) = Normally closed contacts are open when the main contacts are closed (break or b-contact). Normally open contacts are closed when the main contacts are closed (make or a-contact). Shunt Terminal Also available on some models: an additional, unprotected circuit tap, switched through the main contacts. E-T-A International Auxiliary Contacts Shunt Terminal E-T-A is an international company, successful in world markets and with offices and support personnel strategically placed around the globe. Our product specialists will be happy to assist with the selection of suitable products based upon a thorough evaluation of your engineering and commercial objectives. R R R R R R R R R Dual Control Relay Trip R R I> R R Relay Trip R An overload sensing circuit electrically separate from the switching contacts is a further possibility on some models. Issue C ☎ R R R R R R R R Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R I> R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R 7 0 An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection Ambient Temperature Influence 0 To ensure optimum matching of circuit breaker performance to the system requirements, E-T-A thermal and thermal-magnetic circuit breakers are not normally compensated for fluctuations in ambient temperature. The circuit breaker is usually subjected to the same heat source as the system so will automatically track its protective requirements. However, some applications require the circuit breaker to operate continuously in either high or low temperatures. The following table shows the correction factors that typically should be applied. The performance of magnetic circuit breakers and type 1410 is not affected significantly within this temperature range. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1.00 1.08 1.16 1.24 Specification Notes Close Mounting of CBEs When several devices are mounted together, an air gap between each is recommended. If this is not possible, each device should carry only 80 % of its rating. Degrees of protection of electrical equipment according to IEC 529 Example: First characteristic digit Second characteristic digit First characteristic digit: Degree of protection against access to hazardous parts and against solid foreign objects Designation Description 0 Non-protected No specific protection of persons against accidental access to live or moving parts. No protection of the equipment against solid foreign objects. 1 Protected against solid foreign objects of ≥ 50 mm Protection against accidental access to live or internal moving parts, e.g. with the back of a hand, but no protection against intended access to these parts. Protection against the ingress of solid foreign objects of 50 mm dia. and greater. 2 Protected against medium-sized foreign objects ≥ 12 mm Protection against finger access to live or internal moving parts. Protection against the ingress of solid foreign objects of 12 mm dia. and greater. 3 Protected against small solid foreign objects ≥ 2.5 mm Protection against access to live or internal moving parts with a tool, or wires etc. of a thickness of > 2.5 mm. Protection against the ingress of solid foreign objects of 2.5 mm dia. and greater. 4 Protected against granular foreign objects ≥ 1 mm Protection against access of live or internal moving parts with a tool, or wires etc. of a thickness of > 1mm. Protection against the ingress of solid foreign objects of 1 mm dia. and greater. 5 Dust-protected Protection against access to live or internal moving parts. Protection against harmful dust deposits. Ingress of dust is not totally prevented, but dust shall not penetrate in a quantity to interfere with satisfactory operation of the equipment. 6 Dust-proof Full protection against access to live or internal moving parts. No ingress of dust. Horizontal installation is preferable. Plug-in Mounted E-T-A Devices The continuous rating capability of E-T-A sockets for plug-in circuit breakers is a function of the total number of circuit breakers fitted and the individual ratings of each. Please enquire with details of your application. IP 4 4 Code letters Second characteristic digit: Degrees of protection against ingress of water Degrees of Environmental Protection for Electrical Equipment Terms such as drip-proof, water splash protection, waterproof and dustproof are all in common usage but may be misleading unless standard definitions are applied. The IEC has developed a standard coding system defined in IEC 529. Protection categories are identified by the prefix letters „IP“ followed by 2 digits, the first of which refers to the level of protection provided against access by solid foreign objects and to hazardous parts; the second digit shows the level of protection against water ingress. Designation Description 0 non-protected No specific protection 1 Protected against water drops falling vertically Drops falling vertically shall have no harmful effects. 2 Protected against water drops falling vertically when enclosure is tilted up to 15° Drops falling vertically shall have no harmful effects when the enclosure is tilted at any angle up to 15° on either side of the vertical. 3 Protected against water spray Water sprayed at an angle up to 60° on either side of the vertical shall have no harmful effects. 4 Protected against splashing water Water splashed against the enclosure from any direction shall have no harmful effects. 5 Protected against water jets Water projected in jets against the enclosure from any direction shall have no harmful effects. 6 Protected against high-pressure water jets Water protected in powerful jets against the enclosure from any direction shall have no harmful effects. *) 7 Protected against the effects of temporary immersion in water Ingress of water in quantities causing harmful effects shall not be possible when the enclosure is is temporarily immersed in water under specified conditions of pressure and time. *) 8 Protected against the effects of continuous immersion in water Ingress of water in quantities causing harmful effects shall not be possible when the enclosure is continuously immersed in water under specified conditions of pressure and time. *) *) Certain equipment does not allow any ingress of water. If applicable, this is included in the relevant equipment specification. 8 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection Preferred degrees of protection Protection against access to hazardous parts and against solid foreign objects Definition of make contact and break contact The definition of IEC Publication 50 (441), 1974 issue, applies. Protection against ingress of water Code letters and first characteristic digit 0 make contact a-contact N/O (Si2) contact Second characteristic digit 1 2 3 4 IP 0 IP 00 IP 2 IP 20 IP 21 IP 22 IP 23 IP 3 IP 30 IP 31 IP 32 IP 33 IP 5 5 6 IP 65 13 2 14 IP 66 Protection degree IP 54 may apply to products with a splashcover, for example for front of panel protection whereas the terminals (IP 00) will be in an enclosed area. Cable ratings to EN 60934 break contact b-contact N/C (Si1) contact EN 60934:1994 + A1 : issue 1994 Standard current ratings as assigned to different cable cross sectional areas (stranded copper cable). mm2 Current rating (A) 1 to 6 1.5 2.5 4 6 10 16 25 35 50 >6 >13 >20 >25 >32 >50 >63 >80 >100 to 13 to 20 to 25 to 32 to 50 to 100 to 125 to 63 to 80 Cable ratings and sizes for aerospace applications Current AWG cable sizes rating EN 2350 MS 3320 (A) 0.5 1 2 2.5 3 4 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 1 IP 54 IP6 Size A control or auxiliary contact which is closed when the main contacts of the mechanical switching device are closed and open when they are open. Example: 20 20 18 18 18 18 18 16 16 14 12 10 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 20 18 16 Airbus Boeing BPS-C-144 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 22 20 16 14 12 20 18 18 18 18 18 16 16 14 12 10 AWG mm2 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 0.21 0.33 0.52 0.82 1.31 2.08 3.31 5.26 AWG =American Wire Gauge A control or auxiliary contact which is open when the main contacts of the mechanical switching device are closed and closed when they are open. Example: 1 11 2 12 Note: The common terminal of change over contacts is often shown as C (common). Terminal identification The following identifications are in conformance with DIN EN 5005 July 1977. However, the diagrams for the examples have been adjusted to DIN 40900 1988 (equivalent to IEC 617 of 1983). Main circuit One-digit numerals - one pair of subsequent numerals per main switching element Example 1 3 2 4 Representation of operating status In accordance with DIN 40719, part 3, issue April 1997, the operating status of switching elements should be represented as follows: ● Telecommunications The representation of the ready status as used by the telecommunications industry - Fuses and circuit breakers are shown in the closed position. ● Power engineering The representation of the open position is used by the power, installation, control and data processing industries. Equipment is represented in the de-energized condition and without the effect of an operating force. Power switches, disconnectors, circuit breakers etc. are shown in the open condition, which is the normal position. 2 main switching elements Auxilairy circuits Two-digit numbers - Second digit function numeral b-contact 1 and 2 a-contact 3 and 4 change over contact 1, 2 and 4 b-contact 7 and 8, delayed change over contact with special functions 5, 6 and 8 - First digit, ordinal number switching elements with identical function and belonging together Examples: .1 .3 .2 .4 Following these definitions, E-T-A products are generally shown in the de-energized condition. .2 b-contact Issue C ☎ .4 a-contact Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com .1 change over contact 9 0 An Introduction to E-T-A Circuit Protection Graphical symbols in accordance with DIN 40900/IEC 617 Description DIN 40900/IEC 617 Operated by electromagnetic actuator 02-13-23 AINSI/CSA Description DIN 40900/IEC 617 Make contact 07-02-01 07-02-02 AINSI/CSA or 0 Operated by electromagnetic overcurrent protection 02-13-24 Break contact 07-02-03 Operated by thermal actuator, for example thermal relay, thermal overcurrent protection 02-13-25 Change-over break before make contact 07-02-04 Manually operated control, general case 02-13-01 Two-way contact with centre-off position 07-02-05 Operated by pulling 02-13-03 Circuit breaker 07-13-05 Operated by pushing 02-13-05 Disconnector (isolator) 07-13-06 Operated by turning 02-13-04 Switch-disconnector (on-load isolating switch) 07-13-08 Operated by stored mechanical energy 02-13-20 Manually operated switch, general symbol 07-07-01 Latching mechanism with mechanical release 102-05-04 Push-button switch with detent, non-automatic return (push/push) Control by fluid level 02-14-01 Three-position switch, manually operated, positions 2 and 3 are locked positions 107-03-02 1 2 3 2,3 Control by flow 02-14-03 Pull-switch (non locking) 07-07-03 Turn-switch (locking) 07-07-04 Contactor (contact open in the unoperated position) 07-13-02 Pressure sensor, making p p> Operating device, general symbol, relay coil 07-15-01 Contactor or relay with three make contacts Operating device with one effective winding x with code Relay coil of a slow-operating relay 07-15-08 Relay coil of a slow-releasing relay 07-15-07 Actuating device of a thermal relay 07-15-21 SO SO OL Electro-magnetic overcurrent protection SOL I> Electro-magnetic undervoltage release (undervoltage release module) Relay coil of a polarized relay 10 ☎ 3 pole contactor with three electrothermal overcurrent releases OL 3 pole disconnector Single pole disconnector with detent, manually operated,1 break contact and 1 make contact DISC 1 11 13 1 11 13 2 12 2 12 14 14 2 Single pole disconnector with 2 parallel contacts, manually operated, with detent and remote trip coil (FA) - type 921 DISC FA 1 3 pole circuit breaker CB U< 07-15-15 3 pole circuit breaker with latching mechanism, electrothermal and electromagnetic overcurrent releases I> I> I> Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Single and multi pole thermal circuit breakers (CBEs) with and without auxiliary contacts Overview Max. voltage ratings 3 AC 415 V, AC 250 V, DC 50 V Current ratings 0.05 ... 30 A 1 With simple operation through the heating effect of current, thermal circuit breakers offer one of the most reliable and cost effective forms of protection device available. As a result they are ideally suited to the protection of a broad range of components and systems - from motors and transformer windings, through printed circuit boards, to the low voltage power distribution circuits of road vehicles, boats, and battery powered machines. Such applications all require the ability to discriminate between safe switch-on surges or transients on the one hand, and harmful sustained overloads on the other. Thermal circuit breakers can withstand high level surges, which arise from lamp loads or motor starting, for example. At the same time they afford protection against the effects of genuine failure such as motor locked rotors. The characteristics of thermal CBE’s can be matched closely to the ratings of the component or system they are protecting, eliminating the need for over-sizing of wiring and connectors, whilst offering dependable protection even under low level overcurrent conditions which cannot be adequately provided for by other methods of circuit protection. E-T-A thermal circuit breakers utilise one of three different mechanisms optimised for their range of operation ● a snap action disc type bimetal and contact assembly ● a bimetal with a mechanical latch and separate spring loaded contact ● a hot wire design with extremely fast switching time All are individually calibrated in the factory to ensure safe, predictable performance under a wide range of conditions. The E-T-A thermal circuit breakers in this catalogue section are manually resettable enabling the power supply to be restored after operation. Several models combine the functions of circuit breaker protection and on/off switching in a single component. There is a choice of rocker, toggle or push button actuation according to user preference. E-T-A’s wide range of models enables the designer to make optimal selections according to specific performance, installation and styling needs. All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 11 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 104-PR-... 104-... 105-... Overview Type No. 1 Description PCB mounting integral type snap-in panel mounting Max. voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 48 V AC 250 V; DC 48 V AC 250 V; DC 48 V Current ratings 0.05...10 A 0.05...10 A 0.05...10 A Aux. contact rating 0.5 A, AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.5 A, AC 250 V; DC 28 V Typical life / contact rating 0.05...5 A 3000 operations at 2 x IN 6 ...8 A 500 operations at 2 x IN 10 A 50 operations at 2 x IN 0.05...5 A 3000 operations at 2 x IN 6 ...8 A 500 operations at 2 x IN 10 A 50 operations at 2 x IN 0.05...5 A 3000 operations at 2 x IN 6 ...8 A 500 operations at 2 x IN 10 A 50 operations at 2 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...2 A 6 x rated current 2.5...10 A 5 x rated current 0.05...2 A 6 x rated current 2.5...10 A 5 x rated current 0.05...2 A 6 x rated current 2.5...10 A 5 x rated current Approvals VDE, Demko, SEV, ÖVE, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, Fimko, Kema VDE, Demko, SEV, ÖVE, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, Fimko, Kema VDE, Demko, SEV, ÖVE, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, Fimko, Kema Available options see pages 23 - 26 see pages 23 - 26 pages 23 - 26 Dimensions ø4 Internal connection diagrams 27.6 9.5 3.5 9.5 27.6 27.6 9.5 OFF 9.5 OFF 9.5 OFF ø4 ø4 19 19 1 5 19 1 1 2 2 4 2 12 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 110/111-P10-G10.. 120-... 124-... Overview 106-... 1 toggle switch/circuit breaker rocker switch/circuit breaker push/push switch/circuit breaker AC 250 V; DC 48 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V DC 28 V DC 28 V 0.05...10 A 0.1...20 A (type 110) 0.1...16 A (type 111) 3...20 A 3...20 A 0.05...5 A 3000 operations at 2 x IN 6 ...8 A 500 operations at 2 x IN 10 A 50 operations at 2 x IN 30,000 operations at 1 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 0.05...2 A 6 x rated current 2.5...10 A 5 x rated current 10 x rated current 160 A 160 A VDE, Demko, SEV, ÖVE, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, Fimko, Kema VDE, CSA, UL, LRoS CSA see pages 23 - 26 see pages 27 - 28 see pages 29 - 30 2.5 16 22 9.5 26 32.5 OFF 36 27.6 9.5 19 Issue C see pages 29 - 30 1/2-32 UN-2A 3/8-27UNS-2A 12 13.5 OFF threadneck panel mounting 1 1 2 2 ☎ 38 36 43.3 5 1 1 2 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 13 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 127-F.../T... 129-L11-H-KF 157/158-... Overview Type No. 1 127-F-... 157-... Description plug-in, integral, or snap-in panel mounting (-F), or rail (-T), with manual release option base mounting with manual release threadneck panel mounting Max. voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 28 V (type -F) DC 28 V (type -T) DC 28 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V Current ratings 0.05...25 A 3...25 A 0.05...25 A Typical life / contact rating 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn Type -F/-T: 0.05...2.5 A 3 ... 5 A Type -F: 6 ...12 A 13 ...25 A Type -T: 6 ...25 A 3...5 A 20 x rated current 6...25 A 400 A 0.05... 2.5 A 8 x IN 3 ... 5 A 20 x IN 6 ...12 A 200 A 13 ...25 A 400 A Approvals VDE, CSA, UL, LRoS, Semko CSA, LRoS, BWB (VG 95345 part 9) VDE, CSA, UL, LRoS, Semko Available options see pages 31 - 33 see pages 35 - 36 see pages 37 - 39 Aux. contact rating 3/8-27UNS-2A ø4 9.4 9.4 45 45 20 OFF 13.5 OFF ø4 45 11.5 OFF Dimensions 8 x IN 20 x IN 200 A 400 A 400 A Internal connection diagrams 14 ☎ 31 31 31 1 1 1 2 2 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 1140-E... 1140-F... 1140-G... Overview 1110-... 1 threadneck panel mounting AC 250 V; DC 28 V (DC 50 V UL/CSA) AC 240 V; DC 48 V AC 240 V; DC 48 V AC 240 V; DC 48 V 0.05...16 A 3.5...16 A 3.5...16 A 3.5...16 A 0.05...4 A 10,000 operations at 1xIN 5... 16 A 6,000 operations at 1xIN 3.5... 8 A 1000 operations at 2xIN 10...16 A 50 operations at 2xIN 3.5... 8 A 1000 operations at 2xIN 10...16 A 50 operations at 2xIN 3.5... 8 A 1000 operations at 2xIN 10...16 A 50 operations at 2xIN AC 250 V: 0.05...16 A 8 x IN DC 28 V: 0.05... 6 A 10 x IN 7...10 A 200 A 12...16 A 300 A 3.5... 8 A 8 x IN 10...16 A 120 A 3.5... 8 A 8 x IN 10...16 A 120 A 3.5... 8 A 8 x IN 10...16 A 120 A VDE, CSA, UL, BV, LRoS, Semko VDE, CSA, UL, Semko, Kema VDE, CSA, UL, Semko, Kema VDE, CSA, UL, Semko, Kema see pages 41 - 42 see pages 43 - 44 see pages 43 - 44 see pages 43 - 44 14 3/8-27 UNS-2A 34.5 34.5 51 ø 4.2 19 19 15.6 Issue C ø 4.2 34.5 15 11 OFF 10 OFF snap-in panel mounting 11 OFF integral type OFF snap-in panel mounting, push/push switch/circuit breaker 19 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 15 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 1140-G.5. 1160-... 1170-... Overview Type No. 1 Description threadneck panel mounting, double pole, thermally protected on one pole automotive circuit breaker controlled reset operation automotive circuit breaker plug in mounting, manual release Max. voltage rating AC 240 V; DC 48 V DC 12 V DC 28 V Current ratings 0.05...16 A 12...30 A 5...25 A Typical life / contact rating 0.05...3 A 3,000 operations at 2 x IN 3.5 ...8 A 1,000 operations at 2 x IN 10 ...16 A 50 operations at 2 x IN 300 operations at 2 x IN 6,000 operations at 1 x IN 3,000 operations at 2 x IN ≤ 20 A 1,000 operations at 2 x IN 25 A Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...3 A 6 x IN 3.5 ...8 A 8 x IN 10 ...16 A 120 A 200 A, L/R = 2.5 ms 5...15 A 200 A 20...25 A 400 A Approvals VDE, CSA, UL, Kema Available options see pages 45 - 46 see pages 47 - 48 see pages 49 - 51 Aux. contact rating 7 OFF 3/ -27 UNS-2A 8 ø4 7.6 6.4 17.5 49.5 38 14 OFF Dimensions 25.1 19 Internal connection diagrams 1 3 18.8 1 1 2 2 4 2 16 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 1410-L1... 1410-L2... 1410-G1... Overview 1410-F1.. 1 miniaturized rocker switch/circuit breaker, snap-in panel mounting, fast acting miniaturized PCB mounting type, fast acting miniaturized PCB mounting type, fast acting threadneck panel mounting, fast acting AC 240 V; DC 28 V (DC 48 V UL/CSA) AC 240 V; DC 28 V (DC 48 V UL/CSA) AC 240 V; DC 28 V (DC 48 V UL/CSA) AC 240 V; DC 28 V (DC 48 V UL/CSA) 0.63...10 A 0.63...10 A 0.63...10 A 0.63...10 A 0.2 x IN, max. 1 A 0.2 x IN, max. 1 A 30,000 operations IN ≤ 6.3 A 10,000 operations IN > 6.3 A AC 3,000 operations IN > 6.3 A DC 300 operations at 2 x IN 500 operations at 2 x IN 300 operations at 2 x IN 500 operations at 2 x IN 0.63...2.5 A 12 x IN 3.15...10 A 8 x IN AC max.70 A 3.15...10 A 10 x IN DC 0.63...2.5 A 12 x IN 3.15...10 A 8 x IN max. 70 A 0.63...2.5 A 12 x IN 3.15...10 A 8 x IN max. 70 A 0.63...2.5 A 12 x IN 3.15...10 A 8 x IN max. 70 A CSA, UL, SEV VDE, CSA, UL VDE, CSA, UL VDE, CSA, UL see pages 53 - 54 see pages 55 - 56 see pages 55 - 56 see pages 55 - 56 ø7 11.7 3.1 10 3.1 5 9.5 17 23.2 11 3.1 ON 23.5 1 LINE Issue C 4 25 28 28 2 3 2 3 2 1 1 1 2 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 17 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 1610-21 1610-22 1658-... Overview Type No. 1 Description automotive circuit breaker standard fuseblock mounting automotive circuit breaker standard fuseblock mounting with manual release option threadneck panel mounting disc bimetal operation Max. voltage rating DC 24 V DC 12 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V Current ratings 6...25 A 6...25 A 5...25 A Typical life / contact rating 300 operations at ≤ 50 A 500 operations at ≤ 50 A 1,000 operations at ≤ 50 A Interrupting capacity Icn ≥ 3 operations at ≤ 150 A ≥ 1 operation at ≤ 2000 A ≥ 3 operations at ≤ 200 A ≥ 1 operation at ≤ 2000 A 200 A Aux. contact rating Approvals VDE, CSA, UL Available options see pages 57 - 59 see pages 61 - 63 see pages 57 - 59 ø6 0.7 27 24 24 28.8 2 6.4 12 1 6.4 12.7 6 3.8 OFF OFF Dimensions 17.5 18.8 18.8 Internal connection diagrams 18 ☎ 32 1 1 1 2 2 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 3120-F... 3130-F... 2-4100-... Overview 3120-F... 1 rocker switch/circuit breaker, single and double pole, snap-in panel mounting push button switch/circuit breaker, single and double pole (press-to-reset only) with single or two button operation 1, 2 or 3 pole switch/circuit breaker, snap-in panel mounting threadneck panel mounting AC 250 V; DC 50 V AC 250 V; DC 50 V 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V; DC 50 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.1...20 A 0.1...20 A 0.1...20 A 1 pole 0.1...16 A 2 and 3 pole 0.05...10 A 50,000 operations at IN ≤16A 2 pole 30,000 operations at IN ≤16A 1 pole 10,000 operations at IN >16 A 50,000 operations at IN ≤16A 2 pole 30,000 operations at IN ≤16A 1 pole 10,000 operations at IN >16 A 30,000 operations 1 and 3 pole 50,000 operations 2 pole 2,000 operations at 2 x IN 0.1...2 A 2.5...20 A 2.5...20 A 0.1...2 A 2.5...20 A 2.5...20 A 0.1...2 A 2.5...20 A 2.5...16 A 2.5...12 A 14 + 16 A 0.05...2 A 10 x rated current 2.5 ...6 A 8 x rated current 7 ...10 A 6 x rated current 10 x rated current 150 A (1 pole) 250 A (2 pole) 10 x rated current 150 A (1 pole) 250 A (2 pole) 10 x rated current 150 A (1 pole) 250 A (2 pole) 150 A (3 pole) 130 A (3 pole) VDE, CSA, UL, LRoS, BV, Semko VDE, UL, CSA, Semko VDE, CSA, UL, Semko see pages 65 - 76 see pages 65 - 76 see pages 77 - 80 see pages 81 - 82 OFF VDE, CSA, UL, LRoS, BV, Semko 3/8-27 UNS-2A 42.5 7.7 15 33 OFF 33 9 33 14.2 22.5 OFF position I.3 LINE I.1 I.2 1 2 41 41 2 pole thermally protected 11 12(k) Issue C line load 34 2 pole thermally protected 21 11 22(k) 12(k) ☎ LINE I.I line load 6.5 3 2.I 3.I 2.2 3.2 19 1 21 22(k) I.2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 2 19 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-5000-... 2-5200-... 2-5700-... Overview Type No. 1 Description flange mounting, with manual release option plug-in type, with manual release option. Specially suited to automotive and marine applications threadneck panel mounting, with optional push/push switch actuation Max. voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 28 V DC 28 V AC 250 V to special order AC 250 V; DC 28 V Current ratings 0.05...25 A 0.05...16 A up to 25 A to special order 0.05...25 A Typical life / contact rating 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...2.5 A 8 x rated current 3 ...5 A 20 x rated current 6 ...12 A 200 A 13 ...25 A 400 A 0.05...2.5 A 8 x rated current 3 ...5 A 20 x rated current 6 ...16 A 400 A 0.05...2.5 A 8 x rated current 3 ...5 A 20 x rated current 6 ...12 A 200 A 13 ...25 A 400 A Approvals VDE, CSA, UL, Semko, SEV, LRoS, Nemko Semko, LRoS VDE, CSA, UL, Semko, SEV, LRoS, BV, Nemko Available options see pages 83 - 86 see pages 87 - 88 see pages 83 - 86 Aux. contact rating 22.5 OFF 18.2 OFF ø9.5 IG1=3/8-27UNS-2A ø13.5 15.5 OFF Dimensions 46.5 44 48.5 A A 1 3 2 2 9.6 31 Internal connection diagrams 20 ☎ 0,05...2,5 A 1 4 3 2 10.4 4 10.4 1 29 50 1 1 1 2 2 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-6200-... Overview 2-6400-... 1 flange mounting, with auxiliary contacts, with manual release option threadneck panel mounting, with auxiliary contacts AC 250 V; DC 28 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A 0.05...16 A 1A, AC 250 V; DC 28 V 1A, AC 250 V; DC 28 V 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 10 x rated current 10 x rated current VDE, CSA, UL, Demko, Semko VDE, CSA, UL, Demko, Semko see pages 89 - 92 see pages 89-92 ø6.4 11 11 39 46 18.5 OFF 22.5 OFF ø8.5 31 1 31 5 7 4 6 2 Issue C 1 5 7 4 6 2 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 21 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers - Selector Chart 106 ● ● ❍ 110/111 ● ● ❍ ● Illumination 250 48 10 ● 250 48 10 ❍ ● 250 48 10 ❍ ● 250 28 20 multi pole MAX IN (A) ❍ DC (V) ● ● single pole ❍ Water splash cover Auxiliary contacts ❍ Manual trip facility Shunt terminal ● Screw terminals ● Max. ratings Number of poles AC (V) ● 105 Solder terminals 104 Main terminal design Blade terminals Socket Flange Overview 1 Mounting method Threadneck Type ❍ 120 ● ● ❍ ● ● 28 20 124 ● ● ❍ ● ● 28 20 127 ● ● ❍ ● 28 25 ● ● ● 28 25 ● ● 158 1110 1140 ● ● 129 157 ● ● ● ● ● 250 28 25 ● ● ● 250 28 25 ❍ ● 250 28(50) 16 ❍ ● 240 48 16 ● 12 30 ● ● 28 25 ● ● 28(48) 10 ❍ ● 24 25 250 28 25 ● ● ● ● 1160 ● ● 1170 ● ● 1410 ● ● 1658 ● ● 1610 ● ● ● ● ● ● ❍ ● ● ❍ ❍ 3130 ● ● ❍ ❍ ● ● ● 2-5000 2-5700 ● ● ❍ ❍ ● ● ❍ 250 50 20 ● ❍ ● ● ❍ 415 50 20 ❍ ● 250 28 10 ❍ ● 250 28 25 ● 250 28 25 ● 250 28 25 ● 250 28 16 ● 250 28 16 ❍ ❍ ❍ ● ● ❍ ● ● ● ❍ ● 250 ❍ ❍ plug-in pins ● ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ● 2-6200 2-6400 ● ● 2-5200 ● ❍ ● 3120 2-4100 250 ❍ ❍ ❍ ● = standard ❍ = optional 22 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 104/105/106-... Description Miniaturised single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset tease free, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Available in versions for PCB or panel mounting, snap-in or threadneck, or as an integral type. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). For higher current ratings see type 1140. Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, printed circuit boards, hand-held machines and appliances. Accessories X 201 285 01 1 Ordering information Type No. 104 105 106 106-M1 106 - - 5A = ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Voltage rating Current ratings Auxiliary circuit Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) * mounting hardware bulk shipped Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.05 0.08 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 1 1.2 1.5 Internal resistance (Ω) 285 134 81 22 8.7 5.5 3.3 2.45 1.6 1.45 0.9 0.6 0.4 105-... 106-... Technical data PCB mounting type (-PR), or integral type (-P30/P10) snap-in panel mounting threadneck panel mounting with hex and knurled nut * threadneck mounting for standard fuseholder cutout * Terminal design P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 P30 blade terminals A2.8-0.8 PR solder terminal pins for PCB mounting (type 104 only) Shunt terminal (optional) A3 same as main terminals (up to IN 6 A/3 A max. load) Auxiliary contacts (optional) Si51 type 104 only Current ratings 0.05...10 A - P30 - 104-... Water splashcover/knurled nut assembly for type 106. Current rating (A) 1.8 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 6 7 8 10 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.28 0.25 0.18 0.11 0.076 0.067 0.051 ≤ 0.05 ≤ 0.05 ≤ 0.05 ≤ 0.05 ≤ 0.05 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 48 V 0.05...10 A 0.5 A, AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...5 A: 3000 operations at 2 x IN 6 ...8 A: 500 operations at 2 x IN 10 A 50 operations at 2 x IN -20...+60 °C (T 60) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.05 ... 2 A 6 x IN 2.5 ...10 A 5 x IN IN UN 0.05...4.5 A AC 250 V 200 A 5A AC 250 V 1000 A 6...10 A AC 250 V 2000 A 0.05...10 A DC 48 V 200 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 10 g (57-500 Hz),±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 25 g ( 11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 10 g Approvals Authority Voltage ratings VDE, Demko, AC 250 V, DC 28 V SEV, ÖVE AC 250 V, DC 28 V CSA, UL AC 250 V, DC 48 V Semko AC 250 V, DC 48 V Nemko AC 250 V Fimko AC 250 V Kema (EN 60934) AC 240 V, DC 48 V Circuit breakers with -Si51 not approved Issue C ☎ Current ratings 0.05...10 A 0.05...10 A 0.05...10 A 0.1...10 A 0.05...10 A 0.1...10 A 0.05...10 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 23 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 104/105/106-... Dimensions ON ø7 mounting holes 104-PR 104-PR-A3 0.05...6 A 0.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-A2.8-0.8 7.3 30 30 cut-out dimensions 6.5 6.5 4.5 0.8 0.5 hole for mounting screw M2 usable depth 4.5 mm 11 terminal design for correct stand-off distances 104-PR 7...10 A Ø 2.2 3.5 9.5 1 1 29.6 6.5 ø4 27.6 max. 3 29.6 27.6 9.5 ø4 1.2 OFF 6.5 ON 104-P30 1.2 max. 3 9.5 OFF 104-PR 9 11 19 1 9 3 2 1 2 8±0.2 17.5 19 8±0.2 9.5 21 17.5 104-P30 104-P30-A3 7...10 A 0.05...6 A 9.5 105-P30 104-PR-(A3-)Si51 ø4 29.6 27.6 3.5 9.5 1.2 max. 3 21 23 27.6 31.6 1.2 max. 3 2 ø0.85 9.5 6.5 ON OFF ON ø4 6.5 10 OFF ø7 ø7 4.5 1 blade terminals DIN 46244-A2.8-0.8 mounting hole a 14 0.8 11 (A3) 11 19 terminal design for correct stand-off distances 25 d 0.8 1.0 1.5 2-3 mounting holes 12.5 104-PR-Si51 7...10 A 9.5 5 2 23.5 21.5 21.5 3 8±0.2 5 4 23.5 4 11.3 +0.3 1 105-P30 105-P30-A3 7...10 A 0.05...6 A 2 8±0.2 17.5 24 b 5 5 1 12.5 a 21.9 22 22.1 22.2 d 17.5 19 21 104-PR-Si51 104-PR-A3-Si51 0.05...6 A b 12 9 ☎ 3.8 9.5 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 104/105/106-... Internal connection diagrams 106-P30 Types 104 105 106 3/8-27UNS-2A tightening torque 0.8 Nm 10.5 ON 13.5 OFF Dimensions Types 104-...-A3 105-...-A3 106-...-A3 Types 104-...-A3-Si51 1 1 1 5 ø4 3 4 27.6 2 2 2 1 9.5 1.2 max. 3 0.7 7 3 Typical time/current characteristics at 23°C 19 blade terminals DIN 46244-A2.8-0.8 10000 mounting hole 7 - 10 A 8.8 SW14 0.1 - 6 A 8.9 - 0.1 15.7 11 1000 9 Trip time in seconds 9.6 - 0.1 106-P30 7...10 A 106-P30-A3 0.05...6 A 3.8 100 10 tightening torque 0.5 Nm ø18.8 mounting hole 11.3 +0.15 - 0.1 106-M1 1 0.1 1 panel thickness >0.8 ø16±0.1 operating area 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Installation drawing for type 106 ø18 17 47 3.5 max. 2 20 2 24 Issue C mounting area ☎ 12 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 25 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 104/105/106-... Terminal design Accessories 104/105/106-P10 0.05...6 A Water splash cover (transparent)/knurled nut assembly (type 106-... only) X 201 285 01 Degree of protection IP 64 10 7...10 A 6.3 104/105/106-P10-A3 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 0.05...6 A 1 polarizing tooth 5.3 polarizing tooth 104/105/106-P30-A3 9.5 0.05...6 A 26 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 110/111-P10-G10 Description Single pole toggle switch/thermal circuit breakers (S-type TO CBE to EN 60934) for threadneck panel mounting. Available with optional neon illumination (filament bulb for low voltages) to indicate the ON position. Fitted with toggle or baton style actuator in a range of colours translucent for illuminated version. Under overload the actuator returns to the OFF position. Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, extra-low voltage wiring systems, power supplies. 1 110-P10-G10 111-P10-G10 (illuminated) Ordering information Technical data Type No. 110 non illuminated 111 illuminated (please specify voltage) Terminal design P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 Shunt terminal (optional) A3 shunt terminal, max. load 5 A Mounting G10 threadneck panel mounting, 1/2-32 UN-2A * Switch style options OB baton WB baton - water splash protected (IP 54) OT toggle WT toggle - water splash protected (IP 54) Switch colour designation opaque translucent 01 black 14 red 02 white 15 orange 04 red 17 transparent 06 blue 08 grey 09 green Current ratings 0.1 ...20 A (type 110) 0.1 ...16 A (type 111) Illumination (type 111 only) 12 V DC 10 to 14 V 24 V DC 20 to 28 V 115 V AC 90 to 140 V 220 V AC 185 to 275 V 111 - P10 - - G10 - OB 14 - 5A - 12 V Voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 28 V Current ratings 0.1...20 A (type 110) 0.1...16 A (type 111) Typical life 30,000 operations at 1xIN or 5,000 operations at 2xIN Ambient temperature -30 ... +60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 10 x IN Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) IN 0.1...16 A 18...20 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40 050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 4 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.3 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 30 g ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. *mounting hardware bulk shipped UN AC 250 V AC 115 V 2,000 A 2,000 A Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 0.1 97.6 2.5 0.2 0.2 22.4 3 0.1 0.3 10.9 3.5 0.09 0.4 6.1 4 0.05 0.5 4.0 5 0.04 0.6 2.7 6 0.03 0.7 1.8 8 < 0.02 0.8 1.6 10 < 0.02 1 1.07 12 < 0.02 Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings 1.2 0.66 15 < 0.02 VDE AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.1...20 A 1.5 0.50 16 < 0.02 LRoS AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.1...16 A 1.8 0.33 18 < 0.02 CSA / UL 2 0.27 20 < 0.02 AC 250V, DC 28 V AC 115 V, DC 28 V 0.1...16 A 18 ...20 A Issue C ☎ Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Approvals Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 27 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 110/111-P10-G10 Dimensions 110/111-P10-G10-... Installation drawings 110/111-P10(-A3-)G10-OB../-WB.. 110-P10-G10-OB../WB../-OT../WT-... tightening torque 1.5 Nm 1/2-32 UN-2A 10° operating area 5 5 5 5 5 mounting area 36 terminal for illumination (type 111 only) 110-P10-A3-G10-OB../WB../-OT../WT-... operating area blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 43.3 20 20.5 24.4 24.5 9.5 1 32 12 20.5 16 ø4.6 5.5 15 12.7 -0.1 5 32 mounting hole 5 5 5 5 mounting area 111-P10-G10-OB../WB../-OT../WT-... 16 operating area 12 -0.1 8 20.5 12.7 24.5 110/111-P10(-A3-)G10-OT../-WT.. 12 15 5.5 5 32 SW mounting area 111-P10-A3-G10-OB../WB../-OT../WT-... Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 10000 operating area 24.5 0.1 -2.5 A Trip time in seconds 1000 15 15 5 32 3 - 20 A 5 mounting area 100 Internal connection diagrams 10 110-P10-... 111-P10-... 1 1 1 2 2 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 28 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 5 Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 120-P50/124-... Description Single pole switch/thermal circuit breaker (S-type TO CBE to EN 60934) for snap-in panel mounting. Available in rocker (120-P50) or push/push (124-P50) switch versions. Under overload the actuator returns to the OFF position. Typical applications Extra low voltage automotive and marine wiring systems. 1 120-P50 Ordering information Technical data Type No. 120 snap-in panel mounting type with rocker operation 124 snap-in panel mounting type with push/push button Mounting (type 124 only) F10 mounting depth 36.5 mm F20 mounting depth 38 mm Terminal design P50 blade terminals 4.8x0.8 mm Shunt terminal (optional) A3 blade terminal 4.8x0.8 Current ratings 3...20 A 124 - F10 - P50 - A3 - 4A 124-...-P50 ordering example Voltage rating DC 28 V Current ratings Typical life 3...20 A 10,000 operations at IN Ambient temperature -30 ... +80 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 2.5 kV Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 500 V Interrupting capacity Icn 160 A Vibration 120: 10 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz) 124: 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 40 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 168 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Pollution degree 2 Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω)x10-3 Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω)x10-3 Humidity 144 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca 3 67 10 < 20 Mass 3.5 67 12 < 20 120: approx. 23 g 124: approx. 27 g 4 67 15 < 20 4.5 49 16 < 20 5 38 20 < 20 7.5 26 Approvals (type 120) Authority CSA Voltage ratings DC 28 V Issue C ☎ Current ratings 3...15 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 29 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 120-P50/124-... Dimensions 120-P50 Dimensions 124-... 3 3 fully pressed down 2.5 OFF 1.3 -0.3 21.6 40.5 32.5 44.5 36.5 22 34 26 1 30 4 11 0 2.5 16 ON bright red indicator band, visible in OFF position ON position 6 -0.3 OFF position 3 -0.3 panel thickness 5 to 7 mm panel thickness 1 to 2 mm 124-F10-P50 20 10 mounting cut-out blade terminal DIN 46244-A4.8-0.8-Ms 38 42 33 min. 1 3.5 R 36.5 +0.3 mounting cut-out 16 25 min. 2 20.5 +0.3 41 21 11 +0.2 R 350 29 R 150 4 4 -A3 terminal 4.5 36 -A3 terminal panel thickness 5 to 7 mm or panel thickness 1 to 2 mm blade terminal DIN 46244-A4.8-0.8-Ms 38.1 +0.2 R3 21.1 +0.2 .2 R1-0 .5 Internal connection diagram Typical time/current characteristics 10000 +23°C 4 -30°C -A3 terminal 1 1.3 -0.3 OFF 4 21 11 blade terminal DIN 46244-A4.8-0.8-Ms 38 42 33 .5 R3 23 16 100 .2 R3 1+0.1 2±0.1 sunk mounting 0.1 20 38.1 +0.2 2 +0.1 5 R3. 38.1 +0.2 -0.1 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 ☎ +0.1 min. 2 +0.2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 2 R1 -0.5 21.1 2 21.1+0.2 1 raised mounting min. 2 1+0.1 1 mounting cut-out mounting cut-out 2±0.1 10 R1 -0.5 1+0.1 Trip time in seconds 6 -0.3 +80°C 1000 30 21.6 42 46 38 34 2 ON 2.5 (A3) 3 -0.3 bright red indicator band, visible in OFF position (3) fully pressed down 124-F20-P50 1 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 127-... Description Single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset, tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934: M-type when fitted with optional manual release feature). Available in versions for plug-in or integral mounting, track mounting, or with a frame for snap-in panel mounting. The optional -KF housing is particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, battery chargers, extra low voltage systems. Accessories 1 10F-P10 10-F-K10 10F-A10 Y 301 166 02 Y 301 166 01 X 210 589 01 X 210 589 02 X 210 588 01 X 210 588 02 X 210 588 03 X 210 588 04 Modular snap-together surface mounted sockets, each accommodating two plug-in circuit breakers. With push-on terminals. As above but with screw terminals. As above but with a combination of screw and push-on terminals. Two-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10F-K10/-A10 sockets. Four-way brass connecting/bus bar links. Fifty-way 1.5mm2 cable links with pre-fitted connection lugs for type 10F-K10/-A10 sockets. As above but with 2.5mm2 cable links. 100-way 1.5mm2 cable links with pre-fitted push-on connectors for type 10F-P10 sockets, brown As above, but with 2.5mm2 cable links, black. As above, but with 2.5mm2 cable links, red. As above, but with 2.5mm2 cable links, blue. Ordering information Type No. 127 Mounting options leave blank for integral/plug-in option F for snap-in mounting T11 track mounting with captive stud terminals T12 track mounting with screw terminals Terminal design (for use with and without flange -F) P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 K10 screw terminals M4x6 Manual release (optional) H manual release facility Special housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Current ratings 0.05...25 A 127 - F - P10 - H - - 10 A Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Internal resistance (Ω) 280 127-T11-... Technical data Voltage rating Current ratings AC 250 V; DC 28 V (type -F) DC 28 V (type -T) 0.05...25 A Typical life 5,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -20...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) type -F: 0.05 ...2.5 A 3... 5 A 6...12 A 13...25 A type -T: 0.05...2.5 A 3... 5 A 6...25 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Current rating (A) 1.5 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.6 0.08 100 1.8 0.1 110 2 0.3 0.15 56 2.5 0.2 0.2 29 3 0.1 0.25 18 3.5 0.06 0.3 14 4 0.06 8 x IN 20 x IN 200 A 400 A 8 x IN 20 x IN 400 A Vibration 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Db Mass 127-F-..: approx. 24 g 127-T..-: approx. 35 g ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Current rating (A) 0.05 127-F-... 0.4 0.35 9.8 4.5 0.05 0.4 7 5 0.05 0.45 5.9 6 0.02 0.5 4.9 7 0.02 0.6 3.4 8 0.02 Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings 0.7 2.5 10 < 0.02 VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...25 A 0.8 1.8 15 < 0.02 CSA, UL AC 250 V 0.1...16 A 0.9 1.5 16 < 0.02 LRoS AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.2...25 A 1 1.2 20 < 0.02 Semko (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...25 A 1.2 0.8 25 < 0.02 Type 127-T..- approvals N/A Issue C ☎ Approvals Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 31 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 127-... Dimensions Installation drawings 127-F-P10-H 127-F ø4 45 6.5 ON 11.5 OFF 2 operating area 9.4 1 19.8 11.5 31 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 127-T11 operating area max. 2 max. 2 16 14.5±0.2 mounting area 41.5 a b 127-T11 34 34 53 II 1 b I 38±0.1 34 53 26 a 38.4±0.1 1-2.5 2.6-4 31 ø4 11.5 127-T12 operating area max. 2 63 52 47 6 ON 12 OFF mounting area 13 1 spacing 14 44 34 34 53 34 53 26 7 M4 tightening torque for M4 max. 1.2 Nm 54 max. 2 127-T12 31 ø4 max. 2 G profile EN 50035-G... 11.5 Terminal design 127-F-K10 47 6 ON 52 63 12 OFF mounting area 13 9.4 7 M4 44 14 54 32 tightening torque for M4 max. 1.2 Nm G profile EN 50035-G... ☎ spacing flat head screw M4x6 ISO 1580 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 127-... Internal connection diagram Accessories 1 2 2 68 1 Mounting sockets 10F-P10 1 8 2 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 0.05 - 2.5 A 1 30 1 12 6 9.5 1 1000 2 50 1 5.6 3 - 30 A wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 12 2 10000 1 10F-K10 Trip time in seconds 7.5 7 15 45 13 75 100 10F-A10 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 8 1 2 1 2 59 10 1 7 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 0.1 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Accessories for sockets 2-way bus bar Y 301 166 02 7.9 4.2 4-way bus bar Y 301 166 01 8.5 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 2.9 2 12.5 1 15 15 t = 0.8 15 15 52.9 22.9 Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 (black) X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 (brown) 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper ~70 ø2.5 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5 mm2 (brown) X 210 588 02/2.5 mm2 (black) X 210 588 03/2.5 mm2 (red) X 210 588 04/2.5 mm2 (blue) ~70 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 33 1 34 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 129-L11-H-KF Description Single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset, tease-free, tripfree, snap action mechanism and separate manual release (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Designed for bolt-on mounting with terminal block type 83-P10. The special housing (-KF) supplied as standard, is particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles and marine craft. Accessories 1 83-P10 Surface mounted terminal blocks, each accommodating six bolt-on circuit breakers. Fitted with terminals for push-on connectors. Ordering information Technical data Type No. 129 base mounting and connection Terminal design L11 Manual release H manual release facility Housing KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Current ratings 3...25 A 129 - L11 - H - KF - ...A 129-L11-H-KF ordering example Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 3 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.1 Current rating (A) 8 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.02 3.5 0.06 10 < 0.02 4 0.06 12 < 0.02 4.5 0.05 16 < 0.02 5 0.05 20 < 0.02 6 0.02 25 < 0.02 7 0.02 Voltage rating DC 28 V Current ratings 3...25 A Typical life 5,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -40... +75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity IN 3... 5 A 20 x IN 6...25 A 400 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 32 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (55-2000 Hz),±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) to VG 95210 part 28 Shock 50 g (11 ms) to VG 95210 part 28 Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to VG 95210 Part 2 Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210 Part 7 Mass approx. 25 g Approvals Authority Voltage rating CSA DC 28 V Current rating 3...25 A LRoS DC 28 V 3...25 A BWB (VG 95345 part 9) DC 28 V 6...25 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 35 Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 129-L11-H-KF Dimensions Internal connection diagram ø4 0.8 45 8.5 ON 13.5 OFF 1 1 2 11.5 31 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C ø4.3±0.1 4.3±0.1 8 5±0.1 40 50 10000 1000 Trip time in seconds Accessories Mounting block 83-P10 100 1 16 78 46 M4 12 10 0.1 max. screw length 6 mm tightening torque 1.2 Nm 1 ø6.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 4.7 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 36 7 10 10 13.5 ☎ Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 157/158-... Description Single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset, tease-free, tripfree, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Available in versions for threadneck panel mounting, plug-in or integral mounting. The optional -KF housing is particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, extra low voltage wiring systems. 1 Accessories 157-... 158-... See series 127. Technical data - Also X 200 799 02 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly for type 157. X 200 799 01 As above with the cover bonded to the nut for extra retention. X 200 798 01/02 As X 200 799 02 and 01 above but featuring a slotted knurled ring for wrench front of panel tightening. X 210 739 01 Water splashcover/hex nut assembly for type 157. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Ordering information Type No. 157 threadneck panel mounting * 158 integral or plug-in mounting Terminal design P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 K10 screw terminals M4x6 Special housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Current ratings 0.05...25 A 157 - P10 - - 10 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. *mounting hardware bulk shipped Voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 28 V Current ratings 0.05...25 A Typical life 5,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -20...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacityIcn 0.05...2.5 A 8 x IN 3 ... 5 A 20 x IN 6 ...12 A 200 A 13...25 A 400 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 24 g Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) Internal resisance (Ω) 0.05 280 3 0.1 0.08 100 3.5 0.06 0.1 110 4 0.06 0.2 29 4.5 0.05 0.3 14 5 0.05 0.4 7 6 0.02 0.5 4.9 7 0.02 0.6 3.4 8 0.7 2.5 10 < 0.02 0.8 1.8 12 < 0.02 1 1.2 13 < 0.02 1.2 0.8 15 < 0.02 Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings 1.5 0.6 16 < 0.02 VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...25 A 1.8 0.4 20 < 0.02 CSA, UL AC 250 V 0.1...16 A AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.2...25 A AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...25 A 0.02 Approvals 2 0.3 22 < 0.02 LRoS 2.5 0.2 25 < 0.02 Semko (EN 60934) Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 37 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 157/158-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 157-P10 1 tightening torque max. 1 Nm 3/8-27UNS-2A 1.2 20 OFF 2 45 14 ON 4 8 ø4 1 9.4 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 19.8 10000 0.05 - 2.5 A 3 - 30 A mounting hole ø9.6 -0.1 Trip time in seconds 31 8.9 -0.1 14.5 1000 100 10 158-P10 ø8 ø4 3 20 OFF 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 45 14 ON 7.7 1 9.4 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 19.8 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 14.5 Installation drawings 31 max. 5.4 operating area 9.4 35 157/158-K10 flat head screw M4x6 ISO 1580 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm 1 38 ☎ mounting area Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 157/158-... 2 2 Front panel water splash cover, transparent, Y 300 538 01 and knurled nut Y 300 628 01 X 200 799 02 (IP64) X 200 799 01 (bonded to nut) (IP64) 1 Mounting sockets 10F-P10 68 Accessories for type 157-... 1 Accessories 8 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 10F-K10 30 1 1 Front panel water splash cover, transparent with special knurled nut X 200 798 01 (IP64) X 200 798 02 (bonded to nut) (IP64) wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 12 2 12 2 6 9.5 1 50 1 5.6 1 3/8-27 UNS-2B 7.5 3/8-27 UNS-2B 7 15 45 13 75 10F-A10 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Splash cover (black) with hex nut, without O-ring (IP64) X 210 739 01 1 2 1 2 59 8 3/8-27 UNS-2B 7 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 7.9 12.5 8.5 4.2 4-way bus bar Y 301 166 01 2.9 Accessories for sockets 2-way bus bar Y 301 166 02 15 15 t = 0.8 15 15 52.9 22.9 Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 (black) X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 (brown) 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper ~70 ø2.5 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5 mm2 (brown) X 210 588 02/2.5 mm2 (black) X 210 588 03/2.5 mm2 (red) X 210 588 04/2.5 mm2 (blue) ~70 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 39 1 40 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1110-... Description Single pole switch/thermal circuit breaker (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934) with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism. Designed for snap-in panel mounting utilising keyed round hole or industry standard fuse-holder cut-out dimensions. Featuring an ergonomically styled two colour actuator with indicator band clearly showing the tripped/OFF position. Available with square or circular bezels. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, extra low voltage systems, household and office machines, instrumentation, marine applications. 1 1110-F1.. Accessories Y 304 745 01 Y 305 602 01 Technical data Water splash cover for use with square bezels Terminal shroud, for insulation or dust protection Ordering information Type No. 1110 snap in panel mounting Mounting F1 panel thickness 0.8...1.6 mm F2 panel thickness 1.8...3 mm F3 with location pin; panel thickness 0.8...1.6 mm F4 with location pin, panel thickness 1.8...3 mm Number of poles 1 1 pole protected Actuator style 2 black push button/white indicator ring, standard Other indicator ring colours are available to special order Terminal design P1 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 Characteristic curve M1 medium delay Current ratings 0.05...16 A 1110 - F1 1 2 - P1 M1 - 0.5 A ordering example Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.05 Internal resistance (Ω) 442 Current rating (A) 2 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.25 0.08 123 2.5 0.1 110 3 0.12 27.8 3.5 0.09 0.3 12.4 4 0.07 0.4 7.0 5 0.05 0.5 4.5 6 0.04 0.6 3.1 7 ≤ 0.02 0.7 2.3 8 ≤ 0.02 0.8 1.7 10 ≤ 0.02 1 1.1 12 ≤ 0.02 1.2 0.71 15 ≤ 0.02 1.5 0.41 16 ≤ 0.02 1.8 0.38 ☎ AC 250 V; DC 28 V (DC 50 V to special order) Current ratings 0.05...16 A Typical life 0.05...4 A: 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 5 ...16 A: 6,000 operations at 1 x IN Ambient temperature -20...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 250 V: 0.05...16 A DC 28 V: 0.05... 6 A 7 ...10 A 12 ...16 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077/EN60934 PC 1) IN 0.05... 6 A 7 ...16 A 0.05...16 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 8 g (57-500 Hz)±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 12 g 8 x IN 10 x IN 200 A 300 A UN AC 250 V AC 125 V DC 50 V 1000 A 1000 A 200 A 0.19 0.2 Issue C Voltage rating Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A UL CSA AC 250 V AC 125 V DC 50 V AC 250 V; DC 50 V 0.05... 6 A 7 ... 16 A 0.05...16 A 0.05...16 A LRoS, BV AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.5 ...16 A Semko (EN 60934) AC 250 V 0.05...10 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 41 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1110-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 1110-F1.. / -F2.. / -F3.. / -F4.. 1 When installing the circuit breaker apply pressure on bezel only 19 19 ON black 2.4 white 2 47.5 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 10000 9 12.5 51 0.05 - 6 A 7 - 16 A 12.1 13.2 15.6 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Panel cut out 1110-F1..-P.M1-...A 1110-F2..-P.M1-...A +0.1 13.8 - 0.2 ±0.05 +0.1 +0.2 - 0.4 ±0.05 installation side 0.8 … 1.6 16 ±0.1 Trip time in seconds 1000 100 10 +0.2 - 0.4 13.8 -0.2 1 10 9.5 15 OFF 10 installation side 16 ±0.15 1.8 … 3 1 insertion force ≤20 N, removal force ≥120 N insertion force ≤20 N, removal force ≥120 N 1110-F3..-P.M1-...A 0.1 1110-F4..-P.M1-...A 2.2 +0.2 R0.5 +0.2 - 0.4 ±0.05 17 +0.2 17 installation side 16 ±0.15 installation side 1.8 … 3 16 ±0.15 0.8 … 1.6 Installation drawing 40 20 +0.2 - 0.4 +0.2 ±0.05 6 8 10 2 4 … times rated current 0.6 0.8 1 R0.5 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Accessories - Water splashcovers (transparent) Push button splash cover Y 304 745 01 (IP 54) operating area ø14.5 1.25 17.8 14 When using splashcover please note that the max. panel thickness is reduced by 0.5mm Terminal shroud Y 305 602 01 20.5 60 2.2 +0.2 ø4 3 3 25 25 mounting area 42 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1140-... Description Miniaturised single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Available in versions for panel mounting, snap-in or threadneck, or as an integral type. For lower current ratings see types 104, 105, 106. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, hand-held machines and appliances. Accessories X 201 285 01 1 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly for type 1140-G. Ordering information 1140-G.1. Voltage rating AC 240 V; DC 48 V (DC 50 V UL/CSA) Current ratings 3.5...16 A Typical life 3.5...8 A 1000 operations at 2 x IN 10...16 A 50 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -20...+60 °C (T 60) Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 3.5... 8 A 8 x IN 10...16 A 120 A Interrupting capacity (UL 10777) IN 3.5...16 A 3.5 ... 7A 8 ...16 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40 050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis ordering example *mounting hardware bulk shipped Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 3.5 1140-F... Technical data Type No. 1140 single pole thermal circuit breaker Mounting E2 integral mounting F1 snap-in panel mounting G0 threadneck panel mounting without mounting hardware G1 threadneck panel mounting, with hex nut and knurled nut * G2 threadneck panel mounting, for standard fuseholder cut-out * G4 threadneck panel mounting with metal knurled nut* Number of poles 1 1 pole protected Actuator style 1 black push button Terminal design P1 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 Characteristic curve M1 medium delay Current ratings 3.5...16 A 1140 - F1 1 1 - P1 M1 - 10 A 1140-E... UN DC 50 V AC 250 V AC 250 V Internal resistance (Ω) 0.06 Current rating (A) 10 Internal resistance (Ω) < 0.02 Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 4 0.04 12 < 0.02 Corrosion 5 0.03 13 < 0.02 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 10 g 6 0.02 15 < 0.02 7 < 0.02 16 < 0.02 8 < 0.02 200 A 1000 A 2000 A Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE AC 240 V; DC 28 V 7 ...16 A CSA AC 250 V, DC 50 V 3.5...16 A AC 250 V; DC 50 V 3.5...16 A Semko AC 240 V 7 ...16 A Kema (EN 60934) AC 240 V; DC 48 V 3.5...16 A Issue C ☎ UL Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 43 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1140-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 1140-E211-P1M1 ø7 2 34.5 27.5 4 7.8 11 ON OFF Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly, transparent X 201 285 01 (IP 64) 1 ø4.2 Accessory Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 1 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 10000 19 9 Trip time in seconds 11 1000 hole for mounting screw M2x5 1140-F111-P1M1 10 4 ON 7.8 ø7 1 34.5 27.5 2 OFF 11 ø4.2 100 0.1 1 2 9 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 19 d 0.8 1.0 1.5 2-3 40 a 21.9 22 22.1 22.2 b 11.3+0.3 Installation drawings d b 14 a 20 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 11 panel cut-out 25 4 6 8 10 … times rated current operating area 1140-F... ON 10.8 8 ø4.2 8 8 mounting area 7 OFF 14 tightening torque max. 1 Nm 3/8-27 UNS-2A 8 1140-G111-P1M1 operating area 8 8 34.5 27.5 0.7 1140-E... 8 8 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 mounting area mounting hole operating area 1140-G... 19 8 9 8 ø9.6 -0.1 11 SW 14 8.9 -0.1 8 44 ☎ mounting area 8 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1140-... (2 pole) Description Miniaturised double pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset teasefree, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Threadneck panel mounting. Suitable for line and neutral switching - the thermal actuator operating on one pole simultaneously opens both poles under overload conditions. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, hand-held machines and appliances. Especially suited to AC duties where the correct orientation of line/ neutral is not known/cannot be guaranteed. 1 Accessories 1140-G.5. X 201 285 01 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly. Ordering information Technical data Type No. 1140 double pole threadneck panel mounting Mounting G0 threadneck panel mounting without mounting hardware G1 threadneck panel mounting with hex nut and knurled nut * G2 threadneck panel mounting for standard fuseholder cut-out * G4 threadneck panel mounting with metal knurled nut* Number of poles 5 double pole, 1 pole protected Actuator style 1 black push button Terminal design P7 blade terminals DIN 46244-C Characteristic curve M1 medium delay Current ratings 0.05...16 A 1140 - G1 5 1 - P7 M1 - 16 A ordering example Voltage rating 0.05...16 A Typical life 0.05...3 A 3000 operations at 2 x IN 3.5... 8 A 1000 operations at 2 x IN 10... 16 A 50 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -20...+60 °C (T 60) Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole/pole Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...3 A 3.5... 8 A 10... 16 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) IN 0.05...16 A 0.05...7 A 8...16 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40 050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 13 g *mounting hardware bulk shipped Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.05 Internal resistance (Ω) 345 Current rating (A) 1.8 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.3 0.06 240 2 0.08 142 2.5 0.2 0.1 88 3 0.1 0.2 24 0.3 3.5 0.06 0.3 9.9 4 0.04 0.4 5.9 5 0.03 0.5 3.7 6 0.02 0.6 2.2 7 < 0.02 0.7 1.9 8 < 0.02 0.8 1.4 10 < 0.02 1 0.9 12 < 0.02 1.2 0.6 15 < 0.02 1.5 0.5 16 < 0.02 AC 240 V; DC 48 V (DC 50 V UL/CSA) Current ratings 6 x IN 8 x IN 120 A UN DC 50 V AC 250 V AC 250 V 200 A 1000 A 2000 A Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE AC 240 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A UL, CSA AC 250 V; DC 50 V 0.05...16 A Kema (EN 60934) AC 240 V; DC 48 V 0.05...16 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 45 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1140-... (2 pole) Dimensions Internal connection diagram 1 ON ø4.2 3 7 0.7 14 tightening moment max. 1 Nm 3/ -27 UNS-2A 8 10.8 OFF 1140-G15... 49.5 4 2 1 blade terminal DIN 46244-C mounting hole SW 14 11 ø9.6 -0.1 Typical time/current characteristics 9 10000 8,9 -0.1 19 0.05 - 3 A 3.5 - 16 A 1000 Trip time in seconds ON ø4.2 7 100 10 49.5 0.7 14 tightening torque max. 0.5 Nm 3/8-27 UNS-2A 10.8 OFF 1140-G25... 13.8 +0.15 -0.1 1 mounting holes 11 ø9.6 -0.1 blade terminal DIN 46244-C 9 8,9 -0.1 19 panel thickness >0.8 ø16±0.1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Accessories Installation drawing Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly, transparent X 201 285 01 (IP 64) 8 8 operating area mounting area 46 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1160-... Description Thermal circuit breaker, with controlled self-resetting mechanism, specially suited to installation in inaccessible locations. Under overload conditions the circuit breaker contacts will open to protect the load circuit. A low current excitation circuit ensures that the contacts remain open thereby avoiding the hazards of automatic reset operation. The circuit breaker is reset by switching off the supply circuit for a short period. Typical applications Automotive and marine extra low voltage wiring systems and components. 1 1160-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 1160 single pole plug-in type Design standard 02 standard version 12 V Current ratings 12, 15, 20, 30 A Voltage rating DC 12 V Current ratings 12...30 A Typical life 300 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Holding current < 0.6 A 1160 - 02 - 12A Reset time at 23°C after 5 s of load with UN < 35 sec ordering example Standard current ratings and typical voltage drop values Current rating (A) Voltage drop (mV) 12 < 150 15 < 150 20 < 150 30 < 150 Issue C ☎ Interrupting capacity (o-o-o) 200 A, L/R = 2.5 ms Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 54 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 6 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 47 Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1160-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 25.1 1 2.2 17.5 23.8 1 7.6 2 9.3 2.5 5.2 0.8 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 9.9 9.2 10000 Accessories Sockets available to special order. Trip time in seconds 1000 100 10 1 0.1 0.6 0.8 1 6 8 10 2 4 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 48 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1170-... Description Compact single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset, tease free, trip free, snap action mechanism and separate (colour coded) manual release. Combining full feature circuit breaker protection and convenience with low cost of ownership benefits. Fitted with blade terminals for plug-in mounting. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles and marine craft. 1 1170-... Accessories 12-J20 12-P10 12-P10-20 12-P10-30 12-P10-40 12-P10-60 X 210 588 01 X 210 588 02 X 211 157 01 X 211 157 02 Technical data single mounting socket with screw terminals for DIN rail mounting single mounting socket with .250 quick connect terminals for DIN rail mounting 2-way mounting socket 3-way mounting socket 4-way mounting socket 6-way mounting socket 100-way 1.5mm2/AWG 16 cable links with pre-fitted push-on connectors for type 12-P10 mounting socket as above, but with 2.5mm2/AWG 14 cable links Bus bar with terminal Bus bar without terminal Type No. 1170 plug-in Design standard 01 blade terminals for automotive fuse blocks (standard) with retaining clips 02 blade terminals for automotive fuse blocks, without retaining clips 21 as design 01 but with higher interrupting capacity 22 as design 02 but with higher interrupting capacity 31 blade terminals for automotive fuse blocks with retaining clips and ribs for higher pull-out force Current ratings 5...25 A DC 28 V (AC to special order) Current ratings 5...25 A Typical life 6,000 operations at IN 3,000 operations at 2 x IN ≤ 20 A 1,000 operations at 2 x IN 25 A Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Interrupting capacity Icn 5...15 A 200 A (1170-01/-02/-31) 5...15 A 400 A (1170-21/-22) (higher capacity to special order) 20...25 A 400 A Ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity Ordering information 1170 - 01 - 15 A Voltage rating ≥ 1 break operation at 2000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (57-500 Hz)±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 50 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 13 g ordering example Standard current ratings, typical voltage drop values and actuator colours (manual release) Current rating (A) Voltage drop (mV) Actuator colour 5 < 150 orange-brown (approximating RAL 8023) 6 < 150 mossy-green 7.5 < 150 hazel (approximating RAL 8011) 8 < 150 honey (approximating RAL 1005) 10 < 150 red (approximating RAL 3020) 15 < 150 blue (approximating RAL 5012) 20 < 150 yellow (approximating RAL 1018) 25 < 150 pearl (approximating RAL 1013)* (approximating RAL 6005) *= off-white (without dye) with ultradur Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 49 Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1170-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 1 3 ON ø4 3 7 OFF 1170-01/-21 38 2 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 6.4 7.6 1 10000 0.6+0.23 max. 9.8 5.2 14.5 18.8 3.6 4.2 terminal area to DIN 72581 part 3 1000 Trip time in seconds 20 22 current rating without A 3 ON ø4 10 3 7 OFF 1170-02/-22 100 38 1 7.6 0.1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 6.4 1 0.6+0.23 5.2 3.6 14.5 max. 9.8 18.8 4.2 terminal area to DIN 72581 part 3 20 22 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.84 0.88 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 current rating without A ON ø4 3 3 7 OFF 1170-31 38 18.8 16.6 4.2 7.6 6.4 0.6 15.2 max. 9.8 5.2 14.5 18 0.6+0.23 3.6 terminal area to DIN 72581 part 3 5.3 20 22 current rating without A 50 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1170-... Accessories Ordering information Mounting socket 12 Socket 12-P10 30.3 25.4 Weidmüller style label (not supplied) 3.5 47 43 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Type No. 12 Mounting socket Terminal design P10 blade terminals A 6.3-0.8 J20 screw terminals 6-32 UNC A10 1 blade terminal A6.3-0.8 / 1 screw terminal 6-32 UNC Version ... blank: single socket 20 two-way 30 three-way 40 four-way 60 six-way 58 12 - P10 - 20 1 ordering example ø3.9 12.7 symmetrical hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 48.4 Accessories for mounting socket 12 Socket 12-J20 30.3 25.4 Weidmüller style label (not supplied) terminal screw 6-32 UNC Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5 mm2 (brown) X 210 588 02/2.5 mm2 (black) 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated ~70 3.5 43 47 spring washer 58 ø3.9 12.7 symmetrical hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 48.4 Bus bar X 211 157 01 with terminal X 211 157 02 without terminal Socket 12-A10 30.3 25.4 Weidmüller style label (not supplied) cylinder head screw ISO1207-M4x4 nickel plated 2 terminal screw 6-32 UNC washer A 4.3 DIN 125 nickel plated 10 3.5 43 47 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 7 12.8 154.8 58 symmetrical hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 ø3.9 12.7 spring washer 48.4 Dimensions for surface mounting 60 7 13 ø4 48.4 Other sockets available to special order Labels: Weidmüller, D-33102 Paderborn Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 51 1 52 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1410-F1... Description Miniaturised single pole rocker switch/thermal circuit breaker combining ON/OFF switching and extremely fast overload performance in a single component (S-type TO CBE to EN 60934/IEC 934). Under overload conditions an internal neon (filament bulb for low voltages) illuminates to give a clear signal of the tripped status of the mechanism and thereby the cause of power interruption, suffix -B. Alternatively the illumination can be conventionally wired to indicate the ON status of the device, suffix -E. Returning the rocker switch through the OFF position and back ON will reset the mechanism and restore the supply. Largely temperature-insensitive. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 1 Motors, transformers, solenoids, PCBs, hand-held machines, appliances, instrumentation. Ordering information Technical data Type No. 1410 snap-in panel mounting type Mounting F snap-in panel mounting Size of frame 1 to fit mounting cut-out 28 x 12.7 mm Number of poles 1 single pole, thermally protected Accessories 0 without accessories Terminal design P1 blade terminals 2.8-0.8 Characteristic curve F1 fast acting Actuator style W rocker, rounded profile Actuator colour 14 red translucent Actuator markings Q I and 0 Trip/ON illumination (optional) B illuminated when tripped E illuminated when ON Voltage range (optional) 2 20- 28V marked 24V 35mA 3 90-140V marked 115V <1mA 4 185-275V marked 230V <1mA Current ratings 0.63...10 A 1410 - F 1 1 0 - P1 F1 - W 14 Q E 3-2A Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values 0.8 Internal resistance (Ω) 1.05 1.0 Current rating (A) Voltage rating Current rating range Typical life circuit 1-3 AC 240 V; DC 28 V (DC 48 UL/CSA) 0.63...10 A protection circuit 1-2 Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Current rating (A) 0.63 1410-F1.. Corrosion Humidity Mass 30,000 operations for IN ≤ 6.3 A AC/DC 10,000 operations for IN > 6,3 A AC 3,000 operations for IN > 6,3 A DC 300 operations at 2 x IN -20 ... +60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 1500 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.63...2.5 A 12 x IN 3.15 ...10 A 8 x IN AC, max. 70 A 3.15 ...10 A 10 x IN DC or to UL 1077 at AC 125/DC 48 V: 200 A operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 20 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 48 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 96 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 9 g Internal resistance (Ω) 3.15 < 0.1 4 < 0.1 Approvals 1 <1 5 < 0.1 Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings 1.5 <1 6.3 < 0.1 SEV (EN 60934) 1.8 < 0.8 8 < 0.1 2 < 0.8 10 < 0.1 AC 240 V DC 28 V AC 125 V 0.63... 4 A 0.63... 8 A 0.63...10 A 2.5 < 0.12 DC 48 V 0.63... 8 A Issue C ☎ CSA, UL Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 53 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1410-F1... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 1410-F...-....-....B. 1410-F...-....-....B. 1410-F...-....-....E. 20° 16 45 ° 20 ° 1 13.5 6 17 32 27.6 5 OFF 1.5 1 LINE 3 ON 3 2 1 LINE 4 2 6.5 1 9 9.5 3 21.2 23.2 N.B. When the circuit breaker trips electrically terminal 2 (and 3) remain live (illumination voltage). 5.1 blade terminal DIN 46244-C blade terminal DIN 46244-A2.8-0.8 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 1 12 7.5 8.8 1 12 23.5 10000 2.1 32.3 1000 Trip time in seconds 10.4 illuminated trip indication 21.2 20° 16 1410-F...-....-....E. 100 10 45° 20° 20° 1 13.5 1 17 6 32 27.6 0.1 5 1.5 OFF 3 ON 6.5 0.01 23.2 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 3 2 21.2 1 9 9.5 Installation drawing 2.8 5.1 blade terminal DIN 46244-C 11.5 12 1 7.5 8.8 12 1 23.5 operating area 2.1 blade terminal DIN 46244-A2.8-0.8 32.3 10 10.4 illuminated trip indication 21.2 sharp edged 54 32 0.8 … 3 28 +0.2 12.7 +0.3 mounting hole ☎ R 0. 2 +0 .2 10 10 10 10 mounting area Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1410-L/-G... Description Single pole press-to-reset thermal circuit breaker with extremely fast overload switching performance (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Single hole threadneck, PCB or integral mounting with a choice of designs. Miniaturised construction minimises PCB real estate required. Type 1410-L2 and 1410-G1 versions feature changeover contacts suitable for providing status output signals. Largely temperature-insensitive. Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, PCBs, hand-held machines, appliances, instrumentation. 1 1410-L1... Ordering information L 1 1 0 - L1 F1 - S 01 - 0.8 A Voltage rating Current rating range 1-2 Auxiliary circuit 1-3 Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity (o-o-o) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration ordering example Shock Corrosion Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.63 Internal resistance (Ω) 1.2 1410-G1... Technical data Type No. 1410 single pole circuit breaker Configuration L PCB mounting G threadneck panel mounting Mounting 1 threadneck 3/8-27 UNS-2A (1410-G) 1 PCB 16.3x4.6 grid (1410-L) 2 PCB 10.15x7.62 grid (1410-L) Number of poles 1 1 pole, thermally protected Hardware 0 without 1 with hex nut and knurled nut (1410-G only) bulk shipped Terminal design L1 solder pins 1.8x0.8 silver-plated (-L1 only) L2 solder pins 1x0.8 silver-plated (-L2 and -G1 only) P2 blade terminals A2.8-0.8 silver-plated (-G1 only) Characteristic curve F1 fast acting Actuator S manual re-set Actuator colour 01 black (for -G1.. and -L1..) 02 white (for -L2..) Current ratings 0.63 ... 10 A 1410- 1410-L2... Current rating (A) 3.15 Internal resistance (Ω) < 0.1 0.8 1.0 4 < 0.1 1 0.7 4.5 < 0.1 < 0.1 Humidity Mass AC 240 V; DC 28 V (DC 48 V UL/CSA) 0.63...10 A 0.2 x IN max. 1 A, AC 250 V style -L2 and -G1 only 300 operations at 2 x IN (-L2...) 500 operations at 2 x IN (-L1../-G1..) -20...+100 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 1500 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.63...2.5 A 12 x IN 3.15...10 A 8 x IN AC, max. 70 3.15...10 A 10 x IN DC or to UL 1077 at AC 125/DC 48 V: 200 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 20 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 48 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 96 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 5 g Approvals 1.25 < 0.8 5 1.5 < 0.8 6.3 < 0.1 Authority Voltage rating Current ratings 1.8 < 0.8 8 < 0.1 VDE AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.63... 8 A 2 < 0.8 10 < 0.1 UL, CSA AC 125 V; DC 48 V 0.63... 8 A (-L2/-G1) 2.5 < 0.5 DC 50 V 0.63...10 A (-L1) Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 55 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1410-L/-G... Dimensions Internal connection diagrams 1410-L110-L1F1-S01 1410-L11... 12.8 8.6 12.5 1410-L21... 1410-G11... 2 3 2 1 1 5 15 17 20.1 1.8 0.8 4.6 ±0.2 1.8 25 mounting holes 1 Typical time/current characteristics at 23°C 16.3 ±0.2 6 ±0.2 1410-L210-L2F1-S02 10000 32.5 9 1.4 28 1000 10 0.8 30 2 1 1 0.8 Trip time in seconds 3.1 0.4 5 3 6.4 10.15 mounting holes 7.6 7.5 3.8 3 2 1 +0.1 10.15- 0.2 6.4 ±0.2 100 10 1 7.6 ±0.1 1410-G111-L2F1-S01 3/8-27UNS-2A 0.1 0.01 1 11.7 3 2 1 0.8 1 0.4 3.1 3 7 11 0.7 ø7 6.4 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 9 10.15 7.6 Installation drawings 15.7 8.8 mounting hole 8.9 - 0.1 28 11 2 1410-L11... operating area 13 wall made of insulating material ø9.6 - 0.1 1 SW14 1410-G111-P2F1-S01 3/8-27UNS-2A 3 11 mounting area 1410-G... 3 0.4 7.6 11.7 7 0.7 ø7 2.8 6.4 2 1 operating area 0.8 10.15 wall made of insulating material 9 15.7 8.8 11 ~20° mounting hole 8.9 - 0.1 7.6 28 mounting area 13 SW14 56 ☎ ø9.6 - 0.1 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1610-... Description Miniaturised single pole press-to-reset thermal circuit breaker designed for automotive fuse block installation. Extends the benefits of circuit breaker performance and convenience to applications which are cost critical. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles and marine craft. 1 1610-21 Accessories 12-J20 12-P10 12-P10-20 12-P10-30 12-P10-40 12-P10-60 X 210 588 01 X 210 588 02 X 211 157 01 X 211 157 02 Technical data single mounting socket with screw terminals for DIN rail mounting single mounting socket with .250 quick connect terminals for DIN rail mounting 2-way mounting socket 3-way mounting socket 4-way mounting socket 6-way mounting socket 100-way 1.5mm2/AWG 16 cable links with pre-fitted push-on connectors for type 12-P10 mounting socket as above, but with 2.5mm2/AWG 14 cable links Bus bar with terminal Bus bar without terminal Voltage rating Current ratings Service short-circuit breaking capacity Ambient temperature Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity Ordering information Type No. 1610 single pole automotive circuit breaker Voltage rating 21 DC 24 V 22 DC 12 V H1 DC 12 V, with manual release facility Current ratings 6 8 10 15 20 25 A 1610 - 21 - 8 A ordering example Vibration (with mounting socket) Shock (with mounting socket) Corrosion Humidity Mass Current ratings,typical voltage drop values and actuator colours Current rating (A) 1610-22 Voltage drop (mV) Actuator colour (manual release) 6 < 200 mossy-green 8 < 200 honey (approximating RAL 1005) 10 < 200 red (approximating RAL 3020) 15 < 200 blue (approximating RAL 5012) 20 < 200 yellow (approximating RAL 1018) 25 < 200 pearl (approximating RAL 1013)* 1610-21: DC 24 V 1610-22: DC 12 V 6...25 A 1610-21: 300 operations at ≤ 50 A 1610-22: 500 operations at ≤ 50 A -30...+60 °C operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 1610-21: ≥ 3 break operations at 150 A, or ≥ 1 break operation at 2000 A 1610-22: ≥ 3 break operations at 200 A, or ≥ 1 break operation at 2000 A 5 g (57-500 Hz),±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 25 g (ll ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca approx. 5 g N.B. It is good practice to switch off the vehicle's ignition system before resetting the circuit breaker. Free travel of the actuator must be ensured. (approximating RAL 6005) *= off-white (without dye) with ultradur Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 57 Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1610-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 1 6 0.8 ON 3.8 OFF 1610-21 20.3 2.7 28.8 24 2 Typical time/current characteristic curve 6.4 7.5 1 10000 0.6 5.2 +60°C +23°C 3.3 14.5 -30°C 3.9 16.6 1000 1610-22 20.3 Please leave space for button travel 3.4 6 2.7 Trip time in seconds 18.8 100 4 10 7.5 24 1 0.1 6.4 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 0.6 5.2 3.3 14.5 3.9 16.6 18.8 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 1610-H1 20.3 6 6.4 7.5 29.5 3.6 24 0.8 ON 4 OFF 7.3 5.2 0.6 14.5 3.3 16.6 3.9 18.8 58 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 1610-... Accessories Ordering information Mounting socket 12 Socket 12-P10 30.3 25.4 Weidmüller style label (not supplied) 3.5 43 47 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Type No. 12 Mounting socket Terminal design P10 blade terminals A 6.3-0.8 J20 screw terminals 6-32 UNC A10 1 blade terminal A6.3-0.8 / 1 screw terminal 6-32 UNC Version ... blank: single socket 20 two-way 30 three-way 40 four-way 60 six-way 58 12 - P10 - 20 1 ordering example 48.4 ø3.9 12.7 symmetrical hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 Accessories for mounting socket 12 Socket 12-J20 30.3 25.4 Weidmüller style label (not supplied) terminal screw 6-32 UNC 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated ~70 3.5 43 47 spring washer Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5 mm2 (brown) X 210 588 02/2.5 mm2 (black) 58 48.4 ø3.9 12.7 symmetrical hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 Bus bar X 211 157 01 with terminal X 211 157 02 without terminal Socket 12-A10 30.3 25.4 Weidmüller style label (not supplied) cylinder head screw ISO1207-M4x4 nickel plated 2 terminal screw 6-32 UNC washer A 4.3 DIN 125 nickel plated 10 3.5 47 43 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 7 12.8 154.8 58 symmetrical hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 48.4 ø3.9 12.7 spring washer Dimensions for surface mounting 60 7 13 ø4 48.4 Other sockets available to special order Labels: Weidmüller, D-33102 Paderborn Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 59 1 60 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1658-... Description Very cost effective design to meet international requirements. No exposed metal parts which are, or could become, current-carrying except for terminals. ● Manual reset, trip free mechanism ● Extremely small and lightweight ● UL, CSA, VDE approved Typical applications 1 Battery chargers, consumer products, power supplies, motors. 1658-... Accessories Y 306 671 01 Y 303 200 01 Y 300 190 03 Y 302 294 03 Y 300 192 01 Y 302 295 01 Y 301 059 02 Y 302 732 01 Y 303 051 01 X 200 799 01 X 201 285 01 Technical data Mounting nut 3/8", 27-thread Mounting nut 7/16", 28-thread Knurled nut 3/8", 27-thread Knurled nut 7/16" - 28-thread Hex nut 3/8", 27-thread Hex nut 7/16", 28-thread Press to Reset Plate for 3/8", 27-thread, aluminium Press to Reset Plate for 7/16", 28-thread, aluminium Black Plastic Knurled Nut for 3/8", 27-thread Reset Button Seal - long Reset Button Seal - short Ordering information Type No. 1658 single pole thermal circuit breaker Threadneck design G21 manual reset type, 3/8"-27 threadneck G41 manual reset type, 7/16"-32 threadneck A21 auto reset type, 3/8"-27 threadneck A41 auto reset type, 7/16"-32 threadneck A00 auto reset type, without threadneck Hardware 00 no hardware 01 one hex nut, bulk 02 one hex nut, one hex nut, bulk 03 one hex nut mounted 04 one hex nut, one hex nut, mounted 05 one hex nut, knurled nut, bulk 06 one knurled nut, bulk 07 one knurled nut, mounted 08 two hex nuts, bulk Terminals P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 P13 blade terminals A6.3-0.8, 90° S80 straight screw terminals* S83 90° bent screw terminals* Current ratings 5 ... 25 A Voltage rating Current ratings Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077/EN 60934 PC1) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 28 V 5...25 A 1000 operations at 2 x IN -20...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 Test voltage AC 3000 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 200 A IN UN 5...15 A AC 250 V 2000 A 20...25 A AC 125 V 2000 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 16 g 1658 - G21 - 02 - P10 - 5 A Ordering example * Screws and lock washers bulk shipped Standard current ratings and typical voltage drop values Authority Voltage rating VDE AC 250 V; DC 28 V UL, CSA AC 250 V 5...15 A 1658-G... ≤ 140 AC 125 V 20..25 A 1658-G... 15 ≤ 240 AC 125 V 5...25 A 1658-A... 20 ≤ 240 25 ≤ 240 Current rating (A) 5 Voltage drop (mV) ≤ 150 Current rating (A) Voltage drop (mV)) 10 ≤ 140 6 ≤ 150 12 7 ≤ 150 8 ≤ 150 9 ≤ 150 Issue C ☎ Approvals Current ratings 5...25 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 61 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1658-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 0.7 12.7 ON 27 OFF 6 0.5 1 ø6 2 2 12 1 17.5 1 Typical time/current characteristics at 23°C 14 13.6 15.7 10000 32 A00 mounting hole 9.6 -0.1 1000 8.9 -0.1 A21 3/8-27UNS G21 Trip time in seconds 3/8-27UNS 100 4 10 mounting hole 10.2 ±0.1 10 1 A41 0.1 11.2 ±0.1 1 10 7/16-28 double “D” G41 2 4 6 8 10 ... times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Terminal design See ordering information for mounting hardware S83 3 P10 Installation drawing 2 1 2 12 1 8.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 operating area lock washer P10-S83 3 P13 terminal screw 6-32 UNC 7 1 1 2 1 8.5 2 34 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 angled 90° S80 5 5 2 4 terminal screw lock washer 6-32 UNC blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 4 2 12 1 mounting area terminal screw 6-32 UNC 62 ☎ lock washer Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 1658-... Accessories Mounting nut 3/8", 27-thread Y 306 671 01 14.3 Mounting nut 7/16", 28-thread Y 303 200 01 16 2.5 3 0.5 0.5 for 3/8, 27UNS-2B for 7/16, 28UNEF-2B Knurled nut 3/8", 27-thread nickel-plated brass Y 300 190 03 ø13 Knurled nut 7/16", 28-thread nickel-plated brass Y 302 294 03 ø16 2.5 3.2 7/16-28UNEF-2B 3/8-27UNS-2B Hex nut 3/8", 27-thread nickel-plated brass Y 300 192 01 3/8-27UNS-2B Hex nut 7/16", 28-thread nickel-plated brass Y 302 295 01 2.5 7/16-28UNEF-2B SW14 ® T E-T - T SE PR SS E ø9.9 BR E A R R S TO RE A 0.4 KE BREA KE E-T - ø24 0.4 PR ES Press to Reset Plate for 7/16", 28-thread, aluminium Y 302 732 01 SE ø21.4 ® 2.5 SW14 Press to Reset Plate for 3/8", 27-thread, aluminium Y 301 059 02 A 1 T O RE ø11.2+0.7 Press to Reset Plate for 3/8", 27-thread plastic Y 303 051 01 3/8-27 UNS-2B BREA SS TO RE R E SE PR 0.4x45° T E-T - ® KE A 1.6 3.18 ø18.8±0.2 Reset button seal for 3/8", 27-thread short long X 201 285 01 X 200 799 01 3/8-27 UNS-2B 3/8-27 UNS-2B Version with 7/16", 28-thread to special order Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 63 1 64 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Description An extremely versatile range of rocker switch/thermal circuit breakers (S-type TO CBE to EN 60934) offering the choice of single pole, double pole with single pole protection, and double pole with protection on both poles. Designed for snap-in panel mounting with versions available for three different panel cut-out sizes. Neon illumination is optional (filament bulb for low voltages) and there is a range of colours and markings for the rocker. Under overload conditions the rocker returns to the OFF position. Any one of the following additional function modules can be supplied factory fitted to the rear of the switch/circuit breaker. ● Under voltage release coil (for double pole versions only). ● Magnetic trip coil for short circuit protection. ● Magnetic trip coil for remote relay trip. ● Auxiliary contacts for status signalling. ● Mechanical slide interlock. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 1 3120-F... Technical data Motors, transformers, solenoids, extra low voltage wiring systems, office machines, electro-medical equipment, power supplies, communications systems. Voltage rating Current ratings Typical life Accessories Y 303 068 01 Insulated cover, snap-fitted to the exposed areas of the two incoming terminals (when terminal screws are not specified) to provide brush contact protection. Terminal adapter to convert screw terminals to push on connections when factory fitted under voltage release module is specified (two adapters required per unit). Retaining clip for -F3 mounting frame for panel thickness under 2 mm. As above for panel thickness under 4 mm. As above, for -F5 mounting frame. Blanking piece in -F3 size mounting frame. Rear terminal shroud. Separate water splash cover for use with -F4 and -F5 size mounting frames. Y 303 862 01 Y 303 675 01 Y 303 675 02 Y 303 676 01 Y 303 885 31 Y 304 275 01 X 221 619 01 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.1 Current rating (A) 3.5 Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 94 0.2 24 0.3 12 Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 0.0565 4 0.0435 4.5 0.0435 0.4 5.30 5 0.0325 0.5 4.20 6 0.0215 0.6 2.90 7 0.0165 0.8 1.50 8 0.0165 1 0.9 10 <0.02 1.2 0.80 12 <0.02 1.5 0.45 14 <0.02 2 0.27 16 <0.02 2.5 0.0785 18 < 0.02 3 0.0595 20 < 0.02 Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area between poles (2 pole) Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 50 V 0.1...20 A (up to 30 A to special order) 50,000 operations for IN ≤16 A double pole 30,000 operations for IN ≤16 A single pole, 10,000 operations for IN >16 A -30...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.1...2 A 2.5...20 A 10 x IN 250 A 2 pole, or 150 A 1 pole IN UN 2 pole 0.1... 2 A AC 250 V 200 A 2.5... 3 A AC 250 V 1000 A 3.5... 8 A AC 250 V 2000 A 9 ... 16 A AC 250 V 3500 A 18... 20 A AC 250 V 5000 A 0.1...20 A DC 50 V 1000 A operating area IP 40 (IP 54 with water splash protection) terminal area IP 00 8 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca approx. 33 g (double pole) approx. 27 g (single pole) Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Semko AC 240 V, DC 28 V 0.1...20 A DC 50 V 0.1...20 A double pole (EN 60934) DC 50 V 0.1...10 A single pole BV, LRoS AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.1...20 A UL, CSA AC 250 V, DC 50 V 0.1...20 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 65 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Internal connection diagrams 2 pole, 2 pole, thermally protected on both poles thermally protected on one pole only 12(i) 5 42-54V marked 48V 35 mA (B,Y,R) Current ratings 0.1...20 A 21 11 22(i) 12(k) load 22(k) 12(k) 12(i) 12(k) 21 22(i) load 2 pole, unprotected line 11 line 12(i) 1 pole, thermally protected 11 22(i) 12(i) line load 21 22(i) load Typical time/current characteristics Single or double pole load 0.1...2 A 10000 +60°C +23°C -30°C 1000 100 10 1 A B C D E F X X = without marking Rocker illumination (optional) B filament/neon AC/DC G green LED, AC/DC Y yellow LED, AC/DC R red LED, AC/DC Illumination voltage range/ power consumption 0 4 - 7 V marked 6 V 80mA (B,G,Y,R) 1 10 -14V marked 12V 75 mA (B,G,Y,R) 2 20 -28V marked 24V 35 mA (B,G,Y,R) 3 90-140V marked 115V <1 mA (B) 4 185-275V marked 230V <1 mA (B) line 11 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 2.5...20 A 10000 +60°C +23°C -30°C 1000 Trip time in seconds 1 Type No. 3120 rocker switch/circuit breaker Mounting F snap in frame Size of frame panel thickness 3 to fit mounting cut-out 50.5x21.5 mm 1-6.35 mm 4 to fit mounting cut-out 44.5x22 mm 1-2.5 mm 5 to fit mounting cut-out 44.5x 22 mm 2.6-4 mm 6 to fit mounting cut-out 45x33.7 mm 1.2-2.4 mm Number of poles 0 2 pole, unprotected, switch only 1 1 pole, thermally protected 2 2 pole, thermally protected 5 2 pole, thermally protected on one pole only (terminals 11, 12k, 12i) 6 1 pole, unprotected, switch only Mounting frame design 1 collar height 1 mm 3 collar height 9 mm 4 collar height 2 mm with water splash protection (IP 54), not with -F6... Terminal configuration P7 blade terminals 2x2.8x0.8 mm (terminals 12(k), 22(k), 11,. 21), not for under voltage module, not for switch H7 12(k), 22(k): blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 11, 21: terminal screws, not for switch N7 as P7, but including shunt terminals 12(i) and 22 (i) as blade terminals 2x2.8x0.8 mm not for under voltage module G7 as H7, but including shunt terminals 12(i) and 22 (i) as blade terminals 2x2.8x0.8 mm Characteristic curve T1 thermal, 1.01-1.4 x IN Q1 switch only Actuator style W rocker Switch colour designation opaque translucent (for illuminated versions) 01 black 12 white 02 white 14 red 04 red 15 orange 19 green Rocker markings A 0 AUS OFF B I EIN ON C E 0 AUS OFF F X I EIN ON Trip time in seconds Ordering information 100 10 3120 - F 3 2 1 - N7 T1 - W 14 A B 4 - 5 A ordering example 3120 - F . (switch only) 0 . - N7 Q1 - W .. . . . - 20 A N.B. Switch only versions must be specified with -N7 or -G7 terminals. Terminals 12(k) and 22(k) are not fitted. Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.8 0.84 0.88 0.92 1 1.08 1.14 1.23 66 ☎ 1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 40 Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Dimensions Mounting style variants Style F3.1 collar height 1 mm Style F3.3 collar height 9 mm OFF position 9 25 54 10 33 35 33 7 16 35 54 35 25 19.5 optional ilumination 10.7 3.5 21 41 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 10 3.5 10.7 3 21 Style F3.4 collar height 2 mm, with water splash protection 15.5 41 blade terminal DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 1 3 15.5 56 35 27 19.5 10 3.8 flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 10 33 Installation drawing operating area 10.7 3.5 21 3 15.5 41 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm Optional illumination 25 16 48 7 10 15.5 Style F 4.1 7 7 7 10 35 33 8 10 mounting area Cut-out dimensions 10.7 x. R Optional illumination 25 16 7 48 35 33 Panel cut-out F4/F5 min. 2 x. R 0. 1.2 +0.4 1.6 +0.8 2.4 +1 +2.2 +1.1 45 +0.2 -0.05 45 -0.05 45 -0.05 .R dimension “A” ax 10.7 m 44.5 +0.2 3 1.5 10 panel thickness ma 22 +0.3 1-2.5 with ...F4 2.6-4 with ...F5 Style F 5.1 ax “A” .R 0. 3 1.5 33.7 +0.2 - 0.05 21.5+0.2 m 50.5 +0.3 .R 0. 3 2 min. 2 ma m x. R ax 1-6.35 min. 2.5 ma 15.5 41 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm Panel cut-out F6 panel thickness Panel cut-out F3 3 3.5 21 21 Edges of working parts: DIN 6784 3.5 3 15.5 41 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm Dimension diagram for style F6 is available on request. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 67 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Accessories Insulated cover Y 303 068 01 Rear terminal shroud black Y 304 275 01 (IP64) 2.5 40.5 +0,5 20.5 50 0.9 9 1.75 -0.25 70+5 20 10 Terminal adapter Y 303 862 01 13.5 3.7 R3 4 .5 4 ø8 Water splash cover, transparent (IP66) for styles -F4../-F5... X 221 619 01 blade terminal DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 48 Retaining clip for 3120-F3... Ref. Y 303 675 01/02 25 58 Y 303 675 01 suitable for panel thickness < 2 mm Y 303 675 02 suitable for panel thickness < 4 mm ø4.4 35 * 16.5 ø8 3.4 22 28 50.5 Retaining clip for 3120-F5... Ref. Y 303 676 01 60 73 R 52 0. 35 44.5 0. 1 1 1 28 22.5 1 sharp-edged R R3 0.8 2.5 without bends Blanking piece in -F3 frame Y 303 885 31 matt finish 25 54 16.5 31 36 21 41 68 33 1 1 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Description Switch/thermal circuit breaker (S-type TO CBE to EN 60934) with standard isolator style two button operation. Single button press-toreset version also available. Both types can be supplied in single pole configuration only, in double pole with single pole protection, and in double pole with protection on both poles. Designed for snap-in panel mounting. There is a choice of push button colour combinations and neon illumination (filament bulb for low voltages) is optional. Any one of the following additional function modules can be supplied factory fitted to the rear of the switch/circuit breaker. ● Under voltage release coil (for double pole versions only). ● Magnetic trip coil for short circuit protection - see page 113. ● Magnetic trip coil for remote relay trip. ● Auxiliary contacts for status signalling. ● Mechanical slide interlock. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 1 3120-F... Technical data Motors, transformers, solenoids, extra low voltage wiring systems, office machines, electro-medical equipment, power supplies, communications systems, industrial controls. Voltage rating Current ratings Typical life Accessories Y 303 068 01 Y 303 862 01 Y 303 675 01 Y 303 675 02 Y 303 885 31 Y 304 275 01 Y 306 001 01 Y 306 551 01 Insulated cover, snap-fitted to the exposed areas of the two incoming terminals (when terminal screws are not specified) to provide brush contact protection. Terminal adapter to convert screw terminals to push on connections when factory fitted under voltage release module is specified (two adapters required per unit). Retaining clip for -F3 mounting frame for panel thickness under 2 mm. As above for panel thickness under 4 mm. Blanking piece in -F3 size mounting frame. Rear terminal shroud. Water splash cover for use with -F2 size mounting frame. Retaining clip for -F2 mounting frame. Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area between poles (2 pole) Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance per pole (Ω) Current rating (A) Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 0.1 94 3.5 0.0565 0.2 24 4 0.0435 0.3 12 4.5 0.0435 0.4 5.30 5 0.0325 0.5 4.20 6 0.0215 0.6 2.90 7 0.0165 0.8 1.50 8 0.0165 1 0.9 10 <0.02 1.2 0.80 12 <0.02 1.5 0.45 14 <0.02 2 0.27 16 <0.02 2.5 0.0785 18 < 0.02 3 0.0595 20 < 0.02 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 50 V 0.1...20 A (up to 30 A to special order) 50,000 operations for IN ≤16 A double pole 30,000 operations for IN ≤16 A single pole, 10,000 operations for IN >16 A -30...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V >100 M Ω (DC 500 V) 0.1...2 A 2.5...20 A 10 x IN 250 A 2 pole, or 150 A 1 pole IN UN 2 pole 0.1... 2 A AC 250 V 200 A 2.5... 3 A AC 250 V 1000 A 3.5... 8 A AC 250 V 2000 A 9 ... 16 A AC 250 V 3500 A 18... 20 A AC 250 V 5000 A 0.1...20 A DC 50 V 1000 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 8 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca approx. 33 g (double pole) approx. 27 g (single pole) Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Semko (EN 60934) AC 250 V, DC 28 V DC 50 V DC 50 V 0.1...20 A 0.1...20 A double pole 0.1...10 A single pole BV, LRoS AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.1...20 A UL, CSA AC 250 V, DC 50 V 0.1...20 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 69 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Type No. 3120 push button switch/circuit breaker Mounting F snap in frame Size of frame 2 special frame for fitting splash cover 3 to fit mounting cut-out 50.5x21.5 mm, panel thickness 1-6.35 mm Number of poles 0 2 pole, unprotected, switch only 1 1 pole, thermally protected 2 2 pole, thermally protected 5 2 pole, thermally protected on one pole only (terminals 11,12k,12i) 6 1 pole, unprotected, switch only Mounting frame design F with 2 push buttons G with 1 push button (switch-on only) Terminal configuration P7 blade terminals 2x2.8x0.8 mm (terminals 12(k), 22(k), 11,. 21), not for under voltage module, not for switch H7 12(k), 22(k): blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 11, 21: terminal screws, not for switch N7 as P7, but including shunt terminals 12(i) and 22 (i) as blade terminals 2x2.8x0.8 mm not for under voltage module G7 as H7, but including shunt terminals 12(i) and 22 (i) as blade terminals 2x2.8x0.8 mm Characteristic curve T1 thermal, 1.01-1.4 IN Q1 switch only, only for N7 or G7 terminal Switch style/colour D 1 push button (re-set only) 01X black 04X red 12X white translucent 19X green translucent S 2 push buttons on/off GRX green translucent/red WRX white translucent/red WBX white translucent/black Push button illumination (optional) B filament/neon, AC/DC L neon, AC G green LED, AC/DC Y yellow LED, AC/DC R red LED, AC/DC Illumination voltage range 0 6 V 80 mA (B, G, Y, R) 1 12 V 75 mA (B, G, Y, R) 2 24 V 35 mA (B, G, Y, R) 3 115 V <1 mA (L) 4 230 V <1 mA (L) 5 48 V 35 mA (B, Y, R) Current ratings 0.1...20 A 3120 - F 3120 - F 3 2 F - N7 T1 - S 3 0 F - N7 Q1 - S GRX ... L . 4 - 10 A . - 20 A 2 pole, thermally protected line 11 12(i) 12(k) load 2 pole, thermally protected on one pole only 21 11 22(i) 12(i) 22(k) 12(k) 1 pole, thermally protected 12(i) 12(k) line 21 22(i) load 2 pole, unprotected line 11 11 22(i) 12(i) line load 21 22(i) load Typical time/current characteristics 1 or 2 pole load 0.1...2 A 10000 +60°C +23°C -30°C 1000 100 10 1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 2.5...20 A 10000 +60°C +23°C -30°C ordering example 1000 switch only N.B. Switch only versions must be specified with -N7 or -G7 terminals. Terminals 12(k) and 22 (k) are not fitted. Trip time in seconds 1 Internal connection diagrams Trip time in seconds Ordering information 100 10 1 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.8 0.84 0.88 0.92 1 1.08 1.14 1.23 70 ☎ 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 40 Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Dimensions Installation drawing 3120-F3.F-...-S... Optional illumination operating area OFF position 25 54 14.2 33 10 15.5 15 10 16.2 1 7 8 7 10 10 7 3.5 10.7 3 21 mounting area 15.5 41 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S Panel cut-out flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 3120-F3... 3120-F3.G-...-D... min. 2.5 Optional illumination ma 1-6.35 OFF position 54 25 14.2 16.2 x. R 2 50.5 .3 +0.3 x. R0 10 33 21.5 +0.2 15 10 ma 3120-F2... 3.5 3 21 metal min. 2 plastic min. 3 15.5 41 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 60 ±0.15 flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm +0.5 ø4.3 water splash cover (see page 72) 26 +0.2 retaining clip 3120-F2.F-... 50.5 +0.2 10.7 panel cover R2 74 Edges of working parts: DIN 6784 60±0.1 35.4 4.5 10.2 10 15 10 16.2 33 ø3.2 10 PT-screw Type K40 ø4mm 10.7 3 3.5 21 15.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 41 flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 71 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3120-F... Accessories Insulated cover Y 303 068 01 Rear terminal shroud black Y 304 275 01 (IP64) 2.5 40.5 +0,5 20.5 50 0.9 9 1.75 -0.25 70+5 20 R3 13.5 4 .5 3.7 10 Terminal adapter Y 303 862 01 ø8 4 Water splash cover, transparent (IP66) for style 3120-F2.F-... X 221 619 01 Consisting of - retaining clip Y 306 551 01 - cover Y 306 001 01 blade terminal DIN 46244-C-Ms-S Retaining clip for 3120-F3... Ref. Y 303 675 01/02 58 48 retaining clip panel 1.4 Blanking piece in -F3 frame Y 303 885 31 ø8 16.5 Y 303 675 01 suitable for panel thickness < 2 mm Y 303 675 02 suitable for panel thickness < 4 mm * 2 22 28 25 50.5 ø4.4 ø6.5 cover matt finish 25 54 16.5 35 31 60 33 36 1 1 73 21 41 72 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Auxiliary Contact Module X3120-S for circuit breaker 3120-F... Description Dimensions 25.5 A module supplied factory fitted to type 3120 to provide electrically separate changeover contacts which operate as the main contacts open/close. Ideally suited to status signalling and sequence switching. Typical applications 10 21 14 1 Monitoring of the switching position of the circuit breaker or any connected load. 8.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-A2.8-0.5-Ms-silver plated 7.5 7.5 2 19.8 Ordering information Internal connection diagram Type No. X3120 Module for type 3120 Function S auxiliary contact module Contact configuration 0 change-over contact Terminal design 1 blade terminals 2.8 x 0.5, silver plated Contact rating AC DC Voltage rating Current rating Voltage rating Current rating 12 V 0.1...4 A 24 V 0.1...4 A A 10-250 V 0.1...4 A 60 V 0.1...1 A 110 V 0.1...0.5 A 220 V 0.1...0.25 A B 5 -250 V 0.05...1 A 5 V-250 V 0.05...1 A M module mounted to circuit breaker 3120-.. X3120 - S 0 1 A M ordering example Approvals (complete circuit breaker/module assembly) Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V, DC 28 V 4A UL, CSA AC 250 V 4A line 11 12(i) 12(k) 32 22(i) load 31 22(k) Technical data Voltage rating Current rating Typical life Ambient temperature Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) between main and auxiliary circuit Insulation resistance Vibration Shock Humidity Mass ☎ 34 Module mounted Corrosion Issue C 21 AC 250 V; DC 220 V 4 (1) A 50,000 operations -30...+60 °C Test voltage AC 3000 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 6 g (type X3120-S...A) 8 g (type X3120-S...B) (57-500 Hz), ±0.46 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 15 g (11 ms), type X3120-S...A 20 g (11 ms), type X3120-S...B to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-30, test Ca approx. 38 g (complete assembly) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 73 Undervoltage Release Module X3120-U...for circuit breaker 3120-F... Description Dimensions A module suitable for all double pole versions of type 3120 to trip the main switch/circuit breaker mechanism in the event of loss of voltage. When the voltage is restored the rocker switch must be reset to reconnect the load, thereby avoiding the safety hazards associated with automatic re-starting of machinery. Note: Basic unit 3120-...-H7 or -G7 screw terminals necessary. 41 +0.1 - 0.2 33.5 15 ° Machines such as power tools, industrial equipment and domestic appliances where automatic restart after restoration of power could be dangerous (EU Machinery Directive) 7.6 Typical applications 1 flat head screw M3.5x5-MS ISO1580 for mains connection 6.6 10.7 21 21 22 23.5 2 terminals X3120-U02… blade terminal DIN 46244-A2.8-0.8 1 terminal X3120-U01… Without terminal(s): X3120-U00… Ordering information line 21 11 12(i) 12(k) load line 21 line 11 22(i) 12(i) 22(k) 12(k) load line 21 22(i) 12(i) 22(k) 12(k) 22(i) load 22(k) ordering example Approvals (complete circuit breaker/module assembly) Authority Voltage ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 100...240 V; DC 24 V UL, CSA AC 100...240 V; DC 24 V Technical data Voltage ratings Release values Release delay Latch-in values Ambient temperature Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass 74 line 11 X3120-U02 U< M X3120-U01 U< X3120 - U 00 00 X3120-U00 U< Type No. X3120 Module for type 3120 Function U undervoltage release module Terminal design 00 standard (without separate connections) 01 1 blade terminal 2.8x0.8 02 2 blade terminals 2.8x0.8 Voltage ratings 00 230/240 V AC 50/60 Hz 01 120 V AC 50/60 Hz 02 100 V AC 50/60 Hz 03 24 V DC M module mounted to the circuit breaker Internal connection diagrams ☎ AC 100, 120 V, 230/240 V 50/60 Hz DC 24 V 20 to 70 % UN (at a rated voltage of AC 100 V the device may release at 70 V and must release at 20 V) t < 20 ms > 85 % UN -30...+60 °C 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 48 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95% RH to IEC 68-2-30, test Ca approx. 53 g (complete assembly) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Remote Trip Module X3120-M... for circuit breaker 3120-F... Description Dimensions 30 A module which adds remote trip capability to all versions of type 3120. A voltage applied across the coil, by means of an external sensor for example, will cause disconnection of the main switch/circuit breaker mechanism. Typical applications blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S Ordering information P7 M - 12 V Authority Voltage ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 12...240 V; DC 12...24 V UL, CSA AC 12...240 V; DC 12...24 V line 21 11 12(i) 12(k) module mounted 22(i) load FA 22(k) 12(n) remote trip 12 Technical data Voltage ratings Power consumption Pulse operation Release delay Typical life Ambient temperature Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) between main circuit and trip coil circuit Insulation resistance Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass ☎ 14 21 ordering example Approvals (complete circuit breaker/module assembly) Issue C 18 10.7 Internal connection diagram Type No. X3120 Module for type 3120 Function M magnetic relay trip module Style 2 magnetic remote trip coil Terminal design P7 blade terminals 2 x 2.8 x 0.8 tin plated M module mounted to the circuit breaker Voltage ratings AC 12/24/48/60/120/220/230/240 V DC 12/24 V X3120 - M 2 1 9 Electrical monitoring of safety sytems, remote trip. AC 12...240 V; DC 12...24 V approx. 200 W 20 ms < tON <100 ms/tOFF > 10 sec t < 20 ms 50,000 operations at UN -30...+60 °C Test voltage AC 3000 V >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 30 g (ll ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-30, test Ca approx. 53 g (complete assembly) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 75 Mechanical Slide Interlock Module X3120-V...for circuit breaker 3120-F... Dimensions 9.8 Suitable for use with all type 3120 versions, this module provides a mechanical safety interlock which, according to the option specified, prevents the main switch/circuit breaker mechanism from being reset/ switched on. The actuator is intended for use with interlock systems to ensure that machinery cannot be operated without covers and safety guards in place, for instance. 8.2 13 21 5.2 Typical applications 18 Description 14 custom designed part Mechanical monitoring of safety systems, e.g. for garden shredders interlock version 01 ø4.1 2 5 1 21 13 8 1.8 21 4 3.2 21 11 2.9 4 9 8 interlock may be moved in either direction min. 8.5 mm max. 10.5 mm Ordering information Type No. X3120 Module for type 3120 Function V mechanical slide interlock module Module operation 1 3120 can only be switched on without the interlock fitted Interlock design 00 without interlock 01 interlock version 01 (see dimension diagram) Delivery condition of slide L interlock supplied separately with the module M module factory-fitted with the slide in its centre position O module supplied without interlock Operating direction of interlock 0 without interlock, or interlock supplied separately 1 interlock operated from the side near terminals 11, 12k, 12i of the 3120-... 2 interlock operated from the side near terminals 21, 22k, 22i of the 3120-... Assembly status L module supplied separately M module mounted to the circuit breaker X3120 - V 76 1 00 O 0 M ☎ ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3130 Description Single, two and three pole rocker switch/thermal circuit breakers (Stype TO CBE to EN 60934) of compact design for snap-in panel mounting. Available either with protection on one/both/all poles or, in the case of the double pole version, protection on one pole only. Neon illumination is optional (filament bulb for low voltages) and there is a choice of rocker colours. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934) Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, household and office machines, hand tools. Ordering information Type No. 3130 rocker switch/circuit breaker Mounting F snap in frame Frame 1 standard 3 special single pole version Number of poles 1 single pole, thermally protected 2 2 pole, thermally protected 3 3 pole, thermally protected 5 2 pole, thermally protected on one pole only 6 3 pole, thermally protected on two poles only A 1 pole, unprotected Frame mounting 0 panel thickness 1-2.5 mm (only 3130-F1..-...) 1 panel thickness 1.5-3.2 mm (only 3130-F3.1-...) Terminal design P7 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S H7 for terminals 1.1, 2.1 3.1 terminal screws M 3,5 for terminals 1.2, 2.2, 3.1 blade terminals N7 blade terminals, with shunt terminal Characteristic curve T1 thermal, 1.05-1.4 IN Q1 switch, only with terminal design -N7 Switch style W rocker, one-piece, rounded profile Switch colour designation opaque translucent 01 black 12 white 02 white 14 red 04 red 19 green 09 green Rocker markings Q "I" and "O" moulded in Rocker illumination Multi pole versions B filament/neon, AC/DC G green LED, DC R red LED, DC Y yellow LED, DC Single pole version W 12 Q Y white rocker, yellow LED, AC/DC W 14 Q R red rocker, red LED, AC/DC W 19 Q Y green rocker, yellow LED, AC/DC Illumination voltage range* 1 6 V (4-7 V) B, G, R, Y 2 12 V (10-14 V) B, G, R, Y 3 24 V (20-28 V) B, G, R, Y 4 48 V (42-54 V) B, R, Y 6 115 V (90-140 V) B (R**, Y**) 7 230 V (185-275 V) B (R**, Y**) 8 415 V (320-450 V) B Current ratings 0.1...20 A 1 pole 0.1...16 A 2 and 3 pole 3130 - F 1 3 0 - P7 T1 - W 12 Q B 7 - 5 A * N/A for non-illuminated version ** Single pole version only Issue C ☎ 1 3130 1 pole ordering example 3 pole Technical data Voltage rating Current ratings Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area current path/current path Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 240 V; 3 AC 415 V; DC 50 V 0.1...20 A 1 pole 0.1...16 A 2 and 3 pole 30,000 operations at IN, 1 and 3 pole 50,000 operations at IN, 2 pole -30...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.1... 2 A 10 x IN 2.5...20 A 150 A 2.5...16 A 250 A 2.5...12 A 150 A 14 + 16 A 130 A IN 0.1...12 A 1 + 2 pole AC 250V/3500A 3 pole 3AC 250V/5000A 1 + 2 pole DC 50V/2000A 1 pole 2 pole 3 pole 3 pole 14...16 A AC 250V/3500A DC 50V/2000A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 5 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis 1 pole: 25 g (11 ms) 2 + 3 pole: 20 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca approx. 45 g (three pole) approx. 31 g (double pole) approx. 17 g (single pole) Approvals Authority Voltage rating Current rating VDE (EN 60934) AC 240/415 VDC 50 V single pole multi pole single pole multi pole single pole DC 28 V 0.1...20 A 0.1...16 A 0.1... 8 A 0.1...16 A 0.1...20 A UL, CSA AC 250 V, DC 50 V 3 AC 250 V 0.1...16 A 0.1...12 A 1 and 2 pole 3 pole Semko AC 240 V, DC 28 V 3 AC 415 V 0.1...16 A 0.1...12 A 1 and 2 pole 3 pole DC 50 V Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 77 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3130 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 3.5 Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 0.0565 0.2 24 4 0.0435 0.3 12 5 0.0325 0.4 5.30 6 0.0215 0.5 4.20 7 0.0165 0.8 1.50 8 0.0165 1 0.9 10 <0.02 1.2 0.80 12 <0.02 1.5 0.45 14 <0.02 2 0.27 16 <0.02 2.5 0.0785 18 <0.02 3 0.0595 20 <0.02 Multi-pole types: all poles symmetrically loaded With single pole overload, thermal tripping will be at approx. 1.54 x IN with 2 pole devices and at approx. 1.6 x IN with 3 pole devices. 0.1...2 A 10000 +60°C +23°C -30°C 1000 Trip time in seconds Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 94 Internal connection diagrams 100 10 1 pole 3 pole LINE I.I LINE I.I 2.I 1 3.I 0.1 1 I.2 load lamp 2 pole I.2 2.2 2.2 switch LINE I.I 2.I 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 2.5...20 A 1 pole 2.5...16 A 2 and 3 pole 10000 LINE I.I +60°C +23°C 2.I -30°C 1000 I.3 I.2 2.2 2.3 Trip time in seconds 1 Current rating (A) 0.1 Typical time/current characteristics 100 10 1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.8 0.84 0.88 0.92 1 1.08 1.14 1.23 78 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3130 OFF terminal for illumination conductor size 0.14 mm2, length 180 mm 33 LINE I.I I.2 I.3 LINE I.I I.2 10 10 I.3 37.5 32.5 ON 2 2 14.5 9.5 5.85 ON Dimensions 3130-F130-... 33 OFF 5.85 Dimensions 3130-F110-... 2 20 3 2 20 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 34 2 unit I blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 34 1 Side view Side view switch only LINE I.I LINE I.I flat head screw M3.5x5 -MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm flat head screw M3.5x5 -MS ISO 1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm Panel cut-out -0.4 -0.2 18 panel thickness 1-2.5 mm .5 < R0 panel thickness 1-2.5 mm +0.3 +0.2 36 14.6 +0.3 Optional illumination Edges of working parts: DIN 6784 26 21 OFF ON 2 Dimensions 3130-F310-... 5.85 2 Edges of working parts: DIN 6784 I.2 LINE I.I I.3 17.8 9.5 terminal for illumination conductor size 0.14 mm2, length 180 mm LINE I.I I.2 10 10 I.3 33 33 5.85 Dimensions 3130-F120-... ON 2 2 20 unit I 2 20 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 34 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 34 Side view Side view LINE I.I R3 +0.2 34 +0.2 optional illumination OFF 34 37.6 +0.2 36 5 R 0. ±0.1 min. 1.5 ±0.1 min. 1.5 R3 41 R3 Panel cut-out LINE I.I flat head screw M3.5x5 -MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm flat head screw M3.5x5 -MS ISO1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm R1 .5 Panel cut-out Panel cut-out A R0.5 ±0.1 panel thickness 1-2.5 mm 19.5 29.5 min. 1.5 -0.4 -0.2 min. 1.5 R0.5 < ±0.1 34 39.5 +0.2 Optional illumination B Optional illumination +0.3 B 1.50 35 +0.15 2.35 36 +0.15 3.20 37 +0.15 18 26.1 +0.2 A +0.2 36 +0.3 Edges of working parts: DIN 6784 Edges of working parts: DIN 6784 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 79 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3130 Installation drawing Accessories Splash cover, transparent, for 3 pole version X 221 258 01 (IP 54) I.3 I.2 36.5 LINE I.I 50 5 12 32 5 7 7 mounting area 55 20 ø11 ø4.4 8 ø8 1 10 25 41.5 operating area 50 80 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 2-4100-... Description Single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset, tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Options include an additional unprotected circuit tap (-A3) and -KF housing particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Designed for threadneck panel mounting. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Motors, transformers, solenoids, hand tools, appliances. Accessories X 200 799 02 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly for type 2-4100. As above with the cover bonded to the nut for extra retention. As X 200 799 02 and 01 above but featuring a slotted knurled ring for wrench front of panel tightening. Water splash cover/hex nut assembly for type 2-4100. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Water splash cover transparent, with hex nut, without O ring. X 200 799 01 X 200 798 01/02 X 210 739 01 X 201 296 03 1 2-4100-... Technical data Voltage rating Current rating range Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Ordering information Type No. 2-4100 threadneck panel mounting Terminal design L10 solder terminals P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 mm P50 blade terminals A4.8-0.8 mm Shunt terminal (optional) A3 shunt terminal (3 A max. load) Special housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Current ratings 0.05 ... 10 A 2-4100 - L10 - - - 5A ordering example Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664 A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Shock Corrosion Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Currrent rating (A) 0.05 Internal resistance (Ω) 322 Current rating (A) 1.8 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.34 0.08 125 2 0.29 0.1 101 2.5 0.18 0.2 25 3 0.14 0.3 11 3.5 0.1 Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...10 A 2,000 operations at 2 x IN -20...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.05...2 A 2.5... 6 A 7 ... 10 A 10 x IN 8 x IN 6 x IN IN UN 0.05...4.5 A AC 250 V 200 A 5A AC 250 V 1000 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 10 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 15 g Approvals 0.4 6.3 4 0.08 0.5 4.1 4.5 0.069 0.6 2.8 5 0.053 Authority Voltage rating Current rating 0.7 2.1 6 < 0.05 VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...10 A 0.8 1.6 7 < 0.05 CSA AC 250 V 0.05...3,5A 1 0.97 8 < 0.05 UL AC 250 V 0.05... 5 A 1.2 0.66 10 < 0.05 Semko (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.1...10 A 1.5 0.45 Issue C -A3 versions are not UL approved ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 81 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 2-4100-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram ø6.4 17.5 ON 1 (3) 42.5 3.5 10 22.5 OFF tightening torque 1 Nm 3/8-27 UNS-2A 1 1 2 blade terminals DIN46244-A6.3-0.8 D-shaped threadneck 19 current rating in A 10000 mounting hole 11 Trip time in seconds 0 9.6 -0.1 SW 14 1000 0 2 8.9 -0.1 8.8 8 2 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 6.5 3 7.5 (-A3) Installation drawing operating area 100 10 1 1 6 6 mounting area Terminal design 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Accessories 2 1 2 6.5 -P50 5.5 -L10 1 2 2 3 6 0.1 23 4 max. 2.5 1 Water splash cover, transparent Y 300 538 01 and knurled nut Y 300 628 01 X 200 799 02 (IP64) X 200 799 01 bonded to nut (IP64) 3 3 6 blade terminals DIN46244-4.8-0.8 -P10-A3 3/8-27 UNS-2B 9 Water splash cover, transparent with special knurled nut X 200 798 01 (IP64) X 200 798 02 bonded to nut (IP64) Hex nut with splash cover, black X 210 739 01 (IP64) Water splash cover, transparent, with hex nut, without O ring X 201 296 03 (IP64) blade terminals DIN46244-A6.3-0.8 82 max. 7 3/8-27 UNS-2B ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 3/8-27 UNS-2B Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-5000/2-5700-... Description Single pole thermal circuit breaker with press-to-reset, tease-free, tripfree, snap action mechanism. Type 2-5000 is available with optional manual release (-H), type 2-5700 can be supplied as a push-push switch/circuit breaker (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934 in press-to-reset configuration: M-type when fitted with manual release -H; S-type with push-push operation). Fitted with flange or threadneck for panel mounting. Options include an additional unprotected circuit tap (-A3) and -KF housing particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 1 Motors, transformers, solenoids, battery chargers, power supplies, appliances, machinery, extra low voltage systems. Accessories 2-5700-... Technical data For types 2-5000 and 2-5700 Y 303 563 01 Ten-way connecting/bus bar for use with circuit breakers with screw terminals. For type 2-5000 Y 300 728 01 Water splash cover for type 2-5000. Y 301 056 02 Fixing plate for Y 300 728 01. Y 300 476 01 Rear terminal shroud. For type 2-5700 with IG1 threadneck X 200 799 02 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly. X 200 799 01 As above with the cover bonded to the nut for extra retention. X 200 798 01/02 As X 200 799 02 and 01 above but featuring a slotted knurled ring for wrench front of panel tightening. X 210 739 01 Water splash cover/hex nut. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. For type 2-5700 with IG2 threadneck X 210 663 01 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly. X 201 296 01 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly - without 'O'ring. X 200 801 03 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly - with 'O'ring. Separate hardware Y 300 192 01 3/8" hex nut. Y 300 284 02 3/8" knurled nut. Y 300 116 02 12 mm hex nut. Y 300 065 01 12 mm knurled nut. X 200 801 08 Water splash cover, transparent, with hex nut, with O ring Type No. 2-5000 flange mounting 2-5700 threadneck panel mounting Threadneck design IG1 moulded threadneck 3/8"-27UNS-2A (type 2-5700 only) IG2 moulded threadneck M12x1 (type 2-5700 only) Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 mm K10 screw terminals M4x6 Shunt terminal (optional) -P10 only A3 shunt terminal (up to IN 2.5 A/6 A max. load) Manual release (optional) H manual release facility (type 2-5000 only) DD push to release/push to reset (type 2-5700 only) Special housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Current ratings 0.05 ... 25 A - DD - Voltage rating Current rating range Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Ordering information 2-5700 - IG1 - P10 - 2-5000-... - 8A Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...25 A 5,000 operations at 2 x IN -20...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.05...2.5 A 8 x IN 3... 5 A 20 x IN 6...12 A 200 A (higher interrupting capacity available to special order) 13...25 A 400 A IN UN 0.05...4.5 A AC 250 V 200 A 5... 7 A AC 250 V 1000 A 8...16 A AC 250 V 2000 A 0.05...16 A DC 28 V 200 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 29 g ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 83 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-5000/2-5700-... 280 3 0.08 100 3.5 0.065 0.1 110 4 0.065 0.2 29 4.5 0.05 0.3 14 5 0.05 0.4 7 6 0.02 0.5 4.9 7 0.02 0.6 3.4 8 < 0.02 0.7 2.5 10 < 0.02 0.8 1.8 12 < 0.02 1 1.2 13 < 0.02 2-5000-P10 ø9.5 15 < 0.02 0.6 16 < 0.02 1.8 0.4 20 < 0.02 2 0.3 22 < 0.02 2.5 0.2 25 < 0.02 44 1 4 3 10.4 A 2 19.8 14.5 31 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 current rating in A 2-5000-P10-A3 18.5 0.85 1.5 5 0.05...2.5 A 1 40 50 Approvals ø13.5 4 3 2 ø4.5 1.2 12.2 0.1 7 0.05 OFF Internal resistance (Ω) 5 Current rating (A) 18.2 Internal resistance (Ω) 13 2-5700-P10 0.05...25 A CSA/ UL AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A SEV, Nemko AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...25 A LRoS AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.1 ...25 A BV (type 2-5700 only) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.2 ...25 A ø6.5 10 AC 250 V; DC 28 V A 46.5 VDE, Semko (EN 60934) IG1=3/8-27UNS-2A tightening torque max. 1 Nm IG2=M12x1 tightening torque max. 1.5 Nm 1 4 3 2 19.8 29 D-shaped threadneck 10.4 Current ratings 14.5 IG1=8.8 IG2=11.3 Voltage ratings 16.5 ON Authority 22.5 OFF blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 5 IG1=ø9.6 -0.1 IG2=ø12.2 -0.1 current rating in A SW 14 84 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com IG1=8.9 -0.1 IG2=11.5 -0.1 1 Current rating (A) Dimensions ON Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-5000/2-5700-... Terminal design Internal connection diagrams -P10-A3 0.05...2.5 A 4 3 1 2 4 3 0.05...2.5 A 3...25 A (with or without shunt terminal) 1 (without shunt terminal) 1 2 (3) 10.4 1 -K10 13 flat head screw M4x6 ISO1580 tightening torque 1.2 Nm (-A3) 2 2 1 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Installation drawings 2-5000-... 10000 operating area 0.05 - 2.5 A 3 - 25 A A 1 4 3 2 mounting area Trip time in seconds max. 2.5 1000 100 10 2-5700-... max. 2.5 1 operating area 0.1 1 1 4 3 2 1 Issue C 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 25 25 A 1 ☎ mounting area Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 85 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-5000/2-5700-... Accessories for types 2-5000 and 2-5700 with screw terminals -K10 Bus bar Y 303 563 01 176 162 X 18 60° 1.1 10 M4 7 Accessories for type 2-5000-... Accessories for type 2-5700-... Water splash cover, transparent for push button (IP64) Y 300 728 01 With 3/8" threadneck (-IG1) Water splash cover, transparent Y 300 538 01 and knurled nut Y 300 628 01 X 200 799 02 (IP64) X 200 799 01 bonded to nut (IP64) 0.5 2.3 Fixing plate Y 301 056 02 19.2 1.5 50 31.5 14.5 4.5 40 18 18.5 3/8-27 UNS-2B Water splash cover, transparent with special knurled nut X 200 798 01 (IP64) X 200 798 02 bonded to nut (IP64) 40 50 Hex nut with splash cover black X 210 739 01 (IP64) transparent splas cover X 201 296 03 (IP64) Rear terminal shroud, transparent (IP64) Y 300 476 01 12.5 29 3/8-27 UNS-2B E-T-A 49 3/8-27 UNS-2B Separate hardware Hex nut Y 300 192 01 Knurled nut Y 300 284 02 3/8-27UNS-2B ø13.5 ø12 3/8-27UNS-2B ø6 SW14 ø11.4 1 2 X 2.5 4 With M12 threadneck (-IG2) Hex nut with splash cover, black X 201 296 01 without O ring (IP64) X 200 801 03 with O ring (IP66) X 200 801 08 transparent with O ring (IP66) Water splash cover, transparent, with knurled nut X 210 663 01 (IP64) M12x1 M12x1 Separate hardware Hex nut Y 300 116 02 M12x1 SW14 86 ☎ Knurled nut Y 302 065 01 3.2 2.5 0.5 x 45° Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com M12x1 ø17 Issue C Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 2-5200-... Description Single pole thermal circuit breaker with push-to-reset, tease-free, tripfree, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60934; M-type when fitted with optional manual release feature). Designed for plug-in mounting with E-T-A sockets 10 and 16. The optional -KF housing is particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems and components. Accessories 10R-K10 10R-P10 10R-A10 Y 301 166 02 Y 301 166 01 16 X 200 409 01 Y 301 477 01 1 Modular snap-together surface mounted sockets, each accommodating two plug-in circuit breakers. With screw terminals. As above but with push-on terminals. As above but with a combination of screw and push-on terminals. Two-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10 sockets. Four-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10 sockets. Single socket for symmetric EN rail mounting. Adapter for mounting socket type 16 to asymmetric rail (G-profile). Blanking plug with insulated pins, for sockets 10, 20, 40, 60. Ordering information Type No. 2-5200 plug-in Manual release (optional) H manual release facility Special housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Special version 051034 Voltage rating AC 250 V Current ratings 0.05 ... 16 A 2-5200 - H - - 051034 - 5 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. 2-5200-... Technical data Voltage rating Current rating range Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Mass Test voltage AC 1500 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 0.05...2.5 A 8 x IN 3...5 A 20 x IN 6...16 A (25 A) 400 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 8 g (57 to 500 Hz/ ±0.61 mm, 10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 35 g Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) 0.05 280 2.5 0.08 100 3 0.1 110 3.5 0.065 0.2 29 4 0.065 0.3 14 4.5 0.05 0.4 7 5 0.05 0.5 4.9 6 0.02 0.6 3.4 7 0.02 Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings 0.7 2.5 8 < 0.02 LRoS AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A 0.8 1.8 10 < 0.02 Semko AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A 1 1.2 12 < 0.02 1.2 0.84 13 < 0.02 1.5 0.6 15 < 0.02 1.8 0.4 16 < 0.02 2 0.25 Issue C ☎ Internal resistance (Ω) Humidity DC 28 V (AC 250: suffix 051034) 0.05...16 A (up to 25 A to special order) 5,000 operations at 2 x IN -20...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 0.2 0.1 Approvals Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 87 Thermal Automotive Circuit Breaker 2-5200-... Dimensions Accessories Sockets 10R-K10 ø13.5 4 ø9.5 12 22 21 68 12 11 22 7 15 8 45 75 2 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 9.6 1 6 ø4.4 Bus bar for sockets 10...: Y 301 166 02 (2-way) 10R-A10 19 14.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 7.9 12.5 15 21 11 22.9 50 Y 301 166 01 (4-way) 7 wire cross sectional areas 2 2 x max. 2.5 mm stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid Internal connection diagram t = 0.8 22 12 59 10 5 current rating in A 31 8.5 4.2 8 2.9 7,5 1 21 11 50 12 5.6 30 9.5 48.5 10 ON 15.5 OFF 1 10R-P10 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 13 12 1 15 15 15 52.9 Socket 16 1 70 52 39.5 32 2 1.5 38.5 15 Adapter for EN rail 50035-G32 (specified as a separate item) X 200 409 01 for socket 16 available on request symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 10000 Blanking plug Y 301 477 01 for sockets 10R-P10/K10 Terminal for mounting rack X 200 800 01 for sockets 10R, 10F on EN rail 50 035-G32 0.05 - 2.5 A 3 - 25 A 42 27.5 14 M5 x 12 100 19 50 12 9.5 Trip time in seconds 9.5 30 1.5 1000 ø4 14.5 27 10 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5mm2 (brown) X 210 588 02/2.5mm2 (black) X 210 588 03/2.5mm2 (red) X 210 588 04/2.5mm2 (blue) 1 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated 0.1 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 88 ☎ ø2.5 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com ~70 2 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper ~70 1 Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 (black) X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 (brown) Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-6200/2-6400-... Description Single pole thermal circuit breakers with push-to-reset, tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R type TO CBE to EN 60934; M-type when fitted with manual release features/type 2-6200 only). Featuring auxiliary contacts (1 x N/C; 1 x N/O) as standard. Options include manual release (type 2-6200 only), an additional unprotected circuit tap (-A3), a centre reset position in which all contacts are open (-ZR: type 2-6200-H only), and -KF housing particularly suited to high humidity and other damp conditions. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 1 Motors, transformers, solenoids, controls for oil and gas boilers. For type 2-6400 with IG1 threadneck X 200 799 02 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly. X 200 799 01 As above with the cover bonded to the nut for extra retention. X 200 798 01/02 as X 200 799 02 and 01 above but featuring a slotted knurled ring for wrench front of panel tightening. X 210 739 01 Water splash cover/hex nut. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. For type 2-6400 with IG 2 threadneck X 210 663 01 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly. X 201 296 01 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly without 'O'ring. Separate hardware Y 300 192 01 3/8" hex nut. Y 300 284 02 3/8" knurled nut. Y 300 116 02 12 mm hex nut. Y 300 065 01 12 mm knurled nut. Ordering information Type No. 2-6200 flange mounting, with auxiliary contacts 2-6400 threadneck panel mounting, with auxiliary contacts* Mounting (type 2-6400 only) IG1 moulded threadneck 3/8-27UNS-2A IG2 moulded threadneck M 12 x 1 Terminal design - main circuit L10 solder terminals P10 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 mm Shunt terminal (optional) A3 shunt terminal same as main terminal (up to 7 A/ 5 A max. load; up to 16 A/10 A max. load) Manual release (optional) H manual release facility (type 2-6200 only) Intermediate position (optional) ZR intermediate position (type 2-6200-H only) Auxiliary contacts (standard) Si N/O and N/C contacts, solder terminals Special housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity condition Current ratings 0.05 ... 16 A - P10 - 2-6400... Technical data Accessories 2-6200 - 2-6200-... - - - Si - Voltage rating Current rating range Auxiliary circuit Typical life Ambient temperature Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main circuit to aux. circuit aux. circuit 4-5 to 6-7 Insulation resistance Interrupting capacity Icn Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration Shock Corrosion Humidity Mass AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A 1 A, AC 250 V/DC 28 V 5,000 operations at 2 x IN -20...+60 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 840 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 10 x IN IN UN 0.05...4.5 A AC 250 V 200 A 5...7 A AC 250 V 1000 A 8...15 A AC 250 V 2000 A 16 A AC 250 V 3500 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 10 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis 40 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca approx. 25 g - 8 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. *mounting hardware bulk shipped Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 89 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-6200/6400-... 2-6200-... 31 12.5 18.5 ON OFF ø8.5 16.5 39 5 11 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.30 0.20 0.12 0.10 0.07 0.056 0.046 0.035 0.03 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 7 Current rating (A) 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 6 7 8 10 12 15 16 7 Internal resistance (Ω) 257 138 90 32.2 14.6 8.4 5.15 3.82 2.80 2.15 1.42 0.96 0.51 0.40 -P10 0.05 - 7A Approvals 11.5 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 50 Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A CSA/ UL AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A Semko (EN 60934) AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.1 ... 16 A Demko AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...16 A current rating in A 21 5 ø3.5 Authority 40 5 2-6400-... 10.5 16.5 ON ø6.4 8.8 11.3 =IG1 =IG2 22.5 (moulded threadneck) OFF IG1=3/8-27UNS-2A tightening torque max. 1 Nm IG2=M12x1 tightening torque max. 1.5 Nm 11 7 46 14.5 11.5 -P10 0.05 - 7A blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 31 =IG1 =IG2 mounting hole 16.5 ø9.6 -0.1 ø12.2 -0.1 current rating in A =IG1 =IG2 8.9 -0.1 SW14 11.5 -0.1 5 Installation drawing 2-6200-... 18 operating area 39 38 1 Current rating (A) 0.05 0.08 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 1 1.2 1.5 1.8 Dimensions 3 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values 1.5 4 90 ☎ mounting area Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 4 Issue C Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-6200/6400-... Terminal design Internal connection diagrams -P10 0,05...7 A 0.05...7 A 8...16 A see dimension diagram 1 -P10 8...16 A 5 7 4 6 1 (2) (3) 2 3 (-A3) (-A3) 5 7 4 6 2-6200-...-ZR 1 -P10-A3 0,05...16 A 0 (Z) 1 1 (3) 5 7 4 6 0 (Z) 1 1 (3) 5 7 4 6 0 (Z) 1 1 (3) intermediate position OFF position 7 4 6 2 2 2 5 ON position -L10 0,05...7 A 5 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 7 10000 -L10 8...16 A Trip time in seconds 1000 -L10-A3 0,05...16 A 100 10 1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 20 40 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Installation drawing 2-6400-... 42.5 43.5 22.5 operating area 1.5 4 Issue C ☎ mounting area 4 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 91 Thermal Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2-6200/6400-... Accessories for type 2-6400-... With 3/8" threadneck (-IG1) Water splash cover, transparent Y 300 538 01 and knurled nut Y 300 628 01 X 200 799 02 (IP64) X 200 799 01 bonded to nut (IP64) 3/8-27 UNS-2B Water splash cover, transparent with special knurled nut X 200 798 01 (IP64) X 200 798 02 bonded to nut (IP64) Hex nut with splash cover black X 210 739 01 (IP64) 3/8-27 UNS-2B 3/8-27 UNS-2B Separate hardware Hex nut Y 300 192 01 Knurled nut Y 300 284 02 3/8-27UNS-2B ø13.5 3/8-27UNS-2B SW14 ø11.4 1 2.5 4 With M12 threadneck (-IG2) Hex nut with splash cover black X 201 296 01 without O ring (IP64) X 200 801 03 with O ring (IP66) X 200 801 08 transparent with O ring (IP66) Water splash cover transparent with knurled nut X 210 663 01 (IP64) M12x1 M12x1 Separate hardware Hex nut Y 300 116 02 Knurled nut Y 302 065 01 M12x1 SW14 92 3.2 2.5 0.5 x 45° ☎ M12x1 ø17 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Single and multi pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers (CBEs) with and without auxiliary contacts Overview Voltage ratings max. 3 AC 433 V, AC 250 V, DC 65 V Current ratings 0.05...32 A 2 A latching type bimetal is combined with a magnetic coil to provide the joint benefits of delayed operation for low level over-current protection and fast magnetic action on higher value short circuits. E-T-A thermal-magnetic circuit breakers for track mounting can be fitted to different standard rail designs, either direct in the case of combi-foot models, or with an E-T-A adapter. E-T-A has perfected thermal-magnetic technology to provide a choice of mounting options, covering an extensive range of current ratings all with high precision performance. These models are well suited to telecommunications, process control and other industrial applications where sophisticated equipment needs correct - and dependable - protection. The narrow profile of E-T-A thermal-magnetic circuit breakers enables high density packaging solutions. All models are available in special configurations with separate thermal and thermal-magnetic circuits, providing capability for overload protection together with an independent control circuit, which may be operated in response to an external sensor input. Additional features to ensure perfect fit of device to application include options such as auxiliary contacts for status signalling and the choice of push button or toggle manual control. There are also single, two and multi-pole models in a range of types and variants. Plug-in versions provide a convenient means of positive circuit interruption by simply removing the circuit breaker - ideal for safety critical systems during maintenance and shutdown. All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 93 Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 201 / 201-WA 2210-S2..-... E2210 assembly single pole Description rail mounting 201 standard type 201-WA low resistance option socket or panel mounting, toggle actuator, single or multi pole, with auxiliary contact option type 2210-S on Euro Card for 19" rack mounting Max. voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 65 V 3 AC 433 V; AC 250 V; DC 65 V 3 AC 433 V; AC 250 V; DC 65 V Current ratings 201: 0.05...16 A 201-WA: 0.05...10 A 0.1...25 A 0.1...16 A Aux. contact rating without auxiliary contacts AC 240 V / DC 65 V 1A AC 240 V / DC 65 V 1A Typical life / contact rating 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 201: 0.05...0.8 A self-limiting 1...2 A 200 A 2.5...16 A 400 A 201-WA: 0.05...0.2 A self-limiting 0.3...2 A 200 A 2.5...10 A 400 A 0.1... 5 A 6 ...25 A 0.1... 5 A 400 A 6 ...16 A 800 A Approvals VDE, Demko, CSA, UL, LRoS VDE, CSA, UL, Demko, Semko, BV, LRoS Available options see pages 101 - 103 see pages 105 - 108 2 400 A 800 A see pages 109 - 112 Dimensions 0 I 53 68 11 OFF 10.5 1 single pole circuit breaker 7.5 100 I 0 10 Overview Type No. 40.8 80 174 Internal connection diagrams 1 94 ☎ (Z) LINE 0 I 1 11 23 12 24 I I> 2 2(k) OFF position (Z) LINE 0 I 1 11 23 12 24 I> 2(k) ON position Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com (Z) line 1 0 I 11 23 12 24 I 2(k) OFF position Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Rack 19BGT2 2210-S2.. for distribution rails Distribution rail X2210-S0606J 19" racks with sockets type 63-P10-Si (5 or 10) rack for max. 5 sockets type 63-P10-Si Prewired and auxiliary contact options toggle actuator, single pole, with auxiliary contact, for distribution rail or mounting socket distribution rail for installation in telecommunications control cabinets, fitted with retaining clip, extraction tool and cover AC 250 V, DC 65 V AC 250 V, DC 65 V AC 250 V; DC 65 V AC 250 V, DC 65 V Max. 16 A for each position Line feed: max. 63 A Max. supply for each socket: 20 A Max. load per position: 16 A 0.4...25 A complete unit: max. 80 A max. 25 A for each position Max. 1 A for each position Line feed: max. 32 A Max. supply for each socket: 10 A Max. 1 A for each position AC 240 V / DC 65 V 1A max. 1 A for each position 10,000 operations at 1xIN 2210-S2..-...-410033: AC 250 V 1000 A DC 65 V 2000 A or 2210-S2..-...-410005: AC 250 V 2000 A DC 65 V 3500 A VDE, CSA, UL, Demko, Semko see pages 115 - 116 see pages 117 - 122 0 12 see pages 113 - 114 see pages 123 - 124 I 196 37.7 46 12 2k 2.5 84 x 5.08 = 426.72 482.6 482.6 (158.3) 11 10 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 50 75 101.6 465 8 54.3 68 465 188 40.8 Sig LINE 1 11 I> 99 185 482.6 (N) 45 (U) 2 465 12 I> 2(k) Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 95 Overview 19" Rack 2 Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Distribution rail X2210-K... 2210-T2...-... 2215-... 3 pole 2215-L1.. Description fully insulated distribution rail for plug-in mounted circuit breakers, for telecommunications and control systems rail mounting, toggle actuator, single or multipole, with auxiliary contact option threadneck or PCB mounting, toggle actuator, single pole, with auxiliary contact option Max. voltage rating AC 250 V, DC 65 V 3 AC 433 V; AC 250 V; DC 65 V AC 250 V; DC 48 V Current ratings complete unit: max. 80 A max. 25 A per position 0.1...32 A 0.05...10 A Aux. contact rating max. 1 A per position AC 240 V / DC 65 V 1A AC 250 V / DC 28 V 1A Typical life / contact rating 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 0.1... 5 A 6 ...32 A 300 A Approvals VDE, CSA, UL, BV, LRoS VDE, CSA, UL, Semko, see pages 131 - 134 see pages 135 - 137 2 Available options see pages 125 - 129 400 A 800 A Dimensions I I 78.5 Si 2 LINE Si 1 ø8.8 12 11 14 1 15 15 26.5 46 2 + - 0 52 0 15 11.5 multipole 10 45 ø12 ø4.8 43.5 40 29 U 31 Sig + 23 - Internal connection diagrams N max. A 45 Overview Type No. 0 I line (Si) 1 11 25.6 0 I line (Si) 1 11 12 (Si) I ☎ I line 1 12 (Si) 11 12 14 I Si-break contact 2 2 OFF position ON position 96 0 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com I 2 Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2215-F1.. 3120-....-..M1- 3200 rocker version type 2215-L on Euro Card for 19" rack mounting flange mounting, toggle actuator, double pole, with auxiliary contact option switch/circuit breaker with rocker or push button operation plug-in type with standard manual release facility AC 250 V; DC 48 V AC 250 V; DC 48 V AC 250 V; DC 50 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V 0.05...10 A 0.05...10 A 0.1...16 A 0.05...25 A AC 250 V / DC 28 V 1A AC 250 V / DC 28 V 1A without auxiliary contacts without auxiliary contacts 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 30,000 operations at 1 x IN 1pole 50,000 operations at 1 x IN 2pole 4,000 operations at 2 x IN 300 A 600 A 0.1...2 A 100 x IN 2.5...16 A 250 A 2 pole or 150 A 1 pole 0.05...0.8 A self-limiting 1...2 A 200 A 2.5...25 A 400 A VDE, CSA, UL VDE, CSA, LRoS see pages 145 - 148 see pages 149 - 152 see pages 141 - 143 see pages 139 - 140 48.5 10 30 100 I 0 52.6 I 0 LINE I 0 11 14 1 1 9 19 18 29 174 0 I line 1 11 0 I line 1 3 12 14 50 41 21 11 line 21 line 1 12 14 22 24 I> 2 OFF position I I 12(i) 22(i) I 12 2 I> 2 4 Issue C 11 2 9.6 12 9 2 ø9.5 15.5 0 35 14 I OFF 54 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 97 Overview Circuit breaker E2215 2 Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 3300-... / 3400-... 3500-... / 4000-... 3600 / 3900-P10-Si Description threadneck panel mounting, with auxiliary contact option 3300 fast acting 3400 standard delay flange mounting 3500 standard type with aux. contact option 4000 low resistance type with standard aux. contacts and intermediate position Max. voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 65 V AC 250 V; DC 65 V AC 250 V; DC 65 V Current ratings 0.05...16 A 3500: 0.05...16 A 4000: 0.05...10 A 3600: 0.05...16 A 3900: 0.05...10 A Aux. contact rating AC 250 V / DC 65 V 1A AC 250 V / DC 65 V 1A AC 250 V / DC 65 V 1A Typical life / contact rating 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN 5,000 operations at 2 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...0.8 A self-limiting 1...2 A 200 A 2.5...16 A 400 A 3500: 3600: 2 0.05...0.8 A self-limiting 1...2 A 200 A 2.5...16 A 400 A 0.05...0.2 A self-limiting 0.3...2 A 200 A 2.5...10 A 400 A 4000: socket mounting, single pole 3600 standard type with auxiliary contact option 3900 low resistance type with standard aux. contacts and intermediate position 0.05...0.8 A self-limiting 1...2 A 200 A 2.5...16 A 400 A 0.05...0.2 A self-limiting 0.3...2 A 200 A 2.5...10 A 400 A 3900: Approvals VDE, Demko, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, LRoS VDE, Demko, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, LRoS VDE, Demko, CSA, UL, Semko, Nemko, LRoS Available options see pages 153 - 156 see pages 157 - 160 see pages 161 - 164 ø6.5 10 11 ø11.5 51 46.5 50.3 ø8.5 11 OFF 13 OFF ø6.4 22.5 OFF Dimensions 11 Overview Type No. 42 40.8 42 Internal connection diagrams line 1 I 2 98 ☎ 5 7 3 4 6 3 from IN=8 A line 1 I 5 7 3 4 6 line 1 3 from IN=8 A 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com I 5 7 3 4 6 3 from IN=8 A 2 Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers E-T-A Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers - Selector Chart ● ● ● ● ● ● 3200 ❍ ❍ 16 433 65 32 250 65 25 250 48 10 250 50 16 ● 250 28 25 ● ● ● ● ❍ ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Choice of characteristic curves 65 ❍ ❍ Illumination multi pole single pole Water splash cover Manual trip facility Auxiliary contacts shunt terminal ● ● ● ● 3120 ● 250 ● ❍ ❍ ● ● ● ● ● ❍ 3300 ● ● ● ● ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ ● 250 65 16 3400 ● ● ● ● ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ ● 250 65 16 ● ● ● ❍ ❍ ● ● 250 65 16 3500 ● 3600 ● ● ● ❍ ● ● 250 65 16 3900 ● ● ● ● ● ● 250 65 10 ❍ ● ● ● 250 65 10 4000 ● ● ● Overview ● distribution rail ● ● MAX IN (A) 2210 for ● DC (V) ● Max. ratings Number of poles AC (V) 2210 screw terminals solder terminals plug-in pins blade terminals Printed Circuit Board Main terminal design ● 201 2215 rail socket flange Mounting method threadneck Type No. 2 ● = standard ❍ = optional Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 99 Overview Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 2 100 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 201/-WA Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and two button operation (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Featuring a narrow profile housing, recessed terminals, standard EN rail mounting, and precision CBE performance. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934) Typical applications Process control systems, instrumentation. Accessories X 200 409 01 X 210 589 01 201-WA-... low-resistance type Technical data Mounting adapter for asymmetric rail (G-profile). 50-way 2.5 mm2 cable links with prefitted connection lugs, black As above but with 1.5 mm2 cable links, brown Bus bar Bus bar Supply terminal for bus bar X 210 589 02 X 221 497 00 X 221 498 00 X 221 496 00 201-... standard type Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 65 V (DC 80 V UL/CSA) Current rating range 201: 0.05 ... 16 A 201-WA: 0.05...10 A Typical life 5,000 operations at 2xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Ordering information Type No. 201 201-WA single pole, rail mounted version low-resistance version Option 2705 fitted with adapter X 200 409 01 Current ratings 0.05...16 A (type 201) 0.05...10 A (type 201-WA) 201-WA - - 10 A Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 201 201-WA 0.05...0.8 A 1...2 A 2.5...16 A 0.05...0.2 A self-limiting 0.3...2 A 200 A 2.5...10 A 400 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) UN AC 250 V DC 80 V 5 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 60 g Internal resistance (Ω) 201 201-WA 0.05 447 211 3 0.19 0.054 0.1 131 48 4 0.090 0.035 0.2 40 12.4 5 0.061 0.025 0.3 19.3 5.7 6 0.041 < 0.02 0.4 10.4 3.1 7 0.034 < 0.02 0.5 7.1 2.0 8 < 0.02 < 0.02 0.6 4.3 1.32 10 < 0.02 < 0.02 0.8 2.5 0.76 12 < 0.02 1 1.67 0.49 14 < 0.02 Authority Voltage ratings 1.5 0.61 0.21 15 < 0.02 VDE, Demko, AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...16 A 2 0.38 0.101 16 < 0.02 CSA, UL AC 250 V, DC 80 V 0.05...16 A 2.5 0.24 0.078 LRoS AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.3...16 A ☎ 1000 A 1000 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 20 Current rating (A) Issue C Internal resistance (Ω) 201 201-WA IN 0.05...16 A 0.05...16 A Vibration Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 2 Approvals Current ratings Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 101 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 201/-WA Dimensions Internal connection diagram ON conductor cross section max. 0.5 - 10 mm2 rigid conductor 0.5 - 6 mm2 flexible conductor tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm I> 43 53 11 line 1 11.5 5 OFF 45 ø8.5 12-14 6.5 4.8 7.5 2 80 12.5 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 slot for fitting labels from Wieland Type 9003 Weidmüller Type BS.1/2 SchT PES Phoenix dekafix Type DST6 T./WT 4K-DST5 2 current rating in A 2 Phillips screw, size 2 to EN ISO 4757 Installation drawing for protection class II (IEC 730-1) operating area (double insulation) cable entry cable entry Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 mounting area Typical time/current characteristics Type 201 0.05...7 A AC AC Type 201-WA 0.05...10 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 1 2 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20 % on DC supplies. ☎ DC 10 0.1 0.001 102 Type 201 8...16 A 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Magnetic tripping currents are decreased by 20 % on AC supplies. Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 201/-WA Accessories 20 Adapter for EN rail 50035-G32 specified as a separate item X 200 409 01 Adapter X 200 409 01 G profile EN 50035-G32 Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5 mm2 (black) X 210 589 02/1.5 mm2 (brown) 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper ø2.5 ~70 2 Bus bar X 221 498 01 16 x 12.5 = 200 12.5 2.5 29 1.3 14 IEC 664 500 V/70 A (40°C) CE E-T-A® GERMANY 207 3.5 Supply terminal for bus bar X 221 496 01 5.2 11 1.3 17 M4 2.5 4.6 9 conductor size max. 10 mm2 12 15 16 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 103 2 104 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S.. Description One, two and three pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with trip-free, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation (S-type TM CBE to EN 60934/IEC 934). Designed for panel or plug-in mounting. Available with auxiliary contacts (1 x N/O, 1 x N/C) for status signalling and fitted with an unprotected shunt tap terminal as standard. Two and three pole models are internally linked to ensure that both/all poles trip in the event of an overload on one pole, even if the actuator is held in the ON position. A choice of characteristic curves further extends the range of applications possibilities for these CBEs. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Process control equipment, robotics, machine tool control, communications systems, instrumentation. Special versions, e.g. for aggressive environmental conditions and low voltages (5 V) on request. Technical data Ordering information Type No. 2210 single or multi pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker Mounting S socket or panel mounting Actuator design 2 toggle Number of poles 1 1 pole protected 2 2 pole protected 3 3 pole protected 4 4 pole protected 5 2 pole, protected on one pole only Panel mounting 0 without hardware 1 with M3 thread 2 with 6/32 thread Terminal design (main contacts) P1 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Characteristic curve F1 fast acting: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 2-4xIN DC (DC only) M1 standard delay: therm. 1.05-1.4xIN; magn. 6-12xIN AC;7.8-15.6xIN DC T1 delayed: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 10-20xIN AC T2 thermal only, 1.01-1.4xIN M3 standard delay, low resistance: therm.1.4-1.8xIN; magn. 6-12xIN AC; 7.8-15.6xIN DC Intermediate position H without intermediate position (standard) Z with intermediate position Auxiliary contacts 0 without auxiliary contacts 1 with auxiliary contacts in all poles 2 with auxiliary contacts in pole 1 (only multi pole devices) 3 with auxiliary contacts in poles 1 and 3 (≥3 pole devices) Auxiliary contact function 1 one each N/C and N/O (standard) 2 one N/O contact (23/24) 3 one N/C contact (11/12) 4 one N/O contact, closed in the intermediate and ON position Auxiliary contact - terminal design 1 same as main terminals Current ratings 0.1...25 A 2210 - S 2 1 0 - P1 F1 - Z 1 1 1 - 10 A Remote trip coil available to special order. Issue C 2210-S2... ☎ Voltage rating AC 250 V; 3 AC 433 V (50-60 Hz); DC 65 V (higher voltages to special order) Current rating range 0.1...25 A for curves M1, T1, T2 0.1...16 A for curves F1, M3 Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 240 V/DC 65 V Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C (T 60) Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2,5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main/aux. circuit aux. circuit 11-12/23-24 pole/pole Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 1000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.1...5 A 400 A; 6...25 A 800 A Curve T2 : 0.1...25 A 15xIN Curve M3: 0.1... 2 A AC 200 A Interrupting capacity IN (UL 10771) UN 1 pole 2 pole 3 pole 0.1...8 A AC 250 V 1000 A 2000 A 3AC 250V 2000 A 10...16 A AC 125 V 2000 A 2000 A 3AC 250V 2000 A 20A AC 250 V 3500 A 3500 A 3AC 216V 3500 A 0.1...20 A DC 65 V 2000 A 2000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration Curve F1: 3 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.23 mm (10-57 Hz) Curves M1, M3, T1, T2: 5 g (57-500 Hz),±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock Curve F1: 25 g (11 ms), directions 1,2,3,4,5 10 g (11 ms), direction 6 Curves M1,M3, T1, T2: 25 g (11 ms), directions 1,2,3,4,5 20 g (11 ms), direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours in 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 50 g per pole ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 105 2 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S.. for AC 81 M3 standard delay for AC + DC 42 T2 thermal for AC + DC 77 24.2 11.7 10.4 5.6 10.2 23 0.4 9.2 6.6 6.0 2.9 5.7 0.5 6.8 4.1 3.9 1.75 3.7 0.6 4.2 3 2.7 1.42 2.6 0.8 2.8 1.65 1.53 0.75 1.39 1 1.6 1.10 0.98 0.5 0.9 1.5 0.78 0.47 0.42 0.22 0.36 2 0.42 0.28 0.24 0.136 0.19 2.5 0.26 0.183 0.17 0.083 0.141 3 0.18 0.124 0.12 0.057 0.091 4 0.12 0.077 0.073 0.041 0.051 5 0.092 0.063 0.055 0.032 0.040 0.039 ≤␣ 0.02 0.021 ≤␣ 0.02 10 0.022 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 12 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 16 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 12.5 1 11 23 11.5 24 12 2k 6.8 12.5 12.5 polarizing tooth 6x6.8 = 40.8 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 0.027 ≤␣ 0.02 20 - ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 - ≤␣ 0.02 25 - ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 - ≤ 0.02 50 mounting thread M3 or 6/32 max. screw length 5.8 mm tightening torque 0.5 Nm 32 unit III unit II unit I Approvals 12 ≤ 0.02 25 5.5 0.045 43 Ø11 ≤ 0.02 37.5 3.5 0 0.054 0.025 19 0 6 8 1 26.1 11.6 ON OFF 68 39.3 17.5 18 10 0.2 0.3 30.5 Z 25° 25° multi pole devices 16 Authority Voltage ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V, DC 65 V Current ratings 3 AC 433 V 0.1...25 A AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1...25 A Demko, Semko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1...16 A LRoS, BV 3 AC 415 V, Cut-out dimensions 2210-S2... 32 AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1...20 A 16 3-pole 2-pole 1-pole Toggle positions 1.5 12.5 12.5 ON position ø4 intermediate position 36.6 OFF position ø11.5 90° s UL, CSA 24 recess with panel thickness s > 1.5 mm ø11.5 Installation drawing 2210-S2.. Shock directions operating area (double insulation) 3 5 6 4 1 current rating 1 11 23 20 2 5 2 T1 delayed 0 Current Internal resistance (Ω) rating F1 M1 (A) fast acting standard delay for DC for AC + DC 0.1 162 92 Dimensions 2210-S... 10.5 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values 24 12 2k mounting area (standard insulation) 106 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S.. Internal connection diagrams Accessories for 2210-S... with auxiliary contact function 1 (one each N/O and N/C) (...-H111-...) without intermediate position (...-Z111-...) with intermediate position 2-way mounting socket 23-P10-Si I line 1 line 1 (Z) 11 23 0 I line 1 (Z) 11 0 23 I 11 polarized blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 23 7.4 4.4 4.4 I> I> 2(k) OFF position 2(k) intermediate position (Z) I line 1 23 0 (Z) I I> line 1 24 2(k) ON position 12.5 25 0 (Z) I line 1 2 6 polarized recess 23 24 I> 2(k) OFF position 50 75 12.5 30 23 24 I> retaining clip 24 with auxiliary contact function 4 0 6.25 50 57.4 12 24 12.5 64 12 50 57.4 24 64 12 22.2 21 10 7.4 3.5 6 x 6.8 = 40.8 6.8 (Z) 0 6-way mounting socket 63-P10-Si (retaining clip Y 302 974 01 available on request) Single mounting sockets with adapter 17-P10-Si 17-P10-Si-20025 (retaining clip Y 302 974 02 available on request) slot fitting labels from Phoenix ZB, RBS, DST Weidmüller dekafix, BS, PES Wieland Type 9003 I> 2(k) intermediate position 2 polarized blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 retaining clip 2(k) ON position Bus bar for type 17 socket (for max. 100 A continuous load) X 211 157 01 with terminal X 211 157 02 without terminal cylinder head screw M4x4 ISO1207 nickel plated washer A 4.3 DIN 125 nickel plated 2 Phoenix terminal AKG 35 (max.cross section 35 mm2) 80 45.s 41.3 5 1.4 33.3 Accessories for mounting sockets 6.5 25.8 8.5 depth 10 mm 10 12.5 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 adapter X20040901 G-profile EN 50035-G32 polarization recess Single mounting sockets with adapter 17-P70-Si 17-P70-Si-20025 (retaining clip Y 302 974 02 available on request) slot fitting labels from Phoenix ZB, RBS, DST Weidmüller dekafix, BS, PES Wieland Type 9003 female connector blade terminals DIN 46244 part 2 C profile (2xA2.8-0.8) retaining clip M4 Cu rail, tin-plated 6.5 Insulated sleeving for bus bar Y 303 824 01 80 45.8 41.3 12.5 9 5.4 5 fusible link (1.1 mm thick constriction) 154.8 1.4 12.8 33.3 7 25.8 8.5 10 depth 10 mm 10 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 125 adapter X20040901 G-profile EN 50035-G32 17 polarization recess Toggle guard for 1 pole units X 221 617 01 24 1 2.5 R9 R15 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5mm2 brown X 210 588 02/2.5mm2 black X 210 588 03/2.5mm2 red X 210 588 04/2.5mm2 blue 12 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated 38 9.5 R5 12 ~70 ø3.5 32 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 107 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S.. Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +10 +23 +30 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.79 0.83 0.88 0.93 1 1.04 1.11 1.19 1.29 -M1 0,1...6 A 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 10 1 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 1 2 -T1 8...25 A AC 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current AC 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 2 -M3 6...16 A 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 0.001 1 2 -T2 0,1...6 A AC* 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current AC/DC 10000 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 Trip time in seconds 10000 1 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 2 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current ☎ AC/DC 1 0.1 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 10 0.1 0.001 2 -T2 8...25 A 10000 10 AC* 1 0.1 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 10 0.1 0.001 2 -M3 0,1...5 A 10000 10 AC* 10 0.1 -T1 0,1...6 A Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds 1000 1 Trip time in seconds -M1 8...25 A 10000 0.001 108 AC* 10000 Trip time in seconds 2 DC 10000 Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds -F1 0,1...16 A Multi pole devices: all poles symmetrically loaded. With single pole overload, thermal tripping will be at max. 1.7 x IN with curves F1, M1 and T2, and at max. 2.2 x IN with curve M3. N.B. * Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 30% on DC supplies. 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker E2210-... Description Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker mounted on Euro Card for 19" rack mounting, with one Euro Card accommodating one or two single pole, double pole or three pole circuit breakers. Convenient toggle actuation enables series 2210 additionally to be used as an ON/OFF switch. A red LED is located in the front frame of the Euro Card, indicating the switching status of the circuit breaker (via the auxiliary circuit). E2210-... Typical applications Technical data Process control, measuring and control systems, telecommunications. Circuit breaker 2 Main circuit: voltage rating 3 AC 433V; AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 65 V current rating range 0.1...16 A Standard current ratings 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.8 A 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 A 6 8 10 12 16 A Auxiliary circuit: voltage rating AC 240 V; DC 65 V current rating 1A Other data see type 2210-S2.. Front plate Dimensions (1 TE = 5.08 mm, 1 HE = 44.45 mm) Width: one single pole circuit breaker one double pole circuit breaker 4 TE 6 TE one three pole circuit breaker 9 TE two single pole circuit breakers 4 TE two double pole circuit breakers 10 TE two three pole circuit breakers 12 TE Height: Material: 3 HE aluminium, anodized LED Voltage rating Issue C ☎ DC 24 V / DC 60 V Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 109 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker E2210-... One single pole circuit breaker Ordering information Type No. E2210 Dimensions d b z *) (Z 1 I 11 23 12 24 I> 2(k) OFF position 0 (Z) I 1 11 23 12 24 0 (Z) 1 I I> load 2(k) intermediate position 11 23 12 24 I> 2(k) ON position Two single pole circuit breakers Dimensions unit I (G I) multi-pin connector LED R1 LED I 0 3HE 100 I 0 X R2 unit II (G II) 174 4TE view X d b z Terminal selection GI G II z(6/8) + 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 12 24 23 11 12 24 23 11 R1 22 2(k) z(14/16) R2 + 24 26 G II 28 1 30 1 32 Internal connection diagrams for units G I and G II (Z I 1 11 23 12 24 2(k) OFF position LED G II 2(k) GI 0 LED G I z(10/12) - 20 I> ☎ 32 line 0 Clearly add the desired specifications. 110 28 30 Internal connection diagram 0.1/0.2 A **) With mounting styles 6, 7 and 8: both circuit breakers must have the same characteristics. ***) It is possible to fit circuit breakers of mixed current ratings on the Euro Card. LED (14/16) R1 + 24 26 GI 1 (10/12) - 20 22 2(k) same as main terminals **) Current ratings 0.1 ... 16 A ***) only with 2x1 pole/2x2 pole/2x3 pole 2 4 6 8 10 12 LED 14 16 12 24 23 11 GI E2210 - 6 1 1 - S 2 1 1 - 02 - H 1 1 1 - 0.1 A XX 3HE 4TE view X Terminal selection intermediate and ON position Auxiliary contact-terminal design 1 X 174 magn.6-12xIN AC; 7.8-15.6xIN DC different curves for multi pole versions to order*) Intermediate position **) H without intermediate position (standard) Z with intermediate position Auxiliary contacts **) 1 with auxiliary contacts (only with 1x1 pole, 2x1 pole) 5 with auxiliary contact only in the last unit of multipole versions Auxiliary contact function **) 1 1 N/C, 1 N/O (standard) 2 1 N/O (23/24) 3 1 N/C (11/12) 4 1 N/O contact, closed in the 100 I 0 therm.1.4-1.8xIN AC; XX E-T-A LED E-T-A 2 multi-pin connector R1 E-T-A Mounting style 1 1 x single pole, central mounting (standard) 2 1 x single pole, top mounting 3 1 x single pole, bottom mounting 4 1 x double pole, central mounting (standard) 5 1 x three pole, central mounting (standard) 6 2 x single pole, symmetrical mounting (standard) 7 2 x double pole, symmetrical mounting (standard) 8 2 x three pole, symmetrical mounting (standard) Front plate 1 aluminium (standard) 2 moulded LED 1 red, DC 24 V (standard) 2 red, DC 60 V 3 green, DC 24 V 4 green, DC 60 V Circuit breaker Mounting S panel mounting Actuator design 2 short toggle Number of poles 1 1 pole protected 2 2 pole protected 3 3 pole protected 5 2 pole, protected on one pole only Panel mounting 1 with M3 thread Terminal design (main contacts) = P1 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Characteristic curve **) 01 F1 fast acting: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 2-4xIN DC (DC only) 02 M1 standard delay: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 6-12xIN AC; 7.8-15.6xIN DC 03 T1 delayed: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 10-20xIN AC 04 T2thermal only, 1.01-1.4xIN 05 M3 standard delay, low resistance: (Z) 0 I 1 11 23 12 24 I> 2(k) intermediate position 0 line (Z) I load 1 11 23 12 24 I> 2(k) ON position Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker E2210-... One double pole circuit breaker One three pole circuit breaker Dimensions Dimensions multi-pin connector multi-pin connector R1 R1 LED X 3 HE I 0 100 X E-T-A 0 3HE I 100 E-T-A LED G IC G IB G IA G IB G IA 174 174 6TE Terminal selection d b z 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 12 24 23 11 G IB (14/16) R1 + G IB LED G IB G IC G IB LED 20 2(k) G IB 26 28 1 G IA 32 Internal connection diagram Internal connection diagram 0 (Z) G IA line 1 I G IB line 1 11 II II II 23 0 II G IC LED (14/16) R1 + 2 28 32 G IB line 1 I II 1 G IC line 1 11 23 II II I> I> 2(k) 2(k) load load I> I> I> 2(k) load 2(k) load 2(k) load Two double pole circuit breakers Two three pole circuit breakers Dimensions Dimensions multi-pin connector G IB R1 E-T-A E-T-A 0 II LED I G IIB R2 multi-pin connector G IC G IB G IA 100 X E-T-A 100 0 LED I R1 I G IA 3HE I 0 unit I (G I) LED E-T-A unit I (G I) II 12 24 12 24 LED 0 unit II (G II) unit II (G II) 174 10TE view X 30.6 space between guide rails 174 6 G IIA 1 10 2(k) G IIB 1 14 18 22 26 30 4 12 24 23 11 12 12 24 GII 23 16 11 20 22 24 24 2(k) z(6/8) + G I+G II G II LED 2(k) Internal connection diagram for units 1 (G I) and 2 (G II) 0 (Z 1 2(k) 32 1 I II 6 G IC 1 2(k) z(10/12) - G IIA z(14/16) R2 + G IB 1 2(k) 1 2(k) LED G II G IIC 1 G IB G IA/G line 1 LED G I G IA 30 32 R1 G I LED 28 26 28 space between guide rails d bz 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 20 8 GI 10TE view X 40.6 Terminal selection d bz 2(k) 10 14 18 22 26 30 4 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 20 12 24 23 11 12 12 24 GII 23 16 11 8 GI 20 22 24 II II II G I+G II G II LED 2(k) 28 1 2(k) 32 1 26 28 0 (Z) I Issue C ☎ I> 2(k) load LED G I z(10/12) z(14/16) R2 + LED G II G IB 30 Internal connection diagram for units 1 (G I) and 2 (G II) R1 G IA 24 32 G IB/G line 1 11 23 z(6/8) + G I LED G IA/G IIA G IB/G IIB G IC/G IIC line line line 1 1 1 11 23 II II II II II 12 24 12 24 I> 2(k) load X G IIC G IIB G IIA R2 G IIA Terminal selection LED G IC 24 G IA line (z) (10/12) - G IC 20 22 2(k) 1 26 2(k) 1 30 2(k) 1 G IB 1 30 12 24 23 11 G IC 24 G IA 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 (10/12) - 22 2(k) d b z 3HE Terminal selection 9 TE view X view X I> 2(k) load I> 2(k) load I> 2(k) load Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 111 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker E2210-... Dimensions of sockets for Euro Cards 0Z041Z000004 84.9 10.1 0Z041Z000004 24/7 pole mixed socket to DIN 41612 - form M. Connection: 7 pole for 6.3x0.8 mm connectors and 24 pole midi-wire wrap posts (1 x 1 mm). 12.4 2.9 The following sockets may be used with single pole circuit breakers: 20 10 Description ø1 0Z041Z000007 24/7 pole mixed socket to DIN 41612 - form M. Connection: 7 pole for 6.3x0.8 mm connectors and 24 pole for 2.8x0.8 mm connectors. blade terminals A6.3x0.8 DIN46244 8.17 6x5.08=30.48 7x5.08=35.56 7.62 5.08 14.8 ø2.8 5.08 6.5 0Z041Z000005 A 15 pole socket to DIN 41612, form H, for 6.3 x 0.8 mm connectors is required in addition to the socket mentioned above, if two double pole or two three pole circuit breakers are fitted on one Euro Card. 22 Sockets for Euro Cards 90 2 95 0Z041Z000007 8 20 10 10 84.9 A6.3x0.8 A2.8x0.8 95 5.08 14.8 12.4 6.5 ø2.8 90 5.08 7.62 7x5.08=35.56 5.62 6x5.08=30.48 5.62 0Z041Z000005 12.4 20 10.1 2.9 84.9 blade terminals A6.3x0.8 DIN46244 14x5.08=71.12 5.08 6.5 14.8 ø2.8 8.17 90 95 112 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C 19" Rack Description 19" rack fitted with E-T-A sockets 63-P10-Si to accommodate thermalmagnetic circuit breakers with each terminal block accepting up to 6 circuit breakers. Three rack sizes are available. Typical applications Technical data Circuit breakers that may be accommodated on 19" racks fitted with E-T-A sockets 63-P10-Si: type 2210 type 3600 type 3900 see pages 105 - 108 see pages 161 - 164 see pages 161 - 164 Ordering information X 201 097 01 X 211 530 01 X 201 096 01 Issue C Type No. X 201 096 01 X 201 097 01 X 211 530 01 Height (1 HE = 44.45 mm) 4 HE 4 HE 2 HE Material: The 19" rack and the mounting flanges are made of 2 mm thick steel sheet. Colour: RAL 7032, grey 2 Connection for 10 E-T-A terminal blocks 63-P10-Si for 5 E-T-A terminal blocks 63-P10-Si for 9 E-T-A terminal blocks 63-P10-Si plus 1 fuse holder ☎ by means of one or two 4 pole female multi-pin connectors for max 4 mm2 cables, which may be connected either on the right or left side of the rack. Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 113 19" Rack Accessories Dimensions X 201 097 01 19" rack with 10 E-T-A sockets 63-P10-Si type 63 e.g. type 3600-P-Si or 3900-P-Si Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5mm2, brown X 210 588 02/2.5mm2, black X 210 588 03/2.5mm2, red X 210 588 04/2.5mm2, blue e.g. type 2210 (465) ~70 37.7 14 482.6 177 7 101.6 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated 93 56 40 431 2 2 X 201 096 01 19" rack with 9 E-T-A sockets 63-P10-Si plus one fuse holder type 63 e.g. type 3600-P-Si or 3900-P-Si e.g. type 2210 fuse holder 37.7 14 482.6 177 7 101.6 (465) 56 2 93 40 431 X 211 530 01 19" rack with 5 E-T-A sockets 63-P10-Si e.g. 6 x type 3600-P-Si or 3900-P-Si e.g. 6 x type 2210 type 63 88.5 2 465 482.6 56 2 93 40 431 114 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C 19BGT2 19" Rack Description The compact 19" rack features aluminium profiled cross members with an anodized front plate. The panel cutout accommodates up to 30 positions numbered 1 through 30. Blanks cover unused positions, with 6, 12, 24 or 30 being ”open“. The rack can be fitted with plug-in type circuit breakers 3600/3900, 2210 or E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controller (SSRPC) E-1048600. Please specify the correct option according to the ordering information shown, as different depths must be allowed for. Four bus bars (X1...X4) with 10 positions each (6.3 mm blade terminals) provide easy terminal connection. Prewired options available ex factory are: ● Parallel connected feed (2.5 mm2) with separate supply for each socket via bus bars X1 and X2. Choice of wiring colours: black, red, blue, grey. Outputs are not connected. ● Parallel connected auxiliary contacts (N/C) grouped per socket, 0.75 mm2, via bus bars X3 (supply) and X4 (signalisation). Choice of wiring colours: black, red, blue, grey. Technical data 19" rack ● Series connected auxiliary contacts (N/O) of all positions with 0.75 mm2, via bus bars X3 (feed) and X4 (signalisation). Choice of wiring colours: black, red, blue, grey. ● Custom designed connection according to specification. Other fittings, e.g. back-up fuse, separate circuits, custom designed markings etc., are available to special order. Ordering information Type No. 19BGT 19"-rack Height 2 2 HE = 88.90 mm Circuit breaker types (prepared) 2210 for circuit breaker type 2210 3600 for circuit breaker type 3600 1048 for SSRPC E-1048-600 Number of positions 06 6 poles 12 12 poles 18 18 poles 24 24 poles 30 30 poles Feed prewired A0 without A2 feed prewired (2.5 mm2) Wire colour SW black RT red BL blue GR grey Auxiliary contacts prewired (0.75 mm2) B0 without B1 aux. contacts connected in series (not for E-1048-600) B2 aux. contacts connected in parallel Wire colour SW black RT red BL blue GR grey 19BGT 2 - 2210 - 24 A2 SW - Issue C B1 ☎ RT length: 84 TE total length: 426.72 mm height: 2 HE total height: 88.90 mm depth: 184 mm material: aluminium, anodized Front cutout for 30 positions, numbered 1 through 30 1 socket = 6 positions (No. 1 - 6) 2 sockets = 12 positions (No. 1 - 12) 3 sockets = 18 positions (No. 1 - 18) 4 sockets = 24 positions (No. 1 - 24) 5 sockets = 30 positions (No. 1 - 30) blanks cover unused sockets. Mounting socket polarised E-T-A mounting socket type 63-P10-Si (6 positions) rear blade terminals 6.3 mm max. load: 16 A continuous Bus bars Feed (X1, X2) 10-way for 6.3 mm blade terminals max. current rating: 63 A 2 Bus bars 10-way for 6.3 mm blade terminals Auxiliary contacts (X3, X4) max. current rating: 32 A Feed HO7VK cables 2.5 mm2 with fully insulated 6.3 mm blade terminals to VBG 4 one cable per socket max. current rating: 20 A Auxiliary contact wiring HO7VK cables 0.75 mm2 with fully insulated 6.3 mm blade terminals to VBG 4 max. current rating: 20 A Wire colour option black, red, blue, or grey Voltage rating AC 250 V/DC 65 V Housing ground/earth on the inner side via 6.3 mm blade terminals ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 115 19BGT2 19" Rack Dimensions Terminals Feed (2210, 3600/3900) X1 - feed X2 - feed X3 - aux. contact supply feed X4 - signalisation aux. contacts auxiliary contact supply signalisation feed in e.g. 6 x type 2210 1 e.g. 6 x type 3600-P-Si type 63-P10-Si or 3900-P-Si 2 3 Socket 4 5 6 7 8 9 S1 10 11 12 13 S2 14 S3 … S5 465 X1 - feed 88 75 Feed with auxiliary contacts connected in parallel (2210, 3600/3900) X3 - aux. contact supply feed X2 - feed X4 - signalisation aux. contacts 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 84 x 5.08 = 426.72 482.6 2 2 185 3 2 1 Socket 6 5 4 7 8 9 S1 10 11 12 S2 13 14 S3 … S5 Feed with auxiliary contacts connected in series (2210, 3600/3900) X1 - feed X2 - feed X3 - aux. contact supply feed X4 - signalisation aux. contacts Example: Version for 18 positions 75 88 465 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 2 3 Socket 4 5 6 7 8 9 S1 10 12 11 S2 14 13 S3 … S5 84 x 5.08 = 426.72 Feed (E-1048-600) 482.6 X1 - feed X3 - error output supply X2 - feed X4 - fault indication output Accessories Feed terminal X 221 503 01 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 S1 9 10 11 12 S2 13 14 S3 … S5 30 Socket Feed with fault outputs connected in parallel (E-1048-600) 50 bus bar X1, X2 6.3 mm connectors conductor size 6 … 25 mm2 X1 - feed load X2 - feed control X3 - error output supply X4 - fault indication output 52 Blanks (can be separated) Y 306 485 01 1 Socket 2 3 4 5 6 7 S1 8 9 10 11 S2 12 13 14 S3 … S5 71 Internal connection diagrams 2210 150 1.5 mm2, grey H07V-K line 1 11 23 line 1 5 I> to bypass the auxiliary contacts of sockets not used ☎ 2(k) 3 4 green E-1048-600 1 +UB 7 6.3 mm pin, tinned copper 12 24 116 3600/3900 6 control circuit IN+ 2 IN- 5 7 F+ fault indication 3 circuit F- Control and Protection Electronics Q 6 I> 2 3 from IN = 8 A 4 load Plug-in jumper X 221 544 01 -UB red Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S291-P9M2-410033-...A Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with trip-free, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation. Two-chamber construction with cascade contact arrangement to provide high voltage DC capability and high switching performance. Designed for plug-in mounting in distribution rails X 2210-S0606J, X 2210-K... or terminal blocks 23P10-Si-202005 and 63-P10-Si-202005. Typical applications Communications systems, power supplies, process control equipment. 2210-S291-P9M2-410033-... A Accessories 23-P10-Si-202005 Technical data Lug mounted socket which accommodates one single pole two-chamber type 2210 circuit breakers. With push-on terminals. 63-P10-Si-202005 Lug mounted socket which accommodates 3 single pole two-chamber type 2210 circuit breakers. With push-on terminals. X 2210-S0606J Terminal rail X 2210-KA303 E X 2210-K0404 E X 2210-K0505 E X 2210-K0606 E X 2210-K0707 E X 2210-K0808 E X 2210-K0909 E 3-way terminal blocks 4-way terminal blocks 5-way terminal blocks 6-way terminal blocks 7-way terminal blocks 8-way terminal blocks 9-way terminal blocks X 211 018 01 Tool to aid withdrawal of circuit breakers from terminal blocks. Voltage rating 1...25 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 240 V/DC 65 V resistive load Typical life > 10,000 operations at 1 x IN > 20,000 operations mechanical Ambient temperature -30°C...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Internal resistance (Ω) 1 1.10 2 0.25 3 0.13 4 0.07 6 0.04 8 0.02 10 0.02 16 < 0.02 25* < 0.02 2 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 250 V 1000 A cosϕ = 0.8 DC 65 V 2000 A L/R = 4 ms Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz), ± 0.38 mm (10-57 Hz); to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11ms) directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 20 g (11 ms) direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours in 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 80 g Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) AC 250V; DC 65V Current rating range *80% IN continuous load Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V, DC 65 V 1...25 A Demko/Semko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 1...16 A CSA/UL AC 250 V, DC 65 V 1...25 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 117 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S291-P9M2-410033-...A Dimensions Internal connection diagrams 3.6 LINE 1 LINE 1 11 11 unit 1 0 I 12 25° 25° 0 12 25 I 12 I> I> 18 ON 1 unit 2 OFF 2(k) OFF position 2(k) ON position 68 19 43 3.5 12.5 11.5 1 12 2k 3 10 1 11 2 Shock directions 2.1 5 12.5 6.8 6 4 1 40.8 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 50 mounting thread M3 max. screw length 5.8 mm tightening torque max. 0.5 Nm 32 2 unit II 12.5 9 8A unit I 16 Installation drawing 1 11 20 5 operating area (double insulation) 12 2k mounting area (standard insulation) 118 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S291-P9M2-410005-...A Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with trip-free, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation. Two-chamber construction with cascade contact arrangement to provide high voltage DC capability and high switching performance. Designed for plug-in mounting in distribution rails X 2210-S0606J, X2210-K... or terminal blocks 23-P10Si-202005 and 63-P10-Si-202005. Typical applications Communications systems, power supplies, process control equipment. 2210-S291-P9M2-410005-... A Technical data Accessories 23-P10-Si-202005 Lug mounted socket which accommodates one single pole two-chamber type 2210 circuit breakers. With push-on terminals. 63-P10-Si-202005 Lug mounted socket which accommodates 3 single pole two-chamber type 2210 circuit breakers. With push-on terminals. X 2210-S0606J Terminal rail X 2210-KA303 E X 2210-K0404 E X 2210-K0505 E X 2210-K0606 E X 2210-K0707 E X 2210-K0808 E X 2210-K0909 E 3-way terminal blocks 4-way terminal blocks 5-way terminal blocks 6-way terminal blocks 7-way terminal blocks 8-way terminal blocks 9-way terminal blocks X 211 018 01 Tool to aid withdrawal of circuit breakers from terminal blocks. Voltage rating AC 250V; DC 65V Current rating range 0.4...25 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 240 V/DC 65 V Typical life > 10,000 operations at 1 x IN > 20,000 operations mechanical Ambient temperature -30°C...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 250 V 0.4...1 A 1.6...25 A DC 65 V 0.4...4 A 6...25 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz), ± 0.38 mm (10-57 Hz); to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11ms) directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 20 g (11 ms) direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours in 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 80 g Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 0.4 6.87 0.65 1 Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 6 0.09 2.96 8 0.03 1.84 10 0.03 0.02 1.6 0.75 12 2 0.50 16 < 0.02 2.5 0.35 20* < 0.02 3 0.25 25* < 0.02 4 0.15 *80% IN continuous load 2 cosϕ = 0.8 self-limiting 2000 A L/R = 4 ms self-limiting 3500 A Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.4...25A Demko/Semko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.4...16 A CSA/UL AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.4...25 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 119 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S291-P9M2-410005-...A Dimensions Internal connection diagrams 3.6 LINE 1 LINE 1 11 11 unit 1 0 I 12 I 12 I> I> 25 25° 25° 0 12 18 1 unit 2 OFF ON I> I> 2(k) 2(k) OFF position ON position 68 19 43 3.5 12.5 11.5 12 2k 3 1 10 1 11 2 Shock directions 2.1 5 6 4 12.5 6.8 1 40.8 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 50 2 mounting thread M3 max. screw length 5.8 mm tightening torque max. 0.5 Nm 32 unit II 12.5 9 8A unit I 16 Installation drawing Selective back-up fuses operating area (double insulation) Voltage rating 1 11 20 5 DC 60 V AC 250 V Prospective shortcircuit Selective to NH fuse rating Current rating of 2210-S291-P2M2-410005 3500 A 2000 A 12 2k mounting area (standard insulation) 35 A ≤ 6A 50 A ≤ 12 A 63 A ≤ 20 A 80 A ≤ 25 A 100 A ≤ 25 A 35 A ≤ 3A 50 A ≤ 8A 63 A ≤ 20 A 80 A ≤ 25 A 100 A ≤ 25 A NH fuse according to VDE 0636, part 21 (IEC 269) NH fuse = low voltage power fuse 120 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S291-P9M2-410...-...A Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors shown to determine the circuit breaker rating required. 0.4...6 A AC Ambient temp. °C 0.4...6 A +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 10000 100 100 Trip time in seconds 1000 10 1 0 +10 +23 +30 +40 +50 0.1 +60 1.04 1.11 1.19 1.29 DC 10000 1000 Trip time in seconds -30 -20 -10 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.79 0.83 0.88 0.93 1 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 10 1 0.1 2 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current 8...25 A 1 AC 8...25 A +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 10000 DC 100 Trip time in seconds 100 Trip time in seconds 1000 1 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 1 Issue C +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 10 0.1 0.001 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current 10000 1000 10 2 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current ☎ 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 121 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-S291-P9M2-410...-...A Accessories Mounting sockets 23-P10-Si-202005 retaining clip Y 302 974 01 to special order polarized blade termminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 22.2 7.4 21 10 terminal 40.8 50 11 57.4 250V 1 E-T-A Typ 23 Gr. C 1 64 2 6.8 4.4 12 2(k) 12.5 6.8 3.5 coding plug 2 6 25 2 30 63-P10-Si-202005 polarized blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 22.2 21 10 7.4 3 2 1 1 11 50 E-T-A Typ 63 Gr. C 64 6.8 4 40.8 5 6.25 250V 6 12.5 57.4 4.4 12 50 6.8 12.5 3.5 2(k) 2 6 75 30 terminal coding plug Distribution rail X2210-S06... see pages 123 - 124 Distribution rail X2210-K... 122 ☎ see pages 125 - 129 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Distribution rail X2210-S06... Description E-T-A rails distribute electrical power in telecommunications, automation, data and control systems. They have been designed to industry standard requirements and are suitable for mounting in ETSI control cabinets. These distribution rails are supplied with mounting bracket, cover, 6 blanks and withdrawal tool. Live parts in terminal areas are protected against brush contact (VDE 106, part 100). Typical applications Telecommunications systems using ETSI racks; process control, measuring and control systems. Ordering information Type No. X2210 Module for circuit breaker type 2210-... Version S distribution rail Identification number 06 6 positions Terminal block (fitted) 00 without 01 1 x 02 2 x 03 3 x 04 4 x 05 5 x 06 6 x Accessories (fitted) G without H with mounting bracket J with mounting bracket, cover and 6 blanks K with mounting bracket, cover and 5 blanks L with mounting bracket, cover and 4 blanks M with mounting bracket, cover and 3 blanks N with mounting bracket, cover and 2 blanks P with mounting bracket, cover and 1 blank Q with mounting bracket and cover, without blanks R without mounting bracket, with cover and 6 blanks X2210 - S 06 06 J ordering example X2210-S06... with circuit breaker 2210-S291... Technical data Circuit breakers to be fitted 2210-S291-P9M2-410005 2210-S291-P9M2-410033 Voltage rating AC 250 V, DC 65 V Load max. 25 A per position max. 80 A for complete unit Signalisation (N/C contact) AC 240 V / DC 65 V max. 1 A per position Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 2.5 kV Flame resistance (IEC 695, part 2-2) self-extinguishing Terminal design input output ☎ Pollution degree 2 clamp-type terminal 2.5 to 25 mm2 clamp-type terminal 0.5 to 2.5 mm2 Typical volume resistances in main circuit input terminal B + (N) to output terminal + (N) < 1.5x10-3 Ω input terminal B - (U) to female contact 2 (k) < 1.5x10-3 Ω input terminal B-Sig to female contact 12 < 2x10-3 Ω output terminal - (U) to female contact 1 < 1.5x10-3 Ω output terminal - ⊥ to female contact 11 < 2x10-3 Ω Mass X2210-S0606J Issue C 2 660 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 123 Distribution rail X2210-S06... Dimensions Installation example voltage input mounting bracket withdrawal tool blank e.g. 2210-S291-P9M2-410005-…A terminal block legend strip 196 (N) (U) load input - cover 2 188 50 2 -1 Phillips screw M5 DIN 7985 (captive) 3 8.5 17 16.4 7 6.5 Phillips screw M2.5 DIN 41494 T1.5 (captive) 30.5 63.5 (U) 25 mm2 conductor size cable to be stripped over 15 mm 01 02 (N) Sig distribution rail 29 2.6 13.5 (158.3) 46 54.3 2.5 45 Sig 8 + 03 99 2.5 mm2 conductor size 04 Phillips screw M4 DIN 7985 terminal block circuit breaker 05 withdrawal tool X 211 018 01 06 legend strip 124 ☎ blank Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Distribution rail X2210-K... Description E-T-A rails distribute electrical power in telecommunications, automation, data and control systems. A compact version is available for 3 to 9 loads. Mounting brackets and cover are not included. Live parts in terminals areas are protected against brush contact (VDE 106 part 100). Typical applications Telecommunications systems (surveillance systems); process control. X2210-K... Ordering information Type No. X2210 Module for circuit breaker type 2210-... Version K compact distribution rail Identification number A3 for 3 circuit breakers 04 for 4 circuit breakers 05 for 5 circuit breakers 06 for 6 circuit breakers 07 for 7 circuit breakers 08 for 8 circuit breakers 09 for 9 circuit breakers Terminal block (intermediate element) (fitted) 00 without 01 1 x 02 2 x 03 3 x 04 4 x 05 5 x 06 6 x 07 7 x 08 8 x 09 9 x E short version X2210 - K 04 04 E ordering example for 4 positions Technical data Circuit breakers to be fitted 2210-S291-P9M2-410005 2210-S291-P9M2-410033 Voltage rating AC 250 V, DC 65 V Load max. 25 A per position max. 80 A for complete unit Signalisation (N/C contact) AC 240 V/DC 65 V max. 1 A per position Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 2.5 kV Flame resistance (IEC 695, part 2-2) self-extinguishing Terminal design input (terminal A/B): output (terminal block + or N, ⊥ or U) ☎ Pollution degree 2 clamp-type terminal 2.5 to 25 mm2 single and stranded conductor clamp-type terminal 0.5 to 2.5 mm2 single and stranded conductor Typical volume resistances in main circuit input terminal A/B +(N) to output terminal + (N) < 1,5 x 10-3 Ω input terminal A/B - (U) to female contact 2 (k) < 1,5 x 10-3 Ω input terminal A/B - Sig to female contact 12 < 2 x 10-3 Ω output terminal - (U) to female contact 1 < 1,5 x 10-3 Ω output terminal to female contact 11 < 2 x 10-3 Ω Mass X2210-K0404 E Issue C 2 approx. 280 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 125 Distribution rail X2210-K... Dimensions Internal connection diagram Distribution rail X2210-KA303 E X2210-K0404 E X2210-K0505 E X2210-K0606 E X2210-K0707 E X2210-K0808 E X2210-K0909 E 3-way 4-way 5-way 6-way 7-way 8-way 9-way B 99.6 125.2 150.7 176.3 201.9 227.5 253.1 A 116 141.5 167.5 193 218.5 244 270 distribution rail + Si circuit breaker 0 I I> 2.5 … 25 mm2 conductor size stripped over 15 mm 16.4 0.5 … 2.5 mm2 conductor size stripped over 11 mm I> 7 terminal block + 13.5 29 31 26.5 30.2 44 ø4.8 e.g. 2210-S291-P9M2-410033-…A 2 load ø8.8 2 - + I> 9 U 46 2.4 63.5 126 ☎ I> N 45 flat head screw ISO 7045-M4 to secure and withdraw terminal block terminal block + - load 17 insulation co-ordination to IEC 664 and 664A: 2.5kV/2 + terminal block ø9.5 0.5 … 2.5 mm2 conductor size stripped over 11 mm M6 15 contact point 25.4 36 2 ø12 10 Sig 23 25.6 B -0.8 max. A circuit breaker 0 I 1.2 29 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Distribution rail X2210-K01.../K02.../K03... Description E-T-A rails distribute electrical power in telecommunications, automation, data and control systems. They have been designed to the BW7R design requirement of the telecommunications industry. Mounting brackets and cover are not included. Live parts in terminal areas are protected against brush contact (VDE 106 part 100). Typical applications Telecommunications systems of the BW7R design; process control, measuring and control systems Ordering information Type No. X2210 Module for circuit breaker type 2210-... Version K distribution rail Identification number 01 standard 02 distribution rail for remote supply 03 distribution rail, separate rails (2x8 outputs) Terminal block (intermediate element) (fitted) 00 without 01 1 x 02 2 x 03 3 x 04 4 x 05 5 x 06 6 x 07 7 x 08 8 x 09 9 x 10 10 x 11 11 x 12 12 x 13 13 x 14 14 x 15 15 x 16 16 x Accessories (fitted) B insulating sleeving 2, cover 1 C insulating sleeving 2, cover 0 D insulating sleeving 0, cover 1 F insulating sleeving 1, cover 2, for remote supply X2210 - K 01 04 B ordering example X2210-K01.../K02.../K03... Technical data Circuit breakers to be fitted 2210-S291-P9M2-410005 2210-S291-P9M2-410033 Voltage rating AC 250 V, DC 65 V Load max. 25 A per position max. 80 A for complete unit Signalisation (N/C contact) AC 240 V/DC 65 V max. 1 A per position Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 asnd 664A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 2.5 kV Flame resistance (IEC 695, part 2-2) self-extinguishing Terminal design input (terminal A/B): output (terminal block + or N, ⊥ or U) ☎ Pollution degree 2 clamp-type terminal 2.5 to 25 mm2 single and stranded conductor clamp-type terminal 0.5 to 2.5 mm2 single and stranded conductor Typical volume resistances in main circuit input terminal A/B +(N) to output terminal + (N) < 1,5 x 10-3 Ω input terminal A/B - (U) to female contact 2 (k) < 1,5 x 10-3 Ω input terminal A/B - Sig to female contact 12 < 2 x 10-3 Ω output terminal - (U) to female contact 1 < 1,5 x 10-3 Ω output terminal to female contact 11 < 2 x 10-3 Ω Mass X2210-K0116 B Issue C 2 approx. 1140 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 127 Distribution rail X2210-K01.../K02.../K03... Connection Installation protection against electric shock * (insulating sleeving) connection pin (Cu 6 mm dia.) auxiliary contact of the CBEs (bridged between distribution rails on request) load circuits common auxiliary contact rail supply captive screw *** Sig (N) (U) current input cable slide (to eject the connection pin) terminal block (may be withdrawn to connect the load circuit) circuit breakers cover rack 2 Sig (N) (U) plug-in CBE ** captive screw *** 25 mm2 terminals (to connect the next distribution rail) Connection pins and insulating sleeves may be removed when the distribution rail is directly connected by cable. ** Inserted in cover. *** Also ground connection between distribution rail and 7R rack. Separate ground connection not required. * Internal connection diagram (U) – circuit breaker Sig terminal block (N) + captive screw blank 0 I I> The distribution rail is secured to the mounting bracket by means of the captive screws. A moulded cover is provided. Two aluminium brackets carry the distribution rail and the moulded cover, at the same time leaving room for the cables. Several units can similarly be mounted together. – + The supply cable which should be protected to a max. of 100 A is connected via a terminal block to the plus, minus and signal cables. Further distribution rails may be connected with power on by means of the insulated slide pins. load The distribution rail will accommodate up to 16 circuit breakers or similar components. 0 I An intermediate block is fitted for each position to facilitate installation of the load circuits in service. All 16 plug-in blocks can be inserted or removed by the Phillips screw. I> Load circuits can be safely installed without interrupting the supply. Finger-safe distribution rail components can also be inserted with power on. – + Plug-in connections ensure ease of intallation. terminal block load 128 The cover and blanks provide front of rail protection. – (U) ☎ Sig + (N) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Distribution rail X2210-K... Description Application E-T-A distribution rails ensure ease of expansion and retrofit without the need to disconnect the system. Safe operation with power on is ensured by the fully insulated plug-in design, enabling industry demands for trouble-free operation to be satisfied. Major benefits of this wellproven system include high reliability and user convenience. E-T-A distribution rails meet the needs of many power supply systems including the 7R design of the German telecommunications market. ● Telecommunications Terminal rails of the Bw7R type 2 design can be connected to power supplies providing AC 230 V (max. 275 V) or DC 60 V (max. 75 V). A back-up fuse with a max. rating of 100 A should be connected. Power distribution is by means of 16 outputs which are protected by E-T-A circuit breakers. Expansion is possible as required. Even where space is at a premium E-T-A circuit breakers type 2210S291-P9M2-410005-.., for both AC and DC use, will protect all downstream electrical equipment from overcurrent and short-circuits as well as providing protection against electrical shock hazards. The Bw7R type 2 configuration can be equipped with one standard unit and one modified version for remote supply devices. Additional versions of the standard type are suitable both for telecommunications and process control and automation. Power supply units of telecommunication equipment are typically connected downstream. - X2210-K0116 B is designed to power system units - X2210-K0212 F is designed for remote feeds Both terminal rails can be mounted in Bw7R racks, one unit requiring a space of 500 mm. ● Process control, automation and telecommunications Initially designed for Bw7R (vertical mounting), the terminal rails are also suitable for 19" control cabinets and other designs. Features Distribution rails ● Fully insulated design ● Distribution rail X2210-K0316 E Absolutely safe in operation even when retrofitted, as live parts cannot be touched. ● Ease of mounting Fastening of the assembly is by means of two bolts only. ● Ease of electrical installation The connection of only plus, minus and signal cable is required to operate the distribution rail for 16 outs. No further wiring is necessary. ● Cost-effective expansion Distribution rails can readily be installed in multiples. Safe electrical connection of several rails, even during systems operation, is by use of coupling pins. Positions 8 and 9 of this type are physically isolated so that two independent distribution rails with 8 outputs each are available in one housing. The signal contact rail is not isolated. Feed-in from both sides. Two separate power supplies which can carry different potentials (e.g. DC 65 V; AC 230 V) are accommodated on 500 mm spacings. ● Terminal strip X2210-K0404 E to X2210-K0404 E A compact version of the distribution rail is available for applications requiring small distribution rails with up to 9 outputs only but providing the same benefits as the standard version. Feed from one side allows the supply of 4 to 9 outputs. The compact distribution rail can be used where space is at a premium because its length may be varied. ● No costly system downtime Live components need not be disconnected when the system is expanded. ● Safe connection of the supply line Plug-in intermediate elements provide safe connection of the supply line independent of its position, thereby minimising installation difficulties. ● Ease of access Distribution rails can be mounted from the front. The load lines which are preconnected to the adapter plug can be easily inserted in the cable space obviating the need for costly threading. ● Compact design ● Group signalisation The circuit breakers suitable for the distribution rails comprise an auxiliary contact closing when the main contact opens. All auxiliary contacts are placed above the distribution rail, parallel between ground and the group signalisation rail. ● Single signalisation Single signalisation can be provided by means of a modified intermediate element. The ground connection generally required in telecommunication systems is obviated. ”Signal potential“ is applied to the terminal of the intermediate element as soon as the circuit breaker trips. The system manufacturer should however provide separate signal lines (max. 16) which should be connected to the ground terminal of the intermediate element. Optimum utilisation of the space available as circuit breakers, distribution rail and accessories have been designed in close cooperation with users and system designers. ● Electrical safety The system is suitable for voltages up to AC 275 V or DC 75 V (max. 100 A back-up fuse; 25 mm2 connecting cable). Insulation co-ordination in conformance with IECF 664 and 664A. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 129 2 2 130 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-T2.. Description One, two and three pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with tripfree, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation (S-type TM CBE to EN 60934/IEC 934). Featuring a combi-foot design for both symmetric and asymmetric rail mounting. Available with auxiliary contact (1 x N/ O or 1 x N/C) for status signalling. Two and three pole models are internally linked to ensure that both/all poles trip in the event of an overload on one pole, even if the actuator is held in the ON position. This CBE can be supplied in current ratings to 32 A with a choice of characteristic curves. All screw terminals are recessed for safety. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 2210-T2.. Process control equipment, robotics, machine tool control, communications systems, instrumentation. Ordering information Issue C ☎ 3 pole Technical data Type No. 2210 single and multi pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker Mounting T rail mounting Actuator design 2 toggle Number of poles 1 single pole protected 2 2 pole protected 3 3 pole protected 4 4 pole protected 5 2 pole, protected on one pole only Accessories 0 without accessories Terminal design (main contacts) K0 screw terminals Characteristic curve F1 fast acting: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn.2-4xIN DC (DC only) M1 standard delay: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 6-12xIN AC, 7.8-15.6xIN DC T1 delayed: therm. 1.01-1.4 IN; magn. 10-20xIN AC T2 thermal only, 1.01-1.4xIN M3 standard delay, low resistance: therm. 1.4-1.8xIN; magn. 6-12xIN AC, 7.8-15.6 x IN DC Auxiliary contact design H without intermediate position Auxiliary contacts 0 without auxiliary contacts 1 with auxiliary contacts 2 auxiliary contacts on pole 1 only (multi pole devices) 3 auxiliary contacts on pole 1 and 3 (≥3 pole devices) Auxiliary contact function 2 N/O contact 3 N/C contact Auxiliary contact - terminal design 1 screw terminals Current ratings 0.1 ... 32 A 2210 - T 2 1 0 - K0 M1 - H 1 2 1 - 10 A single pole Voltage rating AC 250 V; 3 AC 433 V (50/60 Hz); DC 65 V AC 277/480 V UL/CSA Current rating range 0.1...32 A (32 A resistive load only) Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 240 V / DC 65 V Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C (T 60) Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main/aux. circuit pole/pole Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 3000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.1...5 A 400 A; 6...32 A 800 A; Curve T2 : 0.1...32 A 15xIN Curve M3: 0.1... 2 A 200 A AC Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) IN 0.1...16 A 1 + 2 pole AC 277 V /5000 A 3 pole 3 AC 480 V /5000 A 1 + 2 pole DC 65 V /2000 A 20...32 A AC 277 V /2000 A 3 AC 480 V /2000 A DC 65 V / 2000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 20 Vibration Curve F1: 3 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.23 mm (10-57 Hz) Curves M1, M3, T1, T2: 5 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock Curve F1: 25 g (11 ms), directions 1,2,3,4,5 10 g (11 ms), direction 6 Curves M1, M3, T1, T2: 25 g (11 ms), directions 1,2,3,4,5 20 g (11 ms), direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 60 g per pole ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 131 2 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-T2.. Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values low resistance T2 slot fitting labels from Phoenix Weidmüller Wieland standard delay thermal for AC + DC 42 11.7 for AC + DC 77 23 9.2 6.6 6.0 2.9 5.7 0.5 6.8 4.1 3.9 1.75 3.7 0.6 4.2 3 2.7 1.42 2.6 0.8 2.8 1.65 1.53 0.75 1.39 1 1.6 1.10 0.98 0.5 0.9 1.5 0.78 0.47 0.42 0.22 0.36 2 0.42 0.28 0.24 0.136 0.19 2.5 0.26 0.183 0.17 0.083 0.141 3 0.18 0.124 0.12 0.057 0.091 4 0.12 0.077 0.073 0.041 0.051 5 0.092 0.063 0.055 0.032 0.040 6 0.054 0.045 0.039 0.021 0.027 8 0.025 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 10 0.022 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 12 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 16 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤␣ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 20 - ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 - ≤␣ 0.02 25 - ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 - ≤ 0.02 32 - ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 - ≤ 0.02 11.5 88.5 0.4 18 10.2 78.5 5.6 9-12 Si 2 Si 1 12-14 15 10.4 25 44 11.6 37.5 30.5 ON 7.5 17.5 20 OFF 12 0.3 45 12.5 12.5 43.5 G-profile EN 50035-G32 40 main contact terminal max. 6 mm2 (rigid conductor) tightening torque 0.5 Nm symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 EN 50022-35x15/1.5 Si-terminal max. 1.5 mm2 (rigid conductor) tightening torque 0.5 Nm 5.5 Approvals 12.5 unit III Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) 3 AC 433 V, AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1...32 A LRoS, BV 3 AC 433 V, AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1...32 A UL, CSA 3 AC 480 V, AC 277 V, DC 65 V 0.1...32 A unit II unit I 11.5 2 M3 5.5 Current Internal resistance (Ω) rating F1 M1 T1 (A) fast acting standard delay delayed for DC for AC + DC for AC 0.1 162 92 81 0.2 39.3 26.1 24.2 Dimensions multi pole devices Internal connection diagrams Installation drawing ...-H131-... OFF position line (Si) 0 I 1 11 NC contact 12 (Si) 12 (Si) I ...-H121-... 0 I I 2 line 1 (Si) 13 NO contact 0 I 2 line 1 14 (Si) 132 operating area (double insulation) ON position line (Si) 0 I 1 11 Si 1 Si 2 14 (Si) I I 2 2 ☎ (Si) 13 mounting area Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-T2.. Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +10 +23 +30 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.79 0.83 0.88 0.93 1 1.04 1.11 1.19 1.29 DC -M1 0,1...6 A -M1 8...32 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current -T1 0,1...6 A AC 1 2 -T1 8...32 A 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current AC 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current -M3 6...16 A AC* 0.001 1 2 -T2 0,1...6 A 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current AC/DC 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C Issue C 0.001 0.001 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current ☎ AC/DC 1 0.1 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 10 0.1 0.001 2 -T2 8...32 A 10000 10 AC* 1 0.1 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 10 0.1 0.001 2 -M3 0,1...5 A 10000 10 2 0.001 0.001 2 AC* 10 0.1 1 Trip time in seconds AC* 10000 0.001 Trip time in seconds N.B. * Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 30% on DC supplies. 10000 Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds -F1 0,1...16 A Multi pole devices: all poles symmetrically loaded. 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 133 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2210-T2.. Accessories Shock directions Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 black X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 brown 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper 5 6 1 ø2.5 2 ~70 3 4 Bus bar for 2 pole units X 221 497 01 9 x 25 = 225 25 L1 L2 L1 L2 1.3 2.5 L1 L2 L1 L2 L1 L2 L1 IEC 664 500 V/70 A (40°C) CE L2 L1 L2 L1 L2 L1 L2 L1 L2 E-T-A® GERMANY 29 12.5 12.5 14 2 250 6.5 Bus bar for 1 pole units X 221 498 01 16 x 12.5 = 200 12.5 2.5 29 1.3 14 IEC 664 500 V/70 A (40°C) CE E-T-A® GERMANY 207 3.5 Supply terminal for bus bar X 221 496 01 5.2 11 1.3 17 M4 2.5 4.6 9 conductor size max. 10 mm2 12 15 16 134 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2215-L.../G... Description Miniaturised single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with tripfree, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation (S-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Two designs provide the option of either printed circuit board or threadneck panel mounting. A separate shunt tap terminal and auxiliary contacts are available. Fast acting, medium or long delay characteristics can be specified for both models. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 935). Typical applications Control equipment, communications systems, instrumentation. 2215-L1.. Ordering information Technical data Type No. 2215 single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker Mounting G1 threadneck panel mounting L1 PCB mounting Number of poles 1 1 pole protected Mounting hardware 0 without accessories 1 2 hex nuts 1/4"-40 UNS-2A, serrated washer, location pin (-G1 only) Terminal design (main contacts) P1 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 without shunt terminal B1 blade terminals 6.3-0.8, with shunt terminal L1 solder pins, without shunt terminal M1 solder pins, with shunt terminal Characteristic curve F1 fast acting: 1.01-1.4xIN ; magn. 2-4xIN DC (DC only) M1 standard delay: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 5-10xIN DC; magn. 3.5-8xIN AC T1 delayed: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn.10-16xIN AC Auxiliary contacts S0 without auxiliary contact S1 with auxiliary contact (change over) Auxiliary contact - terminal design 1 blade terminals 6.3x0.8 -G1 2 solder pins -L1 Current ratings 0.05...10 A 2215 - G1 1 1 - P1 F1 - S1 1 - 0.5 A Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 48 V (higher DC voltages to special order) Current rating range 0.05...10 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 250 V/DC 28 V Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main/aux. circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 300 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) 200 A 1000 A 2000 A 200 A Vibration Curve F1: 6 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.46 mm (10-57 Hz) Curves M1, T1: 8 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock Curves F1, M1, T1: 30 g (11 ms), directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, Curve F1: 10 g (11 ms), direction 6 Curves M1, T1: 15 g (11 ms), direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Internal resistance (Ω) Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 25 g ordering example 440 1.5 0.54 0.1 108 2 0.33 0.2 29.9 2.5 0.20 0.3 14.2 3 0.14 0.4 7.9 4 0.084 0.5 5.0 5 0.057 0.6 3.5 6 0.8 1.8 8 ≤ 0.02 1 1.19 10 ≤ 0.02 ☎ UN AC 250 V AC 250 V AC 250 V DC 50 V operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 0.05 Issue C IN 0.05 A 0.1...6 A 8...10 A 0.05...10 A 2 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current ratings (A) 2215-G1.. 0.043 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 135 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2215-L.../G... Dimensions 2215-L1... 25° 0 ø1.5 25.6 12 • 11 14 6 8.6 4 1 4 11.5 11 12 11 14 19 LINE 2 1 1x0.8 2.5 2 11 A3 LINE 10.6 5 35 49 52 16 1.7 14 I operating area (double insulation) 4 spacer 14 25° Installation drawing 3 29 mounting area (standard insulation) 2 Dimensions 2215-G1... Internal connection diagram 0 10° 10° I line 1 11 tightening torque max. 1 Nm 0 ø3 I (3) 12 threadneck 1/4"-40 UNS-2A 8 hex nut 14 19 serrated washer I lock washer 53.5 52.5 2 LINE 11 12 11 14 1 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 9 2 Shock directions 5 2.5 • 6 3 6 11.5 29 4 front panel cut-out ø6.4 1 +0.1 6.1 2 ø2.4 +0.1 Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...10 A UL AC 250 V, DC 50 V 0.05...10 A CSA AC 250 V, DC 48 V 0.05...10 A Semko AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.1 ...10 A 136 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2215-L.../G... Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +10 +20 +30 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.79 0.83 0.88 0.93 1 1.04 1.11 1.19 1.29 -F1 0.05...6 A DC -F1 8...10 A N.B. *Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 30% on DC supplies. DC -M1 0.05...6 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 10 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 1 2 -M1 8...10 A AC* 0.001 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 2 -T1 0.05...6 A 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC* 1 1000 1000 100 100 100 1 Trip time in seconds 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC* 1 0.1 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 10 0.1 0.001 2 -T1 8...10 A 10000 10 2 1 0.1 0.001 AC* 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 137 2 138 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker E2215 for 19" Rack Mounting Description Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker mounted on Euro Card for 19" rack mounting, with one Euro Card accommodating up to three circuit breakers. Convenient toggle actuation enables series 2210 additionally to be used as an ON/OFF switch. A red LED is located in the front frame of the Euro Card, indicating the switching status of the circuit breaker (via the auxiliary circuit). Typical applications Process control, measuring and control systems, telecommunications. E2215-... Ordering information for circuit breakers only Type No. E2215 Technical data Circuit Breaker Mounting 1 3 x 1 pole, mounted symmetrically (standard) 2 2 x 1 pole, mounted centrally above and below 3 2 x 1 pole, mounted above and below 4 2 x 1 pone, mounted below and centrally 5 1 x 1 pole, mounted above 6 1 x 1 pole, mounted centrally 7 1 x 1 pole, mounted below Handle 1 aluminium handle (standard) LED 1 red LED, DC 24 V (standard) Circuit breaker Actuator design L2 moulded toggle Number of poles 1 single pole protected Accessories 0 without Terminal design P1 blade terminals A6.3-9,8 (standard) Characteristic curve 01 F1 fast acting: therm. 1.01x1.4 IN; magn. 2-4xIN DC (DC only) 02 M1 standard delay: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 5-10xIN DC; magn. 3.5-8xIN DC 03 T1 delayed: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 6-13xIN AC Auxiliary contacts S1 with auxiliary contacts (change over) Auxiliary contact - terminal design 1 same as main terminals Current ratings 0.05...10 A E2215 - 3 1 1 - L2 1 2 Main circuit: voltage rating AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 48 V current rating range 0.05...10 A standard current ratings 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.8 A 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 A 6 8 10 A Auxiliary circuit: voltage rating AC 250 V/DC 28 V current rating 1A Other data see type 2215 Front plate Dimensions: width height Material 4 TE (1 TE = 5.08 mm) 3 HE (1 HE = 44.45 mm) aluminium, anodized LED Max. voltage rating DC 24 V 0 - 02 - S1 1 - 0.1 A ordering example Select the circuit breakers to above ordering information. For further information please refer to pages 135 - 137. It is possible to fit circuit breakers of mixed current ratings on the Euro Card. Please add "Circuit breakers to be mounted on Euro Card" to the circuit breaker designation when ordering so that the applicable suffix number for the special version (E2215-L2..) can be determined . 19" racks may also be fitted with one or two circuit breakers by the customer, using industry standard components such as base plates, front plates with handle, sockets. Connection by means of blade terminals 6.3x0.8 mm. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 139 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker E2215 for 19" Rack Mounting Dimensions multi-pin connector unit II (GII) unit I (GI) ON OFF LED I R1 3 HE X 100 ON OFF R2 ON OFF R3 unit III (GIII) 174 4 TE Terminal selection Wiring diagram for LED-display view X 2 d b z GI 12 11 14 GII 12 11 14 GIII 12 11 14 GI GII GIII 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 d4 b4 + R1 d10 b10 + R2 d16 b16 + R3 LED 20 2 1 2 1 2 1 22 z4 z10 z16 24 26 28 30 32 Connection of the Euro Card to DIN 41612 with socket type H7/F24-F413.173 Connection of the 19" rack to DIN 41494. Internal connection diagrams applicable to all circuit breakers, G I to G III 0 I line 1 11 12 14 I> 2 OFF position 140 ☎ 0 I line 1 11 12 14 I> 2 ON position Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2215-F1... Description Miniaturised two pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with trip-free, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation (S-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Fitted with panel mounting flange and push-on termination, also suitable for mounting on Euro Cards. Available with auxiliary contacts and a choice of fast, medium or long delay characteristics. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Control equipment, communications systems, instrumentation. 2215-F1... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 2215 double pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker Mounting F1 flange mounting, with M3 mounting thread Number of poles 2 2 pole protected 5 2 pole, protected on one pole only Accessories 0 without Terminal design (main contacts) P1 blade terminals 6.3 x 0.8 mm, without shunt terminal Characteristic curve F1 fast acting: 1.01-1.4xIN ; magn. 2-4xIN DC (DC only) M1 standard delay: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 5-10xIN DC; magn. 3.5-8xIN AC T1 delayed: therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 8-16xIN DC; magn. 6-13xIN AC Auxiliary contacts S0 without auxiliary contacts S1 with auxiliary contacts (change over) S2 with auxiliary contact on pole 1 only Auxiliary contact - terminal design 1 blade terminals 6.3x0.8 Current ratings 0.05...10 A 2215 - F1 2 0 - P1 F1 - S1 1 - 0.5 A Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 48 V (higher DC voltage to special order) Current rating range 0.05...10 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 250 V/DC 28 V resistive load Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole/pole main/aux. circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 600 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration Curve F1: 6 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.46 mm (10-57 Hz) Curves M1, T1: 8 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock Curves F1, M1, T1: 30 g (11 ms), directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Curve F1: 10 g (11 ms), direction 6 Curves M1, T1: 15 g (11 ms) direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 50 g ordering example Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current ratings (A) Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 0.05 440 0.1 108 Current ratings (A) 1.5 Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 0.54 2 0.33 0.2 29.9 2.5 0.20 0,3 14.2 3 0.14 0.4 7.9 4 0.084 0.5 5.0 5 0.057 0.6 3.5 6 0.8 1.8 8 ≤ 0.02 1 1.19 10 ≤ 0.02 Issue C ☎ 2 0.043 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 141 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2215-F1... Internal connection diagram Dimensions 2215-F1... 42 0 line 1 3 I 34 25° 25° 21 15.5 0 12 14 22 24 13.5 I 11 I I 2 4 52.6 M3 Shock directions LINE 12 11 14 1 9 2 2.5 6 • 2 5 11.5 0.5 29 6 3 22.5 4 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 1 front panel cut-out 17 ø3.4 2 13 34 Installation drawing 2 12 11 14 1 4 11 LINE 19 35 16 14 operating area (double insulation) 3 mounting area (standard insulation) 142 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 2215-F1... Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +10 +23 +30 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.79 0.83 0.88 0.93 1 1.04 1.11 1.19 1.29 -F1 0.05...6 A DC -F1 8...10 A N.B. *Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 30% on DC supplies. DC -M1 0.05...6 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 -M1 8...10 A AC* 2 -T1 0.05...6 A 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC* 1 1000 1000 100 100 100 1 Trip time in seconds 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC* 1 0.1 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 10 0.1 0.001 2 -T1 8...10 A 10000 10 2 0.001 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC* 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 143 2 144 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 3120-...-M1-.. Description Single or two pole rocker switch/thermal-magnetic circuit breaker (Stype TM CBE to EN 60934). The addition of a magnetic tripping module to the type 3120 range described in catalogue section 1 extends the choices available to include single pole with thermal-magnetic protection; double pole switching with thermal-magnetic protection on one pole, thermal protection on the other; double pole switching with thermal-magnetic protection on one pole only. All are offered with rocker switch or push button control - two buttons for ON/OFF or one button press-to-reset only, in designs to suit one of three different panel cut-out sizes. Neon illumination (filament bulb for low voltages) is optional. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications 3120-...-M... Motors, machine tools, office equipment, appliances. Accessories Y 303 068 01 Technical data Insulated cover, snap-fitted to the exposed areas of the two incoming terminals (when terminal screws are not specified) to provide brush contact protection. Retaining clip for -F3 mounting frame for panel thicknesses under 2 mm. As above for panel thicknesses under 4 mm. Blanking piece in -F3 size mounting frame. Separate water splash cover for use with -F4 and -F5 size mounting frames. Y 303 675 01 Y 303 675 02 Y 303 885 31 X 210 832 01 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current ratings (A) 0.1 Internal resistance per pole (Ω) therm-.magn. therm. 165 94 Current ratings (A) 2.5 Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 50 V Current ratings 0.1...16 A Typical life 50,000 operations at 1xIN double pole 30,000 operations at 1xIN single pole 2 Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area therm-.magn. therm. Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area current path/ current path 0.20 0.0785 Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.1...2 A 100 x IN 2.5...16 A 250 A 2 pole 150 A 1 pole Internal resistance per pole (Ω) 0.2 42.5 24 3 0.14 0.0595 0.3 20.2 12 3.5 0.114 0.0565 0.4 9.7 5.40 4 0.092 0.0435 0.5 7.17 4.30 5 0.06 0.0325 0.6 4.9 3 6 0.043 0.0215 0.8 2.65 1.50 7 0.030 0.0215 1 1.49 0.9 8 0.029 0.02 1.2 1.25 0.7 10 0.021 0.02 1.5 0.74 0.45 14 <0.02 <0.02 2 0.49 0.29 16 <0.02 <0.02 Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) AC 240 V, DC 28 V 0.1...16 A DC 50 V 0.1...16 A double pole DC 50 V 0.1...10 A single pole CSA, UL AC 250 V 0.1...14 A Issue C ☎ AC 1500 V IN 0.1...4 A 5... 10 A 12...14 A UN AC 250 V AC 250 V AC 125 V 200 A 2000 A 1000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 (with water splash protection IP 54) terminal area IP 00 Vibration 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 30 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 53 g (2 pole) approx. 50 g (1 pole) Approvals Authority Test voltage AC 3000 V Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 145 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 3120-...-M1-.. Ordering information Type 3120 2 Ordering information rocker switch/circuit breaker Mounting F snap-in frame Size of frame panel thickness 3 to fit in cut-out 50.5x21.5 mm 1 - 6.35 mm 4 to fit in cut-out 44.5x22 mm 1 - 2.5 mm 5 to fit in cut-out 44.5x22 mm 2.6 - 4 mm 6 to fit in cut-out 45x33.7 mm 1.2 - 2.4 mm Number of poles 1 1 pole, thermal-magnetic protection 2 2 pole, thermal-magnetic protection on one pole, thermally protected on the other pole 5 2 pole, thermal-magnetic protection on one pole, unprotected on the other pole Mounting frame design 1 collar height 1 mm 3 collar height 9 mm (with safety frame) 4 collar height 2 mm, with water splash protection (IP 54) (not with -F6 frame) Terminal configuration P7 blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 mm (terminals 12(k), 22(k), 11, 21) H7 12(k), 22(k): blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 11, 21: terminal screws M3.5, blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 N7 as P7, but shunt terminals (12(i) and 22(i)) are blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 G7 as H7, but shunt terminals (12(i) and 22(i)) are blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 Characteristic curve M1 standard delay, therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 4-9xIN AC Switch style W rocker Switch colour designation OPAQUE TRANSLUCENT (for illuminated versions) 01 black 02 white 04 red 12 white 14 red 15 orange 19 green Rocker markings A 0 AUS OFF B I EIN ON C D 0 AUS OFF E I EIN ON F A B C D E F X X X = without marking Rocker illumination (optional) B with illumination AC/DC G green LED, AC/DC Y yellow LED, AC/DC R red LED, AC/DC Illumination voltage range/ power consumption 4-7 V/6 V/80 mA (B,G,Y,R) 0 1 10-14 V/12 V/75mA (B,G,Y,R) 2 20-28 V/24 V/35mA (B,G,Y,R) 3 90-140 V/115 V/<1 mA (B) 4 185-275 V/230 V/<1 mA (B) 5 Type 3120 push button switch/circuit breaker Mounting F snap-in frame Size of frame 2 special frame for fitting splash cover 3 to fit in cut-out 50.5x21.5 mm panel thickness 1 - 6.35 mm Number of poles 1 1 pole, thermal-magnetic protection 2 2 pole, thermal-magnetic protection on one pole, thermally protected on the other pole 5 2 pole, thermal-magnetic protection on one pole, unprotected on the other pole Mounting frame design F frame with two push buttons G frame with one push button Terminal configuration P7 blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 mm (terminals 12(k), 22(k), 11, 21) H7 12(k), 22(k): blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 11, 21: terminal screws M3.5, blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 N7 as P7, but shunt terminals (12(i) and 22(i)) are blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 G7 as H7, but shunt terminals (12(i) and 22(i)) are blade terminals 2x2.8-0.8 Characteristic curve M1 standard delay, therm. 1.01-1.4xIN; magn. 4-9xIN AC Switch style/colour D 1 push button (reset only) 01X black 04X red 12X white translucent 19X green translucent S 2 push buttons ON/OFF GRX green translucent/red WRX white translucent/red WBX white translucent/black Push button illumination (optional) B filament bulb (AC/DC) L neon (AC) G green LED, AC/DC Y yellow LED, AC/DC R red LED, AC/DC Illumination voltage range/ power consumption 4-7 V/6 V/80 mA (B,G,Y,R) 0 1 10-14 V/12 V/75mA (B,G,Y,R) 2 20-28 V/24 V/35mA (B,G,Y,R) 3 90-140 V/115 V/<1 mA (L) 4 185-275 V/230 V/<1 mA (L) 5 42-54 V/48 V/35 mA (Y,R) Current ratings 0.1...16 A 3120 - F 3 2 F - N7 M1 - S GRX L 4 - 10 A ordering example 42-54 V/48 V/35 mA (B,Y,R) Current ratings 0.1...16 A 3120 - F 3 2 1 - N7 M1 - W 12 A B 4 - 10 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. 146 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 3120-...-M1-.. Dimensions Mounting frame variants Mounting style -F3.1, with rocker Collar height 1 mm Mounting style -F3.3, with rocker collar height 9 mm optional illumination OFF position 25 16 54 35 25 19.5 33 30 3.5 Flat-head screw M3.5x5 ISO 1580 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm flat-head screw M3.5x5 ISO 1580 tightening torque max.0.8 Nm 3.5 30 10 10 33 35 35 7 9 54 15.5 9 9 15.5 blade terminal DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 18 blade terminals DIN 46244-C-Ms-S 18 14 21 41 2 14 21 41 Mounting style -F3.4, with rocker collar height 2 mm, with water splash protection Installation drawing 56 35 10 Required safety distances for rocker and push button 3.8 27 19.5 10 15.5 operating area Mounting style -F3.F-..-S.., with 2 push buttons optional illumination OFF position 54 25 14.2 16.2 8 7 7 10 15 mounting area 10 7 Cut-out dimensions Cut-out for mounting style -F3 with rocker and push button x. min. 2.5 panel thickness ma Cut-out for mounting style -F6 with rocker R2 50.5 +0.3 0.3 .R x ma -0.4 -0.2 min. 2 ma x. R 1.5 “A” .,3 R0 x. ma 44.5 +0.2 optional illumination OFF position 54 25 15 16.2 14.2 10 21.5 -0.2 min. 2 ma x. R 1.5 .3 x. ma +0.3 1-2.5 for ...F4 2.6-4 for ...F5 Cut-out for mounting style -F4/-F5 with rocker -0.4 panel thickness 1.2 +0.4 1.6 +0.8 2.4 +10 0 0 +1.1 45 +2.2 dimension “A” 45 +0,2 45 -0.05 -0.05 -0.05 R0 For mounting styles -F2.., -F4.., -F5.., -F6.. please see pages 67 and 71 22 Issue C Mounting style -F3.G-...-D..., with 1 push button 33.7 +0.2 - 0.05 +0.2 1-6.35 -0.4 -0.2 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 147 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 3120-...-M1-.. Internal connection diagrams Accessories therm.-magn. protection on one pole thermally protected on the other pole Insulated cover Y 303 068 01 therm.-magn. protection on one pole unprotected on the other pole line 11 2.5 line 21 21 0.9 9 11 22(k) 22(i) Retaining clip for 3120-F5... Y 303 676 01 Retaining clip for 3120-F3... Y 303 675 01/02 12(k) I> 20 I> 58 50.5 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 44.5 sharp-edged R * 1 1 22 AC 28 1 R3 Single or double pole load 0.1...2 A 100 0.8 Blanking piece in -F3... size mounting frame Y 303 885 31 matt finish 10 25 54 16.5 31 1 1 Trip time in seconds without bends Y303 675 01 suitable for panel thickness < 2 mm Y303 675 02 suitable for panel thickness < 4 mm 1000 2.5 10000 33 36 0.1 0.01 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 2.5...16 A 21 41 AC 10000 N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 25% on DC supplies. 1000 Separate water splash cover for use with -F4../-F5.. size mounting frames X 221 619 01 48 25 100 10 ø8 1 16.5 Trip time in seconds 0.1 3.4 ø4.4 0.01 35 2 52 R 12 35 0. 12 28 12(k) 12(i) 22.5 22(i) 0. 1 12(i) 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.8 0.84 0.88 0.92 1 1.08 1.14 1.23 148 ☎ 60 73 Separate water splash cover for style -F2 see page 72 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3200 Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, press-to-reset, snap action mechanism and additional manual release (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Designed for plug-in mounting with E-T-A sockets 10 and 16. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Control equipment, extra-low voltage wiring systems and components. 3200-... Technical data Accessories 10R-K10 10R-P10 10R-A10 Y 301 166 02 Y 301 166 01 16 Y 301 477 01 Modular snap-together surface mounted sockets, each accommodating two plug-in circuit breakers. With screw terminals. As above but with push-on terminals. As above but with a combination of screw and push-on terminals. Two-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10 sockets. Four-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10 sockets. Single socket for symmetric EN rail mounting. Blanking plug with insulated pins, for sockets 10, 20, 40, 60. 50-way 1.5mm2 cable links with pre-fitted connection lugs for type 10F-K10/-A10 sockets. As above but with 2.5mm2 cable links. 100-way 1.5mm2 cable links with pre-fitted push-on connectors for type 10F-P10 sockets. As above but with 2.5mm2 cable links. Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 28 V 2 Current ratings 0.05...25 A Typical life 4000 operations at 2xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V double insulation Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...0.8 A 1...2 A 2.5...25 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz)±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Type No. 3200 plug-in Current ratings 0.05...25 A Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca 3200 - 5 A Mass approx. 50 g X 210 589 01 X 210 589 02 X 210 588 01 X 210 588 02 Ordering information ordering example Standard current ratings and typical internal resistances Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) self-limiting 200 A 400 A Approvals Internal resistance (Ω) Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...25 A 0.05 534 4 0.141 CSA AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...15 A 0.1 149 5 0.107 LRoS AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.3 ...25 A 0.2 56 6 0.060 0.3 24.2 7 0.049 0.4 13.6 8 < 0.02 0.5 8.1 10 < 0.02 0.6 5.25 12 < 0.02 0.8 3.55 14 < 0.02 1 2.02 15 < 0.02 1.5 0.90 16 < 0.02 2 0.51 18 < 0.02 2.5 0.36 20 < 0.02 3 0.23 25 < 0.02 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 149 Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3200 Dimensions Internal connection diagram ON 10 ø13 48.5 15.5 OFF line 1 ø9.5 I > 2 2 9.6 1 19 current rating in A 11 2 14 43 19 50 2 Installation drawing 1 43 34.5 operating area (double insulation) Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 2 6 N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Typical time/current characteristics 0.05...7 A AC AC 18...25 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 1 2 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current ☎ AC 10 0.1 0.001 150 8...16 A 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breaker 3200 Accessories Sockets (continuous load up to 16 A) 10R-K10 10R-P10 1 Blanking plug Y 301 477 01 for sockets 10R-P10/K10/A10 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 13 12 1 42 27.5 14 1.5 9.5 22 21 30 12 68 12 21 11 22 6 9.5 11 50 12 5.6 30 Terminal for mounting rack (DIN/EN 50035-G32) X 200 800 01 for sockets 10R, 10F 7 8 45 75 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 M5 x 12 19 50 12 15 9.5 7,5 ø4 14.5 27 10R-A10 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 for sockets 20, 40, 60, 10R-K10/-A10 and 16 22 21 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper 7 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid Bus bars for sockets 10...: Y 301 166 02, two-way 12.5 8.5 4.2 Y 301 166 01, four-way 15 ø2.5 2.9 7.9 2 ~70 12 11 59 8 15 t = 0.8 15 15 52.9 22.9 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5mm2, brown X 210 588 02/2.5mm2, black X 210 588 03/2.5mm2, red X 210 588 04/2.5mm2, blue for sockets 10R-P10, 10R-A10 Socket 16 39.5 32 38.5 15 1.5 Adapter for socket 16 X 200 409 01 for track mounting to EN 50035-G32 (G profile) on request 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated ~70 70 52 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 151 2 152 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3300/3400 Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with tease-free, trip-free, press-to-reset, snap action mechanism (R-type TM CBE to EN 60934; M-type with manual release -H). Available with fast acting and standard magnetic tripping characteristics - types 3300 and 3400 - both with threadneck panel mounting. Options include auxiliary contacts, a separate shunt tap terminal (-A3), and pull-to-trip manual release (-H). Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Control systems, instrumentation, medical equipment, machine tools, robotics. Accessories X 210 663 01 Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly for version with press-to-reset only (-IG2). Concertina style splash cover/hex nut assembly for version with press-to-reset only (-IG2). X 200 801 08 Ordering information Type No. 3300 fast acting 3400 standard delay Mounting IG2 moulded threadneck M12x1, protection class II, (bulk-shipped) not with -H;leave blank for metal threadneck (required for -H) Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 K20 screw terminals M3.5x5.5 with clamp (not for -Si and -A3) Shunt terminal (optional) A3 same as main terminals, up to IN=7 A max. load 5 A Manual release (optional) H manual release facility (pull) for M12x1 metal threadneck only *) Auxiliary contacts (optional) Si with silver-plated solder terminals (N/O and N/C) Current ratings 0.05...16 A 3400 - IG2 - P10 - - 3400 - - H - Si - 10 A - P10 - - Si - 10 A ordering example, without manual release and with moulded threadneck ordering example, with manual release and metal threadneck Internal resistance (Ω 3300 3400 Current ratings (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 3300 3400 0.05 477 447 3 0.18 0.19 0.1 131 131 4 0.109 0.090 0.2 41 40 5 0.066 0.061 0.3 19.6 19.3 6 0.046 0.041 0.4 10.4 10.4 7 0.032 0.034 0.5 7.2 7.1 8 0.020 ≤0.02 0.6 4.8 4.3 10 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 0.8 2.5 2.5 12 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 1 1.93 1.67 13 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 1.5 0.81 0.61 14 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 2 0.44 0.38 15 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 2.5 0.27 0.24 16 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 Issue C ☎ standard delay Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 65 V 2 Current ratings 0.05...16 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 250 V/DC 65 V Typical life 5000 operations at 2xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) operating area Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main circuit/aux. circuit aux. circuit 4-5/6-7 Test voltage AC 3000 V double insulation AC 1500 V AC 840 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...0.8 A self-limiting 1...2 A 200 A 2.5...16 A 400 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) IN 0.05...16 A 0.05...16 A UN AC 250 V DC 80 V 1000 A 1000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass 3300: approx. 55 g 3400: approx. 50 g Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current ratings (A) 3400 fast acting Technical data *) metal threadneck version for -H is not approved. The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. 3300 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 153 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3300/3400 Dimensions Internal connection diagrams -IG2-P10 line 1 3 10 ON 16 line 1 M12x1 tightening torque max. 1.5 Nm 11 50.3 (-IG2) 52.3 (-H) OFF 22.5 ø6.4 42 6 3 from IN=8 A I> I> 2 with shunt terminal (-A3) 2 and auxiliary contacts (-Si) 14.5 -P10-A3 5 11.5 -0.1 11.4 SW14 4 Einbauloch 29 2 7 Terminal design blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 current rating in A 5 ø12.2 -0.1 1 3 2 ø6.4 ON OFF -H 10.5 -P10-Si 46 2 7 1 18.5 24.5 M12x1 -K20 5 mounting holes 1.5 2 9 1 ø12.5 +0.2 9.5±0.2 M3.5x5.5 ISO 1207 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm ø3 +0.2 Installation drawing Approvals 3 max. 2.5 operating area (double insulation) 41 26 (max. 2 mm when fitted with water splash cover) 1 3 Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Demko, AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...16 A LRoS AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.3 ...16 A CSA, UL AC 250 V, DC 80 V 0.05...16 A Nemko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...15 A (3300) AC 250 V 0.05...16 A (3400) Semko AC 250 V 2 A and 2.5 A Metal threadneck version for -H is not approved 3 mounting area 154 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3300/3400 Typical time/current characteristics Type 3300 0.05...7 A AC Type 3400 0.05...7 A +60 °C 10000 AC +60 °C 10000 +23 °C +23 °C 1000 Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds 100 10 1 -30 °C 1000 -30 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 2 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Type 3300 8...16 A 1 2 Type 3400 8...16 A AC +60 °C 10000 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC +60 °C 10000 +23 °C +23 °C -30 °C 1000 100 Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds 100 10 1 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Accessories For push buttons with M12 moulded threadneck (-IG2) Hex nut with splash cover, black X 201 296 01 (IP 64) X 200 801 08 (IP 66)with O-ring M12x1 Issue C -30 °C 1000 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Water splash cover, transparent with knurled nut X 210 663 01 (IP 64) M12x1 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 155 2 156 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3500/4000 Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and two button operation (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Featuring a flange for panel mounting, and optional auxiliary contacts and unprotected shunt tap terminal. Type 4000 offers lower internal resistance values and is fitted as standard with auxiliary contacts and an intermediate reset position in which all contacts are isolated. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Control systems, instrumentation, medical equipment, machine tools, robotics, communications systems. 3500 standard type Ordering information Technical data Type No. 3500 standard version 4000 low resistance version Mounting (optional) F11 flange with additional M3 insertion nuts Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8, tinned K20 screw terminals M 3.5x5.5 with clamp (not with -Si or type 4000) Shunt terminal (optional) A3 same as main terminals (up to IN = 7 A, max. load 5 A) Auxiliary contacts (optional with type 3500) Si auxiliary contacts, silver plated terminals one each N/O and N/C ZR-Si auxiliary contacts with intermediate position (standard with type 4000) Current ratings 0.05...16 A (type 3500) 0.05...10 A (type 4000) 3500 - - P10 - A3 - Si - 10 A Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 65 V Current rating range 3500: 0.05...16 A 4000: 0.05...10 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 250 V/DC 65 V Typical life 5,000 operations at 2xIN -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main/aux. circuit aux. circuit 4-5/6-7 Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 840 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 3500 0.05...0.8 A 1...2 A 2.5...16 A 4000 0.05...0.2 A 0.3...2 A 2.5...10 A self-limiting 200 A 400 A IN 0.05...16 A 0.05...16 A UN AC 250 V DC 80 V 1000 A 1000 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) type 3500 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current ratings (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 3500 4000 0.05 447 211 3 0.19 0.054 0.1 131 48 4 0.090 0.035 0.2 40 12.4 5 0.061 0.025 0.3 19.3 5.4 6 0.041 ≤0.02 0.4 10.4 3.1 7 0.034 ≤0.02 0.5 7.1 2.0 8 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 0.6 4.3 1.32 10 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 0.8 2.5 0.76 12 ≤0.02 1 1.67 0.49 14 ≤0.02 1.5 0.61 0.21 15 ≤0.02 2 0.38 0.101 16 ≤0.02 2.5 0.24 0.078 ☎ Current ratings (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 3500 4000 2 Ambient temperature ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Issue C 4000 low-resistance type Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 40 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 157 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3500/4000 Dimensions Internal connection diagrams with shunt terminal (-A3) and auxiliary contacts (-Si) ø8.5 4 line 1 line 1 46.5 6.3 2.5 4.5 3 11 11.5 4 6 I> I> 2 2 3 from IN=8 A line 1 5 7 4 6 line 1 5 7 4 6 line 1 5 7 4 6 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 50 3 29 2 7 Switching position with intermediate position and auxiliary contacts (-ZR-Si) 42 current rating in A 5 4.5 11 OFF ON 15.5 9.5 Version -P10 M3 insertion nuts (-F11) 20 I> 5 2 OFF position ø3.5 58 3 from IN=8 A Installation drawing 3 I> 3 from IN=8 A 2 intermediate position 3 I> 3 from IN=8 A 2 ON position Terminal design -P10-A3 operating area (double insulation) max. 2.5 7 7 -P10-Si -P10-A3-Si 8 1 -K20 mounting area 1.5 9 5 M3.5x5.5 ISO 1207 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings 3500: VDE, Demko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...16 A CSA, UL AC 250 V, DC 80 V 0.05...16 A Nemko, Semko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...10 A LRoS AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.3 ...16 A 4000: VDE, Demko, Semko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...10 A LRoS AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.3 ...10 A CSA, Nemko AC 250 V 0.05...10 A 158 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3500/4000 Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 3500 0.05...7 A AC* 3500 8...16 A N.B. * Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. ** Magnetic tripping currents are decreased by 20% on AC supplies. AC* 4000 0.05...10 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C Issue C 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current ☎ DC** 2 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 159 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3500 Special version 3500-...-2100 Special version 3500-...-2350 Single pole thermal-magnetic overcurrent circuit breaker with slow magnetic trip curve, suitable for high inrush currents (up to 12xIN). Suffix -2100 is also available for types 3400 and 3600. Enquire for further details. Typical applications Typical applications Industrial control systems, telecommunications, etc. Industrial control systems Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Internal resistance (Ω) 292 165 41.7 19.7 12.1 7.9 5.5 2.6 1.88 0.77 0.42 0.24 Current rating (A) 3 4 5 6 7 8 10 12 14 15 16 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.18 0.11 0.067 0.052 0.035 0.031 0.022 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.05 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.8 1 1.5 2 Internal resistance (Ω) 583 167 49.9 23.1 12.8 8.7 3.45 2.3 0.89 0.48 Current rating (A) 2.5 3 4 5 6 10 12 15 16 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.42 0.21 0.13 0.11 0.056 0.022 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 Typical time/current characteristics AC AC 10000 10000 1000 1000 100 100 +80 °C Trip time in seconds +23 °C Trip time in seconds 2 Current rating (A) 0.06 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.8 1 1.5 2 2.5 Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker suitable for high ambient temperatures. The special rating of the circuit breaker allows resetting at no load in ambient temperatures up to +80°C. Suffix -2350 is also available for types 3400 and 3600. Enquire for further details. 10 1 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. 160 10 ☎ 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3600/3900 Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and two button operation (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Designed for plug-in mounting with E-T-A sockets 17-P10Si, 23-P10-Si, 63-P10-Si; or panel mounting using E-T-A clips. Featuring an unprotected shunt tap terminal and optional auxiliary contacts. Type 3900 offers lower internal resistance values and is fitted as standard with auxiliary contacts and an intermediate reset position in which all contacts are isolated. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Process control systems, instrumentation, communications systems. 3600 standard type Accessories 23-P10-Si 63-P10-Si 17-P10-Si 17-P10-Si-20025 Y 301 398 02 X 210 588 01 X 210 588 02 Y 300 504 02 3900 low-resistance type Technical data Lug mounted socket. With push-on terminals. Lug mounted socket. With push-on terminals. EN rail mounted socket. Socket supplied with adapter fitted or asymmetric rail mounting (G-profile). Withdrawal tool - spring metal clip to aid withdrawal of the circuit breaker from its mounting socket. 100-way 1.5mm2 cable links with pre-fitted pushon connectors for type 10F-P10 sockets. As above but with 2.5mm2 cable links. One pair of clips to facilitate panel mounting of types 3600 and 3900. Ordering information Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 65 V Current rating range 3600: 0.05...16 A; 3900: 0.05...10 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 250 V/DC 65 V Typical life 5000 operations at 2xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main/aux. circuit aux. circuit 4-5/6-7 Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 840 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 3600 0.05...0.8 A 1...2 A 2.5...16 A 3900 0.05...0.2 A self-limiting 0.3...2 A 200 A 2.5...10 A 400 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) type 3600 IN 0.05...16 A 0.05...16 A UN AC 250 V DC 80 V Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Type No. 3600 standard version 3900 low-resistance version Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Auxiliary contacts (optional with type 3600) Si with blade terminals 6.3-08,one each NO/NC, (type 3900 with intermediate position as standard) Si60 special auxiliary contact closed in the intermediate and ON position ZR-Si auxiliary contacts with intermediate position (type 3600) Si3/R special auxiliary contacts, 2 NC contacts with reset button (not approved) Current ratings 0.05...16 A (type 3600) 0.05...10 A (type 3900) Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea 3600 - P10 - Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 45 g Si - 10 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.05 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.8 1 1.5 2 2.5 Issue C Internal resistance (Ω) 3600 3900 447 211 131 48 40 12.4 19.3 5.7 10.4 3.1 7.1 2.0 4.3 1.32 2.5 0.76 1.67 0.49 0.61 0.21 0.38 0.101 0.24 0.078 ☎ Current rating (A) 3 4 5 6 7 8 10 12 14 15 16 Internal resistance (Ω) 3600 3900 0.19 0.054 0.090 0.035 0.061 0.025 0.041 ≤0.02 0.034 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 ≤0.02 2 1000 A 1000 A Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Demko, Nemko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.05...16 A Semko AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1 ...10 A CSA/UL AC 250 V, DC 80 V 0.05...16 A LRoS AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.3 ...16 A 3600: 3900: VDE, Demko, Semko AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...10 A Nemko AC 250 V 0.05...10 A LRoS AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.3 ...10 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 161 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3600/3900 Dimensions ON with shunt terminal (standard) and auxiliary contacts ø11.5 ø6.5 ø8.5 line 1 line 1 ø4 5 7 4 6 2 OFF 11 5 -P10-Si Internal connection diagrams 3 3 51 I> I> 3 from IN = 8 A 2 19 2 6 3 7 Switching position with auxiliary contacts and reset button (-Si3/R) 5 2 10 1 4 OFF position line 1 5 6.8 43 2 8.5 2 3 20 11.5 13 7 intermediate position line 1 5 7 ON position line 1 5 7 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 6 x 6.8 = 40.8 current rating in A 3 from IN = 8 A 4 I> 50 6 3 I> 3 from IN = 8 A 2 -Si3/R 4 6 3 from IN = 8 A 2 3 I> 4 6 3 from IN = 8 A 2 Switching position with special auxiliary contact (-Si60) ON OFF position line 1 7 ø6.5 ø8.5 ø4 intermediate position line 1 7 ON position line 1 7 2 OFF 11 5 ø11.5 3 6 51 I> 3 I> 3 from IN = 8 A 2 3 6 3 from IN = 8 A 2 I> 6 3 from IN = 8 A 19 2 6 3 7 5 2 10 1 4 Switching position with intermediate position and auxiliary contacts (-ZR-Si) 6.8 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 6 x 6.8 = 40.8 current rating in A line 1 7 4 6 line 1 5 7 4 6 line 1 5 7 4 6 43 13 20 2 11.5 3 8,5 5 I> 3 I> 3 from IN=8 A 3 from IN=8 A 3 I> 3 from IN=8 A 50 Intermediate position: Holding down reset button and actuating manual release simultaneously. Installation drawing 2 OFF position 2 intermediate position 2 ON position Terminal design -P10-A3 1 3 2 2 38 20 operating area (double insulation) mounting area 162 ☎ 12.5 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3600/3900 Typical time/current characteristics Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 3600 0.05...7 A AC* 3600 8...16 A N.B. * Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. ** Magnetic tripping currents are decreased by 20% on AC supplies. AC* 3900 0.05...10 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 DC** 10 1 2 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Accessories 19" Rack accommodating up to 60 E-T-A thermal-magnetic circuit breakers type 3600-P10-Si or 3900-P10-Si. For technical data see pages 113-114. 19" Rack 19BGT2 2HE for 18, 24 or 30 circuits. For technical data see pages 115 - 116. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 163 Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 3600/3900 Accessories Sockets 17-P10-Si (continuous load up to 16 A) Bus bar for socket 17 (for max. 100 A continuous load) X 211 157 01 with terminal X 211 157 02 without terminal 17-P10-Si- 20025 mounted with adapter Phoenix terminal AKG 35 (max.cross section 35 mm2) slot fitting labels from Phoenix ZB, RBS, DST Weidmüller dekafix, BS, PES Wieland Type 9003 cylinder head screw M4x4 ISO1207 nickel plated 2 polarized blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 retaining clip female connector 25.8 8.5 depth 10 mm 10 10 45.s 5 80 6.5 41.3 1.4 33.3 M4 Cu rail, tin-plated 12.5 12.8 7 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 adapter X20040901 fusible link (1.1 mm thick constriction) 154.8 G-profile EN 50035-G32 polarization recess Insulated sleeving for busbar Y 303 824 01 Retaining clip Y 300 581 11 Please enquire for dimension diagram. 9 5.4 17 125 Sockets 17-P70-Si 17-P70-Si- 20025 mounted with adapter slot fitting labels from Phoenix ZB, RBS, DST Weidmüller dekafix, BS, PES Wieland Type 9003 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01 /1,5mm2, brown X 210 588 02 /2,5mm2, black X 210 588 03 /2,5mm2, red X 210 588 04 /2,5mm2, blue blade terminals DIN 46244 part 2 C profile (2xA2.8-0.8) retaining clip 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated 80 6.5 45.8 41.3 5 1.4 33.3 25.8 8.5 depth 10 mm 10 ~70 2 washer A 4.3 DIN 125 nickel plated 12.5 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 adapter X20040901 G-profile EN 50035-G32 Extraction tool Y 301 398 02 polarization recess 46 Sockets 23-P10-Si 56 63-P10-Si polarized blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 22.2 21 10 7.4 6.25 50 75 12.5 retaining clip 2 mounting clips Y 300 504 02 Installation drawing with mounting clips Y 300 504 02 2 1 7.5 1.9 50 57.4 64 50 57.4 64 12.5 25 12.5 3.5 6 x 6.8 = 40.8 6.8 4.4 4.4 0.5 2 7.4 2 6 8.5 12.5 30 60.4 polarized recess 7.3 8 50 Retaining clip Y 300 581 03 Please enquire for dimension diagram. M4 16.5 164 ☎ 20 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Single and multi pole magnetic and hydraulic-magnetic circuit breakers (CBEs) The E-T-A range of magnetic CBEs includes the miniature Printo-magnetic series (808 and 809) with extremely fast operating characteristics for printed circuit board applications, and series 8330, 8340 and 8350 for higher current duties. Types 808 and 809 cover ratings from as low as 0.006 A up to 5 A with low internal resistance values. Their unique method of magnetic operation not only provides rapid response times, but is also suited to impulse disconnection for control applications. All models within the 8330, 8340 and 8350 range offer a choice of fast acting magnetic operation or hydraulically delayed switching characteristics which may be selected to suit a range of application requirements such as those of the telecommunications and process control industries, where precise and dependable protection of sophisticated systems cannot be compromised. The 8330 is available in single and two pole models, multipole options are also available for types 8340 and 8350. Single, two and three pole models are available with various internal circuit configurations to provide status signal and relay trip functions. Type 8340-G provides the option of either single round hole panel mounting or plug-in mounting utilising an E-T-A series 18 base. On/off control is by means of a push/pull button with visual indication of the off/tripped position. Types 8340-F and 8340-T, with industry standard dimensions and toggle actuation, are panel mounted with two fixing bolts (8340-F) or rail mounted with combi-foot (8340-T). All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved.Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 165 Overview Voltage ratings max. 3 AC 415 V AC 250 V, DC 80 V Current ratings 0.006...100 A 3 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 8330-... Description PCB mounting 808: fast-acting type 809: delayed type Max. voltage rating DC 24 V Current ratings Aux. contact rating 8340-G2... Toggle/baton or rocker circuit breaker, flange or threadneck mounting, with auxiliary contact option (please inquire for other voltages) AC 240 V (50/60 Hz); DC 50 V 808: 0.01 ...5 A 809: 0.006...3 A 0.1...25 A Push/pull circuit breaker, threadneck panel mounting, with auxiliary contact option 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V (50/60 Hz); DC 80 V 0.02...30 A 1A 5A - Typical life 6,000 operations at 5A for switching circuit and 2.65 or 4.4 IN ffor excitation circuit Interrupting capacity Icn 100 A 1000 A max. (to UL 1077) 10,000 operations with 1 x IN see pages 169 - 170 Available options 10,000 operations with IN 1 pole 1,000 operations with IN 2 and 3pole AC: 1200 A DC: 2000 A AC: 1000 A DC: 500 A CSA, UL Approvals CSA, UL, VDE, CSA, UL, BV, LRoS see pages 171 - 174 see pages 175 - 178 18.2 OFF Dimensions ø4 M12x1 10.5 34 ON OFF 57.5 24.8 2.5 OFF 1 11 23 2(i) 24 12 2(k) 10 3 808 / 809-... 30 Overview Type No. 20 35 50 Internal connection diagrams LINE 1 4 5 6 7 NC NO 3 - 166 ☎ + 2 23 2(i) 12 24 I> I> 2 11 LINE 1 C Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 2(k) Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers X8340-S02 /-S04 8340-T... 8350-... Toggle circuit breaker, flange mounting, with auxiliary contact option Modular distribution rail for circuit breaker type 8340-F... Toggle circuit breaker, rail mounting, with auxiliary contact option Toggle circuit breaker, flange mounting, with auxiliary contact option 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V (50/60 Hz); DC 80 V AC 230 V; DC 65 V 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V (50/60 Hz); DC 80 V 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V (50/60 Hz); DC 80 V 0.02...30 A 0.02...80 A 0.02...30 A 0.1... 60 A multi pole 0.1...100 A single pole 6A AC: 6 A DC: 1 A 1A 1A 10,000 operations with 1 x IN single and multi pole 10,000 operations with IN single and multi pole 6,000 operations with IN AC: 1200 A DC: 2000 A AC: 1200 A DC: 2000 A AC: 5000 A (Inc) DC: 5000 A (Inc) VDE, CSA, UL, BV, LRoS, QPL VDE, CSA, UL, VDE, CSA, UL, see pages 187 - 190 see pages 191 - 194 see pages 183 - 186 see pages 179 - 182 3 X8340-S02 45 0 40 18.4 17.5 41.7 I 19.7 40 ON OFF 70.6 1 LINE 49.2 2 LOAD Sig 17.5 9.6 11 57.2 43.7 74 63.1 41.2 2 1 Sig 47.3 (L)(N)+ 14 12 50.8 63.5 89 X8340-S04 load terminals LINE 1 1 pole LINE 1 81.8 +0.3 - 0.1 11 12 14 I> 99+0.3 - 0.1 2 Issue C terminal for group siganlisation ☎ Si Si Si Si LINE 1 I> I> 2 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Overview 8340-F... NC NO C 167 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers Selector Chart Ratings DC (V) MAX IN (A) ● ● 24 3 ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ● ● Flange ● 8340-F 8340-G ❍ ● ● ● ❍ ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ● ❍ ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ● ❍ ● ● ● ❍ ● ● ● ● ● ● 8340-T 8350 ● ● ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ AC (V) ❍ Illumination ● Rocker ● Push-pull ● Toggle 809 Multi pole 5 Single pole Manual trip facility 24 Stud terminals ● Screw terminals ● Solder terminals ❍ Blade terminals ● Rail ● Socket ● Threadneck Auxiliary contacts Choice of characteristic curves Actuator 808 8330 Overview Number of poles Main terminal design Water splash cover Mounting method Printed Circuit Board Type No. ● 240 50 25 ● 415 80 30 ● 415 80 30 ● ● 415 80 30 ● ● 415 80 100 ● ● = standard ❍ = optional 3 168 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 808/809-... Description Single pole miniaturised magnetic circuit breaker with unique highspeed operating mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation. Fitted with electrically separate excitation and switching circuits, and one pair of auxiliary contacts which close when the main circuit is open. Also suitable for impulse operation. Designed for printed circuit board mounting. Low temperature sensitivity. Typical applications Printed circuit boards and components, safety and control systems. 808/809 Ordering information Technical data Type No. 808 fast-acting 809 delayed Manual release (optional) H manual release facility Current ratings 0.01 ...5 A type 808 0.006...3 A type 809 808 - H - 1A ordering example Voltage rating DC 24 V (other voltages to special order) Current ratings Type 808 0.01...5 A Type 809 0.006...3 A Max. continuous load excitation circuit (2-3) 2.65 x IN 4.4 x IN Max. continuous load switching circuit 6-7 auxiliary circuit 4-5 5A 5A Typical life The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Internal resistance (Ω) 808 809 0.006 - 0.01 625 0.012 - -30...+70 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 2 - Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) excitation to switching circuit excitation to auxiliary circuit AC 1680 V > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 100 A Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 808 809 625 0.7 0.143 0.050 - 0.8 0.096 0.040 170 0.9 0.085 0.02 170 77 1 0.073 0.031 Insulation resistance 0.03 77 29.2 1.2 0.050 ≤ 0.02 0.04 47 18.5 1.5 0.031 ≤ 0.02 Interrupting capacity (o-o-o) 0.05 29.2 1.8 - ≤ 0.02 0.06 - 5.6 2 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 0.08 10.3 - 2.5 ≤ 0.02 - 0.1 5.6 3.4 3 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 0.2 1.65 0.89 3.25 ≤ 0.02 - 0.3 0.89 0.28 4 ≤ 0.02 - 0.4 0.39 0.143 4,5 ≤ 0.02 - 0.5 0.28 0.096 5 ≤ 0.02 - 0.6 0.198 0.073 10.3 Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings UL AC 120 V, DC 60 V 0.01...5 A AC 120 V, DC 60 V 0.006...3 A (type 809) AC 115 V, DC 60 V 0.01...5 A (type 808) AC 115 V, DC 28 V 0.006...3 A (type 809) CSA Issue C ☎ 6000 operations at 5 A for switching circuit, at 2.65 or 4.4 x IN for excitation circuit Ambient temperature Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 808/809-H-... Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) 3 Test voltage AC 840 V 1000 A AC 120 V 200 A DC 60 V Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 3 g (57-500 Hz), ±0.23 mm (10-57 Hz), to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 10 g (type 808) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 169 Magnetic Overcurrent Circuit Breakers 808/809-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 808/809 2-3: excitation circuit 6-7: switching circuit 4-5: auxiliary circuit 2.5 ON 2.5 OFF ø4 2 5 6 7 5 2 3 5 - + 14 26 30 4 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 0.5 20 10 Type 808 ø0.7 15.5 15 10000 808-H/809-H 6 2.5 ON 7.5 OFF 3 ø4 2 Trip time in milliseconds 1000 100 10 5 14 26 30 5 1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 20 40 ... times rated current 0.5 20 10 Type 809 15.5 ø0.7 10000 6 Trip time in milliseconds 15 1000 100 10 1 0.1 1 2 4 6 8 10 ... times rated current Note: (Magnetic) tripping currents are decreased by 20% on AC supplies 170 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8330-... Description Single and double pole magnetic and hydraulic-magnetic circuit breaker with trip-free mechanism and toggle or rocker actuation. A choice of fast magnetic only or hydraulically delayed switching characteristics (S type MO or HM CBE to EN 60934/IEC 934) ensures suitability for a wide range of applications. Low temperature sensitivity at rated load. Industry standard dimensions and threadneck or snap in panel mounting. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Power supplies, process control, switchgear and controlgear 8330 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.1 Internal resistance (Ω) per pole Technical data Voltage rating 101 AC 240 V 50/60 Hz DC 50 V 1 0.99 Current rating range 0.1...25 A 2 0.25 Auxiliary circuit AC 125 V 3A; DC 30 V 2 A 3 0.1 Typical life 10,000 operations at IN 5 0.041 Ambient temperature -40...+75°C 10 0.011 15 0.0057 Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) 20 0.0039 25 0.0028 Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in the operating area Approvals Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole to pole main to auxiliary circuit switching to trip circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) UL/CSA AC 240 V; DC 50 V 0.1...25 A Interrupting capacity Icn VDE AC 240/ V; DC 50 V 0.1...25 A 1,000 A at AC 240 V 500 A at DC 50 V Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40; terminal area IP 00 Vibration single pole: 10 g (57-500 Hz) ± 0.76 mm (10-57) double pole: 7 g (57-500 Hz) ± 0.54 mm (10-57) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 50 g (6 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 30 g per pole (depending on version) Issue C ☎ under test Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 171 3 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8330-... black red without without R X X X X X X X X X X X X X W X X X X X X X X X X X X X 24.8 33.5 blade terminal A6.3-0.8 to DIN 46244 17.3 35 33 Actuator configuration C panel cut-out A threadneck mounting, baton 9 26.5 thickness 1.5 - 3 mm A M12 ø12.5 1/2"-32 ø12.7 ø3 +0.2 Installation drawing ON OFF ☎ C X X X green I-O white I-O black I-O red I-O orange I - O green ON-OFF white ON-OFF black ON-OFF red ON-OFF orange ON-OFF Illumination voltage voltage range actuator 1 AC 100-125 V W 2 AC 220-250 V W 3 DC 8- 16 V W 4 DC 16- 24 V W 5 DC 24- 32 V W 6 DC 32- 48 V W X without illumination B, C, R, W Auxiliary contacts A no auxiliary contacts B one change over per pole H one change over per unit (multipole version only) Internal circuit A switch B series trip D relay trip (remote trip) Remote trip 00 no remote trip 03 12V; 04: 24V; 21: 120V; 22: 240V Frequency 4 AC 50/60 Hz 9 DC Current rating 0.1...25 A 8330 - G L 1 0 - P B BS - 3 X A B 00 4 - 5 A 172 B X X X 15.9 13.9 2 2 without 13.9 29 Marking 2 pole M12x1 or 1/2"-32 ON Colour white 1 pole threadneck mounting, paddle ON 2 3 7 B C D H J M N P T U Actuator configuration B OFF Type No. 8330 circuit breaker Mounting F flange mounting, black G threadneck mounting, black (standard) H threadneck mounting, light-grey Q flange mounting, light-grey Size Mounting: F G H Q G panel thickness 1 -2.5 mm X X L M12 12 mm high (flattened on one side) X X M 1/2"-32 12 mm high (flattened on one side) X X Number of poles 1 single pole 2 double pole Panel hardware (bulk) Mounting: F G H Q 0 without hardware X X X X 9 rocker guard X X B 2 hex nuts, 1 legend plate X X D 2 hex nuts, 1 washer with locating pin, 1 legend plate X X F 1 hex nut, 1 knurled nut, 1 legend plate X X H 1 hex nut, 1 knurled nut, 1 washer with locating pin, 1 legend plate X X S 1 legend plate, with splash cover X X Terminal design P blade terminals A6.3-0.8 Actuator configuration B paddle, 1 paddle/unit for accessories 0,B,D,F,H C baton, 1 baton/unit for accessories 0,B,D,F,H,S R rocker, 1 rocker/unit for accessories 0,9 W illuminated rocker, 1 rocker/unit, for accessories 0,9 Characteristic curve 00 switch only AS long delay BS medium delay CS short delay OP instantaneous trip Actuator colour and marking details OFF 3 Dimensions – threadneck mounted version 44.5 Ordering information 1 terminal area ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8330-... Internal connection diagrams Dimensions flange mounted version Actuator configuration R, W A Switch only with auxiliary contacts optional with rocker guard B Series trip, single pole with auxiliary contacts LINE 1 NC NO 1pole LINE 1 NC NO 2 6.3 7.8 2pole I> C 2 C 42 53 ON OFF 2 D Relay trip with illumination LINE 1 LINE 1 U > voltage coil 6.3 6.3 15.9 19.5 blade terminal A6.3-0.8 DIN 46244 I> 35.4 39.6 39.6 2 LOAD 2 LOAD Shock directions – Mounting attitudes 1 4 2 3 panel cut-out 3 A 35±0.1 A A 6 36±0.1 17.6 +0.2 33.5 Panel thickness 1.0 - 2.0 2.0 - 2.6 5 +0.2 Terminal configurations Auxiliary contacts 18 11.5 Relay trip solder terminal blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 9.9 15 With illuminated rocker 9.9 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 173 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8330-... Typical time/current characteristics Accessories AC 50/60 Hz, DC, ambient temperature +23 °C / +73.4 °F Curve AS - long delay Threadneck design L: Hex nut M 12x1 Y 300 116 02 10000 Threadneck design M: 1/2"-32 Y 300 486 20 18.3 16.1 Trip time in seconds 1000 100 10 M12x1 14 1 0.1 UN 1/2-32 3 Knurled nut M 12x1 Y 302 065 01 0.01 3.15 15.88 1/2"-32 Y 301 999 01 11.25 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 ø15.1 0 ø15.87 0.001 12 Curve BS - medium delay M12x1 10000 UN 1/2-32 3 3.18 Washer with locating pin Y 306 401 01 7 2.8 0.8 8.6 8.6 7.9 ø1 2. 2 0.01 0.8 2.8 2.3 0.001 12 Curve CS - short delay Legend plate Y 306 402 01 I +0 28 ø1 100 OFF 10 O OFF 12 1 I ON 2 +0 .1 1000 Y 306 425 01 5.2 ON 10000 2.3 +0.1 11 5.6 10 28 9 .1 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 7 4 2. 3 ø1 11.25 2 +0.1 0 Trip time in seconds 5.6 +0.1 +0 .1 5.2 +0.1 +0 .1 1 ø17.3-0.2 0.1 3 Y 306 424 01 ø17.3 -0.2 10 7.9 100 ø1 Trip time in seconds 1000 O 12 thickness 0.8 thickness 0.8 ø17 ø17 0.1 Splash cover M 12x1 X 221 427 01 0.01 0.001 1/2"-32 X 221 434 01 splashcover 11.25 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 21.4 12 O ø6.5 Curve OP - instantaneous trip 10000 1000 Trip time in seconds 15.9 0 OF 100 10 1 Ordering code 0.1 Y 300 116 02 0.01 Threadneck design -L (M12) B D F H 2 2 1 1 1 1 S Y 300 486 20 0.001 0 11.25 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Y 302 065 01 Threadneck design -M (1/2"-32) B D F H 2 2 1 1 1 1 Y 301 999 01 1 1 Y 306 401 01 Y 306 402 01 All curves are for mounting planes 1, 2, 3, 4 174 ☎ 1 1 1 1 1 1 Y 306 425 01 X 221 427 01 1 1 Y 306 424 01 Series 8330 will not trip at a halfsine wave of 10 ms and an amplitude of ≤ 8 x IN. S 1 X 221 434 01 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 1 1 1 1 1 Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-G2... Description Single, two and three pole magnetic circuit breakers with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation. A choice of fast magnetic only or hydraulically delayed switching characteristics (S type MO or HM CBE to EN 60934) ensures suitability for a wide range of applications. Convenient threadneck panel or plugin mounting, and with a white push button indicator band showing clearly the tripped/off position. Available with auxiliary contacts (1 x N/O, 1 x N/C) for status signalling and fitted with an unprotected shunt tap terminal as standard. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical application 8340-G2... Control equipment, communications systems, power semiconductors. Ordering information Issue C ☎ 2 pole 3 pole Technical data Type No. 8340 Magnetic push/pull circuit breaker Mounting G threadneck panel mounting Threadneck design 2 M 12x1 Number of poles (main current paths) 0 single pole, switch only 1 single pole, protected 2 two pole, protected 3 three pole, protected 5 two pole, protected on one pole only Panel hardware 0 without panel hardware 1 with hex nut M 12x1 and washer 12/15 Terminal design N blade terminals, with shunt circuit G screw terminals with metric thread (recommended for IN > 20 A). Shunt circuit, blade terminal X separate switching and trip circuit, blade terminals Terminal Size 1 terminals N and X: blade terminals A6.3-0.8 mm. terminal G: screw terminals M4 with flat head screw M4x6 Characteristic curve F4 instantaneous trip: magn. 1.5-2.2 x IN DC (IN ≤ 20A) magn. 1.2-1.7 x IN AC 50/60 Hz (IN ≤ 25 A) E1 short delay: magn.-hydr. 1.01-1.4 x IN, DC E2 short delay: magn.-hydr.1.01-1.4 x IN, AC 50/60Hz H1 medium delay: magn.-hydr. 1.01-1.4 x IN, DC H2 medium delay: magn.-hydr.1.01-1.4 x IN, AC 50/60Hz R1 long delay: magn.-hydr. 1.01-1.5 x IN, DC R2 long delay: magn.-hydr. 1.01-1.5 x IN, AC 50/60Hz Actuator colour A black with white trip indicator band Actuator marking 0 without marking 4 rated current Auxiliary contacts H0 without auxiliary contacts H1 with auxiliary contacts H2 with auxiliary contacts on pole 1 only (2 and 3 pole types) H3 with auxiliary contacts on poles 1 and 3 (3 pole type) Auxiliary contact function 1 one each N/O and N/C 2 1 pair N/O (23/24) 3 1 pair N/C (11/12) Auxiliary contact terminal design 1 blade terminals A6.3-0.8 mm Current ratings 0.02...30 A 8340 - G 2 1 1 - N 1 F4 - A 4 1 pole H1 1 1 - 8 A ordering example Voltage rating 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 80V Current ratings 0.02...30 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 240 V/DC 65 V; 0.5 A, DC 80 V Typical life 1 pole: 10,000 operations at 1xIN 2 and 3 pole: 1000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -40...+85 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dieelectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole to pole (2 + 3 pole) main to auxiliary circuit aux. circuit 11-12/23-24 switching to trip circuit (-X) 3 Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V AC 1000 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 1200 A at AC; 2000 A at DC Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) IN 1 pole 1 pole Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration with button down: 10 g (57-2000 Hz), ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz) at 0.9 x IN Other mounting planes: 10 g (57-2000 Hz) bei IN to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 100 g (11 ms) at 1xIN, directions 1,2,3,4,5 100 g (11 ms) at 0.8xIN, direction 6 to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 70 g per pole 0.025..30 A AC 250 V/3500 A DC 65 V/2000 A Standard purely magnetic type: 8340-G211-N1F4-A4H111-...A Standard hydraulic-magnetic type: 8340-G211-N1E1-A4H0-...A Approvals Authority VDE (EN 60934) UL, CSA LRoS, BV Voltage ratings 3 AC 415 V, AC 240 V, DC 80 V 3 AC 250 V, AC 250 V, DC 65 V AC 250 V, DC 65 V Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Current ratings 0.02...30 A 0.02...30 A 0.1...30 A 175 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-G2... 23 22.4 5 2.44 9.9 9.7 0.5 0.79 3.16 3.1 0.75 0.39 1.55 1.51 1 0.25 0.79 0.77 1.5 0.10 0.37 0.36 2 0.059 0.20 0.24 2.5 0.044 0.146 0.138 3 0.028 0.10 0.099 4 < 0.02 0.059 0.057 5 < 0.02 0.040 0.038 6 < 0.02 0.026 0.026 8 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 10 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 12 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 15 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 16 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 20 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 25 < 0.02* < 0.02 < 0.02 30 < 0.02* < 0.02 < 0.02 6.8 4.6 6x6.8 45 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 SW14 current rating in A location pin for 3mm hole dia. 5 mounting hole 0.8 ø3 +0.2 9.5 50 Terminal design -G 1.5 *duty cycle 50 % ON period, 30 min pane tickness max. 3 mm 10 Accessories terminal with flat head screw M4x6 ISO 1580 tightening torque max.1.2 Nm 6. 6x6.8 45 55.2 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Installation drawings Terminal design -N operating area (double insulation) 8 EN rail mounted socket may be used in multiples of two or three for two and three pole circuit breakers. 18-P10-Si-20025 Socket supplied with adapter fitted for asymmetric rail mounting (G-profile). X 211 158 01 Six-way connecting/bus bar link with clamp terminal. X 211 158 02 Six-way connecting/bus bar link, as above but without clamp terminal. Y 303 824 11 Insulated sleeving for connecting bus X 211 158 .. Y 300 579 11 Retaining clip for socket 18-P10-Si. X 210 588 01 100-way 1.5mm2 brown cable links with pre-fitted push-on connectors. X 210 588 02 As above but with 2.5mm2 black cable links. X 210 588 03 As above but with 2.5mm2 red cable links. X 210 588 04 As above but with 2.5mm2 blue cable links. Y 300 116 02 Hex nut M 12x1 Y 300 118 03 Spring washer X 200 801 01 Concertina style splash cover/hex nut assembly. X 200 802 01 Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. X 200 803 01 Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. 4.6 18-P10-Si mounting area 2 1 1 29 Shock directions / Mounting attitudes 5 4 2 3.5 terminal area Terminal design -G 24 3 mounting area 5 10 6 5 29 3 0.2 0.3 black white ø12.5 +0.2 38 3 39 ±0.2 9.9 0.15 ø8.4 9.5 84 OFF 144 94 1.5 148 ON 35.8 23 ø10.6 18.2 0.08 0.1 tightening torque max. 4Nm M12x1 12.5 365 2.7 376 6.5 94 57.5 0.05 Terminal design -N 1.5 Internal resistance (Ω) per pole curve -F4 curves -E1/H1/R1 curves -E2/H2/R2 376 1498 1814 10 Current rating (A) 0.02 Dimensions (1 pole) 19 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values terminal area 176 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-G2... Dimensions (2 pole) Dimensions (3 pole) 57 38 Typical time/current characteristics Curve -F4, magnetic (IN >20 A, 50 % ON period, 30 min) at 23 °C 10000 Trip time in seconds 1000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0 1 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Short delay curves E1 for DC and E2 for AC 50/60 Hz, hydraulic-magnetic 10000 unit 1 unit 2 Cut-out dimensions: unit 2 min. 40 unit 3 2 pole panel thickness max. 3 mm min. 60 Trip time in seconds 1000 unit 1 100 10 1 0.1 3 0.01 3 pole 0.001 0 1 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Medium delay curves H1 for DC and H2 for AC 50/60 Hz hydraulic-magnetic 10000 Internal connection diagrams LINE 1 11 23 2(i) 12 24 multipole 11 23 2(i) 12 24 LINE 1 unit 1 I> 2(k) I> 2(k) 1 1 pole, protected hydraulic-magnetically LINE 1 11 11 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 23 0.001 0 1 2 3 4 unit 2 23 2(i) 12 1 9 10 11 12 10000 2(k) 24 6 8 5 7 … times rated current Long delay curves R1 for DC and R2 for AC 50/60 Hz hydraulic-magnetic 24 I> 2(i) 12 Trip time in seconds 1 pole, protected magnetically 1000 11 23 2(i) 12 24 1000 2(k) unit 3 I> Circuit variants 1 pole LINE 1 2(k) 23 Trip time in seconds I> 100 10 1 0.1 8340-G211-X1F4-A4H121-…A 1 - 11 2(i) - 2(k) 23 - 24 11 24 2(i) I> switching circuit magnetic trip circuit auxiliary circuit (N/O) 0.001 0 2(k) LINE 1 0.01 1 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 11 8340-G211-X1F4-A4H131-…A 23 12 2(i) I> 1 - 23 2(i) - 2(k) 11 - 12 switching circuit magnetic trip circuit auxiliary circuit (N/C) N.B. Curves E1, E2, H1,H2, R1 and R2 are for mounting planes 1,2,3,4. 2(k) Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 177 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-G2... Accessories Socket 18-P10-Si Polarized socket with adapter 18-P10-Si-20025 retaining clip (accessory) 4 10 mm depth Hex nut Y 300 116 02 ø12+0.2 10 45.8 5 1.4 33.3 25.8 6.5 1.2±0.5 M12x1 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 polarized to ensure correct connection SW14 19 80 Spring washer Y 300 118 03 top-hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 adapter X 200 409 01 polarization recess G profile EN 50035-G32 2.5 ø15 thickness 0.4 mm Accessories for push button Splash cover, transparent nickel plated hex nut X 200 801 08 (IP 66) Splash cover, black black finish hex nut X 200 801 03 (IP 66) Splash seal black/ hex nut assembly and O ring X 200 802 01 (IP 54) Bus bar for socket 18 X 211 158 01 with Phoenix terminal X 211 158 02 without Phoenix terminal Phoenix terminal AKG 35 (cross section max 35 mm2) cylinder-head screw M4x4 ISO 1207 nickel-plated washer A4.3 DIN 125 nickel plated 2 Actuator extension X 200 803 01 female connector e.g. Grohe u. Hartmann part No. 12541 3 7 copper rail tin-plated 10 M4 19 223 Insulated sleeving for bus bars Y 303 824 11 fusible link (constriction 1 mm thick) 9 190 10 3.5 5.4 Retaining clip for socket 18-P10-Si Y 300 579 11 55.5 0.6 52 38 52 53 60 ø1 dimension as delivered 0. 45° mounting dimensions 8 15 3 R 35 Connector bus link -P10 X 210 588 01/1,5mm2, brown X 210 588 02/2,5mm2, black X 210 588 03/2,5mm2, red X 210 588 04/2,5mm2, blue ~70 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated 178 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-F... Description Single and multipole magnetic circuit breakers with trip-free, snapaction mechanism and toggle actuation. A choice of fast magnetic only or hydraulically delayed switching characteristics (S-type MO or HM CBE to EN 60934) ensures suitability for a wide range of applications. Industry standard dimensions and panel mounting. Options include auxiliary changeover contacts, or relay trip function. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Control equipment, communications systems, transportation, power supplies. Accessories X 211 117 01 X 211 118 01 X 211 119 01 8340-F... 1 pole 2 pole 3 pole Technical data Single pole splash cover with fixing plate. Two pole splash cover with fixing plate. Three pole splash cover with fixing plate. Voltage rating Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current Curves and internal resistance per pole (Ω) rating (A) F1 F2 K1, M1, T1, K2, M2, T2 2669 2457 152 452 376 37 100 94 0.02 1498 957 0.05 276 0.1 58 0.25 8.2 6.0 15.5 14.7 0.5 2.3 1.47 3.9 3.2 0.75 0.98 0.63 1.65 1.56 1 0.58 0.35 0.95 0.90 2 0.145 0.096 0.26 0.20 2.5 0.096 0.061 0.15 0.15 3 0.065 0.048 0.10 0.10 5 0.025 < 0.02 0.042 0.040 0.029 0.028 6 < 0.02 < 0.02 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 80V (higher DC ratings to special order) Current ratings 0.02...30 A Auxiliary circuit 6 A, AC 240 V/DC 28 V 1 A, DC 65 V; 0.5 A, DC 80 V Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -40...+85 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole to pole (2 and 3 pole) main to auxiliary circuit switching to trip circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V (version -X) Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 1200 A at AC, 2000 A at DC Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) 3 IN 0.025...20 A 1 pole 2 pole 3 pole 1 to 3 pole AC 250 V/3500 A AC 250 V/3500 A AC 250 V/3500 A AC 250 V/5000 A 3AC 250V/3500 A 3AC250V/5000 A DC 65 V/2000 A DC 65 V/2000 A 25...30 A 8 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 10 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 12 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 15 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 16 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 Vibration 20 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 25 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 30 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 with toggle down: 10 g (57-2000Hz) ±0.76mm (10-57 Hz) at 0.9xIN Directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5: 10 g (57-2000 Hz) at 1xIN. With curves F1, F2 in all planes: 10 g (57-2000 Hz) ±0.76mm (10-57 Hz) at 0.8xIN, to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 100 g (11 ms) at 1xIN, directions 1-5 100 g (11 ms) at 0.8xIN, direction 6. With curves F1, F2: 100 g (11 ms) at 0.8xIN to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 65 g per pole Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE (EN 60934) 3 AC 415 V, AC 240 V, DC 80 V 0.02...30 A UL, CSA 3 AC 250 V, AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.02...30 A LRoS, BV AC 250 V, DC 65 V 0.1 ...30 A QPL (Sweden) AC 240 V, DC 50 V 1 Issue C ☎ ...30 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 179 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-F... Ordering information 1 pole protected magnetically LINE 1 with separate switching and relay circuit LINE 1 11 12 LINE 1 4 3 14 I> I> 2 2 1 pole protected hydraulic-magnetic LINE 1 I> 2 multipole LINE 1 11 11 unit 1 12 I> 12 14 14 I> 2 2 11 1 unit 2 12 14 I> 2 11 1 unit 3 12 14 I> 2 11 1 unit 4 12 14 I> 2 Dimensions Mounting Configuration 8340-F9.. 3.2 30° 30° 5.5 ON OFF 41.2 50.8 19 1 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 2 38.8 6 panel cut-out 66 55.4 ±0.2 9.4 3 Type No. 8340 magnetic circuit breaker with toggle actuator Mounting F flange mounting Configuration 1 with mounting nuts 6-32 UNC 4 with mounting nuts M3 9 snap-in frame Number of poles 0 single pole, switch only 1 single pole protected 2 two pole protected 3 three pole protected 4 four pole protected 5 two pole, protected on one pole only 6 four pole, protected on poles 1, 2 and 3 only 7 two pole, switch only Panel hardware 0 without panel hardware Terminal design (main contact) K2 screw terminals with metric thread, (recommended for IN > 20 A) P1 blade terminals X1 blade terminals with separate switching and relay circuit Characteristic curves Characteristic curve F, instantaneous trip: F1 DC trip at 1.01-1.5xIN F2 AC 50/60 Hz trip at 1.01-1.5xIN Characteristic curve K, short delay: K1 DC trip time at 2xIN: 0.16-1.2 s K2 AC 50/60 Hz trip time at 2xIN: 0.13-1.6 s Characteristic curve M, medium delay: M1 DC trip time at 2xIN: 0.6-7.5 s M2 AC 50/60 Hz trip time at 2xIN: 2.2-20 s Without characteristic curve: Q0 switch only Characteristic curve T, long delay: T1 DC trip time at 2xIN: 10-70 s T2 AC 50/60 Hz trip time at 2xIN: 15-150 s Relay trip X: X1 voltage trip at DC, instantaneous trip X2 voltage trip at AC, instantaneous trip Other curves to special order (e.g. pulse delayed) Actuator colour A black B white Actuator marking 0 without marking 2 ON-OFF 3 I-O 5 I-O side marking Auxiliary contacts H0 without auxiliary contacts H1 with auxiliary contacts H2 auxiliary contacts on one pole only (multi pole) H3 auxiliary contacts on poles 1 and 3 (3 and 4 pole) G1 as H1, but contacts gold plated G2 as H2, but contacts gold plated G3 as H3, but contacts gold plated Auxiliary contact function 4 1 change over contact Auxiliary contact terminal design 2 blade terminal 2.8-0.5 mm Current ratings 0.02...30 A Voltage rating (for relay trip) DC 5 V, 8 V, 12 V, 24 V AC 110 V, 220 V, 240 V Internal connection diagrams 19 Ordering information 38.6 19.2 ±0.2 8340 - F 1 1 0 - P1 M1 - A 1 H1 4 2 - 30 A ordering example 180 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-F... Dimensions Accessories 30° 53 50 39 50.8 41.2 19 44 OFF 19 ON Splash covers (transparent) with fixing plate (IP54) X 211 117 01 X 211 118 01 1 pole 2 pole 3.3 76 16.7 19 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 ø16.8 panel 15 25 12.5 ø17+0.3 3 pole 32 actuator marking ON-OFF or I-0 Cut-out dimensions: 16 32 mounting dimensions: M3 - hole dia. 3.5 6-32 UNC-2B - hole dia. 4 with auxiliary contacts: 3.5±0.1 (M3) X 211 119 01 3 pole 3 mounting hole +0.1 16±0.12 40 OFF OFF unit 1 mounting hole 25+0.3 2 pole OFF unit 2 panel 16 mounting thread M3 or 6-32 UNC-2B mounting depth max. 4.5 mm tightening torque max. 0.33 Nm OFF unit 3 24.5 4.3 mounting hole unit 4 40 max. 4 21 6 1.2 38.8 21 2 50.8 42.15 26.7 38 max. 2 31 1 1.2 17.5 30° 62.5 43.5 24.5 5.5 4 -0.15 (6-32UNC) 1 26.7 +0.1 -0.16 62 54.3 19 -0.07 +0.17 53 2 11 14 12 +0.09 42.2 -0.17 with screw terminals (recommended for IN > 20 A) max. 4 38 21 with separate switching and relay circuit 8340-F...-X... 1.2 50.8 50.8 15.5 35 38.8 3 2 mounting hole 25 +0.3 2 1 6 38.8 terminal with flat hat screw M4x6 ISO1580 tightening torque max.1.2 Nm Installation drawing 22 4 +0.3 59 0 1 59 24.5 35 mounting dimensions: M3 - hole dia. 3.5 6-32 UNC-2B - hole dia. 4 operating area (double insulation) 8 Shock directions / mounting attitudes mounting area 30 1 4 2 2 3 6 2 29 1 5 terminal area Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 181 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-F... Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Curve M1 (medium delay) for DC Curve F1 (instantaneous) for DC 1000 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.001 0 1 2 4 3 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Curve F2 (instantaneous) for AC 50/60 Hz 0 1000 Trip time in seconds 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 100 10 1 0.1 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Curve K1 (short delay) for DC 0 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 1000 Trip time in seconds 11 12 1 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Curve T1 (long delay) for DC 10000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.001 0 1 2 4 3 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 0 1 2 3 Curve T2 (long delay) for AC 50/60 Hz Curve K2 (short delay) for AC 50/60 Hz 10000 1000 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10 0.1 0.01 3 9 1 0.001 2 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 4 10 0.01 1 3 100 0.001 0 2 Curve M2 (medium delay) for AC 50/60 Hz 10000 3 1 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.001 0 1 2 4 3 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 0 1 2 3 N.B. All curves are for mounting planes 1, 2, 3, 4. Other characteristic curves to special order. 182 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Distribution rail X8340-S02 Description Modular distribution rail, each module accommodating 2 magnetic or hydraulic-magnetic circuit breakers and associated load terminals. Circuit breaker status indication (group signalisation) is via 2 busbars. Power supply is via right- or left-side terminal block. Live parts in the plug-in and supply feed terminal areas are protected against brush contact. Circuit breakers may be replaced with power on. (L)(N)+ Sig Sig Typical applications Telecommunications and cellular communication systems X8340-S02 Ordering information Technical data Type No. X8340 Distribution rail for circuit breaker type 8340 Version S rail Identification number 02 modular, for 2 circuit breakers Power supply L left-side R right-side Modules with power supply 1 1 module, 2-way 2 2 modules, 2-way each 0 10 modules, 2-way each Signalisation 0 without signalisation 1 group signalisation 2 group signalisation, through-connected for right- or left-side power supply (main current path separated) Accessories 00 without accessories 01 cover per module 02 ground bridge in first module 03 M4 mounting screw per module 07 cover + ground bridge + M4 mounting screw X8340 - S 02 . . Issue C - . .. ☎ For circuit breaker type 8340-F.10-P1..-H142 Voltage rating AC 230 V, DC 65 V Load 16 A per position 80 A for complete unit Signalisation (N/C) AC 230 V, 6 A /DC 65 V 1 A per position Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 2.5 kV Flame retardance (IEC 695, part 2-2) self-extinguishing Supply terminal design (terminal socket) load (module) signalisation (module) Mass X8340-S02L1-100 Pollution degree 2 3 recessed screw/pressure plate 35 mm2 feed-in 6...25 mm2 with connector sleeve additional blade terminals 6.3x0.8 blade terminals 6.3x0.8 blade terminals 4.8x0.8 245 g ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 183 Distribution rail X8340-S02 Dimensions Internal connection diagram Distribution rail, shown with power supply right-side 16-20 mm (L) – 40 Sig Sig (N) + terminal block 90.6 40 (N)+ 74 63.1 (L)- Sig Sig 41.1 * E-T-A circuit breaker type 8340-F… (not supplied with product) load terminals 58.4 3 (L) – (N) + 1 NC NO I> C (L) – Distribution rail, power supply left-side X8340-SO2L.-… load terminals ground bridge (optional) (N) + 2 mounting screw (optional) terminal block (L) – Sig Sig (N) + module with circuit breaker E-T-A 8340-F… cover (optional) ground bridge in first module (optional) ground connection between signalisation and metal base 184 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Distribution rail X8340-S04 Description Distribution rail for one or two modules suitable for ETSI control cabinet and similar applications. One module comprises 4 positions for magnetic or hydraulic-magnetic circuit breakers and associated line and load terminals. Circuit breaker status indication (group signalisation) is via two busbars. The modular design facilitates the operation of a single distribution rail at two different voltages. Live parts in the plug-in and supply feed terminal areas are protected against brush contact. Expansion or circuit breaker replacement is possible with power on. Typical appalications X8340-S04 Telecommunications, measuring and control systems. Ordering information Type No. X8340 Distribution rail for circuit breaker type 8340 Version S rail Identification number 04 modular, for 4 circuit breakers Modules with power supply 1 1 module, 4-way 2 2 modules, 4-way each Accessories 0 without accessories 1 mounting bracket 2 mounting bracket + cover 3 cover Signalisation 0 without signalisation 1 group signalisation + ground connection 2 group signalisation X8340 - S 04 . . - Issue C . ordering example ☎ Technical data For circuit breakers 8340-F110-P1...-A1H142 Voltage rating AC 230 V, DC 65 V Load 20 A per position 80 A for module Signalisation (N/C) AC 230 V, 6 A/DC 65 V 1 A per position Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 2.5 kV Flame retardane (VDE 0471, part 2-2) self-extinguishing Supply terminal design recessed screw/pressure plate feed 6...25 mm2 or 6...16 mm2 with connector sleeve screw-less connectors 0.5...4 mm2 load and signalisation Mass module cover bracket Pollution degree 2 3 220 g 35 g 145 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 185 Distribution rail X8340-S04 Dimensions Internal connection diagram terminal for group signalisation mounting screw +0.3 X 81.8 - 0.1 mounting space 100 Module for circuit breakers (N) + Sig Sig (L) – screw terminal 99 +0.3 - 0.1 marking strip load terminals (N) + 188 (L) – 100 (N) + (L) – (N) + (L) – 3 * E-T-A circuit breaker type 8340-F… (not supplied with product) View X ø4.6 30.5 8.4 48.4 85 96.3 14 1 NC NO 158.8 C 4xneck screw (Philips) M2.5x11 (captive) to DIN 41494 TL5 (N) + (L) – I> 2 E-T-A circuit breaker type 8340-F… 186 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-T... Description Single, two, three and four pole magnetic and hydraulic-magnetic circuit breakers with trip-free mechanism and toggle actuation. A choice of fast magnetic only or hydraulically delayed switching characteristics (S-type MO or HM CBE to EN 60934) ensures suitability for a wide range of applications. Featuring a combi-foot design for symmetric and asymmetric rail mounting. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Power supplies, control equipment, communication systems, EDP systems. 8340-T... single pole Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current Curves and internal resistance per pole (Ω) rating (A) F1 F2 Technical data Voltage rating K1, M1, T1, K2, M2, T2 0.02 1498 957 2669 2457 0.05 276 152 452 376 0.1 58 37 100 three pole 3 AC 415V; AC 240V (50/60Hz); DC 80V (higher DC voltages to special order) Current rating range 0.02...30 A Auxiliary circuit 1 A, AC 240 V/DC 65 V; 0.5 A DC 80 V 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 94 Typical life 0.25 8.2 6.0 15.5 14.7 Ambient temperature -40...+85 °C 0.5 2.3 1.47 3.9 3.2 Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area 0.75 0.98 0.63 1.65 1.56 1 0.58 0.35 0.95 0.90 2 0.145 0.096 0.26 0.20 2.5 0.096 0.061 0.15 0.15 3 0.065 0.048 0.10 0.10 5 0.025 0.042 0.040 < 0.02 6 < 0.02 < 0.02 8 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 0.029 < 0.02 0.028 10 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 12 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 15 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 16 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 20 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 25 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 30 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.02 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole to pole main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 A AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 1200 A at AC 2000 A at DC Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) Voltage ratings VDE (EN 60934) 3 AC 415 V, AC 240 V, DC 80 V UL, CSA Vibration with toggle down: 10 g at 0.9 IN directions 1,2,3,4,5: 10 g at 1 x IN with curves F1, F2: 10 g at 0.8 x IN in all planes. (57-2000 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 100 g (11 ms) at 1 x IN, directions 1,2,3,4,5 100 g (11 ms) at 0.8 x IN, direction 6 with curves F1, F2: 100 g (11 ms) at 0.8xIN to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 98 g per pole 3 AC 250 V; AC 250 V, DC 65 V Issue C ☎ 25...30 A AC240V/3500 A AC240V/5000 A 3AC240V/5000A DC 65V/2000A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 20 Current ratings 0.02...30 A 0.02...20 A AC240V/3500 A AC240V/3500 A 3AC250V/3500A DC 65V/2000A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Approvals Authority IN 1 pole 2 pole 3 pole 1-3 pole 3 0.02...30 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 187 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-T... Dimensions 89 19.7 30° slot for fitting labels from Phoenix 9-11 24.4 30° ON OFF 70.6 } 2 LOAD 1 LINE 10-12 Snap-in socket for: G profile EN 50035-G32 top-hat rail EN 50022-35x7.5 EN 50022-35x15/1.5 19 38 3 pole 2 pole 1 pole auxiliary contact terminal M3 tightening torque max. 0.5 Nm wire section max. 2.5 mm2 unit III main contact terminal M4 tightening torque 1.2 Nm wire section max.: 0.75 … 10 mm2 rigid conductor 0.75 … 6 mm2 flexible conductor unit II unit I Installation drawing operating area (double insulation) min. 18 2 LOAD 1 LINE mounting area min. 1 3 57 43.4 45 41.7 57.2 Type No. 8340 circuit breaker with toggle actuator Mounting T rail mounting Configuration 1 snap-on installation Number of poles 0 single pole, switch only 1 single pole protected magnetic, 2 two pole protected hydraulic-magnetic 3 three pole protected 4 four pole protected 5 two pole, protected on one poly only 6 four pole, protected on poles 1, 2 and 3 only 7 two pole, switch only Panel hardware 0 without panel hardware Terminal design (main contact) K1 recessed screw/pressure plates M4 Characteristic curve Curve F, instantaneous trip: F1 DC trip at 1.01-1.5 x IN F2 AC 60/50Hz trip at 1.01-1.5 x IN Curve K, short delay: K1 DC trip at 2 x IN 0.16-1.2s K2 AC 60/50Hz trip at 2 x IN 0.13-1.6s Curve M, medium delay: M1 DC trip at 2 x IN 0.6-7.5s M2 AC 60/50Hz trip at 2 x IN 2.2-20 s Without characteristic curve Q0 switch only Curve T, long delay: T1 DC trip at 2 x IN 10-70s T2 AC 60/50Hz trip at 2 x IN 15-150s Other characteristic curves to special order Actuator colour A black Marking on housing top surface E I-O and ON-OFF F I-O and ON-OFF and current rating, voltage, curve and wiring diagram Auxiliary contacts H0 without auxiliary contacts H1 with auxiliary contact H2 with auxiliary contact on one pole only (≥2 pole) Auxiliary contact function 2 1 N/O contact 3 1 N/C contact 43.7 Ordering information terminal area Auxiliary contact terminal design 6 8340 - T 1 1 0 - K1 188 screw/pressure plate M3 Current ratings 0.02...30 A M1 - A E H1 2 6 - 10 A ☎ ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-T... Accessories Internal connection diagrams 1pole protected magnetically LINE 1 Si Si Si N/C H131 Si N/O H121 Connector bus links -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 black X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 brown multipole LINE 1 Si Si Si Si Si Si Si Si Si Si Si Si 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper ø2.5 unit I I> 2 2 1 1pole protected hydraulic-magnetically LINE 1 Si ~70 I> unit II Si I> Si 2 1 Si I> unit III 2 I> Optional N/C or N/O auxiliary contact (Si) 2 3 Shock directions / Mounting attitudes 1 4 2 3 6 Si AUX Issue C Si AUX ☎ 5 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 189 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8340-T... Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Curve M1 (medium delay) for DC Curve F1 (instantaneous) for DC 1000 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.001 0 1 2 4 3 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Curve F2 (instantaneous) for AC 50/60 Hz 0 1000 Trip time in seconds 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 100 10 1 0.1 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Curve K1 (short delay) for DC 0 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 1000 Trip time in seconds 11 12 1 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Curve T1 (long delay) for DC 10000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.001 0 1 2 4 3 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 0 1 2 3 Curve T2 (long delay) for AC 50/60 Hz Curve K2 (short delay) for AC 50/60 Hz 10000 1000 1000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10 0.1 0.01 3 9 1 0.001 2 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 4 10 0.01 1 3 100 0.001 0 2 Curve M2 (medium delay) for AC 50/60 Hz 10000 3 1 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.001 0 1 2 4 3 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 0 1 2 3 N.B. All curves are for mounting planes 1, 2, 3, 4. Other characteristic curves to special order. 190 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8350-... Description Single, two, three and four pole magnetic and hydraulic-magnetic circuit breakers with trip-free-mechanism and toggle actuation. A choice of fast magnetic only or hydraulically delayed switching characteristics (S type MO or HM CBE to EN 60934) ensures suitability for a wide range of applications. Industry standard dimensions and panel mounting. Low temperature sensitivity at rated load. Approved to CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Communications systems, process control and transportation 1 pole 3 pole 8350 Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) per pole 0.1 Technical data Voltage rating 3 AC 415 V; AC 240 V 50/60 Hz DC 80 V Current rating range 0.1... 60 A multi pole 0.1...100 A single pole Auxiliary circuit 6 A, AC 240 V/DC 28 V 1 A, DC 65 V; 0.5A, DC 80 V 6,000 operations at IN 94 1 0.823 2 0.214 3 0.094 5 0.044 10 < 0.02 Typical life 15 < 0.02 Ambient temperature -40...+85°C 20 < 0.02 25 < 0.02 Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) 30 < 0.02 40 < 0.02 Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area 50 < 0.02 60 < 0.02 80 < 0.02 100 < 0.02 Approvals Authority Voltage ratings VDE (EN 60934) 3 AC 415 V, AC 240 V, Current ratings DC 80 V UL, CSA 0.1...60 A Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole to pole main to auxiliary circuit switching to trip circuit Test voltage AC 3000 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn EN 60934, PC 1 UL 1077 5000 A at AC 240/415 V, DC 80 V Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40; terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (10-500 Hz) ± 0.76 mm (10-57) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 100 g (6 ms half-sine) to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, Test Ca Mass approx. 65...100 g per pole (depending on version) 3 AC 433 V, AC 250 V, DC 80 V 1...60 A (100 A single pole) Shock directions 3 4 1 2 3 6 5 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 191 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8350-... Mounting version A standard mounting: 1 to 4 poles pole 1 2 3 4 mounting thread M3 or 6-32 mounting depth 4.2 mm 47.3 63.5 36.6 10.2 18.4 3 19 1 pole 3 pole 57.2 36.8 11 52.4 ø4 46.7 9.6 19.2 28.6 Mounting version C 18.4 C-frame mounting: 1 to 4 poles 47.3 63.5 ø14.8 3.5 3 pole 5. 4 26.7 15.5 ø4 1 pole ø1 38 Mounting version D threadneck mounting: 1 to 3 poles 25.7 20.7 mounting thread M3 or 6-32 mounting depth 4.2 mm 50.8 10 I I O O 8350 - A A 3 B - A A BS - 3 0 A B 0 A - 1 A 16.7 ø4 M12x1 or 1/2"-32 ø1 3 63.5 3 Type No. 8350 circuit breaker with toggle actuator Mounting A* flange mounting, with rectangular aperture, standard toggle C flange mounting, round aperture, standard toggle D threadneck mounting, paddle, IN ≤30 A only, max. 3 poles H rail mounting, IN ≤ 25 A only Configuration A* metric, no interphase barrier B metric M3, with interphase barrier (small) C imperial 6-32, no interphase barrier D imperial 6-32, with interphase barrier (small) Number of poles 1* single pole 2* two pole 3* three pole 4 four pole Colour of front face B* black Terminal design A* stud terminal, M5 or 10-32 (≤60 A) B clamp terminal, M4 or 8-32 (≤30 A) C rear push-on terminal (≤25 A) M*stud terminal, M6 or 1/4-20 (standard for >60 A) Y stud terminal, M6 or 1/4-20 one tooth washer and one hex nut per terminal Actuator configuration A* 1 toggle per pole (mounting A and C) G reduced number of toggles per unit (mounting A and C) J 1 paddle per unit (mounting D) K 1 baton Characteristic curve AS long delay BS* medium delay CS short delay 00 switch only Actuator colour and marking details C white I-0 D black I-0 N white on-off P black on-off 2* white no marking 3* black no marking Not used 0* Auxiliary contacts A* no auxiliary contacts B one change over F trip alarm (on request) H one change over contact in the last pole (for multipole version) L signal contact in last pole (multipole versions only) Internal circuit A switch B*series trip D relay trip J dual control, 4 terminals (≤60A) Remote trip (internal circuit D or J only) current ratings upon request 0* no remote trip 1 DC 24 V 4 AC 120 V 5 AC 230 V Frequency A* AC 50/60 Hz D* DC Current rating 0.1... 60 A (multi pole) 0.1...100 A (single pole) Dimensions 16.7 Ordering information *Bold type versions are preferred. For special configuration please enquire 192 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8350-... Dimensions Internal connection diagrams Mounting version -H 47.3 LINE 1 B - Series trip with auxiliary contacts NC NO LINE 1 NC NO 25.7 19.5 0.8 A - Switch with auxiliary contacts I> 35 87.1 C LOAD 2 C 18.8 LOAD 2 D - Relay trip J - Dual control 6.3 52.4 63.5 Mounting variants LINE 1 LINE 1 U> voltage coil (remote trip) remote trip coil I> I,U> LOAD 2 Terminal design / Dimensions LOAD 2 Actuator configuration A/M stud terminals 3 NC NO C 23 63.5 dual control relay trip 19.4 49.2 17.5 21.5 17.5 16.4 16.4 16.4 47.3 18.4 A 1 toggle per pole G reduced number of toggles per unit 20.3 auxiliary contacts (change over) 18.4 B clamp terminals (IN ≤ 30 A) * * * 47.3 * Denotes microswitch pole on multipole units. Interphase barriers / Dimensions 19.4 11 11 49.2 NC NO C 49.2 23 63.5 20.3 Interphase barrier (small) 8350-.B… 8350-.D… 18.4 C rear push-on terminals (IN ≤ 25 A) Interphase barrier (large) for snap on Y 306 345 01 NC NO C 23 63.5 50 72.3 49.2 19.4 16 10.1 16.4 16.4 16.4 47.3 thickness 1 mm 20.3 63.5 100 blade terminals 6.3 x 0.8 DIN 46244 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 193 Magnetic and Hydraulic-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 8350-... Typical time/current characteristics Accessories Curve AS - long delay for AC 50/60 Hz, DC at ambient temperature +23 °C Splash cover (IP64) for 8350-A.../8350-H... Y 306 265 01 1pole Y 306 266 01 2pole Y 306 267 01 3pole 10000 Trip time in seconds 1000 100 10 1 19.5 0.1 Splash cover M12x1 X 221 427 01 0.001 0 1 1.25 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 … times rated current 9 10 11 1/2"-32 X 221 434 01 splash cover 12 21.4 ø6.5 Curve BS - medium delay for AC 50/60 Hz, DC at ambient temperature +23 °C 15.9 0.01 10000 Trip time in seconds 100 16.1 10 1 M12x1 0.1 UN 1/2-32 3 14 0.01 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 ø15.87 1 1.25 2 1/2"-32 Y 301 999 01 ø15.1 0 3.15 15.88 Knurled nut M12x1 Y 302 065 01 0.001 Curve CS - short delay for AC 50/60 Hz, DC at ambient temperature +23 °C M12x1 UN 1/2-32 3 3.18 10000 Legend plate Y 306 402 01 +0.1 I 28 7 2. ø1 28 +0 .1 5.2 .1 2 +0 10 ON 5.6 I ON ø1 100 Y 306 425 01 +0.1 1000 1 OFF 0.1 O 12 0.01 OFF thickness 0.8 0 1 1.25 2 3 4 6 8 5 7 … times rated current 9 10 11 12 Auxiliary switch (change over contact) Y 306 268 01 Auxiliary switch housing Y 306 269 01 9.7 7.3 12.6 2.5 9.1 Series 8350 with characteristics AS, BS and CS will not trip at a halfsine wave of 10 ms and an amplitude of ≤ 8 times rated current. thickness 0.8 ø17 ø17 0.001 O 12 9.3 Trip time in seconds 7.5 2.8 x 0.5 The tripping characteristics as outlined in this catalogue will only be maintained if the escutcheon is mounted on a vertical surface. 14 15 6.5 3 Threadneck design M: 1/2"-32 Y 300 486 20 18.3 Threadneck design L: Hex nut M12x1 Y 300 116 02 1000 20.2 19.9 194 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches Single and multi pole high performance circuit breakers (CBEs) and battery isolation switches with and without remote control Voltage ratings max. 3 AC 660 V, AC 250 V, DC 220 V Current ratings 0.05...500 A Models are available for aircraft, defence equipment, marine systems and other specialised equipment where safety is paramount. All the circuit breakers in this catalogue section are highly resistant to the effects of shock, vibration, salt spray, humidity and similar influences. Their small physical size, low mass and advanced construction guarantee total versatility. Approvals are held from the supervisory authorities of key relevant industries. For example, E-T-A aircraft circuit breakers have been qualified for use in some of the world’s most advanced aircraft, fixed wing and helicopter. Accessories include panel seals providing various levels of protection for E-T-A single-hole panel mount models, from splash proofing right up to full immersion. Complementing these high performance products, E-T-A battery isolation switches with remote control capability are especially suited to installation in the main battery systems of heavy duty vehicles - including tankers, boats, off-road plant and other battery powered equipment. Remote disconnection offers the dual benefits of user convenience and safety. All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 195 Overview E-T-A high performance circuit breakers, of thermal or thermal magnetic operation, have been designed for applications with uncompromising performance and reliability requirements. 4 High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches Type No. 402-... 410-... Description thermal type threadneck panel mounting thermal-magnetic, surface, panel or track mounting, toggle operated thermal, threadneck panel mounting, push/pull operation Max. voltage rating AC 250 V; DC 28 V AC 240 V; DC 110 V AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current ratings 8...16 A 10...125 A (VDE 0660) 7...100 A (VDE 0641) 6 ...25 A vehicle type (-FN) 7.5...35 A aircraft type (-LN) 6 A, AC 240 V or DC 28 V; 1 A, DC 110 V Typical life 4,000 operations at 2 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 20,000 operations mechanical 4,000 operations at 2 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 1,000 A AC 240 V: 6,000 A DC 110 V: 5,000 A AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1,000 A DC 28 V: 6,000 A LRoS, BV UL, LRoS see pages 207 - 210 see pages 211 - 212 Approvals Available options see pages 205 - 206 ON 58 46 106 90.5 71.5 OFF 46 ø10.6 12.2 OFF 3/8-27 UNS-2A 22.5 OFF Dimensions 11 Overview Aux. contact rating 4 412-... 92 29 Internal connection diagrams line 1 line 1 29 line 1 Si 11 13 12 14 I> 2 196 ☎ 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 2 Issue C High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches 428-... 433 / 434-... 437-... thermal, threadneck mounting, push/pull operation thermal-magnetic, plug-in type, with hand release thermal-magnetic, threadneck panel mounting, with hand release option 433-... fast-acting 434-... standard delay single pole, toggle operated, with remote trip coil AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V DC 144 V 30...50 A vehicle type (-FN) 30...70 A aircraft type (-LN) 0.05...25 A 0.05...16 A 40...240 A 6 A, DC 28 V 0.2 A, DC 180 V 3,000 operations at 240 A/DC 180 V 10,000 operations at 240 A/DC 28 V 20,000 operations mechanical 2,000 operations at 1 x IN 4,000 operations at 2 x IN 4,000 operations at 2 x IN AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1,000 A DC 28 V: 6,000 A 0.05...5 A 400 A 5.5...7.5 A 750 A 8...25 A 1,500 A (with backup fuse NH 40 A to VDE 0636) 0.05...5 A 400 A 5.5...7,5 A 750 A 8...16 A 1,000 A (with backup fuse NH 40 A to VDE 0636) UL, LRoS, BV, QPL Sweden VDE VDE, Demko LRoS, BV see pages 213 - 214 see pages 215 - 217 see pages 219 - 222 see pages 223 - 224 22.5 OFF 15.5 OFF 12.2 OFF ø9.5 2 11 9.6 1 ON 106 90.5 71.5 50.3 48.5 49 OFF 64 max. 4 2,000 A at DC 180 V 10,000 A at DC 28 V ø6.4 ø10.6 19 50 32 line 1 92 42 line 1 line 1 Si 11 13 load 2 I> 2 Issue C ☎ I> I> 2 2 12 14 Si2 2Si2 13 13 23 14 14 24 FA 1 battery + Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Overview 413-... 197 High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches 452-... 482-... Description thermal-magnetic, base mounting thermal-magnetic, threadneck panel mounting, push/pull operation thermal, single pole, threadneck panel mounting, push/pull operation, with auxiliary contact option Max. voltage rating DC 28 V AC 115 V (400 Hz), DC 28 V AC 115 V (400 Hz), DC 28 V, Current ratings 446: 30...400 A; 447: 100...400 A 449: 125...500 A 50...100 A 0.1...50 A Aux. contact rating 10 A Typical life 1,000 operations at 1 x IN 1,000 operations at 1 x IN 10,000 operations, mechanical 5,000 operations at 1 x IN Interrupting capacity Icn 10,000 A DC 28 V: 6,000 A AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1,500 A 0.1...2.5 A 3...3.5 A 4...7 A 7.5...50 A 35...50 A Approvals 449: VG 95345, part 15 447: QPL Sweden LRoS, BV, VG 95345 part 17, QPL Canada, Sweden VG 95345 T21, QPL Canada, LRoS Available options see pages 225 - 226 see pages 227 - 229 see pages 231 - 233 0.5 A, DC 28 V 15 x IN 250 A DC / 150 A AC 500 A 6,000 A DC / 1,000 A AC 3,000 A DC / 1,000 A AC ø20 M12x1 12.2 OFF 12.2 OFF Dimensions 23 M12x1 max. 57 100 Internal connection diagrams 198 ☎ line 1 43.4 max. 50 max. 61.5 44 4 446 / 447 / 449-... 104 Overview Type No. 31 line 1 I> I> 2 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com line 1 2 Issue C High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches 4120-... 4201-... 520 / 530-... thermal, single pole, threadneck panel mounting, push/pull operation, temperature compensated, explosion-proof, miniaturized, with auxiliary contact option, full military specification thermal, single pole, threadneck panel mounting, push/pull operation, temperature compensated, explosion-proof, miniaturized, with auxiliary contact option, commercial aircraft specification single pole, thermal-magnetic, rail mounting, with hand release thermal-magnetic, surface, panel or track mounting, toggle operation 520 double pole 530 three pole AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V AC 250 V; DC 28 V AC 240 V; 3 AC 415 V; 3 AC 500 V 3 AC 660 V; DC 110 V; DC 220 V 1...25 A 1...25 A 0.05...16 A 10...125 A (VDE 0660) 7...100 A (VDE 0641) 0.5 A, DC 28 V 0.5 A, DC 28 V 20,000 operations mechanical 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 20,000 operations mechanical 5,000 operations at 1 x IN 4,000 operations at 2 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 20,000 operations mechanical AC 115 V (400 Hz): ≤4A 5A 7.5...25 A DC 28 V: 1...25 A AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1... 3 A 5...25 A DC 28 V: 1...25 A 0.05...5 A 400 A 5.5...7.5 A 750 A 8...16 A 1,000 A (with backup fuse NH 40 A to VDE 0636) AC 240 V 10,000 A 3 AC 415 V 5,000 A 3 AC 500 V 4,000 A 3 AC 660 V 2,000 A DC 110 V 10,000 A DC 220 V on request 1,000 A 2,000 A 2,500 A 6,000 A 6 A, AC 240 V or DC 28 V; 1 A DC 110 V 1,000 A 2,000 A 6,000 A EN 2495, EN 3773 VDE, Demko LRoS, BV see pages 235 - 238 see pages 239-240 see pages 241 - 242 see pages 207 - 210 2 106 90.5 71.5 line 1 1 3 11 13 I> I> I> 12 14 2 2 4 line 2 1 Issue C ☎ ON 92 80 line 1 line 2 4 7.5 max. 38.6 LINE 1 19.5 19.5 OFF 53 12.5 OFF 11 OFF ø10 ø10 max. 37.2 12.5 OFF LN 29886, VG 95 345 T6, MS 3320, QPL Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Overview 483-... 199 High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches Type No. 583-... isolation switch 911 1 pole 912 2 pole 913 3 pole 914 4 pole toggle operation, surface, panel or track mounting Max. voltage rating 3 AC 200 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V AC 240 V; 3 AC 415 V; 3 AC 500 V; DC 110 V DC 12 V / DC 24 V Current ratings 1...25 A 32 A, 63 A, 125 A 921: 240 A 922: 120 A Aux. contact rating 0.5 A, DC 28 V non-inductive 6 A, AC 240 V or DC 28 V 1 A, DC 110 V 6 A, DC 28 V Typical life 20,000 operations mechanical 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 10,000 operations at 1 x IN 20,000 operations mechanical 10,000 operations electrical 20,000 operations mechanical Interrupting capacity Icn 3 AC 200 V (400 Hz): ≤4A 1,000 A 5A 2,000 A 7.5...25 A 2,500 A DC 28 V: 1...25 A 6,000 A 2,500 A type 921 1,500 A type 922 Approvals LN 29887, VG 95 345 T11, MS 14154, QPL LRoS, BASEEFA Available options see pages 243 - 246 battery isolation switch 921 1 pole 922 2 pole toggle operation, surface mounting, with remote disconnection and reconnection facilities, optional enclosure see pages 251 - 252 see pages 247 - 249 Dimensions 12.5 OFF ø10 OFF ON 92 25.5 92 Internal connection diagrams line A2 A1 200 ☎ B2 B1 C2 C1 ON 106 90.5 71.5 106 90.5 71.5 OFF 38 Overview 921/922 3 pole, thermal, threadneck panel mounting, push/pull operation, temperature compensated, explosion-proof, miniaturized, with auxiliary contact option Description 4 911/912/913/914-... load 2 Si line 1 11 13 2 12 14 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com FA 1 battery + Issue C High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches E-1073-437/921/922 4910 (RCCB) Type No. battery emergency switch, single or double pole, to ADR requirements single or double pole, remote disconnection and reconnection, with undervoltage protection optional remote control circuit breaker (RCCB) single pole, temperature compensated, with auxiliary contacts Description DC 12 V; DC 24 V DC 12 V; DC 24 V DC 28 V (DC 18...36 V) Max. voltage rating 921: 240 A 922: 120 A 437: 40...240 A 921: 240 A 5...100 A Current ratings 6 A at DC 28 V 6 A at DC 28 V DC 28 V, AC 115 V (400 Hz): 3A Aux. contact rating 10,000 operations electrical 20,000 operations mechanical 10,000 operations electrical 20,000 operations mechanical 50,000 operations at 1 x IN Typical life Overview E-1032 DC 28 V (921): 2,500 A DC 28 V (922): 1,500 A DC 28 V (437): 10,000 A DC 28 V (921): 2,500 A DC 28 V (922): 1,500 A 6,000 A Interrupting capacity Icn 4 922: 120 A Approvals TÜV see pages 257 - 260 see pages 253 - 256 see pages 261 - 262 Available options Dimensions I 1 1081-01 1(+) PTB Nr. 111 B/E29861S 2(-) 3 L11 FE 4 L13 L15 circuit breaker 0.5 A 6 L6 L7 L8 3 4 5 6 L1 5 L10 L5 GGVS 8 9 10 I 1 Load Issue C Battery ☎ B LINE electronics L14 CB ON LINE / + A1 S3 S2 (only with 437) ADR L2 OFF L12 back up power 4 11 13 23 I> 30 86 87 87a 15 31 II double contact up 125 A Electronic control unit L3 L4 Generator D+ 85 switch 921/922 FA circuit breaker 437 a R1 Internal connection diagrams load b 1032Electronic 10 180 Emergency + 1 2 (-) Batt D+ - Relay 85 2.5 222 244 4 3 (+) Batt C 135 45 61 146 II Power supply LOAD A M10x25 31 38.8 3 57.15 9.1 154 CB 2 7 + + undervoltage ON / OFF external control switch 12 14 24 3 5A 5B RCCB type 4910 A2 S1 LOAD / - battery terminal strip status max. 2 W indicator control unit ICU Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 201 High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches ● ❍ ❍ ● 520 530 IN ❍ multi pole ● Manual trip facility Auxiliary contacts ● DC (V) ❍ ❍ ❍ Ratings AC (V) ● single pole ❍ screw terminals solder terminals plug-in pins blade terminals rail surface socket ● 410 Number of poles Main terminal design Water splashcover 402 panel Mounting method threadneck Type Choice of characteristic curves High Performance Circuit Breakers - Selector Chart 250 28 25 ● 240 110 125 412 ● ● ● ❍ ● ● 115 28 35 413 ● ● ● ❍ ● ● 115 28 70 250 28 25 250 28 16 ● 428 433/434 ● (❍) ● ❍ ● ❍ ❍ ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ● ● ❍ ● ● ● 144 240 446/447/449 ● ● ❍ ● ● ● 28 500 ● 115 28 100 115 28 50 452 ● 482 ● ● Overview 437 ● 483 ● 4120 ● 4 4201 ● ● 4910 ● 520/530 583 ● ❍ ❍ ● ● ❍ ● ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ❍ ● ❍ ● 583 115 28 25 ● ❍ ● ❍ ● 583 115 28 25 250 28 16 28 100 660 220 125 115 200 28 ● ● ● ❍ ● ❍ ● ● ❍ ● ● only 520 ❍ 410 ● ● ❍ 483 ● 911 912 913 914 110 922 24 120/922 240/921 ❍ ❍ 12 24 120 240 1pol. ❍ ❍ 12/24 144 120 240 1pol. 911-914 ● ❍ ❍ ● ❍ ● 921/922 ● ❍ ❍ ● ❍ ● ❍ 921 ● ❍ E-1032 ● ● E-1073 ● ● ❍ ❍ 25 125 240 1pol. only 911/ 912 ❍ ● 240 ● ● = standard ❍ = optional 202 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches VG Number E-T-A Type VG Number E-T-A Type VG 95345 T06-001 VG 95345 T06-002 VG 95345 T06-003 VG 95345 T06-004 VG 95345 T06-005 VG 95345 T06-006 VG 95345 T06-007 VG 95345 T06-008 VG 95345 T06-009 VG 95345 T06-010 VG 95345 T06-011 VG 95345 T06-012 VG 95345 T06-013 VG 95345 T06-014 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-1A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-2A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-2,5A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-3A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-4A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-5A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-6A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-7,5A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-8A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-10A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-15A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-16A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-20A 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN-25A VG 95345 T15-106 VG 95345 T15-107 VG 95345 T15-108 VG 95345 T15-109 449-K-H-FN-Si-315A 449-K-H-FN-Si-350A 449-K-H-FN-Si-400A 449-K-H-FN-Si-500A VG 95345 T17-001 VG 95345 T17-002 VG 95345 T17-003 VG 95345 T17-004 VG 95345 T17-005 VG 95345 T17-101 VG 95345 T17-102 VG 95345 T17-103 VG 95345 T17-104 VG 95345 T17-105 452-K34-FN2-60A 452-K34-FN2-70A 452-K34-FN2-80A 452-K34-FN2-90A 452-K34-FN2-100A 452-K14-LN2-60A 452-K14-LN2-70A 452-K14-LN2-80A 452-K14-LN2-90A 452-K14-LN2-100A VG 95345 T06-101 VG 95345 T06-102 VG 95345 T06-103 VG 95345 T06-104 VG 95345 T06-105 VG 95345 T06-106 VG 95345 T06-107 VG 95345 T06-108 VG 95345 T06-109 VG 95345 T06-110 VG 95345 T06-111 VG 95345 T06-112 VG 95345 T06-113 VG 95345 T06-114 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-1A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-2A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-2,5A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-3A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-4A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-5A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-6A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-7,5A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-8A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-10A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-15A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-16A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-20A 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN-25A VG 95345 T11-001 VG 95345 T11-002 VG 95345 T11-003 VG 95345 T11-004 VG 95345 T11-005 VG 95345 T11-006 VG 95345 T11-007 VG 95345 T11-008 VG 95345 T11-009 VG 95345 T11-010 VG 95345 T11-011 VG 95345 T11-012 VG 95345 T11-013 VG 95345 T11-014 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-1A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-2A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-2,5A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-3A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-4A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-5A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-6A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-7,5A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-8A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-10A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-15A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-16A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-20A 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN-25A VG 95345 T21-001 VG 95345 T21-002 VG 95345 T21-003 VG 95345 T21-004 VG 95345 T21-005 VG 95345 T21-006 VG 95345 T21-007 VG 95345 T21-008 VG 95345 T21-009 VG 95345 T21-010 VG 95345 T21-011 VG 95345 T21-012 VG 95345 T21-013 VG 95345 T21-014 VG 95345 T21-015 VG 95345 T21-016 VG 95345 T21-017 VG 95345 T21-018 VG 95345 T21-019 VG 95345 T21-020 VG 95345 T21-021 VG 95345 T21-022 VG 95345 T21-023 VG 95345 T21-024 VG 95345 T21-025 482-N-MS-0,5A 482-N-MS-1,0A 482-N-MS-1,5A 482-N-MS-2,0A 482-N-MS-3,0A 482-N-MS-3,5A 482-N-MS-4,0A 482-N-MS-4,5A 482-N-MS-5,0A 482-N-MS-5,5A 482-N-MS-6,0A 482-N-MS-6,5A 482-N-MS-7,0A 482-N-MS-7,5A 482-N-MS-8,0A 482-N-MS-10A 482-N-MS-12A 482-N-MS-15A 482-N-MS-20A 482-N-MS-25A 482-N-MS-30A 482-N-MS-35A 482-N-MS-40A 482-N-MS-45A 482-N-MS-50A VG 95345 T11-101 VG 95345 T11-102 VG 95345 T11-103 VG 95345 T11-104 VG 95345 T11-105 VG 95345 T11-106 VG 95345 T11-107 VG 95345 T11-108 VG 95345 T11-109 VG 95345 T11-110 VG 95345 T11-111 VG 95345 T11-112 VG 95345 T11-113 VG 95345 T11-114 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-1A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-2A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-2,5A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-3A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-4A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-5A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-6A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-7,5A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-8A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-10A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-15A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-16A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-20A 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN-25A VG 95345 T15-001 VG 95345 T15-002 VG 95345 T15-003 VG 95345 T15-004 VG 95345 T15-005 VG 95345 T15-006 VG 95345 T15-007 VG 95345 T15-008 VG 95345 T15-009 VG 95345 T15-101 VG 95345 T15-102 VG 95345 T15-103 VG 95345 T15-104 VG 95345 T15-105 449-K-H-FN-125A 449-K-H-FN-160A 449-K-H-FN-200A 449-K-H-FN-225A 449-K-H-FN-250A 449-K-H-FN-315A 449-K-H-FN-350A 449-K-H-FN-400A 449-K-H-FN-500A 449-K-H-FN-Si-125A 449-K-H-FN-Si-160A 449-K-H-FN-Si-200A 449-K-H-FN-Si-225A 449-K-H-FN-Si-250A VG 95345 T21-101 VG 95345 T21-102 VG 95345 T21-103 VG 95345 T21-104 VG 95345 T21-105 VG 95345 T21-106 VG 95345 T21-107 VG 95345 T21-108 VG 95345 T21-109 VG 95345 T21-110 VG 95345 T21-111 VG 95345 T21-112 VG 95345 T21-113 VG 95345 T21-114 VG 95345 T21-115 VG 95345 T21-116 VG 95345 T21-117 VG 95345 T21-118 VG 95345 T21-119 VG 95345 T21-120 VG 95345 T21-121 VG 95345 T21-122 VG 95345 T21-123 VG 95345 T21-124 VG 95345 T21-125 482-MS-0,5A 482-MS-1,0A 482-MS-1,5A 482-MS-2,0A 482-MS-3,0A 482-MS-3,5A 482-MS-4,0A 482-MS-4,5A 482-MS-5,0A 482-MS-5,5A 482-MS-6,0A 482-MS-6,5A 482-MS-7,0A 482-MS-7,5A 482-MS-8,0A 482-MS-10A 482-MS-12A 482-MS-15A 482-MS-20A 482-MS-25A 482-MS-30A 482-MS-35A 482-MS-40A 482-MS-45A 482-MS-50A VG 95345 T23 A VG 95345 T23 B VG 95345 T23 D X 200 802 01 X 200 801 08 X 200 803 01 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Overview Cross Reference List of German military part numbers versus E-T-A part numbers 4 203 High Performance Circuit Breakers and Battery Isolation Switches Overview Cross Reference List of EN military part numbers versus E-T-A part numbers 4 EN/MS Number E-T-A Type MS Number E-T-A Type EN 2495-01A M EN 2495-02A M EN 2495-2A5 M EN 2495-03A M EN 2495-05A M EN 2495-7A5 M EN 2495-10A M EN 2495-15A M EN 2495-20A M EN 2495-25A M 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-1A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-2A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-2,5A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-3A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-5A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-7,5A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-10A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-15A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-20A 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN-25A MS 3320-5VL MS 3320-6VL MS 3320-7.5VL MS 3320-10VL MS 3320-15VL MS 3320-20VL 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-5A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-6A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-7,5A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-10A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-15A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-20A EN 2495-01A U EN 2495-02A U EN 2495-2A5 U EN 2495-03A U EN 2495-05A U EN 2495-7A5 U EN 2495-10A U EN 2495-15A U EN 2495-20A U EN 2495-25A U 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-1A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-2A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-2,5A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-3A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-5A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-7,5A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-10A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-15A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-20A 4120-G111-J2M1-K5S0ZN-25A MS 14154-1 MS 14154-2 MS 14154-2.5 MS 14154-3 MS 14154-4 MS 14154-5 MS 14154-6 MS 14154-7.5 MS 14154-10 MS 14154-15 MS 14154-20 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-1A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-2A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-2,5A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-3A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-4A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-5A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-6A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-7,5A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-10A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-15A 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X-20A EN 3773-004 D 01A EN 3773-004 D 02A EN 3773-004 D 2A5 EN 3773-004 D 03A EN 3773-004 D 05A EN 3773-004 D 7A5 EN 3773-004 D 10A EN 3773-004 D 15A EN 3773-004 D 20A EN 3773-004 D 25A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-1A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-2A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-2,5A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-3A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-5A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-7,5A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-10A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-15A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-20A 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S0ZN-25A MS 3320-1 MS 3320-2 MS 3320-2.5 MS 3320-3 MS 3320-4 MS 3320-5 MS 3320-6 MS 3320-7.5 MS 3320-10 MS 3320-15 MS 3320-20 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-1A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2,5A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-3A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-4A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-5A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-6A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-7,5A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-10A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-15A 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z-20A MS 3320-1L MS 3320-2L MS 3320-2.5L MS 3320-3L MS 3320-4L MS 3320-5L MS 3320-6L MS 3320-7.5L MS 3320-10L MS 3320-15L MS 3320-20L 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-1A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2,5A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-3A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-4A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-5A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-6A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-7,5A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-10A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-15A 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z-20A MS 3320-1V MS 3320-2V MS 3320-2.5V MS 3320-3V MS 3320-4V MS 3320-5V MS 3320-6V MS 3320-7.5V MS 3320-10V MS 3320-15V MS 3320-20V 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-1A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2,5A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-3A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-4A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-5A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-6A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-7,5A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-10A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-15A 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z-20A MS 3320-1VL MS 3320-2VL MS 3320-2.5VL MS 3320-3VL MS 3320-4VL 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-1A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-2.5A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-3A 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z-4A 204 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 402-... Description Single pole high performance version of type 2-5700 (section 1) thermal circuit breaker, with push-to-reset tease free, trip-free, snap action mechanism (R-type TO CBE to EN 60 934). Designed for threadneck panel mounting and for applications with a high fault current switching requirement. Typical applications Extra low voltage systems, industrial equipment. 402-... Accessories X 200 799 02 X 200 799 01 X 200 798 01/02 X 210 739 01 Technical data Water splash cover/knurled nut assembly. As above with the cover bonded to the nut for extra retention. As X 200 799 02 and 01 above but featuring a slotted knurled ring for wrench front of panel tightening. Water splash cover/hex nut. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Ordering information Type No. 402 threadneck panel mounting* Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 K14 screw terminals M4x6 Current ratings 8 ... 16 A 402 - P10 - 10 A Voltage rating 8...16 A (20...25 A to special order) Typical life 4,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 (threadneck should be earthed/grounded) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 2000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 1000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 8 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.61 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 40 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-27, Test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 35 g ordering example *mounting hardware bulk shipped Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 8 < 0.02 14 < 0.02 10 < 0.02 15 < 0.02 12 < 0.02 16 < 0.02 Issue C ☎ AC 250 V; DC 28 V Current rating range Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 4 205 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 402-... Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Dimensions tightening torque max. 1.5 Nm 3/8-27 UNS-2A 16.5 ON 22.5 OFF 402-P10 10000 D-shaped threadneck ø6.5 1000 Trip time in seconds 46 10 100 10 1 11 0.1 0.01 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 mounting hole 29 2 9.6 -0.1 8.8 14.5 SW 14 8.9 -0.1 -K14 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 tightening torque max. 1.5 Nm 3/8-27 UNS-2A 16.5 ON Accessories D-shaped threadneck ø6.5 10 22.5 OFF 0.001 1 current rating in A 57 46 4 Water splash cover, transparent Y 300 538 01 + knurled nut Y 300 628 01 X 200 799 02 (IP64) X 200 799 01 bonded to nut (IP64) 3/8-27 UNS-2B 10.6 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm 29 mounting hole Splash cover, transparent/ hex nut assembly (IP64) X 210 739 01 current rating in A 2 8.9 -0.1 9.6 -0.1 8.8 14.5 SW14 Splash cover, transparent/ knurled nut assembly (IP64) X 200 798 01 X 200 798 02 bonded to nut 3/8-27 UNS-2B 3/8-27 UNS-2B Internal connection diagram line 1 2 206 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 410/520/530-... Description Single, double and three pole high performance thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and toggle actuation (S-type TM CBE to EN 60 934; also to EN 60 947). Designed for rail, panel or surface mounting. Available with a choice of characteristic curves and optional auxiliary contacts. Typical applications Motors, generators, transformers, thyristor and silicon rectifiers. Accessories X 211 118 01 X 211 119 01 X 211 705 01 Single pole splashcover with fixing plate. Two pole splashcover with fixing plate. Terminal insulation cover for use with types 410, 520 and 530 - two per pole required. Interrupting capacity to IEC 947/EN 60947 AC voltage Number Voltage of poles rating Interrupting capacity IN=12-125A Power factor Interrupting capacity IN = 7+10 A Power factor 1 AC 240 V 5,000 A cosϕ = 0.7 3,500 A cosϕ = 0.8 2 AC 240 V 8,000 A cosϕ = 0.7 6,000 A cosϕ = 0.7 3 3 AC 415 V 5,000 A cosϕ = 0.7 3,000 A cosϕ = 0.85 410-K-... 530-K-... Technical data Voltage rating AC 240 V, 3 AC 415 V, 3 AC 500 V, 3 AC 660 V (50/60 Hz), DC 110 V; DC 220 V series connection Current rating range 10...125 A (EN 60947), curves 01/02/04/05 7...100 A (EN 60898), curves B3/C3 Auxiliary circuit 6 A, AC 240 V or DC 28 V; 1 A, DC 110 V Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN 20,000 operations mechanical 3 3 AC 500 V 4,000 A cosϕ = 0.8 2,500 A cosϕ = 0.85 Ambient temperature -20...+60 °C 3 3 AC 660 V 2,000 A cosϕ = 0.85 2,000 A cosϕ = 0.85 Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 6 kV 3 DC voltage Number Voltage of poles rating 1 DC 110 V Interrupting capacity IN = 12...125 A IN = 7+10 A 3,000 A 3,000 A 5,000 A 3,500 A Time constant L/R = 13 ms 1 DC 110 V L/R = 5 ms 2 DC 110 V 5,000 A 3,000 A L/R = 13 ms 2 DC 110 V 10,000 A 6,000 A L/R ≈ 0 ms 2 DC 220 V 2,000 A 2,000 A L/R = 13 ms 2 DC 220 V 3,000 A 3,000 A L/R ≈ 0 ms Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Curves 01, 02, 04, 05: Current Internal resistance rating (A) (Ω) per pole Curves B3, C3: Current rating (A) Internal resistance Ω) per pole 10 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 90 100 125 7 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100 0.033 0.015 0.015 0.010 0.0062 0.0039 0.0031 0.0022 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 0.033 0.015 0.010 0.0062 0.0039 0.0031 0.0022 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 ≤ 0.002 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole/pole main circuit/aux.circuit aux. circuit 11-12/13-14 Test voltage AC 3300 V AC 3300 V AC 2200 V AC 1000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Degree ef protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration curves 02/04/05/B3/C3: 4 g (60-500 Hz) ±0.30 mm (10-60 Hz) curve 01: 3 g (60-500 Hz) ±0.23 mm (10-60 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, Test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock curves 02/04/05/B3/C3: 50 g (11 ms) directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 30 g in direction 6 curve 01: 30 g (11 ms) in directions 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 20 g in direction 6 to IEC 68-27, Test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass 410 (1 pole): approx. 290 g 520 (2 pole): approx. 580 g 530 (3 pole): approx. 870 g 4 Approvals Authority LRoS BV (except type 530) Voltage ratings 3 AC 415 V AC 240 V, DC 110 V Issue C ☎ Current ratings 16...125 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 207 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 410/520/530-... ON 3 OFF Si-terminals M3.5 1 N/C 6 41 1 N/O 92 16 top-hat rail DIN EN 50022-35x7.5 G profile rail DIN EN 50035-G32 (not shown) M3.5 - thread max. 9 mm deep tightening torque max. 0.55 Nm D 45 35 Pole 1 Type 410 C 19 22 E Pole 2 B The exact number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Pole 3 Type 520 - 10 A ordering example Type 530 520 - K - 1 - 01 - 26° 26° 106 90.5 71.5 No. single pole (ratings > 125 A: suffix 17015 - parallel connection) double pole three pole Terminal design - main terminals K screw terminals 10-32 A pressure plate B5-DIN 46288 (curves B3/C3, 7-25 A) 40-63 A pressure plate B5-DIN 46288 (curves B3/C3, 32-63 A) 80-125 A terminal screw DIN 46206, sheet 2, form A, M6 thread Mounting 1 surface mounting 2 rail mounting (DIN EN 50 022-35x7.5) or panel mounting 3 rail mounting on G profile (DIN EN 5035-G32) or panel mounting 4 panel mounting with cylinder head screw M3.5 5 mounting brackets Magnetic trip curves 01 2.1-3xIN (thyristor and rectifier protection) 02 7-10xIN (motor and generator protection to EN 60947) 04 3.5-x5xIN (cable protection to EN 60947) 05 4-6xIN (generator protection to EN 60947) B3 3-5xIN (cable protection to EN 60898) C3 5-10xIN (cable protection to EN 60898) Auxiliary contacts optional (terminals M3.5) Si one each N/O and N/C contact Si1 one N/C (11,12) Si2 one N/O (13,14) 2Si two each N/O and N/C (types 520/530) 3Si three N/C, three N/O (type 530) Current ratings 7...125 A 66 Type 410 520 530 Dimensions 44 Ordering information Mounting methods Surface mounting -1 Current rating rail mounting (DIN EN 50 022-35x7,5) -2 ≤ 32A ≤ 63A ≤ 125A 14.6 B M5 M6 M6 Dimensions C D 13 114 15.4 120 15.4 120 E 7 9 9 Terminal Max. tightening torque pressure plate pressure plate terminal screw 2.0 Nm 2.5 Nm 2.5 Nm surface mounting mounting holes 4.6 35 ø20 44 +1 22 +0.5 ø4 panel mounting -4 97 rail mounting on G profile (DIN EN 50 035-G32) -3 surface mounting with mounting brackets -5 14 9 a Type 410 50 Type 520 72 Type 530 94 a c 3.7 b 4 22 ø4.6 b c 61.5 70 83.5 92 105.5 114 M5 57 208 ☎ 10 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 410/520/530-... Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Internal connection diagram Magnetic trip curves 01,02,04,05 Type 410-K AC Type 410-K-Si line 1 line 1 11 13 12 14 10000 1000 I> I> 2 2 Trip time in seconds 100 10 Type 520-K-Si Type 520-K-2Si 1 05 01 04 0.1 line 1 3 11 13 11 13 21 23 12 14 12 14 22 24 02 0.01 I> I> 2 4 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Magnetic trip curves B3,C3 AC Type 530-K-Si Type 530-K-3Si 10000 3 5 I> I> I> 2 4 6 line 1 11 13 11 13 21 23 31 33 12 14 12 14 22 24 32 34 1000 Trip time in seconds 100 10 4 1 Shock directions B3 0.1 C3 4 0.01 3 2 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. 1 5 Issue C ☎ 6 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 209 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 410/520/530-... Accessories Water splash cover with fixing plate (IP 54) for type 410 X 211 118 01 Terminal insulation cover for types 410/520/530-K X 211 705 01 (1 set = 2 pcs per pole) 1.2 21 94 40 64 max. 4 38 92 44 19 53 24.5 mounting hole ø4 40 +0.3 ø10 44 25+0.3 165 35 Water splash cover with fixing plate (IP 54) for type 520 X 211 119 01 62 53 4 1.2 21 max. 4 38 24.5 59 mounting hole 22 59 +0.3 ø4 25 +0.3 35 210 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 412-... Description Single pole high performance thermal circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). An indicator band on the push button shows clearly the tripped/off position. Threadneck panel mounted and available in tracked vehicle, aircraft and general purpose versions. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles for land, sea and air; defence equipment; battery powered machines. 412-... Accessories X 200 801 08 Technical data Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. X 200 801 03 X 200 802 01 X 200 802 02 X 200 803 01 Ordering information Type No. 412 threadneck panel mounting Terminal design K14 screw terminals M4 (to aircraft specs.) K54 screw terminals M4 sealed housing (to vehicle specs.) Version FN2 vehicle application LN2 aircraft application N2 general application Current ratings 6...25 A (-FN2) 7.5...35 A (-LN2/N2) 412 - K14 - LN2 - 10 A Voltage rating AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 6...25 A (-FN) 7.5...35 A (-LN/-N), lower current ratings to special order Typical life 4,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -55...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1000 A DC 28 V: 6000 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) DC 28 V: 6000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (56-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 204/ IEC 68-2-6, test Fc Shock 25 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 213/ IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to VG 95210, sheet 2/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 101/ IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 106/ IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 40 g ordering example Standard current ratings and typical voltage drop values Current rating (A) 6 Voltage drop (mV) -LN/N -FN ≤ 300 Current rating (A) 15 Voltage drop (mV) -LN/N -FN ≤ 200 ≤ 200 7.5 ≤ 300 ≤ 250 20 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 8 ≤ 250 ≤ 200 25 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 10 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 30 ≤ 200 - 12 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 35 ≤ 200 - 13 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 4 Approvals Test authority Voltage ratings Current ratings UL DC 28 V 0.1...35 A LRoS DC 28 V 6...25 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 211 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 412-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram line 1 412-K54-FN2/N2 2 Typical time/current characteristics Trip time in seconds 412-...-FN 6...25 A 412-K14/K54-FN2/N2 10000 +75 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 1 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 412-..LN 7,5...35 A 412-K14-LN2 Trip time in seconds 4 10000 +75 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C 100 10 1 0.1 412-K14/K54-LN2 0.01 0.001 1 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Accessories (approved to VG 95345, part 23) Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut, M12x1 black cover 212 ☎ Splash cover black/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 54) X 200 802 01 nickel plated nut X 200 802 02 matt black finish nut Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 413-... Description Single pole high performance thermal circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). An indicator band on the push button shows clearly the tripped/off position. Threadneck panel mounted and available in tracked vehicle, aircraft and general purpose versions. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles for land, sea and air; defence equipment; battery powered machines. 413-... Accessories X 200 801 08 Technical data Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. X 200 801 03 X 200 802 01 X 200 802 02 X 200 803 01 Ordering information Type No. 413 threadneck panel mounting Terminal design K14 screw terminals M6 (to aircraft specs.) K34 reinforced screw terminals M6 (to vehicle specs.) K54 as K34, but housing sealed Version FN2 vehicle application LN2 aircraft application N2 general application Current ratings 30...50 A (-FN2) 30...70 A (-LN2/N2) 413 - K14 - LN2 - 40 A ordering example Voltage rating AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 30...50 A (-FN) 30...70 A (-LN/-N), Typical life 2,000 operations at 1 x IN Ambient temperature -55...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 1500 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1000 A DC 28 V: 6000 A Interrupting capacity (UL 1077) DC 28 V: 6000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (56-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 204/ IEC 68-2-6, test Fc Shock 50 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 213/ IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, to VG 95210, sheet 2/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 101/ IEC 68-2-11, Test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 106/ IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 65 g Standard current ratings and typical voltage drop values Current rating (A) Voltage drop (mV) -LN/N -FN Current rating (A) Voltage drop (mV) -LN/N -FN 30 ≤ 250 ≤ 250 50 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 35 ≤ 250 ≤ 250 60 ≤ 200 - 40 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 70 ≤ 200 - 45 ≤ 200 ≤ 200 4 Approvals Test authority Voltage ratings Current ratings UL DC 28 V 30...70 A LRoS, BV DC 28 V 30...70 A QPL Sweden DC 28 V 30...50 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 213 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 413-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 413-K14-... 6.5 4 6 1.5 12.2 black white lock washer ON OFF line 1 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 ø10.6 max. 64 55 max. 63 49 2 Typical time/current characteristics 413-...-FN 30...50 A +23 °C -55 °C .3 x ma screw ISO1580-M6x8(-N/-FN) M6x10 (-LN) lock washer DIN 137-B6 tightening torque max. 2.5 Nm 413-K14-LN2 +75 °C 10000 .5 35° 1000 mounting holes min. ø3.2 9.5 ø12.5 2.7 50 18.5 +0.2 current rating in A Trip time in seconds 23 9.5±0.2 35° 100 10 1 SW14 location pin 32 0.1 0.01 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 black 413-K34/K54-... 6.5 4 1.5 6 lock washer 1 35° x. 3.5 ma screw ISO1580-M6x8(-N/-FN) M6x10 (-LN) lock washer DIN 137-B6 tightening torque max. 2.5 Nm 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current 10000 +75 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 413-K34/K54-FN2/-N2 ø12.5 +0.2 50 2.7 9.5±0.2 mounting holes 9.5 18.5 current rating in A 2 413-..LN/N 30...70 A Trip time in seconds 23 max. 64 49 max. 63 35° 55 OFF 4 0.001 white ON 12.2 ø10.6 SW14 32 min. ø3.2 location pin 0.001 1 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Accessories (approved to VG 95345, part 23) Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut, M12x1 black cover 214 ☎ Splash cover black/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 54) X 200 802 01 nickel plated nut X 200 802 02 matt black finish nut Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 428-... Description Single pole high performance version of type 3200 (section 2) thermalmagnetic circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and additional manual release (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Designed for plug-in mounting with E-T-A sockets 10R or 16. Available with optional silver plated terminal pins for use in corrosive environments. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Extra low voltage systems, control equipment. 428-... Technical data Accessories 10R-K10 10R-P10 10R-A10 Y 301 166 02 Y 301 166 01 16 X 200 409 01 Y 301 477 01 X 210 589 01 X 210 589 02 X 210 588 01 X 210 588 02 X 210 588 03 X 210 588 04 X 200 800 10 Modular snap-together surface mounted sockets, each accommodating two plug-in circuit breakers. With screw terminals. As above but with push-on terminals. As above but with a combination of screw and push-on terminals. Two-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10 sockets Four-way brass connecting/bus bar links for type 10 sockets Single socket for symmetric EN rail mounting. Adapter for mounting socket type 16 to asymmetric rail (G-profile) Blanking plug with insulated pins, for socket 10. 50-way 1.5mm2 cable links with pre-fitted connection lugs for type 10F-K10/-A10 sockets. As above but with 2.5mm2 cable links. 100-way 1.5mm2 cable links, brown, with pre-fitted push-on connectors for type 10F-P10 sockets. As above but with 2.5mm2 cable links, black As above, but red As above, but blue Terminal for mounting rack Voltage rating 0.05...25 A Typical life 4,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...5 A 5.5...7.5 A 8...25 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 50 g Ordering information Type No. 428 plug-in Terminal design AG silver-plated plug-in terminals Current ratings 0.05...25 A 428 - AG - 10 A 400 A 750 A 1500 A (with back-up fuse NH 40 A to VDE 0636) 4 ordering example Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 0.05 Internal resistance (Ω) 534 4 0.1407 0.1 149 5 0.1068 0.2 56 6 0.0627 0.3 24.2 7 0.0491 0.4 13.65 8 ≤ 0.02 0.5 8.08 10 ≤ 0.02 0.6 5.25 12 ≤ 0.02 0.8 3.55 14 ≤ 0.02 1 2.02 15 ≤ 0.02 1.5 0.904 16 ≤ 0.02 2 0.514 18 ≤ 0.02 2.5 0.36 20 ≤ 0.02 3 0.23 25 ≤ 0.02 Issue C AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range ☎ Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...25 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 215 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 428-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram OFF ON 10 ø13 48.5 15.5 line 1 ø9.5 I> 2 2 9.6 1 19 current rating in A 11 2 14 43 19 50 Installation drawing 1 4 43 34.5 operating area (double insulation) Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 2 6 socket N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Typical time/current characteristics 0,05...7 A 8...16 A AC 18...25 A (for IN >20 A 50% ON duty) AC 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 10 1 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 1 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 216 AC 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current ☎ 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 428-... Accessories 10R-K10 1 10R-P10 Blanking plug Y 301 477 01 for sockets 10R-P10/K10 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid 13 12 1 42 27.5 14 1.5 9.5 9.5 22 21 30 12 68 12 6 11 22 21 11 50 12 5.6 30 Terminal for mounting rack X 200 800 01 for socket10R, on EN rail 50035-G32 7 8 45 75 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 M5 x 12 19 50 12 15 9.5 7,5 ø4 14.5 27 10R-A10 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Connector bus link -K10 X 210 589 01/2.5mm2 black X 210 589 02/1.5mm2 brown for sockets 10R-K10/-A10 and 16 50 pin lugs to DIN 46230 tinned copper 21 11 22 12 59 8 ø2.5 ~70 7 wire cross sectional areas 2 x max. 2.5 mm2 stranded 2 x max. 4 mm2 solid Bus bars for sockets 10.-... Y301 166 02 (2-way) 15 15 t = 0.8 15 15 52.9 22.9 Socket 16 70 52 39.5 32 38.5 15 1.5 Adapter for EN rail 50035-G32 (specified as a separate item) X 200 409 01 for socket 16 available on request Connector bus link -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5mm2 brown X 210 588 02/2.5mm2 black X 210 588 03/2.5mm2 red X 210 588 04/2.5mm2 blue for sockets 10R-P10, 10R-A10 4 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 tinned brass, insulated ~70 12.5 8.5 4.2 2.9 7.9 301 166 01 (4-way) symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 217 4 218 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 433/434-... Description Single pole high performance versions of types 3300 and 3400 (section 2) thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with tease-free, trip-free, pressto-reset, snap action mechanism (R-type TM CBE to EN 60934; M-type with manual release -H). Available with fast acting and standard magnetic tripping characteristics - types 433 and 434 - both with threadneck panel mounting. Options include a separate shunt tap terminal (-A3), and pull-to-trip manual release (-H). Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Industrial equipment, control systems, power supplies. 433-... Accessories X 201 296 01 Technical data Concertina style splash cover/hex nut assembly for version with press-to-reset only (-IG2), without Oring. As above, but translucent, with O-ring Splash seal/knurled nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator, for version with press-to-reset only (-IG2). X 200 801 08 X 210 663 01 Voltage rating AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 0.05...16 A Typical life 4,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Ordering information Type No. 433 fast magnetic trip 434 delayed trip Mounting IG2 moulded threadneck M12x1, protection class II, not with -H leave blank for metal threadneck (required for -H) Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 K20 screw terminals M3.5x5.5 (not with -A3) Manual release (optional) H manual release facility ((pull) for M12x1 metal threadneck only. Shunt terminal (optional, not with -K20) A3 up to IN = 7 A max. load 5 A Current ratings 0.05... 16 A 433 - IG2 - P10 433 - - - 5A - P10 - H - - 5A ordering example, without manual release and with moulded threadneck ordering example, with manual release and metal threadneck Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...5 A 5.5...7.5 A 8...16 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass type 433: approx. 55 g type 434: approx. 50 g The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 433-... 434-... (fast acting) (standardl) Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 433-... 434-... (fast acting) (standard) 0.05 477 447 2.5 0.27 0.24 0.1 131 131 3 0.183 0.19 0.2 41 39.6 4 0.109 0.090 0.3 32 19.3 5 0.066 0.061 0.4 10.3 10.4 6 0.046 0.041 0.5 7.2 7.1 7 0.032 0.034 0.6 4.8 4.3 8 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 0.8 2.50 2.5 10 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 1 1.93 1.67 12 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 1.5 0.81 0.60 15 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 2 0.44 0.38 16 ≤ 0.02 ≤ 0.02 Issue C 434-... ☎ 400 A 750 A 1000 A (in accordance with VDE 0636/IEC 269) 4 Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Demko AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...16 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 219 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 433/434-... Dimensions Internal connection diagrams with shunt terminal -A3 line 1 ø6.4 ON OFF Version -IG2-P10 line 1 M12x1 tightening torque max. 1.5Nm 50.3 (-IG2) 52.3 (-H) 10 16 22.5 3 I> I> 2 2 3 > 8A Terminal design 2 11 1 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 42 mounting hole 1 5 ø12.2 -0.1 Version -H 4.9 1.4 10.5 2 9 ø6.4 ON OFF 2 -K20 1 M3.5x5.5 ISO 1207 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 18.5 M12x1 24.5 3 11.4 29 SW14 -P10-A3 14.5 11.5 -0.1 current rating in A 4 ø12.5 +0.2 9.5±0.2 mounting holes ø3 +0.2 Installation drawing 3 max. 2.5 operating area (double insulation) 41 26 (max. 2 mm when fitted with water splash cover) 1 3 3 mounting area 220 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 433/434-... Typical time/current characteristics 433-... 0.05...7 A AC 434-... 0.05...7 A +60 °C 10000 AC +60 °C 10000 +23 °C +23 °C 1000 Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds 100 10 1 -30 °C 1000 -30 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 433-... 8...16 A 1 AC 434-... 8...16 A +60 °C 10000 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC +60 °C 10000 +23 °C +23 °C -30 °C 1000 100 Trip time in seconds Trip time in seconds 100 10 1 10 4 1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Issue C -30 °C 1000 ☎ 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 221 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 433/434-... Accessories For push buttons with moulded threadneck M12 (-IG2) (not with manual release -H) Splash cover black with hex nut assembly X 201 296 01 without O-ring (IP 64) Splash cover translucent with nickel-plated hex nut X 200 801 08 with O ring (IP 66) M12x1 Splash cover (translucent) with knurled nut assembly X 210 663 01 (IP 64) M12x1 4 222 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 437-... Description Single pole high performance thermal magnetic circuit breaker with toggle actuation (S-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Options include auxiliary contacts, a moulded flame retardant enclosure for added environmental protection, and remote operation - disconnection only, or disconnection and re-connection. Typical applications Battery and cable protection for all types of vehicles (including electric), battery powered systems. 437-... Technical data Ordering information Type No. 437 single pole, toggle actuator Enclosure design (optional) B3 moulded, high environmental protection degree, without operating knob B31 moulded, high environmental protection degree, with operating knob B35 as B31, but for remote disconnection and re-connection facility Terminal design K12 flat screw terminals M10, for enclosure B3, B31 or B35 K60 flat screw terminals DIN 46 206, form A, thread M10 Mounting 1 lugs 5 brackets Characteristic curve 06 fast trip 07 delayed trip Auxiliary contacts (blade terminals 6.3x08) Si one each N/O and N/C Si1 one N/C (11/12) Si2 one N/O (13/14) 2Si2 two N/O Remote trip FA electrical remote disconnection FC electrical remote disconnection (FA) and re-connection (FE) BC-FA electrical remote disconnection (FA) and manual/remote re-connection not for enclosure B. Coil voltage 12 DC 12 V 24 DC 24 V Current ratings 40...240 A Voltage ratings ≤ DC 110 V > DC 110 V Voltage rating 40...240 A Auxiliary contact rating 6 A max. at DC 28 V; 0.2 A at DC 180 V Electrical remote disconnection (-FA) operating voltage DC 12 V or DC 24 V operating current approx. 18 A or 12 A max. pulse time 10 ms < tON < 20 ms / tOFF > 10 s switching time < 20 ms Electrical remote re-connection (-FC) operating voltage DC 12 V or DC 24 V operating current approx. 30 A or 15 A max. pulse time 0.1 s < tON < 1.2 s / tOFF > 60 s switching time < 100 ms Typical life -40...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 6 kV 3 4 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664 A) operating area main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 3300 V AC 2200 V aux. circuits 11-12 to 13-14 AC 1000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 2,000 A at DC 180 V; L/R = 0 ms 10,000 A at DC 28 V; L/R = 0 ms 7,500 A at DC 28 V; L/R = 13 ms Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40, terminal area IP 00 (IP 54 with enclosure B...) Vibration Curve 06: 3 g (60-500 Hz), ±0.23 mm (10-60 Hz) Curve 07: 4 g (60-500 Hz), ±0.30 mm (10-60 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock Curve 06: 20 g (11 ms) Curve 07: 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea ordering example Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values 3,000 operations at 240 A, DC 180 V 10,000 operations at 240 A, DC 28 V 20,000 operations mechanical Ambient temperature 437 - B31 - K12 - 5 - 06 - 2Si2 - FA 24 - 50 A - The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. DC 144 V (higher voltage ratings to special order) Current rating range Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH, to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 1000 g (with remote disconnection) approx. 1400 g (with remote disconnection and re-connection) Current rating (A) 40 Internal resistance (Ω) < 0.001 Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 120 < 0,001 50 < 0.001 160 < 0,001 63 < 0.001 200 < 0,001 80 < 0.001 240 < 0,001 100 < 0.001 Issue C ☎ Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings LRoS, ABS, BV DC 180 V 40...240 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 223 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 437-... Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C Dimensions 57 Housing -B3 26 9 Curve 06 (fast trip) 15.3 100 Trip time in seconds 67 1000 116 47 28.5 72 10000 10 1 155 116 0.1 0.01 288 cylinder-head screw M6x16-4.8 ISO 1207 0.001 1 437-K12-5-Si10-...-FA 26° 26° 0 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Curve 07 (delayed trip) M10x25 tightening torque max. 4Nm 10000 3 I 1000 92 13 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8-Bz 2 terminals for remote disconnection 2 terminals for Si1 (N/C) 2 terminals for Si2 (N/O) 4 10 1 44 3 92 83.5 72 M5 100 Trip time in seconds 2 41 91 71.5 106 4 2 0.1 9 61.5 14 57 0.01 180 0.001 1 437-K60-1-...-FA 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 26° 26° 0 M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm Internal connection diagram 4 blade terminal DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8-Bz 2 terminals for remote disconnection 2 terminals for Si1 (N/C) IN ≤ 125 A IN > 125 A 6 41 106 90.5 71.5 3 I 92 13 25 44 ø11 167.5 141 45 35 4 terminals for 2Si2 (2 N/O) location pin for top-hat rail DIN EN 50022-35x7.5 location pin for G profile DIN EN 50035-G32 (not shown) M3.5-9 depth tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm load Si Si2 2Si2 2 11 13 13 13 23 I> 12 14 14 14 24 FA 1 battery + load 2 I> Si2 2Si2 11 Si 13 13 13 23 12 14 14 14 24 FA 1 battery + -BC-FA operating range see type 921-...-BC-FA -FC coil shown with type 922-...-FC 224 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 446/447/449 Description Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breakers with tease-free, trip-free, press-to-reset snap action mechanism and special dual button manual release which avoids the danger of unintended disconnection (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Surface mounted, compact design available with fast acting, standard and delayed switching characteristics. Options include auxiliary contact and remote electrical disconnection. Typical applications Heavy duty vehicles, battery systems, defence equipment. 446-... Ordering information - - 200 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Voltage rating DC 28 V Current rating range type 446: 30...400 A type 447: 100...400 A type 449: 125...500 A Auxiliary circuit 10 A Electrical remote disconnection (-FA) operating voltage DC 12 V or DC 24 V operating current approx. 18 A or 12 A max. pulse time 10 ms < tON < 20 ms / tOFF > 10 s switching time < 20 ms Typical life Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) -55...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main circuit to auxiliary contacts 30 0.006 100 < 0.002 40 0.0048 125 < 0.001 50 0.0038 160 < 0.001 60 0.0028 225 < 0.001 70 0.0025 300 < 0.001 80 0.0023 400 < 0.001 10,000 A operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration without auxiliary contacts: 10 g (56-500 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) with auxiliary contacts: 4 g (56-500 Hz) ±0.30 mm (10-56 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/IEC 68-2-6, test Fc Shock without auxiliary contacts: 50 g (11 ms) with auxiliary contacts: 20 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to VG 95210, sheet 2/IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/IEC 68-2-3, test C Mass approx. 850 g 90 0.0019 449 0.0016 125 < 0.001 125 < 0.001 160 < 0.001 150 < 0.001 225 < 0.001 170 < 0.001 315 < 0.001 200 < 0.001 350 < 0.001 225 < 0.001 400 < 0.001 Authority 250 < 0.001 500 < 0.001 Type 449: 300 < 0.001 only with 50 % ON duty 350 < 0.001 Type 447: 400 < 0.001 QPL Sweden ☎ AC 1000 V >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 100 Issue C 4 Test voltage AC 1000 V Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Internal resistance (Ω) 447 446 1000 operations at IN 2000 operations mechanical Ambient temperature Insulation resistance Current rating (A) 449-... Technical data Type No. 446 / 447 / 449 single pole base mounting Terminal design K screw terminals M12 Manual release H standard Version N general application (excluding type 449) FN vehicle application (excluding type 446) Auxiliary contacts (optional) Si 2 electrically separate auxiliary contacts Remote trip (optional for types 447 and 449) FA12 DC 12 V coil voltage FA24 DC 24 V coil voltage Current ratings 30...400 A type 446 100...400 A type 447 125...500 A type 449 447 - K - H - FN - 447-... Approvals VG 95345, part 15 Voltage ratings Current ratings DC 28 V 125...500 A DC 28 V 125...400 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 225 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers 446/447/449 Dimensions Internal wiring diagrams line 1 4 hex nut M8 14 mm usable thread depth 60 I> Si 7 6 recommended link for FA coil protection FA 2 2 6 23 15 I> 8 ø20 ON OFF ø26 FA terminal 3 N/C 4/5 DC lock washer DIN 137-B12X12CrNi 177 4 104 106 35 10000 2 23.5 Typical time/current characteristics of type 446-... hex nut ISO 4032-M12-Cu2-E1P N/O 6/7 70 5 30 40 line 1 1000 hex screw ISO 4017-M12x30-Cu2-E1P 100 170 140 current rating in A EIN ON 43.5 8.5 Trip time in seconds AUS OFF 100 AUS OFF 12 cylinder head screw ISO 1580-M4x6 with lock washer DIN 137-B4 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 10 1 0.1 0.01 4 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current Circuit breakers with remote disconnection facility will trip 10 % faster. Typical time/current characteristics 447-... 449-... 125...400 A DC 449-... 500 A 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 1 10 1 10 1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.001 0.001 1 2 +75 °C +23 °C -55 °C 226 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 Trip time in seconds 10000 10 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current ☎ 50 % ON duty DC DC 0.001 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80100 … times rated current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 452-... Description Single pole high performance thermal-magnetic circuit breaker, with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off actuation (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). An indicator band on the push button shows clearly the tripped/off position. Threadneck panel mounted in tracked vehicle and aircraft/general purpose versions, with optional fast acting magnetic characteristics. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicle for land, sea and air; defence equipment; battery powered machines. 452-K... Accessories X 200 801 08 X 200 801 03 X 200 802 01 X 200 802 02 X 200 803 01 452-AS... Technical data Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. As above but matt black finish. Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. Ordering information Type No. 452 standard delay curve 452-2 fast trip curve Terminal design K14 screw terminals M6 K34 screw terminals M6, reinforced AS13 screw terminals 8-32 UNC-3B with hex screw 8-32 UNJC3A (NAS 1801-08-6) and washer (MS 35 338-137) AS14 screw terminals 1/4-28UNF-2B with hex screw 1/4 28UNF2A (MS 90726-2), spring washer (MS 35 338-44) and washer (NAS 1149 F0432P) AS03 screw terminal 8-32UNC-3B, without screws AS04 screw terminal 1/4-28 UNF-2B, without screws Version FN2 vehicle application LN2 aircraft/general application LN3 aircraft application, front panel mounting with insulating barrier Current ratings 50...100 A 452 - K14 - LN2 - 80 A Voltage rating AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 50...100 A Typical life 2,500 operations at IN Ambient temperature -55...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 1500 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 115 V: 1500 A DC 28 V: 6000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (55-2000 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/IEC 68-2-6, test Fc Shock 50 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to VG 95210, sheet 2/IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/IEC 68-2-3, test C Explosion to VG 95210, sheet 10/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 109 Mass approx. 122 g ordering example Standard current ratings and typical volt drop values Approvals Current Volt drop Current Volt drop Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings rating (A) 50 (mV) 100 rating (A) 80 (mV) 135 VG 95345, part 17 DC 28 V 60...100 A QPL, Canada DC 28 V 60...100 A 60 120 90 145 QPL, Sweden DC 28 V 60...100 A (452-K34-FN) 70 125 100 150 LRoS, BV DC 28 V 50...100 A 75 130 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 227 4 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 452-... Dimensions 452-K...-... Dimensions 452-AS...-LN3 452-K34-FN2 452-AS13-LN3 ø10.6 black min. 3 current rating in A white max. 55.5 max. 57 min. ø3.2 452-K14-LN2 min. 3 6.35 ax .7 51.5 39 45° current rating in A ☎ 9.5±0.2 ø12.5 +0.2 max. 57 max. 19 80 SW14 max. 55.5 min. 3 6.35 45° terminal screw 39 MS 90726-2 lock washer MS 35338-44 washer NAS1149 F 0432 P ø8.4 black white black m ax .7 51.5 depth of thread min. 6.4 mounting holes min. ø3.2 ø10.6 ø12.2 6 12.2 ax m 16 45° current rating in A 9.5 max. 63.5 .3 .5 OFF 51.5 max. 61.5 44 45° 18.5 terminal screw ISO1580-M6x8 39 with lock washer DIN 137 B6 Tightening torque max. 2.0 Nm 46 max. 55.5 .138-32UNC-2A 50 max. 19 lock washer ON min. 3 black white 4 max. 58.5 1.5 45° ø10.6 12.2 OFF 6 ON 1.5 6.35 terminal screw NAS 1801-08-6 lock washer MS 35338-137 452-AS14-LN3 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 228 black white black m mounting holes 9.5±0.2 80 max. 19 current raitng in A 9.5 depth of thread min. 6.4 ø12.5 +0.2 16 SW14 location pin 6 12.2 OFF 45° max. 63.5 terminal screw 18.25 ISO1580-M6x8 36.5 with lock washer DIN 137 B6 tightening torque max. 2.7 Nm location pin ø8.4 m ax .3 .5 45° ø10.6 ø12.2 ON 52 max. 61.5 44 max. 58.5 46 max. 55.5 .138-32UNC-2A lock washer 50 max. 19 12.2 OFF 6 ON 1.5 6.35 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 1.5 45° Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 452-... Internal connection diagram Accessories (approved to VG 95345, part 23) Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut, black cover line 1 I> 2 M12x1 Typical time/current characteristics Splash cover black/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 54) X 200 802 01 nickel plated nut X 200 802 02 matt black finish nut 452-... (standard delay) +75 °C +167 °F +23 °C +73.4 °F -55 °C -67 °F 10000 Trip time in seconds 1000 100 Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 10 magnetic trip 1 temp. magn. holding (°C) current (A) magn. trip current (A) DC 0.1 magnetic trip 0.01 -55 +23 +75 ≤1280 ≤1250 ≤1140 -55 +23 +75 ≤1070 ≤1010 ≤ 950 ≥2160 ≥2090 ≥2020 AC 0.001 1 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current ≥1800 ≥1740 ≥1680 4 452-2-... (fast trip) 10000 +75 °C +167 °F +23 °C +73.4 °F -55 °C -67 °F Trip time in seconds 1000 100 10 magnetic trip 1 magnetic trip temp. magn. holding (°C) current (A) magn. trip current (A) DC 0.1 0.01 -55 +23 +75 ≤415 ≤390 ≤365 -55 +23 +75 ≤345 ≤325 ≤305 ≥640 ≥615 ≥590 AC 0.001 1 Issue C 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current ☎ ≥530 ≥510 ≥490 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 229 4 230 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 482-... Description Single pole compact high performance thermal circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). An indicator band on the push button shows clearly the tripped/off position. Threadneck panel mounted in tracked vehicle and aircraft/ general purpose versions, with optional auxiliary contacts. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles for land, sea and air; defence equipment; battery powered machines. Accessories X 200 801 08 X 200 801 03 X 200 802 01 X 200 802 02 X 200 803 01 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. Ordering information Type No. 482 single pole thermal circuit breaker Mounting G threadneck panel mounting Threadneck design 1 M12x1 nickel plated 2 M12x1 black 3 15/32-UNS-2A black Hardware - washer for threadneck 0 without hardware 1 corrugated washer 12/15 2 serrated lock washer 12/15, fitted 3 serrated lock washer 12/15, bulk shipped Hardware - hex nut for threadneck 0 without hardware 1 hex nut M12x1 nickel plated 2 hex nut M12x1 black 3 hex nut 15/32-UNS-2B black, fitted 4 hex nut 15/32-UNS-2B black, bulk shipped Terminal design (main terminals) K1 screw terminals with metric thread M4 J1 screw terminals with inch thread 8-32-UNC-2B J2 screw terminals with inch thread 8-32-UNC-3B Characteristic curve M1 thermal 1.15-1.4 IN Terminal screws A flat head screw M4x6, ISO 1580 B Phillips screw 8-32UNC-2Ax6 E hex screw 1640-32UNJC-3Ax11,1 bulk shipped (NAS 1801-08-7) Terminal washers 0 without lock washer 1 lock washer DIN 137-B4 2 lock washer 4.3, fitted 3 lock washer 4.3, bulk shipped (MS 35 338-137) Auxiliary contact S0 without auxiliary contacts S1 with auxiliary contact NC S5 with polarized aux. contact NC Barrier blank: without barrier T with barrier, 31 mm wide Current ratings 0.1...50 A 482-G1/G2... without aux. contacts with aux. contacts Technical data Voltage rating AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 0.1...50 A Auxiliary circuit 0.5 A, DC 28 V Typical life 10,000 operations mechanical 5,000 operations at IN Ambient temperature -55...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.1...2.5 A 15 x IN 3...3.5 A 250 A DC / 150 A AC 4...7 A 500 A 7.5...50 A 6000 A DC / 1000 A AC 35...50 A 3000 A DC / 1000 A AC 4 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (55-2000 Hz) ±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/IEC 68-2-6, test Fc Shock 50 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to VG 95210, sheet 2/IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/IEC 68-2-3, test C Explosion to VG 95210, sheet 10/MIL-STD-202, meth. 109 Mass approx. 43 g without aux. contact approx. 46 g with aux. contact Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VG 95345, part 21 DC 28 V 0.1...50 A for 482-MS/-N-MS QPL, Canada DC 28 V 0.5...35 A LRoS DC 28 V 0.1...50 A 482 - G 1 1 1 - K1 M1 - A 1 S1 T - 10 A ordering example Previous ordering codes: 482-N-MS = 482-G111-K1M1-A1S0-...A 482-MS = 482-G212-K1M1-A1S0-...A Issue C ☎ vehicle circuit breaker aircraft circuit breaker Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 231 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 482-... Dimensions 482-G3... 482-G111-K1M1-A1S0 482-G...-J2M2-... 5 min. 3 ø8.4 black white max. 19 ø10.6 15/32-32UNS-2A tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 6.35 min. 3 6.35 44.1 1.5 -0.5 ø8.4 1.5 43.4 max. 48 16.2 max. 50 22 ° current rating in A mounting holes 9.5 ±0.2 2.7 max. 10.5 5 aux. contact terminals to NAS 1748, for contact plug to NAS 1749 max. 6.5 screw ISO1580-M4x6 lock washer DIN 137 B4 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm ø12.5 +0.2 .5 .2 ax m location pin 45° 9.5 0.8 thickness max. 3 mm 45° 31 black white lock washer Standard current ratings and typical volt drop values 14.5 17.9 18 terminal screw NAS 1801-08-7 lock washer MS 35338-137 ø10.6 ON 7 12.2 0.8 19.3 6 OFF 482-G111-K1M1-A1S1 482-G111-K1M1-A1S5 4 min. 3 6 .6 .6 m 12.7 min. ø3.2 31 black white hex nut MS 25082-B21 in 9.5 ±0.2 thickness max. 3 mm 0.8 ø8.4 lock washer MS 35333-136 52 ø12.5+0.2 2.7 5 9.5 ON screw ISO1580-M4x6 lock washer DIN 137 B4 45° 17.9 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm mounting holes current rating in A location pin 18 OFF .5 .2 ax m 12.2 43.4 9.5 max. 31 max. 48 1.5 lock washer max. 50 current rating in A ø10.6 6.35 6 12.2 location pin tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 ON OFF Dimensions 482-G1/-G2... min. ø3.2 Current rating (A) Volt drop (mV) Current rating (A) Volt drop (mV) 0.1 16,000 0.2 8,000 0.5 3,000 10 < 200 0.8 2,000 15 < 200 1 1,500 20 < 200 1.2 1,200 25 < 200 1.5 1,000 30 < 200 1.8 850 35 < 200 2 800 40 < 200 2.5 700 45 < 200 3 600 50 < 200 4 430 5 350 7.5 230 max. 31 482-G212 mounting holes 9.5 0.8 31 232 ☎ ø12.5 +0.2 5 18 2.7 min. ø3.2 9.5 ±0.2 current rating in A location pin thickness max. 3 mm Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 482-... Internal connection diagrams Accessories (approved to VG 95345, part 23) with auxiliary contact with polarized auxiliary contact line 1 line 1 11 line 1 3 2 2 12 2 5 Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut, black cover M12x1 Splash cover black/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 54) X 200 802 01 nickel plated nut X 200 802 02 matt black finish nut Typical time/current characteristics Trip time in seconds 0.1...2.5 A 10000 +75 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 1 2 4 4 6 8 10 20 40 6080100 … times rated current Trip time in seconds 3...50 A 10000 +75 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 1 Issue C 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 233 4 234 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 483-... Description Single pole, miniaturised, aircraft style thermal circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). An indicator band on the push button shows clearly the tripped/off position. Threadneck panel mounted, available in metric and US (MS 3320) configurations. Advanced two-chamber design contributes to fail-safe operation. Temperature compensated from -55° to +125°C, with optional auxiliary contacts, and fully approved for use on a wide range of aircraft and equipment. Full military specification ensures suitability for the most demanding applications. For three pole version see type 583. 483-... without auxiliary contact Typical applications Technical data Aircraft systems and equipment (fixed wing and helicopters); other extra low voltage wiring applications; defence equipment; communications systems. Accessories X 200 801 08 X 200 801 03 X 200 801 09 X 200 802 01 X 200 802 02 X 200 803 01 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. As above, but hex nut 7/16-32, black finish Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. Standard current ratings and typical volt drop values Current rating (A) Volt drop (mV) 1 750 Current rating (A) 7.5 Volt drop (mV) 520 190 2.5 400 15 190 3 360 20 200 4 350 25 170 5 260 Approvals LN 29886 Voltage rating AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 1...25 A Auxiliary circuit 0.5 A, DC 28 V Typical life 20,000 operations mechanical or 10,000 operations at IN Ambient temperature -55...+125 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 115 V (400 Hz): ≤4A 1000 A 5A 2000 A 7.5...25 A 2500 A DC 28 V: 1...25 A 6000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Vibration (sinusoidal) 230 10 2 with auxiliary contact Vibration (random) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 15 g (70-2000 Hz) ±0.76 mm (5-70 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/ IEC 68-2-6, test Fc/ISO 7137 16.4 g rms, 0.2 g2/Hz ±1.5 dB to VG 95210, sheet 29/ISO 7137 Acceleration 17 g, to ISO 2669 Shock 75 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/ IEC 68-2-27, test Ea/ISO 7137 Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist, severity A 48 hours at 20 % salt mist, severity B to VG 95210, sheet 2/ IEC 68-2-11, test Ka/ISO 7137 Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/ IEC 68-2-3, test C/ISO 7137 Explosion to VG 95210, sheet 10/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 109 VG 95345, part 06 prEN 2995 Altitude ≤ 25,000 m above sea level MS 3320, Mass max. 29 g with auxiliary contact max. 25 g without auxiliary contact with aluminium threadneck: max. 26 g with auxiliary contact QPL USA, Canada, UK, Sweden Issue C ☎ 4 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 235 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 483-... Ordering information 4 Ordering information for approved devices Type No. 483 single pole, with temperature compensation Mounting G threadneck panel mounting, standard L threadneck panel mounting, extended push button V threadneck panel mounting, high vibration performance W threadneck panel mounting, extended push button and high vibration performances Threadneck design 1 M12x1x6.4x8.8 dia. with mounting plate (aux.contact version) 2 15/32-32UNSx6.4x7.8 dia. (without aux. contact) 3 MJ12x6.4x8.8 dia. (without aux. contact) 4 M12x1x6.4x8.8 dia. (without aux. contact) 5 7/16-32UNSx6.4x7.8 dia. (without aux. contact) 6 M12x1x9.4x8.8 dia. (without aux. contact) 7 7/16-32 UNSx6.4x7.8 dia. with mounting plate (aux.contact version) 8 as 483-G1...but with aluminium threadneck Hardware for threadneck (washers) 0 without hardware 1 wave washer 12/15 - mounted 2 mounted washer 12.1/17.2 - mounted 3 mounted washer 11.3/14.9 - mounted 4 mounted washer 12/15 - mounted 5 tooth washer 12.1/17.2, bulk shipped Hardware for threadneck (nuts) 0 without hardware 1 hex nut M12x1 2 hex nut 15/32-32UNS 3 hex nut 7/16-32UNS 5 hex nut MJ12x1 (only with threadneck design 3) 6 hex nut M12x1, brass, bulk shipped, threadneck design 1,4,6 Terminal design (main terminals) K screws terminals with metric thread 1 K14 (M4, MJ4) J screw terminals with inch thread 1 J14 (8-32UNC-2B) 2 J17 (8-32UNC-2B) 3 J25 (6-32UNC-2B) Characteristic curve M1 thermal, 1.15-1.38 IN for military aircraft C1 thermal, 1.15-1.38 IN for civil aircraft Terminal screws A Phillips screw M4x6 B Phillips screw 8-32UNC-2Ax6 C Phillips screw 6-32UNC-2Ax6 D slotted flat head screw M4x6 E hex screw with Phillips head 8-32UNC-3A-9.5 K hex screw with Phillips head 8-32UNC-3Ax7.6 (ASN E0736) L Phillips screw MJ4x6 M as”K“ but bulk shipped Z without accessories Terminal washers 0 without lock washer 1 lock washer B4 2 lock washer 4.3 3 lock washer B4 and washer 4.4/9.5 4 lock washer 3.7 5 lock washer 4.3/9 (ASN A2553) Auxiliary contact S0 without auxiliary contact S1 with auxiliary contact (connector to NAS1749 and LN 65093, size 20) S5 with polarized auxiliary contact Barrier Z without barrier (standard) Colour of the push button 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN (483-96-TC-K14) Metric threadneck M12x1 and terminal design -K14 (M4x6), listed by the German Materialamt der Bundeswehr to VG 95345, part 6. 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN Metric threadneck M12x1 and terminal design -K14 (M4x6) and auxiliary contact -Si, listed by the German Materialamt der Bundeswehr to VG 95345, part 6. 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z (MS 3320) Threadneck size 7/16-32UNSx6.4 and terminal design -J14 (inch thread 8-32), approved to MS 3320. 483-L533-J1M1-B2S0Z (MS 3320-L) Threadneck size 7/16-32UNSx6.4 and terminal design -J14 (inch thread 8-32), approved to MS 3320-L. 483-V533-J1M1-B2S0Z (MS 3320-V) Threadneck size 7/16-32UNSx6.4 and terminal design -J14 (inch thread 8-32), approved to MS 3320-V. 483-W533-J1M1-B2S0Z (MS 3320-VL) Threadneck size 7/16-32UNSx6.4 and terminal design -J14 (inch thread 8-32), approved to MS 3320-VL. 483-G533-J3M1-C4S0Z (483-TC-G11-J25)) Threadneck size 7/16-32UNSx6.4 and terminal design -J25 (inch thread 6-32), listed by the German Materialamt der Bundeswehr to VG 95345, part 6. blank: black (standard) /white (e.g. 7.5) A green/white (e.g. 7.5) G green/white, marking to EN (e.g.7 1/2) N black/white, marking to EN (e.g.7 1/2) Current ratings 1...25 A 483 - G 4 1 1 - K1 M1 - A 1 S0 Z 236 ☎ - 5A ordering example Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 483-... ø10 ø8.4 6.35 3.5 white 5 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 ø8.4 black white 3.5 black lock washer .6 31 31 .4 ° 22 1 .4 .6 m in 1.5 lock washer 16.2 1.5 36.5 6.5 ON tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 12.5 OFF 5 2.5 Dimensions 483-G111-K1M1-A1S1ZN 6.35 6.5 ON ø10 12.5 OFF 2.5 Dimensions 483-G411-K1M1-A1S0ZN (483-96-TC-K14) m in 2 8.5 .5 45° 45° 12.8 8.5 terminal screw ISO 7045-M4x6 with lock washer DIN 137 B4 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm terminal screw ISO 7045-M4x6 with lock washer DIN 137 B4 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm current rating in A 19.5 +0.15 9.5 6.5 location pin 19.5 location pin aux. contact terminals NAS 1748 for connector to NAS 1749 Mounting holes 4 5 2.5 Dimensions 483-G533-J1M1-B2S0Z (MS 3320) ø3.2 14 ø12.5 0.8 SW 10.5 9.5±0.2 ø12.5 +0.2 2 5 ø3.2 mounting holes current rating in A +0.15 +0.2 mounting holes 14 5 14.2 SW 14.2 9.5 9.5±0.2 .5 .1 ax .1 ax m m 45° 45° 12.8 ø3.2 +0.15 7/16-32-UN-2A THD ø8.4 9.5 ±0.2 max. 19 OFF white 6.35 ø12.5 +0.2 31 m in 36.5 .4 .6 1.5 lock washer min. 30 black 3.5 ø10 min. 11.9 ON Mounting holes without auxiliary contact .5 45° 12.8 45° 8.5 Mounting holes with auxiliary contact (Si) terminal screw MS 51957-41 (8-32 UNC-2A) with lock washer MS 35338-137 ø3.2 +0.15 current rating in A 9.5 mounting holes max. 19.8 9.5±0.2 +0.15 +0.2 ø12.5 min. 40 0.8 ø11.5 +0.2 2 5 ø3.2 max. 15 9.5±0.2 .1 ax m min. 20 min. 25 when fitted with splash cover location pin min. 20 min. 25 when fitted with splash cover Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 237 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 483-... Other main terminal designs Internal connection diagrams -J2 line 2 b (31) Terminal distances to: MS 14 105 (a, b) MS 14 153 (a, b) MS 22 073 (a) MS 22 074 (a) MS 25 244 (a) MS 25 373 (a, b) 1 45° a (18) 45° 10.5 with auxiliary contact -J3 with polarized auxiliary contact line 1 11 line 1 3 2 12 2 5 b (35.5) Terminal distances to: MS 26 574 (a, b) 6.5 ON -G6 8.5 45° black Typical time/current characteristics 12.5 OFF a (15) white +125 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C ON OFF -L2/5/7 -W2/5/7 Trip time in seconds 9.4 10000 6.35 white max. 28.6 min. 21.4 black 4 100 10 1 0.1 max. 19.8 location pin 0.8 2 9.5 max. 15 5 0.01 0.001 1 2 current rating in A 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current Accessories (approved to VG 95345, part 23) Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut M 12x1, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut M 12x1, black cover X 200 801 09 matt black finish nut 7/16-32 black cover Splash cover black/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 54) X 200 802 01 nickel plated nut X 200 802 02 matt black finish nut Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 M12x1 238 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 4120-... Description Single pole, miniaturised thermal circuit breaker with snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). Threadneck panel mounted, temperature-compensated, with optional auxiliary contacts. Fully approved for commercial aircraft and similar requirements. Typical applications Extra low voltage wiring systems on all types of vehicles for land, sea and air. Accessories X 200 801 08 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. X 200 801 03 As above but blackened finish. X 200 803 01 Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. 4120-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 4120 single pole, with temperature compensation Mounting G threadneck panel mounting Threadneck design 1 M12x1x6.3 (aluminium) Number of poles 1 1 pole, thermally protected Hardware for threadneck 0 without hardware 1 hex nut M12x1, corrugated washer 12/15, fitted 2 hex nut M12x1 (aluminium), serrated lock washer 12.1/17.2, fitted 3 hex nut M12x1 (aluminium), serrated lock washer 12.1/17.2, bulk shipped Terminal design (main terminals) K1 screw terminals with metric thread K14 (M4) J1 screw terminals with inch thread J14 (8-32UNC-2B) J2 screw terminals with inch thread J17 (8-32UNC-2B) Characteristic curve M1 thermal, 1.15 - 1.38 IN Terminal screws A Phillips screw M4x6, fitted B Phillips screw 8-32UNC-2Ax6, fitted D slotted flat head screw M5x6, fitted K hex screw with Phillips head 8-32UNC3Ax7.6 (ASN E0736), fitted M hex screw with Phillips head 8-32UNC3Ax7.6 (ASN E0736), bulk shipped Z without terminal hardware Terminal washers 0 without lock washer 1 lock washer A4, fitted 2 lock washer 4.3, fitted 5 lock washer 4.3/9 (ASN A2553), fitted 6 lock washer 4.3/9 (ASN A2553), bulk shipped Auxiliary contact S0 without auxiliary contact S1 with auxiliary contact (connector EN3155-016M2018 (NC) S5 with polarized auxiliary contact (NC) Barrier Z without barrier Colour of the push button G green to EN N black to EN S black, with white marking X black, without marking Current ratings 1...25 A Voltage rating AC 115 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 1...25 A Auxiliary circuit 0.5 A, DC 28 V Typical life 20,000 operations mechanical, or 5,000 operations mechanical and 2,500 operations at IN Ambient temperature -55°C ...+125°C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse withstand voltage 1.5 kV Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn AC 115 V (400 Hz): 1... 3 A 1,000 A 5...25 A 2,000 A DC 28 V: 1...25 A 6,000 A Pollution degree 3 4 Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 10 g (57-2000 Hz), ±0.76 mm (5-57 Hz) to ISO 7137, EN 2350 para. 5.3.1 Acceleration 17 g, to ISO 2669, EN 2350 para. 5.3.3 Shock 50 g (11 ms), to ISO 7137, EN 2350 para. 5.3.2 Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to ISO 7137, EN 2350 para. 5.4.2 Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH, to ISO 7137, EN 2350 para. 5.4.3 Explosion to VG 95210, sheet 10 Altitude ≤ 22,000 m above sea level Mass approx. 20.6 g with terminal screws, without -Si approx. 24.6 g with terminal screws, with -Si Standard current ratings and typical volt drop values Current rating (A) Volt drop (mV) 1 1100 2 550 10 230 EN 2495 2.5 460 15 200 EN 3773 3 440 20 190 prEN 2995 5 260 25 190 4120 - G 1 1 1 - K1 M1 - A 1 S0 Approvals (configurations) Issue C ☎ Z N - 10 A ordering example Current rating (A) 7.5 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Volt drop (mV) 250 239 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 4120-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram 4120-G111-K1M1-A1S0ZN (EN2495-...M) ø10 tightening torque max. 5 Nm M12x1 line 1 2.5 ø8.4 18.5 OFF white 3.5 lock washer 1.5 6.35 13 ON black .6 31 type No. .4 in 2 45° 9.5 14 0.8 line 1 3 2 4 2 5 5 14.2 3 location pin current rating in A 19.5 4120-G11.-J2M1-K5S0ZN (EN2495-...U, EN3773-004 D...) ø10 tightening torque max. 5 Nm M12x1 2.5 white 3.5 lock washer serrated lock washer 1.5 31 .6 1 .3 18 SW 14 10.5 terminals: 1 - input 2 - output terminal screw H8-32UNC-3Ax7.6 to FED-STD-H28/2A lock washer tightening torque max. 1.7 Nm location pin current rating in A 9.5 0.8 5 14.2 2 4 45° 19.5 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S1ZG - 4120-G112-J2M1-K5S5ZG ø10 2.5 tightening torque max. 5 Nm M12x1 1000 +23 °C -55 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 1 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current white serrated lock washer 3.5 13 ON 18.5 OFF green 1.5 16.2 6.35 +125 °C ø8.4 31 4 type No. 3 min. 8 .4 in m 1 . ax .6 m 2 10000 type No. Trip time in seconds 6.35 13 ON 18.5 OFF black ax 45° Typical time/current characteristics ø8.4 .4 in 2 m m line 1 5 8.5 terminals: 1 - input 2 - output terminal screw ISO 7045-M4x6 lock washer DIN 137-B4 tightening torque max. 1.7 Nm 45° 12.8 2 SW with polarized auxiliary contact 1 .2 ax m m 2 with auxiliary contact Accessories (approved to VG 95 345, part 23) Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut, black cover 3 14.2 min. 30 19.5 ø3 M12x1 location pin current rating in A mounting holes (Si) ±0.1 9.5±0.2 min. 20 min. 25 * 0.8 5 max. 6.5 mounting holes 9.5 10.5 terminals: 25 1 - input 2 - output terminal screw H8-32UNC-3Ax7,6 to FED-STD-H28/2A lock washer tightening torque max. 1.6 Nm min. 20 min. 25 * ø12.5 +0.2 ø3.5+0.1 Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 9.6±0.1 14 2 SW 45° 18 min. 40 45° aux. contact (connector to EN 3155-016 M2018) +0.2 ø12.5 * min. 25 when fitted with splash cover 240 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Edition A Issue C High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 4201-... Description Single pole high performance version of type 201 (catalogue section 2) thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and two button operation (M-type TM CBE to EN 60934). Standard EN rail mounting, recessed terminals and enhanced short circuit performance. Complies with CBE standard EN 60934 (IEC 934). Typical applications Control systems, industrial equipment. 4201-... Technical data Accessories X 200 409 01 Mounting adapters for asymmetric rail (G-profile). Ordering information Type No. 4201 single pole, rail mounted (EN 50022x35x7.5) Special version (optional) 2705 fitted with adapter X 200 409 01 for G profile to EN 50035-G32 Current ratings 0.05...16 A 4201 - - 5A ordering example Voltage rating AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range 0.05...16 A Typical life 4,000 operations at 2 x IN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area Test voltage AC 3000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 0.05...5 A 5.5...7.5 A 8...16 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidty 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 60 g The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 0.05 447 3 0.19 0.1 131 4 0.090 0.2 39.6 5 0.061 0.3 19.3 6 0.041 0.4 10.4 7 0.034 0.5 7.1 8 ≤ 0.02 0.6 4.3 10 ≤ 0.02 0.8 2.5 12 ≤ 0.02 1 1.67 14 ≤ 0.02 1.5 0.60 15 ≤ 0.02 2 0.38 16 ≤ 0.02 2.5 0.24 Issue C ☎ 400 A 750 A 1000 A (in accordance with VDE 0636) 4 Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Demko AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.05...16 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 241 High Performance Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker 4201-... Dimensions Internal connection diagram line 1 ON conductor cross section max. 0.5 - 10 mm2 rigid conductor 0.5 - 6 mm2 flexible conductor tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm I> 43 53 11 11.5 ø8.5 5 OFF 45 2 12-14 80 6.5 4.8 7.5 Typical time/current characteristics 12.5 0.05...7 A symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 Phillips screw, size 2 to EN ISO 4757 slot for fitting labels from Wieland Type 9003 Weidmüller Type BS.1/2 SchT PES Phoenix dekafix Type DST6 T./WT 4K-DST5 Installation drawing +60 °C +23 °C -30 °C 1000 Trip time in seconds 2 current rating in A AC 10000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 operating area (double insulation) 4 0.001 1 2 8...16 A wire entry wire entry 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current AC +60 °C 10000 +23 °C -30 °C 1000 mounting area Trip time in seconds 100 Accessories Adapter X 200 409 01 for EN rail 50035-G32 specified as a separate item 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 20 1 4 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100 … times rated current N.B. Magnetic tripping currents are increased by 20% on DC supplies. Adapter X 200 409 01 socket can be snapped on from both sides 242 2 ☎ G profile EN 50035-G32 Time/current characteristics are calibrated at 23°C (see page 8). For operation at other temperatures please apply the factors below to determine the circuit breaker rating required. Ambient temperature °C -20 -10 0 +23 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.76 0.84 0.92 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 583-... Description Three pole, miniaturised, aircraft style thermal circuit breaker with tease-free, trip-free, snap action mechanism and push/pull on/off manual actuation (M-type TO CBE to EN 60934). An indicator band on the push button shows clearly the tripped/off position. Threadneck panel mounted, available in metric and US (MS 14154) configurations. Advanced two-chamber design minimises contact contamination to provide fail-safe operation. Temperature compensated with optional auxiliary contacts, and fully approved for use on a wide range of aircraft and equipment. For single pole version see type 483. 583-... with auxiliary contact Typical applications Technical data Aircraft systems and equipment (fixed wing and helicopters); other extra low voltage wiring applications; defence equipment; communications systems. Accessories X 200 801 08 X 200 801 03 X 200 801 09 X 200 802 01 X 200 802 02 X 200 803 01 Water splash cover/hex nut assembly. The concertina design is extended when the button trips to the OFF position. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. As above, but hex nut 7/16-32, black finish Splash seal/hex nut assembly, allowing full visibility of the push button actuator. Plated finish. As above but blackened finish. Screw-tightened clamp-on actuator extension to aid manual operation. Voltage rating Volt drop (mV) Current rating (A) 7.5 Volt drop (mV) 230 1 750 2 520 10 190 2.5 400 15 190 3 360 20 200 4 350 25 170 5 260 1...25 A Auxiliary circuit 0.5 A, DC 28 V Typical life 20,000 operations mechanical 10,000 operations at IN Ambient temperature -55...+125 °C (≤ 15 A) -55...+ 90 °C (> 15 A) Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 1.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole/pole main to aux. circuit Test voltage AC 1500 V AC 1500 V AC 1500 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity Icn 3 AC 200 V (400 Hz): ≤4A 1,000 A 5A 2,000 A 7.5...25 A 2,500 A DC 28 V: 1...25 A 6,000 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration (sinusoidal) 10 g (57-2000 Hz) ±0.76 mm (5-57 Hz) to VG 95210, sheet 19/ IEC 68-2-6, test Fc/ISO 7137 Vibration (random) 16.4 g rms, 0.2 g2Hz ± 1.5 dB to VG 95210, sheet 29/ IEC 68-2-6, test Fc/ISO 7137 Acceleration 17 g, to ISO 2669 Shock 50 g (11 ms) to VG 95210, sheet 28/ IEC 68-2-27, test Ea/ISO 7137 Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist 48 hours at 20 % salt mist to VG 95210, sheet 2/ IEC 68-2-11, test Ka/ISO 7137 Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to VG 95210, sheet 7/ IEC 68-2-3, test C/ISO 7137 Explosion to VG 95210, sheet 10/ MIL-STD-202, meth. 109 Approvals Approvals: LN 29887 VG 95345, part 11 prEN 2996 MS 14154 QPL USA, Canada, UK, Sweden Issue C ☎ 3 AC 200 V (400 Hz); DC 28 V Current rating range Standard current ratings and typical volt drop values Current rating (A) without auxiliary contact Altitude ≤ 25,000 m above sea level Mass max. 67 g with auxiliary contact max. 63 g without auxiliary contact Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 4 243 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 583-... Ordering information 4 Type No. 583 three pole, with temperature compensation Mounting G threadneck panel mounting Threadneck design 1 M12x1x6.4x8.8 dia. with mounting plate (aux. contact version) 2 15/32-32UNSx6.4x7.8 dia. (only without aux. contact) 3 MJ12x1x6.4x8.8 dia. (only without aux. contact) 4 M12x1x6.4x8.8 dia. (only without aux. contact) 5 7/16-32UNSx6.4x7.8 (only without aux. contact) 6 M12x1x9.4x8.8 dia. (without aux. contact) 7 7/16-32 UNSx6.4x7.8 dia. with mounting plate (aux.contact version) Hardware for threadneck (washers) 0 without hardware 1 corrugated washer 12/15, fitted 2 serrated lock washer 12.1/17.2, fitted 3 serrated lock washer 11.3/14.9, fitted 4 serrated lock washer 12/15, fitted Hardware for threadneck (nuts) 0 without hardware 1 hex nut M12x1 2 hex nut 15/32-32UNS 3 hex nut 7/16-32UNS 5 hex nut MJ12x1 (only with threadneck design 3) Terminal design (main terminals) K screw terminals with metric thread 1 K14 (M4, MJ4) J screw terminals with inch thread 1 J14 (8-32UNC-2B) 2 J17 (8-32UNC-2B) 3 J25 (6-32UNC-2B) Characteristic curve M1 thermal, 1.15-1.38 IN for military aircraft C1 thermal, 1.15-1.38 IN for civil aircraft Terminal screws A Phillips screw M4x6 B Phillips screw 8-32UNC-2Ax6 C Phillips screw 6-32UNC-2Ax6 D slotted flat head screw M5x6 E hex screw with Phillips head 8-32UNC-3Ax9.5 K hex screw with Phillips head 8-32UNC-3Ax7.6 (ASN E0736) L Phillips screw MJ4x6 Z without accessories Terminal washers 0 without lock washer 1 lock washer B4 2 lock washer 4.3 3 lock washer B4 and washer 4.4/9.5 4 lock washer 3.7 5 lock washer 4.3/9 (ASN A2553) Auxiliary contact S0 without auxiliary contact S1 with auxiliary contact (connector to NAS1749 and LN 65093, size 20) S5 with polarized auxiliary contact Barrier T barrier 25.5 mm wide (S0 only) U barrier 19.5 mm wide, 37.7 mm long V barrier 25.5 mm wide, colour marking between the terminals (-S0 only) X barrier 19.5 mm wide, 34.1 mm long Colour of the push button blank: black (standard) /white (e.g. 7.5) A green/white (e.g. 7.5) G green/white to EN (e.g. 7 1/2) N black/white to EN (e.g. 7 1/2) Current ratings 1...25 A Ordering information for approved devices 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN (583-96-TC-K14) Metric threadneck M12x1 and terminal design -K14 (M4x6), listed by the German Materialamt der Bundeswehr to VG 95345, part 11. 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN Metric threadneck M12x1 and terminal design -K14 (M4x6) with auxiliary contact -Si, listed by the German Materialamt der Bundeswehr to VG 95345, part 11. 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X (MS 14154) Threadneck size 7/16-32UNSx6.4 and terminal design -J14 (inch thread 8-32), approved to MS 14154. 583 - G 4 1 1 - K1 M1 - A 1 S0 T . - 5 A ordering example 244 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 583-... ø8.4 16.2 B1 38 C1 A1 22° 31 .6 .4 in m A2 m 8.5 15 .1 max. 6.5 min. 30 ø12.5 15 terminals: A1, B1, C1 - input A2, B2, C2 - output mounting holes min. 50 min. 30 SW1 5 current rating in A max. 10.5 min. 50 19.5 5 0.8 2.5 5 screw ISO 7045-M4x6 lock washer DIN 137 B4 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm ø3.2+0.15 C2 8.5 45° 15 terminals: A1, B1, C1 - input A2, B2, C2 - output current rating in A 12.8 15 mounting holes max. 19.8 45° .5 B2 +0.15 ø3.2 45 screw ISO 7045-M4x6 lock washer DIN 137 B4 tightening torque max. 1.2 Nm 2 ax 5 14.2 12.8 2.5 SW14 45° 9.5 ±0.2 .5 .1 ax m 45° 25.5 max. 47 black white lock washer 9.5±0.2 6.35 black white lock washer 3.5 3.5 ø8.4 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 ø10 1.5 12.5 OFF tightening torque max. 4 Nm M12x1 6.5 ON 12.5 OFF Dimensions 583-G111-K1M1-A1S1UN 31 38 36.5 1.5 6.35 ø10 6.5 ON Dimensions 583-G411-K1M1-A1S0TN (583-96-TC-K14) +0.2 ø12.5 +0.2 9.5 9.5 auxiliary contact terminals to NAS 1748 for connectors to NAS 1749 location pin Dimensions 583-G533-J1M1-B2S0X (MS 14154) location pin 4 Other main terminal designs max. 19 OFF 7/16-32-UN-2A THD C1 8.5 45° 31 45° 15 45° 10.5 5 screw MS 51957-41 (8-32 UNC-2A) lock washer MS 35338-137 15 terminals: A1, B1, C1 - input A2, B2, C2 - output mounting holes max. 19.8 ø3.2 +0.15 5 min. 30 -G6 +0.2 ø11.5 white 9.4 0.8 black 8.5 12.5 OFF min. 50 9.5 current rating in A 2 18 -J3 2.5 15 max. 46.7 45° A1 35.5 .5 .1 12.8 B1 6.5 ON ax m 45° black white lock washer ±0.2 .6 .4 in m ø8.4 min. 3 max. 31 1.5 max. 35.1 6.35 ø10 min. 11.9 ON -J2 9.5 location pin Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 245 High Performance Thermal Circuit Breaker 583-... Internal connection diagrams line A2 B2 C2 A1 B1 C1 Accessories (approved to VG 95345, part 23) Splash cover/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 66) X 200 801 08 nickel plated nut M12x1, translucent cover X 200 801 03 matt black finish nut M12x1, black cover X 200 801 09 matt black finish nut 7/16-32, black cover M12x1 with auxiliary contact with polarized auxiliary contact line A1 B1 C1 11 line A1 B1 C1 3 A2 B2 C2 12 A2 B2 C2 5 Splash cover black/hex nut assembly with O ring (IP 54) X 200 802 01 nickel plated nut X 200 802 02 matt black finish nut Actuator extension (black) X 200 803 01 Trip time in seconds Typical time/current characteristics 4 10000 +90 °C 1000 +23 °C -55 °C 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 1 246 2 4 6 810 20 40 6080100 … times rated current ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Isolation Switches 911/912/913/914-... Description Single, two, three and four pole isolators to EN 60947 / IEC 947 with toggle actuation. Designed for rail, panel or surface mounting. Options include auxiliary contacts and remote electrical disconnection. For circuit breaker versions see types 410, 520, 530. Typical applications Control systems, industrial equipment. 911-... Technical data Accessories X 211 118 01 X 211 119 01 X 211 705 01 Single pole splash cover with fixing plate. Two pole splash cover with fixing plate. Terminal insulation cover for use with types 410, 520 and 530 - two per pole required. Ordering information Type 911 912 913 914 913-... No. single pole switch double pole switch three pole switch four pole switch Terminal design K main terminal up to 32 A: pressure plate B5-DIN 46288 up to 63 A: pressure plate B6-DIN 46288 up to 125 A: terminal screws DIN 46206, form A, thread M6 up to 240 A: terminal screws DIN 46206, form A, thread M10 (single pole only) Mounting 1 surface mounting 2 rail or panel mounting (rail DIN EN 50022-35x7.5) 3 rail or panel mounting (rail DIN EN 50035-G32) 4 panel mounting only 5 mounting brackets- surface mounting Auxiliary contacts (terminals M3.5) Si one each N/O and N/C Si1 one N/C (11,12) Si2 one N/O (13,14) 2Si two each N/O and N/C – types 912, 913, 914 only 3Si three each N/O and N/C – types 913, 914 only 4Si four each N/O and N/C – type 914 only Remote trip (optional) FA12 remote disconnection, for DC 12 V FA24 remote disconnection, for DC 24 V Current ratings 32, 63, 125 A (240 A single pole only) 914 - K - 1 - Si - - 63 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Voltage rating AC 240 V; 3 AC 415 A; 3 AC 500 V; DC 110 V Current rating range 32 A, 63 A, 125 A (up to 240 A single pole only) Auxiliary contact rating 6 A at AC 240 V or DC 28 V; 1 A at DC 110 V Electrical remote disconnection (FA) operating voltage DC 12 V or DC 24 V operating current approx. 18 A or 12 A max. pulse time 10 ms < tON < 20 ms /tOFF > 10 s switching time < 20 msec Typical life 10,000 operations at IN 20,000 operations mechanical Ambient temperature -40...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 6 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole/pole main to aux. circuit aux. circuit 11-12 to 13-14 AC 1000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) 4 Test voltage AC 3300 V AC 3300 V AC 2200 V Short-circuit protection back up fuse max. 125 A Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-200 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidty 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 220 g single pole ≤ 125 A approx. 440 g single pole > 125 A approx. 440 g double pole approx. 660 g three pole approx. 880 g four pole Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating Internal resistance (A) (Ω) 32 ≤ 0.002 pro Pol 63 ≤ 0.002 pro Pol 125 ≤ 0.002 pro Pol Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 247 Isolation Switches 911/912/913/914-... Dimensions Internal connection diagrams 911 ≤ 125 A 912 913 914 911 911-...-FA line 1 11 13 2 12 14 line 1 11 13 12 14 3 26° 26° 0 I tightening torque max. 4 Nm Si-terminals M3.5 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 1 N/C (Si1) or FA (pole 1 only) 1 N/O 2 912 1 line 3 11 2Si 21 13 23 2 4 12 22 14 24 1 3 5 11 21 3Si 31 13 23 33 2 4 6 12 22 32 14 24 34 1 line 3 5 7 11 21 31 4Si 41 13 23 33 43 2 4 8 12 22 32 42 14 24 34 44 6 41 90.5 71.5 106 FA 92 16 location for top-hat rail DIN EN 50022-35x7.5 location for G-profile DIN EN 50035-G32 (not shown) D 45 35 line E 22 M3.5 - depth 9 tightening torque max. 0.55 Nm 913 66 44 pole 1 pole 2 88 914 pole 4 B 22 +0.5 14.6 35 ø20 66 ø4.6 Mounting method 4.6 Dimensions B C D M5 13 114 M6 15.4 120 M6 15.4 120 911 > 125 A Terminal E 7 pressure plate 9 pressure plate 9 terminal screw Panel mounting suffix: -4 3 M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm 4 Si terminals M3.5 tightening torque max. 0.8 Nm 1 N/C (Si1) or FA (pole 1 only) 1 N/O 6 41 90.5 71.5 106 I Rail mounting (EN 50035-G32) suffix: -3 tightening torque max. 2.0 Nm 2.5 Nm 2.5 Nm 26° 26° 0 Rail mounting (DIN EN 50022-35x7.5) suffix: -2 92 Mounting brackets - surface mounting suffix: -5 16 location for top-hat rail DIN EN 50022-35x7.5 location for G-profile DIN EN 50035-G32 (not shown) 167.5 141 2 Current rating 32 A 63 A 125 A Surface mounting suffix: -1 14 8.7 97 72 92 14.6 3.7 surface mounting M3.5 -depth 9 tightening torque max. 0.55 Nm M5 22 57 ø4.6 248 9 22 25 44 45 35 83.5 4 6 44 +1.5 +1 22 3.7 surface mounting 97 mounting holes ø4 C 19 pole 3 ☎ 10 4.6 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Isolation Switches 911/912/913/914-... Auxiliary contact arrangement with multi pole switches Accessories double pole devices For series 911 ≤ 125 A Water splash cover translucent with fixing plate (IP 54) X 211 118 01 Si 2 Si 44 53 21 three pole devices Si max. 4 38 3 Si 1.2 2 Si 40 24.5 mounting hole ø4 40 +0.3 25+0.3 35 four pole devices Si 3 Si 2 Si 4 Si For series 911 > 125 A, 912 Water splash cover translucent with fixing plate (IP 54) X 211 119 01 62 53 4 Accessories 1.2 21 Terminal insulation cover (1set = 2 pcs per pole) X 211 705 01 max. 4 38 24.5 59 mounting hole 22 94 92 64 19 59 +0.3 ø4 25 +0.3 ø10 44 35 165 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 249 4 250 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Battery Isolation Switches 921/922 Description Single or two pole isolation switches to EN 60947 with toggle actuation. Options include auxiliary contacts, a moulded flame retardant enclosure for added environmental protection (with or without rotary action external operating knob), and remote operation - disconnection only, or disconnection and re-connection. A version for use in hazardous areas (e.g. petroleum and chemical tankers) is available to special order. Typical applications Vehicles of all types (including tankers), boats, battery powered systems. 921 single pole Ordering information Technical data Type No. 921 single pole switch 922 double pole switch Enclosure design (optional) B3 without external operating knob, for use only with single pole devices B31 with external operating knob, for use only with single pole devices B32 without external operating knob, for use only with double pole devices B33 with external operating knob, for use with double pole devices B34 with external operating knob, for use only with double pole devices* B35 without external operating knob, for use only with single pole devices* *with remote-re-connection facility Terminal design K12 for single pole version, enclosures B3, B31, B35 K60 for single pole version K61 for double pole version K62 for double pole version K72 for double pole version, enclosures B32, B33, B34 Mounting 5 mounting brackets - surface mounting Auxiliary contacts (blade terminals 6.3x0.8) Si2 one N/O Si1 one N/C 2Si2 two N/O Si10 one each N/O and N/C Remote operation FA remote disconnection FC electrical remote disconnection (FA) and re-connection (FE) BC-FA electrical remote disconnection and manual remote re-connection (not for enclosure -B..) Coil voltage 12 AC/DC 12 V 24 AC/DC 24 V Current ratings 240 A (type 921) 120 A (type 922) 921 - B31 - K12 - 5 - Si2 - FA 922 double pole Voltage rating DC 12 V, DC 24 V Current rating range 240 A type 921, single pole 120 A type 922, double pole Auxiliary contact rating 6 A at 24 V Electrical remote disconnection (-FA): operating voltage DC 12 V or DC 24 V operating current approx. 18 A or approx. 12 A max. pulse time 10 ms < tON < 20 ms /tOFF > 10 s switching time < 20 s Electrical remote re-connection (-FC): operating voltage DC 12 V or DC 24 V operating current approx. 30 A or approx. 15 A max. pulse time 0.1 s < tON < 1.2 s /tOFF > 60 s switching time < 100 ms Typical life Ambient temperature -40...+75 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 6 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) operating area pole/pole main to aux. circuit aux. circuits 11-12 to 13-14 Approvals Authority Voltage rating Type LRoS DC 28 V 921, 922 BASEEFA DC 12 V, DC 24 V 922-B33-K72-5-... Issue C ☎ 4 Test voltage AC 3300 V AC 3300 V AC 2200 V AC 1000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Switching capacity Type 921 Type 922 2500 A for 1 s at +23°C 1500 A for 1 s 600 A for 1 min at +23°C 600 A for 30 s 600 A for 2 min at -23°C 600 A for 1 min 600 A for 90 s at 0°C 600 A for 45 s at +23°C at +23°C at -23°C at 0°C Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) operating area IP 40 terminal area IP 00 IP 54 with additional enclosure -B.. Vibration 5 g (57-200 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 1000 g with remote disconnection approx. 1400 g with remote disconnection and re-connection 24 - 240 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. 10,000 operations at IN 20,000 operations mechanical Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 251 Battery Isolation Switches 921/922 Dimensions Enclosure 922-K72-5-...-FC 154 single pole 116 0 I 11 2 196 57 288 135 15.3 47 72 155 189 28.5 0 I 26 15.3 double pole 92 43 70 49 116 49 82 82 M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M5 14 35 9 61 26° M3.5x10 tightening torque max. 0.55 Nm 72 83.5 26° 92 921-K12-5-...-BC-FA.. 11.5 57 0 79 I 164 190 123 114.5 4 N/C and FA 2 45 61 91 35 Internal connection diagrams N/O 92 13 921 4 180 11 30 44 72 92 83.5 FA 57 Si1 2Si2 Si10 13 11 13 23 11 13 14 12 14 24 12 14 1 battery + 922 14 Si2 FE M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M5 load 2 Si2 Si1 2Si2 Si10 13 11 13 23 11 13 3 14 1 battery + 12 14 24 12 14 load 2 9 61.5 4 FE FA 921-K60...-FA 26° 26° Shock directions M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm 4 106 91 4 2 45 3 2 92 13 1 5 252 ☎ 6 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Battery Emergency Switch E-1032-... Description For vehicles carrying dangerous goods the European guideline ADR (European agreement concerning the international carriage of dangerous goods by road) requires that a Battery Emergency Switch should be fitted between the battery and the vehicle electrical system which in an emergency can be operated from the driver’s cab. Once the emergency has been remedied or if the switch was operated by error, the switch must also be resettable from the driver’s cab. Typical applications Commercial vehicles carrying dangerous goods E-1032-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. E-1032 Voltage rating Version NA1 single pole NA2 double pole Enclosure C with moulded enclosure IP65 (GGVS/ADR) Isolation switch 921 single pole switch 922 double pole switch Voltage rating DC 24 V DC 12 V Variant No. e.g. special versions, mounting plate. Designation determined by manufacturer E-1032 - NA1 - C 921 - DC 24 V - ... Voltage range DC 24 V ON: OFF: Current ratings Authority Requirement Approval mark No. TÜV Appendix B2 of ADR TÜ.EGG.030-97 240 A single pole 120 A double pole Overload capacity 2,500 A for 1 s at 23 °C, single pole 1,500 A for 1 s at 23 °C, double pole Current consumption of the electronics ≤ 15 mA (with the control circuit connected) Switching current at UN ON OFF approx. 15A/100 ms approx. 12A/100 ms Control circuit (Ex) (PTB No.III B/E-29861S) Approvals DC 12 V 18-32 V 9-16 V 15-32 V 8.5-16 V The switching function is no longer ensured when the voltage falls below the minimum values. The switch will not change its position when the voltage falls down to 0 V (automatic locking) Control switch (accessory) approx. 20A/100 ms approx. 10A/100 ms 4 0 - 2 mA OFF 4 - 6 mA ON 9 - 11 mA OFF rated to VDE 0171, protection (Ex)i G5 „intrinsically safe“ to GGVS with coding resistance with coding resistance 1 kΩ 330 Ω to ADR for external actuation Temperature range -40...+75 °C Reverse polarity protection If polarized incorrectly, the Emergency Switch will switch off immediately, disconnecting the entire vehicle electrical system. After approx. 30 s the circuit breaker of the ON coil will trip. Resettability When the Battery Emergency Switch is mechanically switched off, it will be reset immediately by the electronics. Typical life 10,000 operations at IN 20,000 operations, mechanical Degree of protection IEC 529/DIN40050) with enclosure IP 54 when connected to GGVS or ADR Vibration 5 g (57-200 Hz), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis blade terminals with cable lugs for M10 terminal studs (IP 00) connector to DIN 72 585 Shock 25 g (11 ms) direction 1-4 15 g (11 ms) direction 5-6 to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Auxiliary contact for auxiliary relay (D±31) max. 6 A (circuit not protected) Corrosion 96 h at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Mass approx.. 3500 g with enclosure, single pole approx. 3700 g with enclosure, double pole Humidity 240 h at 95 RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca DIN/EN 40050 Technical data Terminals Main terminals Control cable Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 253 Battery Emergency Switch E-1032-... Rubber cap Dimensions E-1032-NA1-… 1.. pole supplied with enclosure C 124 max 30 max 15 102 15 23 Tmax = 20 Nm ø11.5 222 M10 tightening torque max. 4 Nm 244 connector to DIN 72585 146 30 max 65 20 Internal connection diagrams ø7 1 ø11 9.5 31 slot for mounting screw M6 EMERGENCY SWITCH Power supply LOAD Connector acc. to DIN 72582 3/4 pole batt + (-) 2 3 (+) Generator D+ POWER SUPPLY BATTERY slotted screw plug 87 Emergency Current limiter for EC tachograph or other approved tachographs 87a 31 Connector acc. to DIN 72582 2 pole 2(-) batt - 4 1 1081-01 PTB Nr. 111 B/E29861S E-1032Electronic - Rel.85 (D+) 1 (+) 1 Circuit Breaker OFF 30 E-1032-NA2-… 2 pole R1 2 3 3 ON 4…6mA 86 ADR 15 BATT 124 46 102 15 23 222 M10 tightening torque max. 4 Nm 244 UB R1 12 V 330 Ω 24 V 1 kΩ 2 ON 85 LOAD Shock direction 20 connector to DIN 72585 30 4 3 86 43 73 146 2 21 1 ø11 ø7 1 4 IP54 86 21 73 IP00 slot for mounting screw M6 - BATTERY 9.5 31 5 6 - LOAD POWER SUPPLY EMERGENCY SWITCH + LOAD + BATTERY slotted screw plug 254 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Battery Emergency Switch E-1032-... Accessories female connector jack for female single wire sealing connector 180° cover for sheathed cable max.16 ADR switch with lid 0Z223Z000141 12 V 0Z223Z000142 24 V mounting hole (with nose washer) 1 2 3 4 90° cover ø12.4 ø3.2 9.3 max. 30 5 or 6 Manufacturer: AMP 1. Female connector SW 0Z112Z000146 2-way 0Z112Z000127 3-way 0Z112Z000147 4-way max. 29 31 ø18.3 ADR switch with bellows 0Z223Z000144 max.16 max.16 ADR switch without bellows 0Z223Z000143 ø32.8 2. Jack for female connector 0Z112Z000126 3. Single wire sealing 0Z112Z000134 20.7 4 max. 30 max. 30 ø5.9 7.8 4. 180° cover for sheathed cable 0Z112Z000135 max. 29 47.5 ø25.8 9.3 ø12.4 ø3.2 mounting hole (with nose washer) max. 29 5. 90° cover for corrugated tube NW10 0Z112Z000136 ø25.8 6. 90° cover for sheathed cable 0Z112Z000145 ø25.8 33 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 42 255 Battery Emergency Switch E-1032-... Approvals / Certificates 4 256 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Battery Isolation Switches E-1073-437 and E-1073-921/-922 Description Single pole circuit breaker type 437 or single/two pole isolation switches types 921/922 featuring an additional electronic function module which limits the duration of the supply to the remote disconnect and reconnect coils, avoiding damage in the event of unusual operating circumstances. Available with undervoltage monitoring option to protect batteries from the effects of deep discharge, status output for undervoltage, auto reset feature. Typical applications Battery and cable protection for all types of vehicle (including electric), battery powered systems. Ordering information E-1073-437 Technical data – Electronic module Type No. E-1073 control unit for types 921/922 and 437 with remote control Voltage rating 0 DC 12 V 1 DC 24 V Control mode 1 ON/OFF control input Additional function 00 none 02 with undervoltage protection and status output 12 with autoreset, undervoltage protection and status output (921/922 only) 2 ON and OFF buttons 33 with control current supply and ON/OFF test input Circuit Breaker/Isolation Switch 437 single pole circuit breaker 921 single pole battery isolation switch 922 double pole battery isolation switch Enclosure design (optional) blank = without housing B3 moulded housing, for use with single pole devices B32 moulded housing, for use with double pole devices B34 moulded housing, external operating knob, for use with double pole devices (not with auto reset) B35 moulded housing, external operating knob, for use with single pole devices (not with auto reset) Terminal design K12 flat screw terminals angled 90°, for single pole version K60 straight flat screw terminals, for single pole version, without housing K72 flat screw terminals angled 90°, for double pole version Characteristic curve (type 437 only) 06 fast magnetic trip 07 delayed magnetic trip (standard) Auxiliary contacts Si01 one N/C, two N/O (one N/C, one N/O with autoreset option) Current ratings 437: 40, 50, 63, 80, 100, 120 160, 200, 240 A 921: 240 A 922: 120 A E-1073 - 1 1 02 - 437 - B3 - K12 - 07 - Si01 - 240 A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Voltage rating DC 12 V DC 24 V Voltage rating range ON 10.3 - 16 V OFF 9 - 16 V 18 - 32 V 16 - 32 V Correct switching performance is not guaranteed if the voltage falls below the minimum value. Temperature range electronic control unit -40...+ 80 °C Operating current ON approx. 30 A OFF approx. 10 A Excitation time ON OFF Switching frequency Power consumption of electronic control unit Control inputs approx. 15 A approx. 20 A typically 100 ms typically 20 ms 0.1 Hz max. typically < 1 mA (when switched off or button operated) E-1073-.1..: ’E/A’(ON/OFF), ’U-AUS’ (undervoltage protection OFF), ’A-W’ (auto reset) Voltage ON (high) OFF (low) Power consumption E-1073-.2..: ’T-EIN’, (button ON) ’T-AUS’, (button OFF) max. 32 V >8V <3V typically 1 mA typically 5 mA 4 EMC according to DIN 40839/ISO 7637 Reverse polarity protection If polarized incorrectly, the Battery Isolation Switch will operate immediately. The circuit breaker will trip after a few seconds. Undervoltage protection switching thresholds hysteresis trip time optional with E-1073-.1.. 11.0 V ±0.2 V 22.8 V ±0.2 V typically 0.5 V typically 40 sec Undervoltage status output(’UST‘), optional with E-1073-.1.. transistor output minus switching current load corresponding to 2 W lamp load, shortcircuit proof Automatic reset (’A-W‘), optional with E-1073-.1.., with series 921/922 only) Reset after mechanical disconnection is provided by the integral electronic control after approx. 100 ms. Control current supply (’+US2‘), with E-1073-.2.. for T-EIN/T-AUS May be connected to 20 control intputs. Noise-voltage proof, short-circuit proof Terminals control terminals blade terminals 6.3x0.8 mm Mass, with circuit breaker approx. 2,000 g without enclosure or isolation switch approx. 2,500 g with enclosure Technical data of switch or circuit breaker see types 437, 921 or 922 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 257 Battery Isolation Switches E-1073-437 and E-1073-921/-922 Features Control functions ● Multiple functions in one unit ● High performance circuit breaker providing battery and cable protection from overloads and short-circuits. ● Master switch for ON/OFF operation ● Electrical remote control ● Undervoltage protection with status output ● Auxiliary contacts (e.g. for generator disconnection) ● Active reverse polarity protection of the entire vehicle electrical system ● Current ratings to 240 A ● Closed-circuit current consumption < 1 mA Technical description E-T-A circuit breaker/battery isolation switches combined with electronic control unit E-1073 will meet a wide range of requirements. Circuit breaker/Battery Isolation switches The main switching contacts will open the plus, the minus or both poles according to model and application. ● Series E-1073-....437 Single pole thermal-magnetic circuit breaker for current ratings up to 240 A, to protect the vehicle electrical system from overloads and short circuits. ● Series E-1073-...-921 Single pole battery isolation switch for current ratings up to 240 A. ● Series E-1073-...922 Double pole battery isolation switch for current ratings up to 120 A. 4 Type 1 E-1073-.1.. with ON/OFF switch ON/OFF control switch input (”E/A“) The battery isolation switch can be operated on or off by an external control switch to plus. Undervoltage protection (optional) This optional feature protects the battery from deep discharge should electrical loads be left on. The battery is automatically disconnected whenever the voltage falls below a critical value for more than 40 s. The unit is reset by operation of the control switch. Sustained undervoltage after reconnection causes the unit to disconnect again after approx. 40 s. Overriding the undervoltage protection (”U-AUS“) Undervoltage protection may be overridden if required by connecting control output ”U-AUS“ to plus terminal or terminal 15. Undervoltage status output (”UST“) Undervoltage is signalled immediately via the minus-switching, short-circuit proof transistor output (2 W lamp load). Auto reset (”A-W“), optional with series 921 and 922 Immediate reset after unwanted mechanical disconnection (e.g. upon excessive vibration) is provided by the integral electronic control. Type 2 E-1073-.2... with ON/OFF button Electronic control unit ON/OFF control inputs (”T-ON/T-OFF“) ON/OFF function is provided by two external switches with a central control function, i.e. several systems can be operated simultaneously. An electronic control unit enables the basic on/off function and two additional functions. The system voltage is connected across terminals +UB/-UB to provide the supply to the control unit and a feed is taken from +US1 for the remotely sited operating switch(es). The quiescent current drain is typically less than 1 mA, with a short duration excursion during excitation of the ON/OFF coils. Additional control current supply (”+US2“) If several circuit breakers/battery isolation switches are operated in parallel, switches can be supplied with control current from any of the electronic control units available. This power source is short-circuit proof, protected from noise voltages and will operate for 20 inputs. Basic function Switch ON/OFF Operation of the ON control switch will energise the switch-on coil for approximately 100 ms causing the main switching contacts to latch closed. Operation of the OFF control switch will cause the disconnect coil to trigger the release of the switching mechanism within approximately 20 ms. Both coil circuits are current limited to prevent damage through overheating. Additional control input ”ON/OFF Test“ (”E/A“) This control input can be used for maintenance purposes. The battery isolation switch is switched on when plus voltage is applied, and switched off when plus voltage is removed. Manual operation An optional external operating knob is available to provide manual control in addition to electrical ON/OFF operation. Reverse polarity protection In the event of reverse polarity connection, the electronic control unit will immediately operate the battery switch to isolate the entire electrical system. The circuit breaker will trip after a short delay to protect the operating coils and must be re-set once the fault has been corrected. Note The circuit breaker should be in the OFF condition when connecting or replacing the battery. Observe Instructions for Installation TM 9/9.3 D/E! 258 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Battery Isolation Switches E-1073-437 and E-1073-921/-922 Dimensions Dimensions Enclosures E-1073-...-437/-921-...-K12-... -B3, single pole 116 154 ø28.5 72 57 4 288 cylinder head screw ISO 1207 M6x16-4.8 45 12 a b 13 14 23 24 116 180 196 -B35, single pole with operating knob 72 92 2 1 terminal strip10 61 FE 11 ø15.3 I 135 II 67 6 ø9 47 5 155 CB ø26 -B32, double pole 70 M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm M5 57 82.5 -B34, double pole, with operating knob 9 E-1073-...-437/921-...-K60-... 82.5 35 192 0 I 155 CB 49 116 30 ø15.3 154 5 6 4 135 288 FE 45 2 Connection diagrams 11 12 a b 13 14 23 24 72 92 141 E-1073-.1...-437/-921/-922 control function for ON/OFF switch Load 4 170 II 11 13 23 series 921/922 b FA series 437 3 L11 green 4 L12 brown (only with series 437) I> A-W Electronic control unit +US1 ON/OFF U-OFF UST. -UB L14 grey L5 grey L6 yellow L7 orange 2 3 +US1 4 E/A 5 6 U-OFF UST. L8 white L4 grey L3 brown L2 grey 1073-...-922-...-K72-... L1 red 6 5 L10 black CB 2 main contacts with series 922 M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm 57 9 CB L15 blackred L13 brown FE FA M5 FE Aux. contact 23-24 only connected when option “autoreset” has been selected double contact ≥ 125 A a 9 +UB 10 -UB 12 14 24 I 154 1 5 6 terminal strip 7 8 battery undervoltage status + + output max. 2 W power supply ON / OFF UVP OFF switch 135 E-1073-.2...-437/-921/-922 control function for ON/OFF switch Load 12 a b 13 14 23 24 3 L11 green 190 L12 brown FE 4 Electronic +US1 ON/OFF T-OFF +US2 T-ON -UB L6 yellow L7 orange 3 +US1 4 E/A 5 6 T-AUS +US2 L9 violet L5 grey 2 L8 white L4 grey L3 brown I> control unit CB L2 grey (only with series 437) L13 brown FE FA 61 double contact ≥ 125 A a 72 92 2 II 11 13 23 series 921/922 series 437 FA L1 rot 6 5 2 main contacts with series 922 b 11 L10 black 57 F I M5 57 1 terminal strip 9 164 Issue C M10x25 tightening torque max. 4 Nm ☎ ON / OFF test OFF button 7 +US2 ON button 8 9 T-EIN +UB 10 -UB 12 14 24 battery power supply Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 259 Battery Isolation Switches E-1073-437 and E-1073-921/-922 Typical applications For road vehicles, e.g. buses and coaches Series E-1073-1102-437-B3-K12-07-Si01-240 A For rail vehicles, e.g. underground carriages Series E-1073-1233-437-K60-06-Si01-200 A In this application, the E-T-A combined battery switch/circuit breaker has several functions: In this application, the E-T-A combined battery switch/circuit breaker has two functions: ● High performance circuit breaker rated at 40 A, providing battery and cable protection from overloads and short circuits. ● Isolation switch, for ON/OFF operation (e.g. for main system disconnection). ● Remote control via external, low-current circuit. ● Untervoltage protection from battery deep discharge should electrical loads be left on. ● Early under voltage signalisation via a warning lamp (undervoltage status output), located as required. ● Undervoltage operation can be overridden if required. ● Auxiliary contact to disconnect the generator field. ● Reverse polarity protection through immediate disconnection of the entire vehicle electrical system if the battery is incorrectly connected. ● High performance circuit breaker providing battery and cable protection from overloads and short circuits. ● Isolation switch between battery and loads. In this application, an ON/OFF remote control switch can be provided in both the first and last carriages. This will enable all batteries to be disconnected from the power distribution system by the operation of one control, irrespective of its location. In the same way, all batteries can be re-connected by the operation of a single control switch. This is extremely helpful during coupling/de-coupling of carriages for example. In addition the E/A test input permits the operation of individual battery switch/circuit breakers during maintenance. OFF + underground carriage Battery + E-1073-1233-437E-T-A E-1073-1233-437- + Control – load circuit control circuit These functions allow the number of components and cables required to be reduced, with significant space and weight saving benefits. II 5 T-OFF 6/7 L12 brown FA FE 4 L13 brown Load – ON/OFF 4 ON/OFF test 4 E/A 5 6 U-AUS UST. 7 8 9 +UB undervoltage status + output max. 2 W + ON/OFF UVP OFF switch – + – load circuit Battery + E-1073-1233-437E-T-A E-1073-1233-437- + Control II 5 T-OFF 6/7 + - underground carriage 12 14 24 +US2 I> ON I 8 T-ON battery control cable “ON” Kl. 15 10 -UB + Load 5 OFF I terminal strip 10 +UB -UB +US1 3 9 + 10 – Battery L1 red 6 L10 black L8 white L7 orange L6 yellow L5 grey L4 grey L3 brown L2 grey control circuit -UB CB 3 +US1 +US1 3 + (External power supply not shown) I> Electronic control unit 2 -UB 9 FE +US1 ON/OFF U-OFF UST. 1 +UB Battery generator field disconnection control cable “ON” double contact ≥ 125 A a L11 green 87a 31 II 11 13 23 series 437 3 85 87 30 I T-ON control cable “OFF” 4 FA 86 I> 8 control cable “OFF” b Kl. 15 generator D+ vehicle electrical system +US2 ON ON/OFF 4 ON/OFF test + 260 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com – Issue C Remote Control Circuit Breaker 4910 (RCCB) Description Single pole remote control circuit breaker (RCCB), temperature compensated, either with or without auxiliary contacts, and featuring a bimetal actuator which trips the circuit breaker mechanism within a specified time under overcurrent conditions. The switching contact latching system is operated by a bi-stable linear motor controlled by electronic circuitry incorporated within the device. Applying the system voltage across the input will switch the RCCB ON, disconnection of the input will cause it to switch OFF. Remote control is achieved through the use of a conventional single pole manually operated aircraft style thermal circuit breaker to connect the supply to the control input of the RCCB. Complies with the requirements of MIL-C-83383. 4910 (RCCB) Technical data Typical applications Aircraft electrical systems and equipment, and other high performance applications. Voltage rating DC 28 V (DC 18...36 V) Current rating range 5... 100 A Auxiliary circuit 3 A, DC 28 V, AC 115 V (400 Hz) Bias current 2.5 mA max Ordering information Switching current/ switching period 2.8 A/ 25 ms Type No. 4910 single pole remote control circuit breaker (RCCB) Variation 01 standard, with auxiliary contacts 02 with modified terminal barrier and auxiliary contacts 03 standard, without auxiliary contacts 04 with modified terminal barrier but without auxiliary contacts Current ratings 5... 100 A Trigger current for ICU (“TRIP FREE“-mode)/ duration 4910 - 01 - 5A ordering example 50,000 operations at IN (inductive or resistive) Ambient temperature -54...+71 °C Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) Test voltage between main terminals AC 1500 V main terminal to mounting area AC 1500 V Insulation resistance Standard current ratings and typical voltage drop values Current ratings (A) 5 7.5 Voltage drop at rated current(mV) 450 Current ratings (A) 40 Voltage drop at rated current(mV) 200 360 50 200 10 347 60 200 15 225 75 200 20 200 80 200 25 200 100 200 35 200 Issue C ☎ 4 > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity DC 28 V: 6000 A Vibration (sinusoidal) 10 g (55-2000 Hz), ±0.76 mm (10-55 Hz) to MIL-STD 202, method 204, condition C Vibration (random) 10-2000 Hz, spectral power density 0.15 g2/Hz, rms value 13.5 g; 5 h/axis loaded with 0.9 IN Shock 25 g (11 ms) to MIL-STD 202, method 213, condition J ISO 7137 (RTCA/DO-160 C, part 7) Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to MIL-STD 202, method101, condition B ISO 7137 (RTCA/DO-160 C, part 14, category S) Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to MIL-STD 202, method 106/ISO 7137 (RTCA/DO-160 C, part 6, category B) Approvals MIL-C-83383 pending approx. 3.2 A /5 s max Typical life Altitude < 15,000 m above sea level Mass approx. 300 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com 261 Remote Control Circuit Breaker 4910 (RCCB) Dimensions Internal onnection diagrams Type 4910 - 01 - 03 Type 4910 - 01 / - 02 (with auxiliary contacts) back up power 4 A LINE 38.8 circuit breaker 0,5 A C 3 5A 5B mounting flange A2 S1 LOAD / 86.8 indicator circuit breaker ICU 2.5 108.2 RCCB Type 4910 electronics B 9.1 10.7 LINE/ + A1 S3 S2 3 57.15 1.4 LOAD 30.5 Type 4910 - 03 / - 04 (without auxiliary contacts) mounting flange 17.5 60 LINE/ + A1 15 ø4.4 back up power 4 RCCB Type 4910 A1 A2 electronics circuit breaker 0,5 A status indicator current rating in A 74.6 6.5 15.3 60 3 5A 5B mounting flange A2 LOAD / - 3.7 82.55 indicator ciruit breaker ICU Type 4910 - 02 - 04 Typical time/current characteristics LOAD A B 4 LINE 13.4 1.4 10000 18.7 C Trip limit: +25 °C 115 … 138 % In +71 °C 100 … 138 % In - 54 °C 115 … 150 % In 60 socket for contact pins M 39029/1-100 or M39029/1-101 Trip time in seconds A1 A2 1000 100 10 current rating (A) thread A mounting torque B (mm) C (mm) nut lock washer washer 5 … 25 0.190-32 UNF-2A 2 Nm 12.7 12.7 AN315-3R MS 35338-43 AN 960-10L 35 … 100 0.250-28 UNF-2A 4.1 Nm 15.5 15.5 AN315-4R MS 35338-44 AN 960-416 1 0.1 mounting flanges mate as shown 0.01 0.8 1 2 4 6 8 10 20 40 … times rated current 262 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 – USA (847) 827-7600 – UK (01296) 420336 – www.etacbe.com Issue C Door Locking, Time Delay and Motor Protection Controls Door Locking Relays Time Delay Relays Motor Protection Controls Motor Start Switches Voltage ratings max. 3 AC 400 V, AC 250 V DC 28 V Current ratings 0.1...16 A Suited both to domestic and heavy duty professional equipment, these relays offer a choice of thermal or magnetic sensing element, with versions for current and voltage control. Energising the relay activates the door locking mechanism, while de-energisation keeps the door locked for a predetermined time until it is safe to be opened again. The E-T-A door locking relay series 6510 has been specifically developed to comply with the requirements of IEC 335-2-25 (Safety for Household and Similar appliances). The product is in modular form and offers door closed signalling and locking possibilities for applications such as microwave ovens with pyrolytic cleaning. The choice of door locking relays available provides flexibility for the designer while ensuring that the legislative demands of different markets can be successfully satisfied. Time Delay Relays The E-T-A series 664 is a voltage activated thermal time delay relay suitable for a wide range of applications and process control applications. The excitation circuit and load switching changeover contacts are electrically separate. Delay times can be specified in fixed steps up to sixty seconds. Motor Protection Controls Series 2-6500 and 2-6700 over current protection devices with automatic reset actuation are particularly suitable for motor control and similar applications. They are designed to distinguish between temporary overloads, for example motor start conditions, and sustained faults such as locked rotor. A reset delay provides an opportunity for the equipment protected to cool before power is re-applied, and the need for operator intervention is avoided. Motor Start Switches E-T-A Motor Start Switches offer a simple and rugged method of disconnecting the auxiliary windings and start capacitors of single phase AC motors. Featuring current sensitive bimetal controlled mechanisms, their switching time is a function of the starting current and its duration. All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 263 Overview Door Locking Relays E-T-A door locking relays are designed to increase the safety of washing machines, dishwashers, microwave ovens and similar appliances. By ensuring that their doors cannot be opened whilst the machine is operating, users are protected from moving parts, high temperatures, steam, harmful radiation and other hazards. 5 Time Delay Relays - Door Locking Systems 683-... 6110-... Description Bimetal operated voltage activated time delay relay, with change over contact and snap action mechanism. Excitation circuit and switching circuit are electrically separate Bimetal operated voltage or current activated door locking relay. Choice of actuator lengths. Aux. contact optional Bimetal operated voltage activated door lock for washing machines Max. voltage rating AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 24 V AC 250 V (50/60 Hz) AC 250 V (50/60 Hz) Current rating of switching circuit/auxiliary contact 5 (2A) 2 (0.3) A 16 (4) A switch on only 4-5/6-7 6A (6A) switch-on only Operating voltages or currents AC 4...240 V 0.1...5 A AC 24...240 V AC 120...240 V Typical life 100,000 operations with 1 x IN 10,000 operations with 1 x IN 5,000 operations with 1 x IN for circuit 4-5 5,000 operations with 1 x IN for circuit 6-7 Overexcitation or interrupting capacity 1.4 UN continuously up to 3 UN short-time VDE, Demko, Nemko, Semko, Fimko, Kema, SEV, ÖVE, IMQ, UTE VDE, KEMA, SEV, Fimko, Demko, Nemko, IMQ see pages 269 - 270 see pages 271 - 272 Approvals see pages 267 - 268 Available options 3 4 2 60 6 12.5 22 38 1 28.5 energized Dimensions 53.5 5 664-... 30 Overview Type No. 5 42 60 Internal wiring diagrams 4 60 5 3 current-activated 60±0.2 6110-...1-... 1 1 264 ☎ 2 2 3 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 4 6(6)A 0(0)A ON OFF 6(6)A 0(0)A 5 6 ON OFF 7 Issue C Door Locking Relays - Motor Protection Controls 6510-F... 2-6500-... 2-6700-... 3620-... Magnetic door lock for cookers with pyrolytic cleaning and microwave ovens Single pole bimetal operated motor protection control, surface mounting with flange, automatic re-set type Single pole bimetal operated motor protection control, surface mounting, automatic re-set type Three pole, voltage-sensitive thermal relay with bimetal operation and auxiliary contact AC 230 V (50/60 Hz) AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 28 V AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 28 V 3 AC 400 V (50/60 Hz) ≤ 10 A 13-14/33-34 16 A (6A) 23-24 10 A (4A) 0.1...10 A 0.1...10 A ≤ AC 230 V (50/60 Hz) 500 operations for circuit 33-34 100,000 operations for circuit 13-13 and 23-24 100,000 operations with 2 x IN 100,000 operations with 2 x IN 1,000 operations at IN 8 x IN 8 x IN 300 operations with 20 A VDE, KEMA, Demko, Nemko, Fimko, ÖVE, IMQ, Semko VDE, Semko, UL VDE see pages 273 - 274 see pages 275 - 276 see pages 275 - 276 6510-F1 Overview AC 230...240 V 5 see pages 277 - 278 50 ±0.1 22 14 26 3 2 12 22 P 0.8 0.25 1 12.5 5 12.5 P 6510-F101-... 33 34 41 42 35 45.5 61 45 4.5 42.5 78 44.5 P i 1 3 5 21 k 2 4 6 22 44 (3) I Issue C 14 24 13 23 2 ☎ 2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 265 Motor Start Switches Description Current sensitive bimetal operated relay for disconnecting auxiliary windings and start capacitors Max. voltage rating AC 250 V (50/60 Hz) Current rating of switching circuit 10 (5) A Operating voltages or currents 0.2...10 A Typical life 100,000 operations at 1 x IN Interrupting capacity 4 IN, max. 20 A Approvals VDE Available options see pages 279 - 280 Dimensions 45 2 22 5 2-7000-... 12 Overview Type No. 3 1 61 Internal wiring diagrams 1 3 2 266 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Time Delay Relay 664-... Description Voltage activated bimetal operated time delay relay with changeover contact and snap action mechanism, excitation circuit and switching circuit electrically separate, operation independent of mounting attitude. High shock resistance. Delay times can be factory-preset as desired. The continuous excitation voltage may be up to 1.4 times the rated value. To shorten the switching time the excitation voltage may be increased to 3 times the rated value but only for that switching time period. Typical applications Process control, diesel engine pre-heaters 664-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 664 thermal time delay relay with changeover contact Terminal design P10 5 blade terminals 6.3x0.8 P19 printed circuit board pins Operating voltage* AC 4...240 V Switching time* 20...60 sec Reset time* 20...60 sec 664 - P10 - 230 V - 20 - 40 6 7.6 Operating voltage (V) 24 Internal resistance (Ω) 200 48 725 60 1,200 10 26.5 115 4,000 12 40 230 16,700 16 73 240 16,700 20 134 8 Issue C 16 ☎ 5 (2) A Operating voltages AC 4...240 V Typical life ordering example Standard operating voltages and typical internal resistance values Internal resistance (Ω) 3.4 AC 250 V (50/60 Hz); DC 24 V Current rating of switching circuit Switching/ reset times in sec *Please indicate the desired switching time, reset time and operating voltage when ordering. The sum of switching and reset time should be between 60 and 120 s. Operating voltage (V) 4 Voltage rating approx. 20 approx. 40 approx. 25 approx. 50 approx. 30 approx. 60 The sum of switching time and reset time should be between 60 and 120 s 100,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature -30...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) excitation circuit/ switching circuit AC 2,000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Overexcitation 1.4 UN continuously up to 3 UN short-time Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) housing IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH test to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 31 g Test voltage Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 5 267 Time Delay Relay 664-... Dimensions Internal wiring diagram 664-P10 60 4 5 3 55 41.8 6.25 6.5 5 13 1 3 30 2 5 7 1 2 15 3 17.5 27 21.5 4 3.7 28.5 0.5 6.5 8.5 20 6 13 6.3 0.8 664-P19 60 55 41.8 6.25 6.5 5 13 1 3 30 3 5 7 3.7 6.5 0.5 28.5 5 15 2 17.5 27 21.5 4 4 6.3 268 ☎ 6.2 8.5 20 6 13 0.8 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Door Locking Relay 683-... Description Voltage or current activated bimetal operated door locking relay in creepage resistant and flame retardant housing. Choice of actuator lengths. Auxiliary contacts optional. Typical applications Washing machines 683-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 683 door locking relay Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Auxiliary contacts Si1 current and voltage activated, 2 (0.3) A, N/O Si2 current and voltage activated, N/C Si50 voltage activated 16 (4) A, N/O Housing KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Variant ... special suffix number for actuator length or style etc. Operating current or voltage 0.1...5 A AC 24...240 V 683 - P10 - Si50 - KF - ... - 230 V ordering example Approvals Authority Voltage rating Current rating VDE, Demko, Nemko, Semko, Fimko, Kema, SEV, ÖVE, IMQ, UTE AC 250 V 2 (0.3)A, 16 (4)A Issue C ☎ Voltage rating AC 250 V (50/60 Hz) Current ratings: circuit Si1, Si2 circuit Si50 2 (0.3) A 16 (4) A switch on only Operating voltages AC 24...240 V Operating currents 0.1...5 A Typical life 10,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature 0... +80 °C (T 80) Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) Test voltage AC 2,000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Locking time (23°C) < 20 sec depending on excitation Release time (23°C) > 40 sec depending on application Actuator travel max. 3.5 mm Actuator force max. 0.2 N Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) actuator area IP 20 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 15 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 22 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 5 269 Door Locking Relay 683-... Dimensions Installation drawings 683-P10-KF-... current activated 683-P10-KF-... current activated 10 27.2 16 38 22 30 3.3 8.1 25 6 8.5 4.3 non-energized 28.5 53.5 energized 6 25 ±1.3 16 12.5 26 ±1.2 actuator motion when energized reference values for operating times 18 4.5 26.5 60 terminal area 3 mounting area 3.5 11.25 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8-MS 0.65 4 7 5 recommended minimum dimensions ø4 9 683-P10-Si50-KF-... voltage activated ±1.2 683-P10-Si50-KF-... voltage activated actuator motion when energized 12.5 6 5 ±1.3 25 6 20 16 26 27.2 3.3 3 25 non-energized 28.5 4.3 ø4 3.5 11.25 0.65 4 7 terminal area blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8-MS 60 9 Internal wiring diagrams 5 5 mounting area 3 5 reference values for operating times 33 18 4.5 26.5 16 38 22 8.1 3 30 53.5 energized 8.5 Application circuit 683-P10 683-P10-KF current activated R 1 program contacts door lock 2 683-P10-Si1-KF current activated 683-P10-Si2-KF current activated 1 1 5 washing motor M M spin motor Mp 2 3 683-P10-Si50-KF voltage activated, without physical isolation 2 270 2 683-P10-Si50-KF voltage activated, with physical isolation 1 4 1 3 2 3 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Door Locking Relay 6110-... Description Bimetal operated voltage activated door lock for washing machines, ensuring compulsory and permanent contact separation when the door is forced open. With standard keyed connectors. Typical applications Washing machines 6110-F10.-P1X.-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 6110 voltage activated door locking relay Configuration/mounting method F flange mounting Lock 1 for door catch 3 for door pin Number of poles 0 unprotected on all poles Circuit variants 1...6 see circuit variants shown overleaf Terminal design P1 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Characteristic curve X0 switch only (version -F..6) (without lock) X2 standard curve: 230 V locking time ≤10 s release time: 40-100 s (at 23°C) X3 standard curve: 110 V locking time: ≤16 s release time: 40-100 s (at 23°C) Slide positioning R1 with locating position Rating operating voltage in V 6110 - F 1 0 1 - P1 X2 - R1 - 230 V Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz Current ratings for circuit 4-5 (µ) for circuit 6-7 6 A (6 A) switch on only 6 A (6 A) switch on only Operating voltages 3-4 AC 120...AC 240 V Typical life for circuits 4-5 for circuits 6-7 5,000 operations at 1xIN 5,000 operations at 1xIN Ambient temperature 0...+80 °C T 80 Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 3 reinforced insulation at locking aperture Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A locking aperture circuit 3-4-5/6-7 Test voltage AC 4,000 V AC 2,000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) locking aperture IP 33 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 z), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 15 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Operating force F1: 3...10 N F3: < 68 N Locking force F1: ≥ 400 N F3: ≥ 200 N Mass approx. 46 g ordering example Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE, Kema, SEV, AC 250 V 16 (6) A Fimko,Demko, Nemko, IMQ Issue C ☎ 6110-F30.-P1X.-... Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 5 271 Door Locking Relay 6110-F10.-P1X.-... Dimensions 6110-F10-... for door pin Dimensions 6110-F30-... for door catch standard keyed connectors code W for thermal door locking blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8-Ms standard keyed connectors code W for thermal door locking blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8-Ms ø8 ø8 12 42 60 ±0.2 42 FS 6x5=30 6x5=30 5 5 12 60 60 11 engaged length of the door catch 1 5 19 15 door pin direction 15 R6 19 6.5 +0.5 door pin in closed position (not part of our product) pin form to drawing Y 306 428 00 4 3 - 10 N min. 400 N 2.5 2 operating force for slide: locking force of the device: door catch in operating mode +0.5 4 - 5 mm slide movement in one direction ( ) ø3.6 17.5 ø3.6 door catch (not part of product) 4.5 6 4.5 chamfer 1x45° chamfer 1x45° engaged length of the door pin 38 20 9.5 22 32.7 -0.2 38 32.7 -0.2 20 9.5 60±0.2 5 -0.1 6° + 4 ° max. 10 thickness max. 9mm 10.5 -0.2 2 = = = 2 17.9-0.2 = 17.9-0.2 5 Installation drawing Circuit variants 5 6110-...1-... 5 > R4 around the hole 3 5 4 6(6)A 0(0)A ON OFF 6(6)A 0(0)A 5 6 ON OFF 7 6110-...3-... 15 3 5.5 3.5 6(6)A 0(0)A 4 ON OFF 5 5.5 3.5 6110-...6-... 6(6)A 0(0)A 15 272 ☎ 25 6 ON OFF 7 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Door Locking Relay 6510-... Description Safety systems for cookers with pyrolytic cleaning facility and microwave ovens according to IEC Standard 335-2-25. 6510-F2: contact system for application in microwave ovens, with one or two auxiliary contacts to monitor latching of the door striker. 6510-F1: same basic unit as type 6510-F2, with an additional bistable electro-magnetic locking mechanism to ensure that the door is closed during pyrolytic cleaning. Operating temperatures up to +120°C. Typical applications Cookers with or without pyrolytic cleaning facility, microwave ovens 6510-F1... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 6510 door locking relay Configuration/mounting method F flange mounting Size 1 contact system with additional bistable electro-magnetic locking mechanism (for cookers with pyrolytic cleaning facility) 2 contact system for microwave ovens Number of poles 0 unprotected on all poles Style, accessories (circuit variants) 1 2 switch contacts (two N0 contacts) 2 1 switch contact (one N0 contact) 3 2 switch contacts (one each NO/NC contact) Terminal design P1 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 mm Characteristic data Q1 Switch: max. 500 magnetic locking and unlocking cycles switching contacts: max. 100,000 cycles Contact load: terminal 13-14: 16 (6) A terminal 33-34: 16 (6) A terminal 23-24: 10 (4) A Q2 Switch: max. 500 magnetic locking and unlocking cycles switching contacts: max. 100,000 cycles Contact load: terminal 13-14: 16 (6) A terminal 33-34: 16 (6) A terminal 23-24: DC 5 V / 100 µA Rating AC 230-240 V 1 % ON duty / 10 sec 6510 - F 1 0 1 - P1 Q1 - 230 V ordering example Approvals Authority Voltage ratings Current ratings VDE Kema, Demko, Nemko, Fimko, ÖVE, IMQ Semko (only -F2) AC 230 V 16 (6) A, 10 (4) A Issue C ☎ 6510-F2... Voltage rating AC 230 V, 50/60 Hz (other voltages to special order) Current ratings circuits 13-14 (-F1/-F2) and 33-34 (-F1) 16 A (6 A) circuit 23-24 10 A (4 A) Coil (-F1 only) excitation 41-42/44 duty cycle AC 230-240 V, approx. 8 A 1 % ON duty /10 s Typical life (VDE 0630) 100,000 operations at 1xIN for circuits 13-14 and 23-24 Typical life ( VDE 0435) 500 operations at 1xIN for circuit 33-34 (-F1 only) - pyrolysis Ambient temperature 0...150 °C (T 150) coil function temp. (-F1 only): +80...+120 °C Temperature at mounting means Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) locking aperture circuits 13-14/23-24 between circuits 13-14/23-24 and 33-34 (-F1 only) between circuits and energization (-F1 only) max. +180 °C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 3 reinforced insulation at locking aperture Test voltage AC 4,000 V AC 2,000 V 5 AC 4,000 V AC 2,000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) locking aperture IP 33 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 z), ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 15 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 96 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH to DIN 40046, sheet 5, test Ca Locking strength (-F1) ≥ 200 N Mass -F1: approx. 75 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com -F2: approx. 36 g 273 Door Locking Relay 6510-... Dimensions 6510-F2 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Ms 8.5 7 30 4.5 35 45 4.5 30 50 ±0.1 38 2 9 42.5 56.5 Door catch (not part of our product) 42.5 56.5 ø5 3.5 3.5 5.5 5.5 8.5 8.5 15.5 15.5 mounting depth 19 mounting depth 19 Installation drawing 6510-F1 Installation drawing 6510-F2 mounting area (standard insulation) accessible area (double insulation) ø10 ø5 ø12 ø5 ø10 Door catch (not part of our product) ø5 ø12 7.5 4.5 FS 25 -40 N 15 - 30 N 45 7.5 FS = closing force: opening force: 2 4.5 78 63±0.2 8.5 FS = closing force: 25 - 40 N opening force: 15 - 30 N locking strength: ≥ 200 N 63±0.2 8.5 9 7.5 7.5 3x7.5=(22.5) 78 FS 3x7.5=(22.5) 50 ±0.1 38 1.5 5 7 1.5 5.5 5 14 30.5 14.5 1.5 6.5 1.5 blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 Ms 4x7.5 = (30) 7.5 1.5 Dimensions 6510-F1 accessible area (double insulation) mounting area (standard insulation) 5 Please ensure that the door catch engages centrally in the locking aperture! Please ensure that the door catch engages centrally in the locking aperture! Internal wiring diagrams 6510-F1.. 6510-F101-... 33 34 41 42 6510-F102-... 44 33 34 41 42 Internal wiring diagrams 6510-F2.. 6510-F103-... 44 33 34 41 42 6510-F201-... 44 14 24 I I 274 24 13 23 I 14 13 ☎ I 14 24 13 23 14 I 13 14 6510-F202-... 23 13 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Motor Protection Controls 2-6500-.../2-6700-... Description Bimetal operated motor protection controls with automatic reset actuation, small physical size, reliable snap-action mechanism. Caution: In specifying these products, care should be taken to ensure that automatic motor re-start does not represent a safety hazard. Typical applications Motors, transformers, extra low voltage wiring 2-6500-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 2-6500 surface type with flange 2-6700 surface type without flange Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Shunt terminal (optional) A3 blade terminals or solder terminals; max. load 5 A Current ratings 0.1...10 A 2-6500 - P10 - - 6A ordering example The exact part number required can be built up from the table of choices shown above. Ordering references for optional features should be omitted if not required. Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz; DC 28 V Current ratings 0.1...10 A Typical life 100,000 operations at 2xIN Protection is ensured for 18 days of continuous locked rotor condition with Ik ≤ 6xIN, max. 30 A, (unsupervised duty) Ambient temperature -10...+60 °C Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664 A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 3 Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) Test voltage AC 2,000 V Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity 8 x IN (co-co-co) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) housing IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Internal resistance (Ω) Shock 15 g (11 ms) test to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH test to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass 2-6500: approx. 20 g 2-6700: approx. 25 g Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) Internal resistance (Ω) 0.1 140 Current rating (A) 2 0.47 2.5 0.33 20.5 3 0.212 11.4 3.5 0.155 0.2 47.5 0.3 0.4 2-6700-... 0.5 7.25 4 0.107 0.6 5.35 4.5 0.095 0.7 3.8 5 0.072 0.8 2.95 6 0.054 1 1.92 7 0.032 1.2 1.32 8 0.02 1.5 0.85 9 < 0.02 1.8 0.59 10 < 0.02 5 Approvals Authority Voltage rating Current rating VDE AC 250 V 0.1...10 A UL AC 250 V, DC 28 V 0.1...15 A (2-6500 only) Semko AC 250 V 0.1...10 A (2-6500 only) Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 275 Motor Protection Controls 2-6500-.../2-6700-... Internal wiring diagram Dimensions 2-6500-P10 (A3) 2-6500-... 6 10.7 3 2 15.7 22 12 8.5 4 P 12° P (3) 4 52 11.5 8.25 44.5 0.5 8.25 2-6700-... P 0.8 ø4 2 8 4 2 3.5 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 10.5 6.3 8 2-6700-P10 10000 45.5 Trip time in seconds 9 ø3 20.5 1000 19.4 4.5 26 0.8 25 8 10.6 11.8 mounting hole 39.5 100 10 6.3 8 1 Accessories for type 2-6500 0.1 1 Water splash cover Y 302 151 01 with flange and holes that may be filed out for cable entry 25 80 15 20 40 The time/current characteristic curve depends on the ambient temperature prevailing. In order to eliminate nuisance tripping, please multiply the circuit breaker current ratings by the derating factor shown below. Ambient temperature °C -10 0 +10 +23 +30 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.84 0.92 1 1 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 29 26 4 6 8 10 … times rated current 5 40 32 5 2 1.5 10 5 23.5 20 276 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Thermal Relay 3620 Description Three pole, voltage-sensitive thermal relay with bimetal operation, auxiliary circuit and manual reset button. Suitable for PCB mounting. Typical applications Motor protection 3620-10 Ordering information Type No. 3620 Three pole thermal relay Configuration 10 standard version Voltage rating 400 V 3620 - 10 - 400 V ordering example Technical data Voltage rating Current rating Auxiliary circuit Excitation voltage Typical life 3 AC 400 V (50/60 Hz) ≤ 10 A 1 A AC 230 V ≤ AC 230 V (50/60 Hz) 1,000 operations at IN Ambient temperture nsulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) 0...+100°C Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 2 reinforced insulation in operating area Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664 A) operating area mounting area circuit/circuit circuit/excitation Issue C ☎ Test voltage AC 4000 V AC 2000 V AC 2000 V AC 2000 V Insulation resistance Trip time at 23 °C Reset time at 23 °C (without load period) Interrupting capacity > 100 MΩ (DC 500 V) < 30 sec Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) IP 00 terminal area IP 40 operating area Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz), ± 0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 15 g (11 ms) to IEC 68-2-27, test Ea Corrosion 48 hours in 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 168 hours at 95 % RH to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 25 g < 80 sec 300 operations with 20 A Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 277 5 Thermal Relay 3620 Internal wiring diagram i 1 3 5 21 k 2 4 6 22 3 15,5 22 6 1 2 4 26,7 5 i (k) 3 k 21 Dimensions 1 4.5 14 22 40° 0.8 1 0.25 5 0.25 1 12.5 5 12.5 12.5 7.5 12.5 7.5 3 35 ø4 1 35 mounting dimensions 12.5±0.1 12.5±0.1 7.5 ±0.1 25±0.2 7.5 ±0.1 5±0,1 5 ø1.5+0.2 ø1.7 +0.2 ø1.5 +0.2 Installation drawing operating area 278 mounting area ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Motor Start Switch 2-7000-... Description Bimetal operated current sensitive relay for disconnection of auxiliary windings and start capacitors of single phase AC motors. The operating time of the auxiliary winding is a function of the starting current and its duration. High contact pressure reduces sensitivity to shock and vibration - no contact sticking. Other features: independent of mounting position and location. Under stalled motor conditions the auxiliary winding and/or the starting capacitor will remain disconnected avoiding damage to the motor. See page 281 for additional information. Typical applications Single phase AC motors 2-7000-... Ordering information Technical data Type No. 2-7000 motor start switch Terminal design P10 blade terminals 6.3-0.8 Housing (optional) KF for tropical and high humidity conditions Current ratings 0.2...10 A Voltage rating AC 250 V, 50/60 Hz Current rating of switching circuit 10 (5) A Ambient temperature 0...+60 °C 2-7000 - P10 - KF - 6 A Insulation co-ordination (IEC 664 and 664A) Rated impulse Pollution withstand voltage degree 2.5 kV 3 ordering example 0.2...10 A Typical life 100,000 operations at 1xIN Dielectric strength (IEC 664 and 664A) Test voltage AC 2,000 V Insulation resistance >100 MΩ (DC 500 V) Interrupting capacity 4 x IN (co-co-co) Degree of protection (IEC 529/DIN 40050) housing IP 30 terminal area IP 00 Internal resistance (Ω) 0.53 Vibration 5 g (57-500 Hz) ±0.38 mm (10-57 Hz) to IEC 68-2-6, test Fc, 10 frequency cycles/axis Shock 25 g (11 ms) test to IEC 68-2-27, Test Ea Corrosion 48 hours at 5 % salt mist to IEC 68-2-11, test Ka Humidity 240 hours at 95 % RH test to IEC 68-2-3, test Ca Mass approx. 18 g Standard current ratings and typical internal resistance values Current rating (A) 2.5 Current rating of excitation circuit Current rating (A) 0.2 Internal resistance (Ω) 91 0.5 16 3 0.435 0.8 6 4 0.342 1 3.65 5 0.27 1.3 2.17 6 < 0.02 1.5 1.62 7 < 0.02 1.8 1.10 8 < 0.02 2 0.97 10 < 0.02 5 Approvals Authority Voltage rating Current rating VDE AC 250 V 0.1...10 A Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 279 Motor Start Switch 2-7000-... Dimensions Internal wiring diagram 1 3 4 52 6.3 2 1 2 44.5 61 3.5 ø3.8 3 8.25 8.5 Typical time/current characteristics at 23 °C 12 8.7 22 10.5 10000 22 1000 Water splash cover Y 302 151 01 with flange and holes that may be filed out for cable entry 100 10 25 80 Trip time in seconds Accessory 15 29 26 5 40 32 1 1.5 10 0.1 5 23.5 20 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 2 4 … times rated current 6 8 10 switching time reset time after 30 s of load The time/current characteristic curve depends on the ambient temperature prevailing. In order to eliminate nuisance tripping, please multiply the circuit breaker current ratings by the derating factor shown below. Ambient temperature °C -10 0 +10 +23 +30 +40 +50 +60 Multiplication factor 0.84 0.92 1 1 1 1.08 1.16 1.24 5 280 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Motor Start Switches Selection of the device The contacts of type 2-7000 will open when energized so that the lowest possible motor current (e.g. the running current of the motor unloaded) must not be less than the current rating of the motor start switch to ensure that the switch will reconnect the auxiliary phase after completion of the starting process. The current rating will determine both the switching characteristics and ratings of the contacts. At the same time the highest possible motor current (short-circuit current at overvoltage) must not exceed 6 times the motor start switch current rating. Normally the A-P-S current rating should be approx. 1/5 of the running current of the motor (see the examples below). Either wiring a or wiring b should be chosen, giving due consideration to these two extreme conditions. Wiring information Wiring with motor start switch (A-P-S) Example for wiring „a“: Current of the motor unloaded (current rating of the motor) 1. Wiring „a“: For this standard connection please observe the following: 3 1 2. Wiring „b“: This special connection is suitable for motors with relatively high short circuit currents: Formula for the motor start switch: Current rating = 1/5 Imax = 1/5 12 = 2.4 A i.e. a motor start switch current rating of 2.5 A (e.g. 2-7000-P10-KF-2.5 A) should be selected. With wiring „a“ the overall current of the motor flows through the bimetal heater (terminal 1). The max. possible current of 12 A is lower than 6 x 2.5 = 15 A, the highest admissible load for the motor start switch. Furthermore the lowest possible motor current (2.6 A) is higher than the motor start switch current rating, ensuring that the auxiliary phase will remain disconnected even when the motor is unloaded. Ha Example for wiring „b“: Current of the motor unloaded:Io = 1.5 A = Imin Other motor data as indicated in example „a“. As in this case the motor start switch current rating must be selected according to the lower minimum current value, only the short-circuit current of the main phase (7 A) may flow through the bimetal heater (terminal 1) in order to prevent overloading. Current rating = 1/5 Ik Ha = 1/5 7 = 1.4 A. i.e. a motor start switch current rating of 1.5 A (e.g. 2-7000-P10-KF-1.5 A) should be selected. The motor start switch rated at 1.5 A must be connected according to wiring „b“. In this case the max. possible load is 7 A, i.e. it is lower than 6 x 1.5 A = 9 A. The current of the motor unloaded (1.5 A) equals the motor start switch current rating - the auxiliary phase will again remain disconnected. A-P-S 3 Mains input: terminal 2 Main phase: terminal 1 Auxiliary phase: terminal 3 1 2 Hi M 1 In this case it is only the main phase current that determines the switching time of the motor start switch. Wiring with Motor Protection Control (M-R): Once the motor has stopped, if an attempt is made to start it P again before the motor start M-R switch has reset, a stall condition will result causing the motor protection control to disconnect the supply. The motor start switch contacts will reset, and the motor may be re-started once the motor start switch has closed again automatically. Wiring with E-T-A Circuit Breaker: This configuration is recommended where the function of the device or equipment is supervised and resetting should only be made manually (e.g. circular saws). Operation of the motor start switch is otherwise the same. Ha 5 A-P-S 2 3 1 2 Hi M 1 Ha E-T-A A-P-S 1 2 3 1 2 Hi M 1 ☎ 2 Hi M 1 The overall starting current of the motor determines the switching time of the motor start switch and must not exceed its max. current capacity. Issue C Short-circuit current of the main phase Ik Ha = 7 A of main and auxiliary phase Ik Ha + Hi = 12 A = Imax A-P-S Mains input: terminal 1 Main phase: terminal 2 Auxiliary phase: terminal 3 Io = 2.6 A = Imin IN = 3.0 A) Ha Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 281 5 282 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827 - 7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) E-T-A solid state remote power controllers combine solid state switching with electronic overload protection and current limiting characteristics. Selected models also include electro-mechanical switching for applications which demand physical contact separation. Physical isolation between control and load circuits is assured through inclusion of an opto-coupler in most models, and all types provide fault status and wire break indication. Advanced thickfilm and hybrid circuitry specially developed and manufactured by E-T-A in-house make a significant contribution to the reliability of these products while ease of installation is achieved through convenient industry standard rail or socket mounting. There is a suitable E-T-A solid state remote power controller for most process control and DC power distribution requirements and characteristics may also be tailored to special circumstances as necessary. All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 283 Overview These products have been designed for the protection of programmable controller outputs, instrumentation, and process control switching circuits. Their performance characteristics are especially suitable for limiting the high in-rush currents associated with solenoids and other high resistance or inductive loads. Versions are also available for power management control in vehicles and marine craft. 6 Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) Overview Type No. 6 E-1048-600.. E-1071-073-... E-1071-128-... Voltage rating of load DC 24 V DC 24 V DC 24 V Current rating of load 0.5 A 1A 2A 4A 0.2 - 3.0 A 0.2 - 3.0 A Short-circuit limitation 25 A (0.5A/1A rating) 75 A (2 A/4 A rating) approx. 2.5 x IN approx. 2.5 x IN Hold current of magnetic coil N/A N/A N/A Operating voltage of SSRPC DC 18 ... 36 V DC 20 ... 48 V DC 20 ... 48 V Display ON indication fault indication control current load current control current minimum current ON indication fault indication Status outputs fault indication via opto coupler (N/O contact) fault indication via auxiliary contact (N/O contact) ON and fault indication via opto coupler after approx. 5 s after approx. 5 s 0 °C ... +60 °C 0 °C ... +60 °C 0 °C ... +60 °C 12/50/65 mm (without socket) 12/80/89 mm (with socket type 17) 45 / 74 / 128 mm 45 / 74 / 128 mm rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 when used with socket 17-P-Si (accessory) rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 Physical isolation of load circuit (after electronic overload disconnection) Temperature range Housing - mounting dimensions (W/H/D) - mounting Other data suitable for lamp load Technical data see pages 287 - 289 284 ☎ monitoring of minimum current, adjustable between 0.1 and 2.1 A see pages 291 - 293 see pages 295 - 297 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) E-1071-353-... E-1071-603/607-... E-1071-803-... DC 48 V DC 24 V DC 24 V DC 24 V 0.2 - 3.0 A parallel operation: max. 4 A 0.2 - 3.0 A parallel operation: max. 4 A adjustable betw. 0.1 and 3.1 A 0.25 A 0.40 A 1A 2A 3A approx 2.5 x IN approx. 2.5 x IN approx. 3.5 x IN approx. 3.5 x IN N/A N/A adjustable between 0.06 A and 1.85 A adjustable between DC 36 ... 60 V DC 20 ... 48 V max. DC 60 V max. DC 60 V control current load current control current load current control current O.K. wire break fault control current load current wire break fault indication via auxiliary contact (N/O) fault indication via auxiliary contact (N/O) ON and fault indication via opto coupler fault indication via auxiliary contact (N/O) after approx. 5 s after approx. 5 s after approx. 5 s after approx. 5 s 0 °C ...+60 °C 0 °C ... +60 °C 0 °C ... +60 °C 0 °C ... +60 °C 45 / 74 / 128 mm 45 / 74 / 128 mm 45 / 74 / 128 mm 45 / 74 /128 mm rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 rail to EN 50022-35x7.5 double unit double unit load current control load current control see pages 299 - 301 see pages 303 - 305 see pages 307 - 309 see pages 311 - 313 Issue C ☎ ( 3 ... 6 W) ( 6 ... 10 W) (15 ... 30 W) (30 ... 50 W) (50 ... 75 W) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 0.06 A 0.1 A 0.25 A 0.5 A 0.75 A and and and and and 0.18 A 0.3 A 0.75 A 1.5 A 2.25 A Overview E-1071-343-... 6 285 Solid State Remote Power Controllers (SSRPCs) E-1071-073 E-1071-128 E-1071-343 E-1071-353 E-1071-603 E-1071-607 E-1071-803 Type No. E-1048-600 Selector chart ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Control circuit Control voltage DC 24 V Max. switching frequency fmax 1 Hz ● ● ● ● ● ● 10 Hz ● 100 Hz 500 Hz ● ● ● ● Load circuit ● PNP transistor output, plus switching NPN transistor output, minus switching Current rating 0.5 A ● 1A ● 2A ● 3A 4A ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Load current max. 0.25 A ● (adjustable, pulse-controlled hold current) max. 0.4 A ● max. 1 A ● max. 2 A ● ● max. 3 A max. 3.1 A ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Physical isolation under fault conditions (short-circuit, overload) ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Physical isolation by hand release ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Reverse polarity protection UB (terminal 1 - terminal 2) ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Short-circuit current, self-limiting ● ● Fault signal output ● Opto coupler ● ● Auxiliary contact (N/O) ● LED ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Constructional features Double unit Overview Current measuring terminals Connection ● Blade terminals Screw terminals ● ● Screw-less connectors 6 286 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1048-600 Description The E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controller (SSRPC) E-1048-600 is an opto decoupled transistorised switching device providing both protection and signalisation. It may be used wherever safe switching and protection of resistive, inductive or lamp loads in DC voltage systems is required. E-1048-600 Technical data (TA = 25 °C; at UN) Typical applications Automation - interface module providing inexpensive power amplification at PLC outputs - optimum protection of individual loads by monitoring the load circuit Protection and control of - motors - solenoids - lamps Load circuit Voltage rating UB Current rating IN Closed-circuit current IS Min. load current Voltage drop UDSmax Overload disconnection Short-circuit current (self-limiting) Features ● Optimum load protection. Available in current ratings of 0.5 A; 1 A; 2 A; 4 A. ● Fast short-circuit limitation and disconnection ● Time/current dependent overload disconnection ● Remote control ● Fault indication: LED and signal output for overload/short-circuit signalization, and wire break indication in the OFF condition. ● Physically isolated fault indication. ● Compact plug-in type Ordering information Type No. E-1048 Solid State Remote Power Controller Version 600 with physically isolated control input and fault indication output Voltage rating DC 24 V DC 24 V (standard) Current ratings 0.5 A 1.0 A 2.0 A 4.0 A Short-circuit disconnection Control circuit Voltage rating Voltage controlled input UE DC 24 V (18...36 V) 0.5 A; 1 A; 2 A, 4 A (other ratings to special order) typically 0.3 mA > 1 mA 0.15 V; 0.3 V; 0.1 V; 0.2 V approx. 1.4 x IN after approx. 100 ms max. 25 A (with 0.5 A and 1 A current ratings) max. 75 A (with 2 A and 4 A current ratings) <250 µs DC 24 V DC 0 V < low level < 5 V DC 8.5 V < high level < 36 V 1...10 mA (18...36 V) 500 Hz Input current IE Max. switching frequency fmax Reset time after shortcircuit/overload disconnection 1 ms Fault indication output (opto coupler) Voltage rating range DC 5...36 V Max. load current 100 mA (∆U < 2 V), with reverse polarity protection Wire break indication < 100 µA load current General data Temperature range 0 °C ... +60 °C Insulation voltage 2.5 kV rms (IEC 664/VDE 0110) Mass 28 g Connection diagram 6 green E-1048 - 600 DC24 V 1.0 A ordering example E-1048-600 1 control circuit fault indication circuit IN+ INF+ F- +UB 2 5 7 Control and Protection Electronics 4 Q Load Where wire break and LED indication is not required, please contact us for a thermal-magnetic circuit breaker (e.g. types 2210, 3600, 3900). 3 6 -UB red Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 287 Solid State Remote Power Controller E 1048-600 Derating curve IN 0 10 30 20 40 50 60 ambient temperature (°C) Typical time/current characteristics 0.5 A and 1 A 1000 100 Trip time in ms At the appropriate input level (>8.5 V), the opto decoupled input in the SSRPC will switch on a power transistor to connect the load to the plus pole of the load circuit supply (UB). The transistor will switch off when - the control voltage (UE) is removed - there is a short-circuit/overload in the load circuit. Status indication is provided by two LEDs (red and green). Thermal-magnetic overload protection occurs at approx. 1.4 times rated current. See time/current characteristic curves. The SSRPC is fitted with blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 and is suitable for plug-in mounting with various E-T-A sockets. Control circuit ON condition: If a voltage higher than 8.5 V is applied to the input terminals (-IN, +IN), the control current (from the PLC) will flow through the opto coupler.The output transistor will be conductive. OFF condition: A control voltage lower than 5 V will switch the output transistor off. Load circuit The load circuit switches depending on the control signal (“0” or “1”). It is electronically monitored for faults. In the event of a short-circuit the circuit is disconnected after max. 250 µs whilst upon inadmissible overload it is disconnected according to the time/current curves shown. Fault indication output The fault indication circuit (F+, F-) is opto decoupled from the load and control circuit. In the OFF condition (i.e. 0 < UE < 5 V), this circuit will provide wire break indication, with the transistor output being open. In the ON condition, the circuit will provide short-circuit and overload monitoring and indication. load current (A) Technical description 10 Status indication Status indication Fault indication output (opto coupler) LED green red 1 current limitation Non-conductive, no duty 0.1 Conductive, normal duty Overload or short circuit at the output IN 10 20 30 I (A) 2 A and 4 A Wire break, in the OFF condition 1000 Trip time in ms Dimensions 6 10 56 R 66 100 1 1 4 6 3 LED red 7 5 2 current limitation LED green 11.5 0.1 50 288 ☎ IN 20 40 60 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 80 I (A) Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E 1048-600 Accessories for E 1048-600 Single mounting sockets with adapter 17-P10-Si 17-P10-Si-20025 (retaining clip Y 300 581 11 available on request) slot fitting labels from Phoenix ZB, RBS, DST Weidmüller dekafix, BS, PES Wieland Type 9003 Connector bus links -P10 X 210 588 01/1.5 mm2 brown X 210 588 02/2.5 mm2 black X 210 588 03/2.5 mm2 red X 210 588 04/2.5 mm2 blue blade terminals DIN 46244 part 2 C profile (2xA2.8-0.8) retaining clip 100 quick-connect tabs 6.3 DIN 46247 Ms tinned, insulated 6.5 80 ~70 45.8 41.3 5 1.4 33.3 25.8 8.5 depth 10 mm 10 12.5 symmetrical rail EN 50022-35x7.5 adapter X20040901 G-profile EN 50035-G32 2 mounting clips Y 300 504 02 Installation drawing with mounting clips Y 300 504 02 polarization recess Single mounting sockets 17-P70-Si, same as 17-P10-Si, but with blade terminals to DIN 46 244-C-Ms (2x A 2.8 - 0.8) 1 0.5 cylinder head screw M4x4 ISO1207 nickel plated washer A 4.3 DIN 125 nickel plated 8.5 12.5 60.4 2 Phoenix terminal AKG 35 (max.cross section 35 mm2) 2 7.5 1.9 2 Bus bar for type 17 socket (for max. 100 A continuous load) X 211 157 01 with terminal X 211 157 02 without terminal 7.3 M4 Cu rail, tin-plated 8 50 female connector M4 20 10 16.5 12.8 7 fusible link (1.1 mm thick constriction) 154.8 Insulated sleeving for bus bar Y 303 824 01 9 5.4 17 125 2-way mounting socket 23-P10-Si 6 6-way mounting socket 63-P10-Si (retaining clip Y300 581 03 available on request) polarized blade terminals DIN 46244-A6.3-0.8 7.4 22.2 21 10 7.4 6.25 50 57.4 64 50 57.4 64 12.5 25 12.5 50 75 12.5 retaining clip 3.5 6 x 6.8 = 40.8 6.8 4.4 4.4 2 6 30 polarized recess Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 289 6 290 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-073 Description The E-T-A Remote Power Controller E-1071-073 is an electronic ON/ OFF control module with protective functions and is suitable for resistive and inductive loads such as solenoids in rolling mills and other large plant applications. It is specifically used in plant modernization where the load circuit supply should be maintained at DC 24 V. E-1071-073 Technical data (TA = 25 °C, UB = DC 24 V) Typical applications Control of hydraulic and pneumatic sytems in production lines and chemical plants. Voltage rating UN Operating voltage UB Current rating IN Current consumption (UB = DC 24 V, Us = “0”) Residual ripple for all voltages Reverse polarity protection UB (terminal 1 - terminal 2) Physical isolation Features ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Solid-state relay with protective functions Solid-state switching avoids contact arcing and welding Inrush current limitation Overload and short-circuit proof output Low control power Control current indication by LED Auxiliary contact Load circuit Load output Load rating Voltage drop at IN Overload disconnection Storage time ts (at 2xIN) Short-circuit limitation Short-circuit response delay Load current monitoring Current measuring terminals Leakage current (US = “O”) Free-wheeling diode Control circuit Control Control voltage US Control current IS Switching frequency fmax Control signal (US = “1”) Protection Signal output Fault indication Ordering information Type No. E-1071 SSRPC 073 with signal output Voltage rating of load DC 24 V Current rating 3.0 A E-1071 - 073 - DC 24 V - 3.0 A General data Ambient temperature Terminals Housing Mounting Self-extinguishing properties Degree of protection ordering example Mounting dimensions Mass Issue C ☎ DC 24 V DC 20...48 V 3A typically 17 mA max. 5 % (3 phase bridge) double pole relay 2-pole - by circuit breaker hand release - approx. 5 s after overload disconnection NPN transistor, minus switching DC 24 V/0.2...3 A max. 1.75 V approx. 1.1 x IN typically 20 ms (see storage time curve) approx. 2.5 x IN approx. 4 µs GREEN LED (lights at Iload > 0.2 A) 2 x 2 mm dia. (shunt 0.1 Ω ± 1 %) max. 3 mA integral opto coupler in control input “0” = 0 ... 5 V “1” = 8.5...35 V typically 5 mA 100 Hz YELLOW LED lights (IS flowing) reverse polarity protection (diode) auxiliary contact (N/O) - max. DC 30 V/3 A - physically isolated - closed with the circuit breaker tripped 6 0...+60 °C (without condensation) screw terminals 2x2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 clamping plate: polycarbonate GV, blue cover: polycarbonate, black top-hat rail to DIN 50022-35 to UL 94: V = 0; VDE 0304: grade 1 IP 20 housing, terminals (IEC 529/DIN 40050) 45 x 74 x 128 mm approx. 240 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 291 Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-073 Technical description Operating modes In principle, the E-T-A SSRPC E-1071-073 operates like conventional electro-mechanical relays, with additional protective and signal functions. The control input replaces the magnetic coil and the power transistor replaces the main contact. Control circuit The control current flows through the LED and the opto coupler immediately a voltage higher than 8.5 V is applied at the input terminals (6 and 7). The opto coupler transmits the signal to the load circuit, at the same time switching the load transistor on. This signal is transmitted as a status signal to all monitoring circuits. The input protection diode protects the control voltage from incorrect polarization. Control current limitation is provided by a constant current diode. Load circuit The load circuit is switched ON or OFF according to the control signal (“0” or “1”), with electronic circuits monitoring the load circuit for faults such as overload or short-circuit. Should one of these faults occur, the monitoring circuitry will immediately react, causing the load transistor to disconnect and the circuit breaker to trip. Transistor disconnection occurs according to the storage time characteristics. The storage time increases noise immunity avoiding disconnection of non-harmful peaks such as those caused by inrush currents from lamp load connection. Storage time is not a constant quantity but is inversely proportional to the overcurrent factor. Operating status Fault-free Short-circuit Wire break operation of the load Control input US “0” “1” “1” “0” “1” YELLOW LED control current 0 1 1 0 1 GREEN LED load current monitoring 0 1 0 0 0 open open Auxiliary contact open open closed Remarks load OFF load circuit breaker ON tripped 1 = LED indicates 0 = LED does not indicate Status indication Status indication is provided by 2 LEDs (yellow and green) on the front of the housing. YELLOW LED = correct control voltage The LED indicates when the control voltage is higher than 8.5 V, with control current flowing. GREEN LED = correct load current The green LED indicates when the load current is higher than 0.2 A. Faults such as too high a load resistance, wire break, poor contact, or overload/short-circuit, are available when only the yellow LED indicates. SSRPC E-1071-073 includes two current measuring terminals (2 mm dia.) on the front. These terminals provide for load current measurement in terms of voltage drop at the 0.1 shunt in the load circuit. time in ms Storage time characteristic curve 1000 6 100 20 10 5 IN 2 3 current limitation 292 ☎ 4 5 x IN (theoretical overcurrent factor) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-073 Dimensions Terminal selection 1 3 Halbleiterrelais 1071 - 073 4 MELDER ISt IMIN Shunt 0,1Ω + - 20 … 48 V 3A 6 7 8 9 2 3 4 5 5 73.2 2 70 1 Halbleiterrelais 1071 - 073 ISt IMIN Shunt 0.1Ω + 10 6 Basic circuit diagram DC 8.5 … 35 V RL DC 20 … 48 V 7- +1 2- 8 yellow 9 3 4 Shunt 0.1 Ω control input - 20 … 48 V 3A 124 45 +6 MELDER 7 8 9 10 Terminal 1 operating voltage +UB: DC 20...48 V 2 operating voltage -UB 3 load (+) 4 load (-) 5 not used 6 control voltage +US: max. DC 35 V 7 control voltage -US 8 auxiliary contact 9 auxiliary contact 10 not used isolator electronics green IMIN 1071 - 073 6 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 293 6 294 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-128 Description The E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-128 is an electronic ON/OFF control module with protective and signalling functions. It is suitable for inductive loads (solenoids, magnetic brakes) when the load circuit supply cannot be increased to the voltage level required for the adjustable controller E-1071-603. The operating status of the controller/load connected is continuously indicated and signalled via opto coupler. E-1071-128 Technical data (TA = 25 °C, UB = DC 24 V) Typical applications Control of hydraulic and pneumatic sytems in production lines and chemical plants where check-back signals for process control systems are needed. Voltage rating UN Operating voltage UB Current rating IN Current consumption (UB = DC 24 V, US = “0”) Residual ripple for all voltages Reverse polarity protection UB (terminal 1 - terminal 2) Physical isolation Features ● Overcurrent and short-circuit proof switching output by electronic current limitation ● Switch-off current largely independent of operating voltage ● Inrush current limitation ● Physical isolation between control and load circuit via opto coupler ● Low control power; control current indication by LED ● Solid state switching avoids contact arcing and welding ● 2-pole physical isolation upon overload or when tripped manually ● Opto decoupled ON and fault indication by LED ● Setting of minimum current on front of housing, with minimum current indication (set at approx. 50 % of the load current rating) ● Current measuring terminals on front of housing ● Reverse polarity protection in control and load circuit Control current Switching frequency fmax Control signal (US = “1”) Protection Status outputs 2 signal outputs Ordering information Type No. E-1071 SSRPC 128 Voltage rating of load DC 24 V Current rating 3.0 A E-1071 - 128 - DC 24 V - 3.0 A Load circuit Load output Load rating Voltage drop at IN Overload disconnection Storage time ts (at 2xIN) Short-circuit limitation Short-circuit response delay Load current monitoring Imin (MIN monitoring, to be set by potentiometer at 50 % of the load current rating) Current measuring terminals Leakage current (US= “O”) Free-wheeling diode Control circuit Control Control voltage US ON indication (terminal 8) ordering example Fault indication (terminal 9) Issue C ☎ DC 24 V DC 20...48 V 3A typically 15 mA max. 5 % (3 phase bridge) double pole relay 2-pole - by manual release (circuit breaker) - approx. 5 s after overload disconnection NPN transistor, minus switching DC 24 V/0.2...3 A max. 2 V approx. 1.1 x IN typically 20 ms (see storage time curve) approx. 2.5 x IN approx. 4 µs GREEN LED lights at Iload> 0.2 Imin. switch position I: 0.1...1.1 A switch position II: 1.1 ...2.1 A 2 x 2 mm dia. (shunt 0.1 Ω ± 1 %) max. 3 mA integral opto coupler in control input “0” = 0 ... 5 V “1” = 8.5...35 V typically 5 mA 10 Hz YELLOW LED lights (IS flowing) reverse polarity protection (diode) ON indication/fault indication - physically isolated by opto coupler - transistor outputs plus switching - max. DC 33 V/100 mA per output - integral free-wheeling diode - 20 ms time delay (eliminating false signals before the minimum current is reached) US = “0”: output non-conductive US = “1”: output connecting plus potential (terminal 10) to terminal 8 fault: output non-conductive no fault: output connecting plus potential (terminal 10) to terminal 9 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 295 6 Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-128 Storage time characteristic curve General data Ambient temperature Terminals 0...+60 °C (without condensation) screw terminals 2x2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 clamping plate: polycarbonate GV, blue cover: polycarbonate, black top-hat rail to DIN 50022-35 to UL 94: V = 0; VDE 0304: grade 1 IP 20 housing, terminals (IEC 529/DIN 40050) 45 x 74 x 128 mm approx. 320 g Housing Mounting Burning behaviour (housing) Degree of protection Mounting dimensions Mass Technical description In principle, the E-T-A SSRPC E-1071-128 operates like conventional electro-mechanical relays, with additional protective and signalling functions. The control input replaces the magnetic coil and the power transistor replaces the main contact. ON and fault indication outputs have more complex functions and may not be compared with auxiliary contacts. Control circuit The control current flows through the LED and the opto coupler immediately a voltage higher than 8.5 V is applied at the input terminals (6 and 7). The opto coupler transmits the signal to the load circuit, at the same time switching the load transistor on. This signal is transmitted as a status signal to all monitoring circuits. The input protection diode protects the control voltage from incorrect polarization. Control current limitation is provided by a constant current diode. Load circuit The load circuit is switched ON or OFF according to the control signal (“0” or “1”), with electronic circuits monitoring the load circuit for faults such as overload or short-circuit. Should one of these faults occur, the monitoring circuitry will immediately react, causing the load transistor to disconnect and the circuit breaker to trip. Transistor disconnection occurs according to the storage time characteristics. The storage time increases noise immunity avoiding disconnection of non-harmful peaks such as those caused by inrush currents from lamp load connection. Storage time is not a constant quantity but is inversely proportional to the overcurrent factor. Signal circuit The signal circuit includes two opto couplers signalising either correct ON duty or a fault. These signals may be computer processed. - The ON signal output indicates correct operating in the ON condition. This output is conductive time in ms Technical data 1000 100 20 10 5 IN 2 3 4 current limitation 5 x IN (theoretical overcurrent factor) Operating modes Operating status Fault-free operation Short-circuit of the load Wire break Load current <minimum current Control input US “0” “1” “0” “1” “0” “1” “0” “1” YELLOW LED control current 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 GREEN LED min. current indication 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 GREEN LED ON indication 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 RED LED fault indication 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 load OFF load ON Remarks phys. isolation no load after connected, approx. 5 s wire break when control voltage is available AND AND AND 6 the load current is higher than the set minimum current the circuit breaker has not tripped there is no wire break. - The fault signal output signalises the fault source which must be eliminated. This output is non-conductive when OR OR OR the circuit breaker has tripped on overload or short-circuit there is a wire break control voltage is available AND the minimum current has not been reached no control voltage is applied although the load current is available. The fault signal output operates on the closed-circuit principle, i.e. it carries plus potential during fault-free operation. 1 = LED indicates 0 = LED does not indicate Status outputs ON Terminal 8 Fault Terminal 9 Remark 0 0 wire break or load current < minimum current (switched on) or short-circuit (switched on) 0 1 fault-free operation (switched off) 1 1 fault-free operation (switched on) 1 - status output carries plus potential 0 - status output carries minus potential 296 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-128 Dimensions Terminal selection 1 2 3 4 5 ISoll 1 2 3 4 5 ISoll 1.1 0.1 0.9 0.7 0.3 0.5 I 24 V/3 A Shunt 0.1Ω + S B 73.2 II 70 I ISt 7 8 9 0.3 0.5 I II ISt Shunt 0.1Ω + S I I = 0.1 - 1.1 A II = 1.1 - 2.1 A - MELDER 6 0.1 0.9 0.7 1071 - 128 1071 - 128 I = 0.1 - 1.1 A II = 1.1 - 2.1 A 1.1 24 V/3 A B MELDER 10 124 45 6 Basic circuit diagram DC 8.5 … 35 V +6 7- RL DC 20 … 48 V +1 2- 3 4 yellow control input Shunt 0.1 Ω isolator 7 8 9 10 Terminal 1 operating voltage +UB: DC 20...48 V 2 operating voltage -UB 3 load (+) 4 load (-) 5 auxiliary voltage -UA for status outputs 6 control voltage +US: max. DC 35 V 7 control voltage -US 8 ON status output (max. 100 mA) 9 fault status output (max. 100 mA) 10 auxiliary voltage +UA for status outputs: max. DC 33 V electronics green outputs logic I min red ON fault green 1071 - 128 I II 0.1 … 1.1 A 1.1 … 2.1 A + 10 8 -5 9 24 V/ 100 mA 6 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 297 6 298 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-343 Description The E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-343 is a double relay with protective function both for resistive and inductive DC 48 V loads. It is particularly suitable to control upward/downward and forward/ backward movements. Failure of one channel will also cause the other channel to disconnect. E-1071-343 Technical data (TA = 25 °C, UB = DC 48 V) Typical applications - Valve timing gears for forward/backward or upward/downward movements (overlapping operation is possible) Parallel circuits which must be completely disconnected after failure of one of the circuits. Voltage rating UN Operating voltage UB Current rating IN Current consumption (UB = DC 48 V, US = “0”) Residual ripple for all voltages Reverse polarity protection UB (terminal 1 - terminal 2) Physical isolation Features ● Small double relay with protective function ● Overcurrent and short-circuit proof outputs ● Two pole physical isolation of both channels - approx. 5 s after electronic fault disconnection - by manual release ● Both part units are disconnected upon isolator tripping ● Current load of each unit: max. 3 A; total current max. 4 A ● Electrical isolation between control and load circuit by means of opto coupler ● Control current indication by RED LED ● Load current indication by GREEN LED ● With auxiliary contact (fault indication) ● Temperature disconnection Ordering information Type No. E-1071 SSRPC 343 double unit Voltage rating of load DC 48 V Current rating 3A / 3A E-1071 - 343 - DC 48 V - 3A / 3A Issue C ☎ ordering example DC 48 V DC 36...60 V 3 A/3 A (2 A + 2 A) typically 21 mA max. 5 % (3 phase bridge) double pole relay 2-pole - by manual circuit breaker release - approx. 5 s after overload disconnection - upon thermal response (approx. 130 °C) Load circuits (I/II) Load output Load rating NPN transistor, minus switching DC 48 V/0.2...3 A per channel parallel duty max. 4 A (e.g. 2 A + 2 A) Voltage drop at IN max. 1.8 V Overload disconnection approx. 1.1 x IN Storage time ts (at 2xIN) typically 20 ms (see storage time curve) Short-circuit limitation approx. 2.5 x IN Short-circuit response delay approx. 4 µs Load current monitoring GREEN LED lights at Iload > 0.1 A) Current measuring terminals 3 x 4 mm dia. (0.1 Ω shunt) Leakage current (US = “O”) max. 3 mA Free-wheeling diode integral Control circuits (I/II) Control opto coupler in control input Control voltage US “0” = 0 ... 5 V “1” = 8.5...35 V Control current typically 5 mA Switching frequency fmax 100 Hz Control signal (US = „1“) RED LED lights (Is flowing) Protection reverse polarity protection (diode) Signal output Fault indication auxiliary contact (N/O) - max. DC 30 V/3 A - physically isolated - closed when the circuit breaker has tripped General data Ambient temperature 0...+60 °C (without condensation) Terminals screw terminals 2x2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 Housing clamping plate: polycarbonate GV, blue; cover: polycarbonate, black Mounting top-hat rail to DIN 50022-35 Self-extinguishing properties to UL 94: V = 0; VDE 0304: grade 1 Degree of protection IP 20 housing, terminals (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Mounting dimensions 45 x 74 x 128 mm Mass approx. 320 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 299 6 Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-343 Technical description Storage time characteristic curve Control circuits (I/II) The control current flows through the LED and the opto coupler immediately a voltage higher than 8.5 V is applied at the input terminals (6 and 7, or 10 and 7). The opto coupler transmits the signal to the load circuit, at the same time switching the load transistor on. This signal is transmitted as a status signal to all monitoring circuits. The input protection diode protects the control voltage from incorrect polarization. Control current limitation is provided by a constant current diode. Load circuits (I/II) The load circuit is switched ON or OFF according to the control signal (“0” or “1”), with electronic circuits monitoring the load circuit for faults such as overload or short-circuit. Should one of these faults occur, the monitoring circuitry will immediately react, causing the load transistor to disconnect and the circuit breaker to trip. Transistor disconnection occurs according to the storage time characteristics. The storage time increases noise immunity avoiding disconnection of non-harmful peaks such as those caused by inrush currents from lamp load connection. Storage time is not a constant quantity but is inversely proportional to the overcurrent factor. time in ms Under normal operating conditions, the E-T-A SSRPC E-1071-343 allows the connection and disconnection of the load outputs of two channels independent of each other. 1000 100 20 10 5 IN After expiration of the storage time (see diagram) the load circuit transistor will become non-conductive. After approx. 5 s the isolator will switch off so as to disconnect the two load circuits. The common auxiliary contact closes signalling the fault. After removal of the fault, the SSRPC can be reactivated by pushing the isolator button. Status outputs Status indication is provided by 4 LEDs (2 x RED, 2 x GREEN). RED LED ON indication (I/II) The red LED indicates when the control voltage is higher than 8.5 V, with control current flowing. 4 current limitation 5 x IN (theoretical overcurrent factor) Operating modes Operating status Faults such as too high a resistance, wire break, poor contact, or overload/short-circuit, are available when only the red LED indicates. Control input RED LED Control current GREEN LED Load current monitoring Auxiliary contact Remarks The SSRPC E-1071-343 includes three current measuring terminals (4 mm dia.) on the front. These terminals provide for load current measurement in terms of voltage drop at the 0.1 Ω shunt in the load circuit (I/II). 1 - LED indicates 0 - LED does not indicate GREEN LED Current flow indication (I/II) The green LED indicates when the load current is above 0.1 A. 3 2 Fault-free Short-circuit operation on the load Wire break “0” 0 “1” 1 “1” 1 “0” 0 “1” 1 0 1 0 0 0 open load OFF open closed open open load both load circuits ON disconnected 6 300 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-343 Dimensions Terminal selection 1 1 2 3 4 2 3 4 5 5 IM I IM I 70 73.2 ISt + Doppelhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 343 0,1 IM 0,1 - II 6 IM ISt + 48 V 3/3 A ISt + Doppelhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 343 II 7 8 9 + 48 V 3/3 A 10 ISt 124 45 6 8 +1 -2 +6 red - I 0.1 Ω + 4 3 green logic -IK -Itotal -Tmax + 10 II red 5 load 1 isolator logic I load 2 -7 green 8 9 10 Terminal 1 operating voltage +UB: DC 36...60 V 2 operating voltage -UB 3 load (+) (carrying plus potential) CAUTION: Do not connect to GND/-UB 4 load I (-) 5 load II (-) 6 control voltage I +US: max. DC 35 V 7 control voltage I, II -US 8 auxiliary contact 9 auxiliary contact 10 auxiliary voltage II +US: max. DC 35 V Basic circuit diagram 9 7 II + 0.1 Ω 1071 - 3.. 6 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 301 6 302 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-353 Description The E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-353 is a double relay with protective function both for resistive and inductive DC 24 V loads. It is particularly suitable to control upward/downward and forward/ backward movements. Failure of one channel will also cause the other channel to disconnect. E-1071-353 Technical data (TA = 25 °C, UB = DC 24 V) Typical applications - Valve timing gears for forward/backward or upward/downward movements (overlapping operation is possible) Parallel circuits which must be completely disconnected upon failure of one of the circuits. Voltage rating UN Operating voltage UB Current rating IN Current consumption (UB = DC 24 V, US = “0”) Residual ripple for all voltages Reverse polarity protection UB (terminal 1 - terminal 2) Physical isolation Features ● Small double relay with protective function ● Overcurrent and short-circuit proof outputs ● Two pole physical isolation of both channels - approx. 5 s after electronic disconnection of a fault - by manual release ● Both part units are disconnected upon the isolator tripping ● Current load of each unit: max. 3 A; total current max. 4 A ● Electrical isolation between control and load circuit by means of opto coupler ● Control current indication by RED LED ● Load current indication by GREEN LED ● With auxiliary contact (fault indication) ● Temperature disconnection Ordering information Type No. E-1071 SSRPC 353 double unit Voltage rating of load DC 24 V Current rating 3A / 3A E-1071 - 353 - DC 24 V - 3A / 3A Issue C ☎ ordering example DC 24 V DC 20...48 V 3 A/3 A (2 A + 2 A) typically 30 mA max. 5 % (3 phase bridge) double pole relay 2-pole - by manual circuit breaker release - approx. 5 s after overload disconnection - upon thermal response (approx. 130 °C) Load circuits (I/II) Load output Load rating NPN transistor, minus switching DC 24 V/0.2...3 A per channel parallel duty max. 4 A (e.g. 2 A + 2 A) max. 1.8 V Voltage drop at IN Overload disconnection approx. 1.1 x IN Storage time ts (at 2xIN) typically 20 ms (see storage time curve) Short-circuit limitation approx. 2.5 x IN Short-circuit response delay approx. 4 µs Load current monitoring GREEN LED lights at Iload > 0.1 A Current measuring terminals 3 x 4 mm dia. (shunt 0.1 Ω ±1 %) Leakage current (US = “O”) max. 3 mA Free-wheeling diode integral Control circuits (I/II) Control opto coupler in control input Control voltage US “0” = 0 ... 5 V “1” = 8.5...35 V Control current IS typically 5 mA Switching frequency fmax 100 Hz Control signal (US = “1”) RED LED lights (Is flowing) Protection reverse polarity protection (diode) Signal output Fault indication auxiliary contact (N/O) - max. DC 30 V/3 A - physically isolated - closed when the circuit breaker has tripped General data Ambient temperature 0...+60 °C (without condensation) Terminals screw terminals 2x2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 Housing clamping plate: polycarbonate GV, blue; cover: polycarbonate, black Mounting top-hat rail to DIN 50022-35 Self-extinguishing properties to UL 94: V = 0; VDE 0304: grade 1 Degree of protection IP 20 housing, terminals (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Mounting dimensions 45 x 74 x 128 mm Mass approx. 320 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 303 6 Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-353 Technical description Storage time characteristic curve Control circuits (I/II) The control current flows through the LED and the opto coupler immediately a voltage higher than 8.5 V is applied at the input terminals (6 and 7, or 10 and 7). The opto coupler transmits the signal to the load circuit, at the same time switching the load transistor on. This signal is transmitted as a status signal to all monitoring circuits. The input protection diode protects the control voltage from incorrect polarization. Control current limitation is provided by a constant current diode. Load circuits (I/II) The load circuit is switched ON or OFF according to the control signal (“0” or “1”), with electronic circuits monitoring the load circuit for faults such as overload or short-circuit. Should one of these faults occur, the monitoring circuitry will immediately react, causing the load transistor to disconnect and the circuit breaker to trip. Transistor disconnection occurs according to the storage time characteristics. The storage time increases noise immunity avoiding disconnection of non-harmful peaks such as those caused by inrush currents from lamp load connection. Storage time is not a constant quantity but is inversely proportional to the overcurrent factor. After expiration of the storage time (see diagram) the load circuit transistor will become non-conductive. After approx. 5 s the isolator will switch off so as to disconnect the two load circuits. The common auxiliary contact closes signalling the fault. After removal of the fault, the SSRPC can be reactivated by pushing the isolator button. Status outputs Status indication is provided by 4 LEDs (2 x RED, 2 x GREEN). RED LED ON indication (I/II) The red LED indicates when the control voltage is higher than 8.5 V, with control current flowing. GREEN LED Current flow indication (I/II) The green LED indicates when the load current is above 0.1 A. Faults such as too high a resistance, wire break, poor contact, or overload/short-circuit, are available when only the red LED indicates. The SSRPC E-1071-353 includes three current measuring terminals (4 mm dia.) on the front. These terminals provide for load current measurement in terms of voltage drop at the 0.1 Ω shunt in the load circuit (I/II). time in ms Under normal operating conditions, the E-T-A SSRPC E-1071-353 allows the connection or disconnection of the load outputs of two channels independent of each other. 1000 100 20 10 5 IN 3 2 4 current limitation 5 x IN (theoretical overcurrent factor) Operating modes Operating status Control input RED LED control current GREEN LED Load current monitoring Auxiliary contact Remarks Fault-free Short-circuit operation on the load Wire break “0” 0 “1” 1 “1” 1 “0” 0 “1” 1 0 1 0 0 0 open load OFF open load ON closed open open both load circuits disconnected 1 - LED indicates 0 - LED does not indicate 6 304 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-353 Dimensions Terminal selection 1 1 2 3 4 2 3 4 5 5 IM I 70 73.2 ISt 0.1Ω - ISt + Doppelhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 353 IM I + Doppelhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 353 0.1Ω IM IM II + 24 V 3/3 A II ISt + 24 V 3/3 A 6 7 8 9 ISt 10 124 45 6 8 +1 -2 +6 red - I 0.1 Ω + 4 3 green logic -IK -Itotal -Tmax + 10 II red 5 load 1 isolator logic I load 2 -7 green 8 9 10 Terminal 1 operating voltage + UB: DC 20...48 V 2 operating voltage -UB 3 load (+) (carrying plus potential) CAUTION: Do not connect to GND/-UB 4 load I (-) 5 load II (-) 6 control voltage I +US: max. DC 35 V 7 control voltage I, II -US 8 auxiliary contact 9 auxiliary contact 10 auxiliary voltage II +US: max. DC 35 V Basic circuit diagram 9 7 II + 0.1 Ω 1071 - 3.. 6 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 305 6 306 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controllers E-1071-603/607 Description The E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controllers E-1071-603/607 are electronic control modules suitable for inductive loads such as solenoids, magnetic brakes etc. They are used ● for safe and quick switching of loads ● for monitoring the electrical condition of the loads ● for compensating different cable lengths The load connected to the relay should be operated with a voltage higher than its rated voltage (DC 24 V) because the load current is controlled electronically (pulse-controlled characteristics). This is to ensure that in industrial plants with different cable lengths (supply cables, load cables) an increased inrush current can be applied to each load. During hold duty the load current is reduced to a smaller value (approx. 60 % of the current rating), thus reducing the operating temperature and extending the life of the loads. E-1071-603 Technical data (TA = 25 °C, UB = DC 36 V) Typical applications Circuits with inductive load such as - solenoids - magnetic brakes etc. in large plants, e.g. rolling mills where a very high availability is required. Features ● Designed for inductive loads (DC 24 V) ● Individual adjustment to various load currents (IN = 0.1...3.1 A) ● Significant reduction of power loss in the load by pulse-controlled characteristics ● Short-circuit proof (short-circuit limitation); physical disconnection from supply after approx. 5 s ● Inrush current monitoring ● Physical isolation: - opto coupler in the control circuit - physical disconnection from supply - opto coupler for status outputs ● Reverse polarity and overvoltage protection in the control, load and status circuits ● Control current indication by YELLOW LED ● O.K. indication by GREEN LED ● Wire break indication by RED LED (load circuit) ● Fault indication by RED LED (incorrect setting etc.) ● Two status outputs for PLCs for function indication (function signal, ON signal) ● Temperature disconnection ● Quick disconnection (do not connect free-wheeling diodes to the load as the free-wheeling current is controlled electronically!) Ordering information Type No. E-1071 SSRPC Terminals 603 screw terminals 607 screw-less connectors to Wago licence Voltage rating of load DC 24 V Current rating 0.1 ... 3.1 A E-1071 - 603 - DC 24 V - 0.1 ... 3.1 A ordering example Max. operating voltage UB Current rating IN Current consumption (UB = DC 36 V, US = “0”) Residual ripple for all voltages max. 5 % (3 phase bridge) Reverse polarity protection UB double pole relay (terminal 1 - terminal 2) Physical isolation 2-pole - by manual circuit breaker release - approx. 5 s after overload disconnection - approx. 15 s after fault indication (RED LED) - approx. 0.5 s after thermal response Load circuit Load output NPN transistor, minus switching, pulse-controlled (approx. 180 Hz) Load rating DC 24 V/adjustable betw. 0.1 and 3.1 A Switch-on current IE UB/Rtotal for approx. 400 ms (with short-circuit limitation) Hold current IH Short-circuit limitation Short-circuit current IK (rms) (depending on UB and IN) Wire break monitoring Current measuring terminals Leakage current (US = 0) Free-wheeling circuitry (see Technical description) Control circuit Control Control voltage US Control current IS Switching frequency fmax Control signal (US = “1”) Protection Status outputs 2 signal outputs ON indication (terminal 8) Function indication (terminal 9) Issue C ☎ DC 60 V (UB min see Technical description) adjustable between 0.1 and 3.1 A (switch and potentiometer) typically 35 mA typically 60 % of the set current rating approx. 3.5 x IN typically 10...400 mA in the ON and OFF condition (RED LED) 2 x 2 mm dia. (shunt 0.1 Ω ±1 %) typically 1 mA integral electronic control with quick disconnection opto coupler in control input “0” = 0 ... 5 V “1” = 8.5...35 V typically 5 mA 1 Hz YELLOW LED lights (Is flowing) reverse polarity protection (diode) overvoltage protection (varistor) 6 ON indication/function indication - physically isolated by opto coupler - transistor outputs, plus switching - auxiliary voltage UA: DC 12...60 V - max. 50 mA per output - integral free-wheeling diode - reverse polarity and overvoltage protection US = “0”: output non-conductive US = “1”: output connecting plus potential (term. 10) to term. 8 fault: output non-conductive no fault: output connecting plus potential (term. 10) to term. 9 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 307 Solid State Remote Power Controllers E-1071-603/607 Technical data Technical description (cont’d) General data Ambient temperature Terminals E-1071-603: E-1071-607: Connection: Housing 0...+60 °C (without condensation) screw terminals 2x2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 screw-less connectors to Wago licence max. 2 x 2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 clamping plate: polycarbonate GV, blue; cover: polycarbonate, black Mounting top-hat rail to DIN 50022-35 Self-extinguishing properties to UL 94: V = 0; VDE 0304: grade 1 Degree of protection IP 20 housing, terminals (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Mounting dimensions 45 x 74 x 128 mm Mass approx. 320 g Setting the current rating The current rating is set by means of a rotary switch (switch setting 0 A - 1 A - 2 A) and a 270° potentiometer (setting range between 0.1 and 1.1 A). The sum of the two settings should equal the current rating of the load. Example: 24 V load with IN = 1.1 A Setting: switch 0 A + potentiometer 1.1 A, or switch 1 A + potentiometer 0.1 A 1 2 3 4 Fault Wire Control break O.K. current 1 1071 - 603 The max. admissible operating voltage of the SSRPC is approx. DC 60 V. The min. operating voltage is a function of the overall ohmic resistance in the load circuit. The switch-on current is reduced by - the voltage drop on the load cable - the load resistance increasing with the operating temperature of the load. Minimum operating voltage UB min Cable length 1A 2x50 m/ 2x100 m/ 2x200 m/ 2x300 m 2A 2x50 m/ 2x100 m/ 2x200 m/ 2x300 m 3A 2x50 m/ 2x100 m/ 2x200 m/ 2x300 m 2 0 Technical description IN 5 Cable size 1.5 mm2 2.5 mm2 1.5 mm2 2.5 mm2 1.5 mm2 2.5 mm2 UB min 33/35/37/40 V 32/33/35/37 V 35/38/44/49 V 34/35/39/42 V 37/41/50/58 V 35/38/42/48 V The load capacity is no longer ensured when the minimum operating voltage is under limits. The RED LED (fault) will indicate and the circuit breaker will trip after approx. 15 s. Resistance increase in the load circuit: 1.5 mm2 cable approx. 2.8 Ω/100 m distance 2.5 mm2 cable approx. 1.6 Ω/100 m distance Switch-on current To reach the max. inrush current the output transistor connects the operating voltage to the inductive load for approx. 400 ms. After this period the load current is set back to hold current. + 0.4 0.6 Shunt 0.1Ω Load 24 V 0.1 …3.1 A 6 7 8 IN /A 0.8 1.0 1.1 0.2 0.1 + 0.6 x IN 9 10 ● Operating voltage (terminals 1 and 2): reverse polarity protected by means of a relay. The relay will only pick up and apply voltage to the device if the operating voltage is correctly polarised. This relay will then remain permanently energized, without being influenced by the control input. ● Control circuit (terminals 6 and 7): reverse polarity protected by means of a diode. ● Auxiliary voltage status outputs (terminals 10 and 5): reverse polarity protected by means of a diode. ● The load output (terminals 3-4) or the inductive load must not be fitted with a free-wheeling diode as the free-wheeling current is controlled electronically. This control also causes a very short fall time of the inductive load. The solenoid connector may be provided with means of visual indication (LED). current IE 6 IN IH approx. 400 ms IE = inrush current IN = rated current IH= hold current ON quick disconnection OFF time t Rated current IN, hold current IH The current rating of the applicable load at its rated voltage should be set between 0.1 and 3.1 A. The hold current of the load is internally adjusted to 60 % of the set current rating. This hold current should be measured by means of a voltmeter connected to the 2 mm current measuring terminals (0.1 Ω shunt). 308 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controllers E-1071-603/607 Operating modes Terminal selection Operating status Fault-free operation control input “0” “1” “1” “0” “1” “1” 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 YELLOW LED control current GREEN LED - O.K. RED LED wire break RED LED fault Functional status (terminal 9) Operating status (terminal 8) Remarks 1 1 0 load OFF Short-circuit Wire break UB too low/transistor on the load short-circuit/ incorrect setting 0 0 0 1 2 3 4 Fault Wire Control break O.K. current 1 5 2 0 + 1071 - 603 0.4 0.6 1.0 1.1 0.2 0.1 Shunt 0.1Ω + 0.6 x IN Load 24 V 0.1 …3.1 A 0 1 0 0 0 0 load physical iso- no load physical isolation ON lation after connected/ after approx. 5 s wire break approx. 15 s 6 IN /A 0.8 7 8 9 10 1 = LED lights; status output carries plus potential 0 = LED does not light; status output is non-conductive Terminal 1 operating voltage +UB: max. DC 60 V 2 operating voltage (-) 3 load (+) 4 load (-) 5 auxiliary voltage -UA for status outputs 6 control voltage +US: max. 35 V 7 control voltage -US 8 status output “operation” (max. 50 mA) 9 status output “function” (max. 50 mA) 10 auxiliary voltage +UA for status outputs: max. DC 60 V/100 mA) Status outputs Operating status Functional status Remark 0 0 0 1 1 0 - CAUTION: FAULT 1 1 operable switched on - O.K. - GREEN LED lights not operable no operation - CAUTION: FAULT operable not switched on - O.K. - GREEN LED indicates Basic circuit diagram 1 - status output carries plus potential 0 - status output is non-conductive Dimensions max. DC 35 V +6 7- max. DC 60 V +1 2current rating IN(A) yellow 1 2 3 Fault Wire Control break O.K. current 4 1 5 control input 2red 2 0.4 0.6 1.0 1.1 0.2 0.1 Shunt 0.1Ω + 0.6 x IN Last 24 V 0.1 …3.1 A 6 IN /A 0.8 70 + 73.2 0 1071 - 603 7 8 9 0 red 10 green 124 45 wire break status output fault operation 3 load load current 4 Shunt 0.1 Ω (0.6 x IN ) O.K. 6 0.1 … 1.1 A + 10 + function max. DC 60V 100 mA 5 5- ☎ 2A logic 1071 - 603/607 Issue C 1 + 9 8 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 309 6 310 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-803 Description The E-T-A Solid State Remote Power Controllers E-1071-803 are electronic control modules suitable for inductive loads (DC 24 V) such as solenoids, magnetic brakes etc. They are used ● for safe and quick switching of loads ● for monitoring the electrical condition of the loads ● for compensating for different cable lengths The load connected to the relay should be operated with a voltage higher than its rated voltage (DC 24 V) because the load current is controlled electronically (pulse-controlled characteristics). This is to ensure that in industrial plants with different cable lengths (supply cables, load cables) an increased inrush current can be applied to each load. During hold duty the load current is reduced to a smaller value (between 25 % and 75 % of the current rating), thus reducing the operating temperature and extending the life of the loads. Technical data (TA = 25 °C, UB = DC 36 V) Typical applications Circuits with inductive load such as Operating voltage UB - solenoids - magnetic brakes etc. where fast switching of inductive loads is required. Features ● Designed for inductive loads (DC 24 V) ● Individual adjustment to various load currents (IN = 0.25 A; 0.4 A; 1 A; 2 A; 3 A) ● Significant reduction of power loss in the load by pulse-controlled characteristics ● Short-circuit proof; short-circuit limitation and physical disconnection from supply after approx. 5 s ● Inrush current monitoring ● Overload protection (current control) ● Fast disconnection (do not connect a free wheeling diode to the load as the the free wheeling current is controlled electronically!) ● Physical isolation: - opto coupler in the control circuit - relay contacts in the load circuit - fault indication by means of auxiliary contact (N/O) ● Reverse polarity protection in the control and load circuits ● Control current indication by YELLOW LED ● Wire break indication by RED LED (load circuit) ● Minimum current indication by GREEN LED Ordering information Type No. E-1071 SSRPC Operating mode 803 pulse controlled Voltage rating of load DC 24 V Current rating 0.25 A 0.4 A 1A 2A 3A E-1071 - 803 - DC 24 V - 1 A Issue C ☎ E-1071-803 ordering example DC 36 V (28...60 V) (function maintained up to DC 18 V) 0.25 A/0.4 A/1 A/2 A/3 A typically 30 mA Current rating IN Current consumption (UB = DC 36 V, US = “0”) Residual ripple for all voltages max. 5 % (3 phase bridge) Reverse polarity protection UB double pole relay (terminal 1 - terminal 2) Physical isolation 2-pole - by manual circuit breaker release - approx. 5 s after short-circuit disconnection Load circuit Load output NPN transistor, minus switching, pulse-controlled (approx. 180 Hz) Load rating DC 24 V/0.25 A ( 3... 6 W) DC 24 V/0.4 A ( 6...10 W) DC 24 V/1 A (15...30 W) DC 24 V/2 A (30...50 W) DC 24 V/3 A (50...75 W) UB/Rtotal for approx. 400 ms Switch-on current IE (with short-circuit limitation) Minimum current Imin adjustable between 25 and 75 % IN ^ hold current IH) (= (e.g. 0.5...1.5 A with the 2 A version) Short-circuit limitation approx. 2 x IN Short-circuit current IK (rms) typically 10 mA (depending on UB and IN) Wire break indication in the ON and OFF condition (RED LED) Current measuring terminals 2 x 2 mm dia. (shunt 0.1 Ω ± 1 %) Leakage current (US = “0”) typically 1 mA Free-wheeling circuitry integral electronic control with quick disconnection Control circuit Control opto coupler in control input Control voltage US “0” = 0 ... 5 V “1” = 8.5...35 V Control current IS typically 5 mA Switching frequency fmax 1 Hz Control signal (US = “1”) YELLOW LED lights (IS flowing) Protection reverse polarity protection (diode) Status outputs Fault indication auxiliary contact (N/O) - max. DC 30 V/3 A - physically isolated - closed when the circuit breaker has tripped General data Ambient temperature 0...+60 °C (without condensation) Terminals screw terminals 2x2.5 mm2 to DIN 46288 Housing clamping plate: polycarbonate GV, blue; cover: polycarbonate, black Mounting on top-hat rail to DIN 50022-35 Self-extinguishing properties to UL 94: V = 0; VDE 0304: grade 1 Degree of protection IP 20 housing, terminals (IEC 529/DIN 40050) Mounting dimensions 45 x 74 x 128 mm Mass approx. 240 g Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 311 6 Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-803 Technical description Technical description (cont’d) Operating voltage UB The max. admissible operating voltage of the SSRPC is approx. DC 60 V. The min. operating voltage is a function of the overall ohmic resistance in the load circuit. The switch-on current is reduced by - the voltage drop on the load cable - the load resistance increasing with the operating temperature of the load. The function as shown below is no longer ensured when the minimum operating voltage (DC 28 V) is under limits. The output will then be continuously conductive, and the set minimum current may no longer be reached. Switch-on current IE To reach the max. inrush current the output transistor connects the operating voltage to the inductive load for approx. 400 ms. After this period the load current is set back to hold current (= minimum current). ● Operating voltage (terminals 1 and 2): reverse polarity protected by means of a relay. The relay will only pick up and apply voltage to the device if the operating voltage is correctly polarised. This relay will then remain permanently energized, without being influenced by the control input. ● Control circuit (terminals 6 and 7): reverse polarity protected by means of a diode. ● The load output (terminals 3-4) or the inductive load must not be fitted with a free-wheeling diode as the free-wheeling current is controlled electronically. This control also causes a very short fall time of the inductive load. The solenoid connector may be fitted with a visual indication means (LED). Operating modes Operating status Fault-free operation control input “0” “1” “0” “1” “1” 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 YELLOW LED control current GREEN LED minimum current RED LED wire break Auxiliary contact current IE IN Remark IH open open load OFF load ON quick release Short-circuit Wire break on the load “1” closed UB too low/ incorrect setting open open open physical no load isolation after connected approx. 5 s wire break current cannot be adjusted approx. 400 ms IE = inrush current IN = rated current IH= hold current 1 - LED lights 0 = LED does not light ON OFF time t Setting of hold current IH (= minimum current) The hold current of the load is set between 25 % and 75 % IN by the 270 ° potentiometer on the front. This hold current should be measured by means of a voltmeter connected to the 2 mm current measuring terminals (0.1 Ω shunt). 1 2 3 4 5 ISoll (%) 75 25 65 6 35 55 Stromhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 803 24 V ISt 45 ISoll Shunt 0.1Ω + 1A/15…30W with UB>36V 6 312 7 ☎ Wire break 8 9 10 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Solid State Remote Power Controller E-1071-803 Dimensions Terminal selection 1 1 2 3 4 2 3 5 4 5 ISoll (%) 25 75 ISoll (%) 75 65 35 ISoll Shunt + 0.1Ω 1A/15…30W with UB>36V 6 7 73.2 ISt 45 70 55 Stromhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 803 24 V 65 - 9 55 Stromhalbleiterrelais 1071 - 803 24 V ISt 45 ISoll Shunt + 0.1Ω Wire break 8 35 25 1A/15…30W with UB>36V 10 Wire break 124 45 6 Basic circuit diagram DC 28 … 60 V +1 -2 DC 8.5 … 35 V 8 9 +6 yellow Imin 75 % IK -7 7 8 9 10 Terminal: 1 operating voltage +UB: max. DC 60 V 2 operating voltage -UB 3 load (+) 4 load (-) 5 not used 6 control voltage +US: max. 35 V 7 control voltage -US 8 auxiliary contact 9 auxiliary contact 10 not used 25 % 3 green Imin red load 4 wire break Shunt 0.1 Ω 1071 - 803 + - 6 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 313 6 314 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Electronic Flow Meters and Flow Monitors E-T-A Flow Meters and Flow Monitors Typical applications The E-T-A range of electronic flow metering and monitoring systems has been designed to measure and supervise the flow rate of gases and liquids in pipelines. Models operating on the calorimetric principle avoid the need for moving parts in the flow stream and are therefore especially suitable for use with liquids of high viscosity, or containing particles or contaminants. Alternatively high precision turbine sensors are available for applications which demand accurate volumetric measurement. Calorimetric models comprise a monitoring sensor head, installed in the pipeline, and an electronic controller which may be either integrated with the monitoring head or remotely sited, according to type. These systems provide an output to signal deviation of flow from a pre-set level. Temperature monitoring and continuous analogue output are additional functions which can be selected on some models. The E-T-A flow meter/monitor programme offers a choice of specification, performance, size and cost to meet a wide variety of different uses and budget requirements. All models are maintenance-free ensuring fit-and-forget reliability, and benefit from E-T-A’s investment in process sensor research and development spanning over 25 years. Applications for E-T-A flow monitors and meters extend across the entire industrial spectrum including: ● Air conditioning systems, radiators and filtration equipment ● Gas and exhaust monitoring systems in heating and power plants, blast furnaces, and gas supply systems ● Welding equipment ● Food processing, brewing and dairy product applications ● Water and waste treatment plant ● Paper manufacturing ● Petrochemical processing ● Pump monitoring and protection ● Control of lubricating, hydraulic and cooling systems ● Agricultural equipment Overview ● Marine and transportation requirements Condensed Selector Chart For liquids: SW 118, SW 119, (B)SFW 120, SFW 120-E, SW 201, SFW 209, FM 1 For air/gas: SW 112, SW 118, SW 119, SLW 120-E, SW 201, FM 1 For hazardous areas: FM1-Ex For granules (powders): SW 201-F, SFW 209, SW 118, SW 119 Issue C ☎ 7 All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 315 Overview 7 316 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Electronic Flow Meters Type No. Monitoring heads for FM 1-... FM 1-... CST-... CSF-... CSF-... CSF-... variable Tri-Clamp DIN/ANSI immersion depth Turbine head monitoring heads TST-...-HM2 Media TST-...-AM1/WM1 gases, oil, liquids, powder menu control linear analogue outputs optional temperature monitoring medium temperature up to +125°C (up to +250°C with turbine head) relay outputs LED/bargraph display Features Flow rate range linear analogue outputs optional temperature monitoring medium temperature up to +130°C 0... 3 m/s for water 0... 5 m/s for oil 0...20 m/s for air/gases Temperature range of medium/ monitoring head -40°C...+130°C (calorimetric head) -30°C...+140°C or 0°C...+250°C (turbine head) Temperature range of electronic control unit +10 °C...+50 °C Outputs analogue outputs: 0/4-20 mA or 0/2-10 V or 0/1-5 V relay or transistor outputs Input voltage DC 24 V (19...32 V) AC 24 V ±10% Type and size of monitoring head CSF: flange-mounted heads to DIN 2500 or DIN/ISO 2825 CST, TST: thread-mounted heads G 1/2A, G 3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT Materials of monitoring head sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316 Ti Cable to electronic control unit 2 m standard, 100 m max. see CPI cat. pages 13 - 15 see CPI cat. pages 16 - 18 Overview Data sheet Dimensions 3/4-14 NPT or 1/2-14NPT B 36 20 7 øA 75 36 14 14 G3/4A or G1/2A SW27 SW27 øA 100 Issue C ☎ B G3/4A 22.8 12 G1/2A 18 10 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 317 Electronic Flow Monitors SW 112-... SW 118-... SW119-... Media air gases, liquids, powder gases, liquids, powder Features 1 switch point (MIN) relay signal output LED status indication 1 switch point (MIN or MAX) non-linear trend outputs relay output LED status indication optional temperature monitoring medium selector switch 1 switch point (MIN or MAX) non-linear trend outputs relay output LED status indication temperature monitoring medium selector switch Flow rate range 0.5 m/s...20 m/s liquids: 0.01 m/s..2 m/s gases: 0.5 m/s...50 m/s liquids: 0.01 m/s..2 m/s gases: 0.5 m/s...50 m/s Temperature range of medium/monitoring head -20 °C...+60 °C -25°C...+70 °C -25°C...+100 °C Temperature range of electronic control unit -20 °C...+50 °C -25 °C...+50 °C -25 °C...+50 °C Outputs 1 relay max. load: 700 mA 1 relay (change over contact) AC 250 V, DC 30 V: 5 A overvoltage category II trend output 4-8 V 1 relay (change over contact) AC 250 V, DC 30 V: 5 A overvoltage category II trend output 4-8 V Input voltage AC 24 V + 10%/-15% DC 19...32 V AC 230 V / 115 V / 24 V +10 %/-15 % DC 24 V ±10 % AC 230 V / 115 V / 24 V +10 %/-15 % DC 24 V ±10 % Type and size of monitoring head monitoring head dia. 18 mm, integral with electronic control unit monitoring heads G1/2A, G3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT integral with the electronic control unit monitoring heads G1/2A, G3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT Material of monitoring head PVC, aluminium, polyamide sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316 Ti, sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316 Ti, Cable length with 2 m cable (standard), max. cable length 25 m, at relay output without cable (standard), max. cable length 50 m, at relay output with 2 m cable (standard), max. cable length 100 m, between monitoring head and electronic control unit Available options see CPI cat. pages 21 - 22 see CPI cat. pages 23 - 26 see CPI cat. pages 23 - 26 Dimensions 80.5 2000+50 82.5 108.5 7 potentiometer screw ☎ 50 20 68.5 ø32 12 318 ø4.2 ø14 LED 37 120 20 70 ø18 20 G1/2A, G3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT 4 46 4 15 162 20 80 23 ø24 ø4.2 Overview Type No. PG9 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com PG9 Issue C Electronic Flow Monitors (B)SFW 120-... SFW/SLW 120-E-... SW 201.. SWT 201.. gases, liquids gases (air), liquids, powder gases (air), liquids, powder 1 switch point (MIN or MAX) transistor output LED status indication SFW 120: industrial applications (MIN) BSFW 120: marine applications (MAX) 1 switch point (MIN or MAX) relay output LED status indication 1 switch point (MIN) non-linear analogue output relay outputs status indication by 2 LEDs medium selector switch 1 switch point (MIN) non-linear analogue output relay outputs status indication by 3 LEDs temperature monitoring medium selector switch 0.01 m/s...2 m/s liquids: 0.1 l/min...10 l/min gases: 2.5 l/min...250 l/min air: 0.5 m/s...100 m/s liquids: 0.01 m/s...5 m/s air: 0.5 m/s...100 m/s liquids: 0.01 m/s...5 m/s -10 °C...+60 °C -10 °C...+60 °C -40 °C...+100 °C -40 °C...+100 °C -10 °C...+60 °C -10 °C...+60 °C -10 °C...+45 °C -10 °C...+45 °C PNP transistor max. load: 0.3 A (DC12V) max. load: 50 mA (DC 24 V) 1 relay (change over contact) AC/DC 28 V: 1 A a) 2 relays (change over contacts), AC 250 V, DC 28 V: 1 A overvoltage category II b) analogue output non-linear 0/4...20 mA a) 3 relays (change over contacts) AC 250 V, DC 28 V: 1A overvoltage category II b) analogue output: non-linear 0/4...20 mA DC 12 V (10.7...16 V) DC 24 V (12...26.4 V) DC 24 V (18...32 V) AC 24 V +10%/-15% AC 230/115/24 V +10%/-15% DC 24 V ± 10% AC 230/115/24 V +10%/-15% DC 24 V ± 10% G 3/4 A or 3/4"NPT sealing: Viton, teflon coated Ermeto sizes EF6 to EF12, 1/4" NPT, G 3/8A sensor and electronic control unit comprised in one housing monitoring heads G1/2A, G3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT monitoring heads G1/2A, G3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT sensor and fitting material: SFW 120: 1.4571/AISI 316 Ti; BSFW 120: AP1D sensor material: AP1D sensor: PVDF; sealing rings: Viton® sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316Ti, sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316Ti, without cable (standard) max. cable length 25m, at transistor output without cable (standard) max. cable length 25m, at relay output 2 m cable (standard), max. cable length 100 m, between monitoring head and electronic control unit 2 m cable (standard), max. cable length 100 m, between monitoring head and electronic control unit see CPI cat. pages 27 - 28 see CPI cat. pages 29 - 30 see CPI cat. pages 31 - 34 see CPI cat. pages 31 - 34 cable 100 50 38 20 lens Overview liquids 85 Issue C ☎ aluminium cover PG13.5 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com SW 27 36 sensor rotated by 90° window 14 NPT1/4" PG 7 90 35 SW 32 G3/4A 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT G1/2A or G3/4A 160 53 66 47 85 ø20 120 7 319 Electronic Flow Monitors Type No. SFW 209 Media liquids, gases, powder Features 1 switch point (MIN or MAX) relay output status indication by 2 LEDs Flow rate range 0.01 m/s...2 m/s with water 0.5 m/s...50 m/s with gases Temperature range of medium/monitoring head -25 °C...+100 °C Temperature range of electronic control unit -10 °C...+60 °C Outputs 1 relay (change over contact) AC 250 V, DC 28 V: 2 A Input voltage AC 230 V / 115 V / 24 V +10%/-15% DC 24 V ± 10% Type and size of monitoring head monitoring heads G1/2A, G3/4A, 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT Material of monitoring head sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316Ti, Cable length 2 m cable (standard),max. cable length 50 m Available options see CPI cat. pages 35 - 36 Dimensions Overview Electronic Control Unit 45 123 20 Monitoring Head G1/2A or G3/4A 1/2"NPT or 3/4"NPT 14 36 73.2 70 7 cable SW 27 sensor rotated by 90° 320 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Flow Meter with Ex approval FM 1-Ex CST-Ex PTB approval; in conformance with EN 50014 and EN 50020 (EEx ibII) PTB approval No. Ex-88-B-2034 in conformance with EN 50014 and EN 50020 for EEx ib II C/II B gases, liquids menu control two analogue outputs relay or transistor outputs for connection of calorimetric monitoring heads water: 0... 3 m/s oil: 0... 5 m/s gases/air: 0...20 m/s -40 °C...+90 °C +5 °C...+33 °C Analogue outputs: 0/4-20 mA or 0/2-10 V or 0/1-5 V relay or transistor outputs DC 24 V (19...32 V) AC 24 V ± 10% AC 230 V +10%/-15% G 1/2A sensor and fitting: 1.4571/AISI 316 Ti Overview 2 m standard, max. cable length 100 m G1/2A 14 240 120 90 PG11 7 27.5 PG9 133 PG11 226 PG13.5 SW27 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 321 Selector chart Overview Ambient temperature -25 °C...+50 °C -20 °C...+50 °C -10 °C...+60 °C -10 °C...+45 °C +10 °C...+50 °C Flow rate range 0.01...1 m/sec 0.01...2 m/sec 0.01...3 m/sec 0.01...5 m/sec 0.05...100 m/sec 0.5...20 m/sec 0.5...50 m/sec 0.5...100 m/sec 0.1...10 l/min 2.5...250 l/min 7 Monitoring head G1/2A G3/4A NPT Special Pressure resistance 1 bar /14.7 PSI 20 bar / 294 PSI 100 bar / 1470 PSI 250 bar / 3675 PSI 300 bar / 4410 PSI Output transistor relay 0...20 mA non linear 4...20 mA non linear 0...20 mA linear 4...20 mA linear 0...5 V 0...10 V 1...5 V 2...10 V 322 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● FM1-Ex SW 118 SW 119 SW 201-F SFW 209 Granules/Powders Ex version SFW 120 E SW 201-F SFW 209 FM 1 SFW/BSFW 120 Liquids SW 118 SW 119 (●) = optionally Input voltage 12 V DC 24 V DC 24 V AC (50/60 Hz) 115 V AC (50/60 Hz) 230 V AC (50/60 Hz) Medium temperature -40 °C...+130 °C -40 °C...+125 °C -40 °C...+100 °C -40 °C...+90 °C -30 °C...+140 °C -25 °C...+70 °C -25 °C...+100 °C -20 °C...+100 °C -20 °C...+60 °C -10 °C...+60 °C 0...+250 °C 0...+140 °C Air/gases SW 112 SW 118 SLW 119 SLW 120 E SW 201-L SFW 209 FM 1 Medium ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ☎ ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Capacitive Level Sensors E-T-A Capacitive Level Sensors First installation E-T-A level sensors are of high quality, practically maintenance free and have a wide operating temperature range. They respond to the change of capacitance occurring when an electrode surrounded by air is immersed into the medium to be monitored. This capacitance change causes a circuit to oscillate which is processed electronically. The Level Sensors are factory preset for water. The different versions can be used as MIN/MAX sensors with closed circuit principle. Power failure and wire break are indicated the same way as incorrect medium level. Models NR 150, NR 160 and NR 200 allow the selection of minimum or maximum switching by means of an integral selector switch, whereas models NR 80, NR 60 and NR 100 are factory-preset as a minimum or maximum sensor. 2. For sensitivity setting turn the potentiometer screw until the LED changes. 3. Adjust the potentiometer screw another half turn to compensate for any tolerances and to eliminate deposits on the sensor (allow for response delay!). For other media it is necessary to readjust the sensors (make sure the medium to be monitored is available!). These instructions do not apply to model NR 60 because its sensitivity is factory preset. For installation details please see the applicable Installation Instructions. Overview Model NR 200 features a potential-free relay change over contact, models NR 100, NR 150 and NR 160 a shortcircuit proof plus switching transistor output, and models NR 60 and NR 80 a minus switching transistor output. 1. Install the Level Sensor and connect it as shown on the connection diagram. 7 All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 323 Level Sensors Type No. NR 60-... NR 80-... NR 100-... Description water, oil, fuels water and liquids with similar electrical conductivity powder, water and liquids with similar electrical conductivity, aggressive media Input voltage/ power consumption DC 9...36 V typically 6 mA or with power supply NG 03 DC 6...36 V typically 5 mA or with power supply NG 03 DC 24 V ±25% typically 30 mA or with power supply NG 03 Output NPN transistor, low side switching, short-circuit and overload protected, with free-wheeling diode, voltage drop <300 mV NPN transistor, low side switching, max.100 mA, with free-wheeling diode, voltage drop approx 2 V PNP transistor, high side switching, max. 0.3 A, short-circuit and overload protected, with free-wheeling diode, voltage drop approx. 2 V Ambient temperature -30 °C...+125°C 0 °C...+70 °C -20°C...+85°C Medium temperature -30 °C...+125°C 0 °C...+70°C (max. 80 °C short-time) -20 °C...+130°C (max. +150 °C short-time) Pressure resistance 25 bar/367.5 PSI N/A 2 bar/29.4 PSI (25 bar/367.5 PSI to special order) Tefzel® ETFE nickel-plated brass, Ms CuZn39Pb3 Viton® nickel-plated brass, Ms CuZn39Pb3 – – – – – ABS = Acrylonitrile butadine styrene – – PTFE = Teflon®/Polytetrafluoroethylene PTFE = Teflon®/Polytetrafluoroethylene – – – PBTP gv = Polybutylene Terephtalate with glass fibre see CPI cat. pages 57 - 58 see CPI cat. pages 59 - 60 see CPI cat. pages 61 - 62 Material probe fitting sealing (O ring) or sensor and fitting housing housing cover connector Technical data 80 101.5 50 10 switching point 30 mm ± 6 56 50 10 PG9 SW17 female plug 18 ø10.5 M27x1 switching point 30 mm ± 6 2 3.5 18.5 SW27 45 ca. 145 101.5 51.5 41 SW32 10 45 ° ø44.5 SW27 ø30 G1A ø44.5 62±0.3 connector ø5 7 30 15 69.5 54.5 M27x1 51.5 41 ø32.5 Overview Dimensions 36 44 80 36 324 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Level Sensors NR 150-... NR 160-... NR 200-... NG 03-... oil and media with low electrical conductivity water and liquids with similar electrical conductivity oil and media with low electrical conductivity power supply with relay output DC 9...36 V typically 13 mA or with power supply NG 03 DC 9...36 V typically 17 mA or with power supply NG 03 AC 115/230/240 V +10%/-15% typically <4VA AC 115/230/240 V +10%/-15% typically <4VA PNP transistor, high side switching, max. 0.3 A, short circuit and overload protected, with free-wheeling diode, voltage drop approx. 2 V PNP transistor, high side switching, max. 0.3 A, short circuit and overload protected, with free-wheeling diode, voltage drop approx. 2 V relay output switching capacity: DC 50...270 W AC 2000 VA switching voltage: DC 300 V/AC 250 V switching current: 6 A for Level Sensors NR 60, NR 80, NR 100, NR 150, NR 160 DC 24 V, 50 mA -20°C...+85°C -20°C...+85°C -20°C...+70°C 0 °C ... + 70 °C -20 °C...+130°C (max. +150 °C short-time) -20 °C...+130°C (max. +150 °C short-time) -20 °C...+85°C (max. +100 °C short-time) N/A 25 bar/367.5 PSI 25 bar/367.5 PSI 25 bar/367.5 PSI N/A ETFE = Tefzel® DIN 1.4305/AISI 303 Viton® – PA6-3T = Trogamide – PA12-Gf = Polyamide 12 with glass fibre DIN 1.4305/AISI 303 Viton® – PA6-3T = Trogamide – ETFE = Tefzel® DIN 1.4305/AISI 303 Viton® ABS = Acrylonitrile butadine styrene ABS = Acrylonitrile butadine styrene – see CPI cat. pages 63 - 64 see CPI cat. pages 65 - 66 see CPI cat. pages 67 - 68 N/A SW32 Issue C ø14 ø26.7 3/4"NPT ☎ 66 80.5 ø14 B 7 26 59 O ring ca. 133 A B G3/4A 16 3/4"NPT 21 NIVEAUSENSOR NR 200 LEVEL SENSOR NR 200 70 25 25 20.2 SW 32 82.5 55 PG7 B A G3/4A SW 32 ø14 PG 7 SW32 Overview 66 ø 21.8 PG7 ca. 150 35 16 A 25 see CPI cat. pages 69 - 70 35 105 PG13.5 123 45 A B G3/4A 16 3/4"NPT 20.2 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 325 Level Sensors ● ● ● ● NR 200 ● NR 160 ● ● NR 150 ● NR 100 NR 80 DC 12 V DC 24 V Input voltage Medium ● ● water oil ● ● ● ● ● powder Sensitivity setting ● ● ● ● ● no ● yes Mounting method invasive ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● MAX ● ● AC 230 V AC 240 V ● ● Medium temperature ● -20... + 130 °C (+150 °C)2) -20... + 85 °C (+125 °C)2) -30... + 125 °C ● ● ● ● -30 ... +125 °C ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Process connector G3/4A (R3/4") ● ● ● ● 0 ... +70 °C Output ● ● -20 ... +70 °C ● relay PNP transistor NPN transistor ● ● -20 ... +85 °C MIN/MAX selector switch ● ● 0 ... + 70 °C Ambient temperature Function MIN or ● AC 115 V ● ●1) non-invasive ● ● G1A (R1") ● 3/4"NPT LED display ● yes ● ● ● ● 1"NPT ● ● no 1) NR 60 NR 200 NR 160 NR 150 NR 100 NR 80 NR 60 Selector chart non-metallic containers M14 x 1.5 ● M18 x 1.5 1/4" NPTF ● ● ● Compression nut Pressure resistance ● 2 bar/29.4 PSI 25 bar/367.5 PSI N/A ● ❍ ● 2 ) short-time Overview ❍ on request 7 326 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Digital Panel Instruments E-T-A Digital Panel Instruments E-T-A digital panel meters are designed to measure, monitor and display electrical, thermal and mechanical values for a wide range of industrial applications. The panel mounted instruments provide a choice of front face dimensions of 96 mm x 48 mm, 96 mm x 24 mm or 48 mm x 24 mm with a 2.5 to 5 digit 7-segment nonreflective LED display, designed for clarity under all lighting conditions. The instruments are available for different supply voltages. Their versatility is further assured through optional features which include adjustable set points for alarm or control purposes and analogue output. Versions for current and voltage measurement can also provide true RMS readings. The E-T-A MDZ 480 is an intelligent frequency measuring instrument which can be connected to a wide range of circuit control sensors such as proximity switches, NAMUR sensors and tachogenerators. The appropriate function is user-selected at the time of installation. All E-T-A panel meters are designed to internationally recognised DIN, VDE and IEC specifications. All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 327 Overview E-T-A pressure meters are suitable for use with all commercially available pressure transducers with standard signal output. A DC 24 V/20 mA output, physically isolated from the measuring input of the meter’s power supply, ensures an interference-free auxiliary power supply for the transducers. 7 Digital Panel Instruments Type No. MDA 241-... MDV 241-... MDC 241-... MDK 241/MDR 241-... DC and AC current measuring instrument DC and AC voltage measuring instrument Temperature measuring instrument for Pt100 to IEC 751 2-conductor circuit Measuring instruments with standard signal input and selectable display range. Pressure instrument MDR 241 with transmitter supply 24 V/20 mA Accuracy DC 0.1%, AC 0.2% of span DC 0.1%, AC 0.2% of span resolution 1 K: 0.3% 0.1 K: 0.1% of span 0.1 % of span Supply voltage DC: 12...26 V physically isolated from the measuring circuit DC: 12...26 V physically isolated from the measuring circuit DC: 12...26 V physically isolated from the measuring circuit DC: 12...26 V physically isolated from the measuring circuit Temperature range 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C Measuring range 0...2 mA 0...20 mA 0...200 mA 0...2 A 0...200 mV 0... 2 V 0... 20 V 0...200 V 0...600 V 0...+ 300 °C +250...+ 800 °C -200 ...+ 200 °C -100.0...+100.0 °C Input: 0...±20 mA 4... 20 mA 0...±10 V 0... ±5 V Display 3 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 3 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 3 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 3 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED Dimensions 96 x 24 x 89 mm 96 x 24 x 89 mm 96 x 24 x 89 mm 96 x 24 x 89 mm Technical data see CPI cat. pages 77 - 78 see CPI cat. pages 77 - 78 see CPI cat. pages 77 - 78 see CPI cat. pages 79 - 80 Overview Description 7 328 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Digital Panel Instruments Type No. MDA 245-... MDV 245-... MDC 245-... Instrument for standard signals (DC current) Instrument for standard signals (DC voltage) Temperature measuring instrument with temperature sensor KTY16-6 Accuracy 0.1% of span 0.1% of span 0.8 % of span Supply voltage DC: 4... 7 V 7...16 V 16...28 V (standard) DC: 4... 7 V 7...16 V 16...28 V (standard) DC: 4... 7 V 7...16 V 16...28 V (standard) Temperature range 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C Measuring range Input: 0...±20 mA 4... 20 mA Input: 0... ±5 V 0...±10 V -30 °C...+100 °C Display 3 1/2 digit 10 mm 7-segment LED selectable display range 3 1/2 digit 10 mm 7-segment LED selectable display range 2 1/2 digit 10 mm 7-segment LED Dimensions 48 x 24 x 85 mm 48 x 24 x 85 mm 48 x 24 x 85 mm Technical data see CPI cat. pages 81 - 82 see CPI cat. pages 81 - 82 see CPI cat. pages 81 - 82 Overview Description 7 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 329 Digital Panel Instruments Overview Type No. MDA 480-... MDV 480-... MDC 480-... MDK 480/MDR 480-... Description AC or DC current measuring instrument. Version for rms measurement for non-sinusoidal curves available. Special calibration if display needs to deviate from input quantity. AC or DC voltage measuring instrument. Version for rms measurement for non-sinusoidal curves available. Special calibration if display needs to deviate from input quantity. Temperature measuring instrument for RTDs or thermocouples. Measuring instrument with normalized inputs and freely selectable display range. Pressure measuring instrument MDR 480 with transmitter supply 24 V/25 mA or for measuring bridge 1 mA or 10 V const. Options 2 limit values 4 limit values 2 limit values + analogue output analogue output 2 limit values 4 limit values 2 limit values + analogue output analogue output 2 limit values 4 limit values 2 limit values + analogue output analogue output 2 limit values 4 limit values 2 limit values + analogue output analogue output Supply voltage AC 240 / 230 / 115 V AC 120 / 60 / 48 / 24 V AC 240 / 230 / 115 V AC 120 / 60 / 48 / 24 V AC 240 / 230 / 115 V AC 120 / 60 / 48 / 24 V AC 240 / 230 / 115 V AC 120 / 60 / 48 / 24 V DC 12...28 V physically isolated DC 12...28 V physically isolated DC 12...28 V physically isolated DC 12...28 V physically isolated Temperature range 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C Measuring range individual: 0...2 mA 0...20 mA 0...200 mA 0...2 A 0...10 A multiple (DC only): 0...2 mA + 0...20 mA + 0...200 mA 0...2 A + 0...10 A special measuring ranges individual: 0...200 mV 0...2 V 0...20 V 0...200 V 0...600 V multiple (DC only): 0...200 mV + 0...2000 mV 0...20 V + 0...200 V special measuring ranges IEC 584: Cu-CuNi Fe-CuNi NiCr-CuNi NiCr-Ni Pt 13 % Rh-Pt Pt 10 % Rh-Pt DIN 43 710: Cu-CuNi Fe-CuNi IEC 751: Pt 100 DIN 43 760: Ni100 Input: Display 3 1/2 or 4 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 3 1/2 or 4 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 3 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 3 1/2 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED Dimensions 96 x 48 x 166 mm 96 x 48 x 166 mm 96 x 48 x 166 mm 96 x 48 x 166 mm Technical data see CPI cat. pages 83 - 90 see CPI cat. pages 83 - 90 see CPI cat. pages 91 - 98 MDR: see CPI cat. pages 99 - 106 MDK: see CPI cat. pages 107 - 114 0...20 mA 4...20 mA 0...10 V 0... 5 V 1... 5 V 2...10 V 0...200 mV special measuring ranges 7 330 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Digital Panel Instruments Type No. MDZ 480-F... MDZ 480-V... Instrument measuring the frequency of bipolar signals in the voltage ranges: AC 15 ... 50 V AC 50 ... 150 V AC 150 ... 430 V Instrument measuring frequency, velocity or events (counting) of digital signals: TTL, 24 V-PLC, open collector, NAMUR Adjustable: function, input, measuring time, parameter (e.g. number of teeth), display Options --- 2 limit values (1 relay) 2 peak values Voltage supply AC 230 V, AC 115 V AC 230 V, AC 115 V Temperature range 0 °C...+50 °C 0 °C...+50 °C Measuring range 0.1 Hz ... 10 kHz 0.1 Hz ... 100 kHz (frequency measurement) 6 ... 99999 min-1 (velocity measurement) 1 ... 9999 ms (period measurement) 0 ...499999 (forward/backward counter, fmax=1 kHz) 0.1 Hz... 100 kHz (special function) Display 4 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED 5 digit 13 mm 7-segment LED Dimensions 96 x 48 x 166 mm 96 x 48 x 166 mm Technical data see CPI cat. pages 115 - 120 see CPI cat. pages 115 - 120 Overview Description 7 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 331 Digital Panel Instruments Current measurement ● DC 0 ... 2 mA DC 0 ... 20 mA ● DC 4 ... 20 mA ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● DC 0 ... 200 mA ● ● DC 0 ... 2 A ● ● ● ● ● ● ● AC 0 ... 2 mA ● ● AC 0 ... 20 mA ● ● AC 0 ... 200 mA ● ● AC 0 ... 2 A ● ● ● AC 0 ... 10 A DC 0 ... 200 mV ● ● DC 0 ... 2 V ● ● ● DC 0 ... 10 V ● ● ● ● DC 0 ... 20 V ● ● DC 0 ... 200 V ● ● DC 0 ... 600 V ● ● AC 0 ... 200 mV ● ● AC 0 ... 2 V ● ● AC 0 ... 20 V ● ● AC 0 ... 200 V ● ● ● AC 0 ... 600 V ● ● Temperature measurement Pt100 ● Ni100 ● thermocouple ● ● temperature sensor Frequency measurement ● ● DC 0 ... 10 A Voltage measurement MDZ480 ● MDV480 ● MDR480 ● MDK480 ● MDC480 ● 96 mm x 48 mm MDA480 MDV241 ● MDR241 ● MDK241 ● 96 mm x 24 mm MDC241 48 mm x 24 mm MDA241 Front dimensions MDV245 Version MDC245 Type No. MDA245 Selector chart ● AC signals ● digital input Display ● 2 1/2 digit 3 1/2 digit ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● 4 1/2 digit ● ● ● 5 digit Voltage supply AC Overview DC Sensor supply DC 24 V Options true rms measurement calibration of display ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● peak value storage 7 332 ☎ ● analogue output 0 ... 10 V ● ● ● ● ● analogue output 0 ... 20 mA ● ● ● ● ● analogue output 4 ... 20 mA ● ● ● ● ● 2 limit values with relay ● ● ● ● ● 4 limit values with relay ● ● ● ● ● Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com ● Issue C Sensors E-T-A Sensors E-T-A Pressure Sensors MSR 400 and MSR 450 are designed to convert nominal pressures up to 400 bar/5880 PSI into standard signals.The robust design of model MSR 400 (voltage supply, EMC, environmental protection, connector to DIN 72585) is perfectly suited to its application in commercial equipment and machinery/plant for the construction industry etc. Model MSR 450 featuring a stainless steel enclosure is designed for general industrial applications (connection method according to DIN 43650). Available with various threads (metric, imperial, NPT) fitting all commercial process connections. Overview E-T-A Velocity Sensors MSZ... provide contactless sensing of mechanical motion such as the rotational speed of drives or rotating shafts. Pulses are generated at ferromagnetic pick-up wheels (i.e. gears) whose teeth pass by the sensor. The electronic control circuitry and the sensor head are designed as an integral unit. The rectangular signal provided by the electronic control circuitry is independent of the pick-up geometry. The instruments are available in a wide voltage supply and temperature range, and various dimensions and connection methods to allow a wide spread of applications in general and automotive industries. 7 All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 333 Sensors Velocity Sensor MSZ 214/218-... Pressure Sensors MSR 400/MSR 450-... Velocity Sensor MSZ 214/218-... for connection to panel instrument MDZ 480 Pressure Sensors MSR 400/MSR 450 for connection to panel instrument MDR 241/480 Description The inductive sensor provides contactless sensing of mechanical motion such as the rotational speed of ferro-magnetic pick-up wheels. When combined with the intelligent frequency measuring instrument MDZ 480, it is a complete speed measuring system. The integral electronic control unit generates a rectangular output signal that is independent of the pick-up geometry. The MSZ 214 has a diameter of 14 mm (M14x1), the MSZ 218 a diameter of 18 mm (M18x1). Both sensor types are available either with permanent cable with open cable end, or with 3 pole connector. Pressure Sensors MSR 400/MSR 450 with thick-film measuring element are designed for various pressure monitoring tasks. Their wide temperature range allows their use in harsh environments (MSR 400 for vehicles and MRS 450 for general industrial applications). Measuring ranges up to 20 kHz 0... 6 bar 0...10 bar 0...16 bar 0...25 bar 0...40 bar Supply voltage DC 5...36 V DC 10...32 V Output open collector NPN Umax = 40 V Imax = 40 mA 1...5 V 4...20 mA 2-conductor (MSR 450) 4...20 mA 3-conductor (MSR 400) Type No. better than 2.5% F.S. Enclosure stainless steel 1.4305/AISI 303 MSR 400: steel 1.0715/AISI 1213, yellow chromated MSR 450: stainless steel 1.4305/AISI 303 Connection 2 m cable or connector MSR 400: 3 pole connector to DIN 72585 or 20 cm cable MSR 450: 3 pole connector to DIN 43650 Degree of protection IP 67 version with cable IP 65 version with connector IP 65 version with cable IP 67/IP 69K MSR 400 version with connector IP 65 MSR 450 version with connector Technical data see CPI cat. pages 123 - 124 see CPI cat. pages 125 - 128 Dimensions 2 12 LIYY 3x0.5 mm2 approx. 33.5 ø2 SW 22 9 14±0.4 ø27 7 65±0.8 2m ø5.2 55 45 M14x1 ø35 SW 27 ø19 334 ☎ ø27 øA 27.5 M14x1 81 ≈50 Overview Accuracy 0... 60 bar 0...100 bar 0...160 bar 0...250 bar 0...400 bar SW27 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Current and Voltage Monitors E-T-A Current and Voltage Monitors series E-107.. are designed to monitor electrical circuits for current or voltage over limits. ● E-T-A Zero Current Monitors E-1076-SR signal a current flowing in the monitoring circuit when fixed current limits are exceeded. They feature a 17 mm wide rail mounted housing and may also be used to switch on an elapsed-hour meter. Internal power supply is by means of the input signal so that no additional wiring is needed. ● E-T-A Current Monitors E-1077 offer the possibility to individually set the MAX and/or MIN limit values by means of the digital switches provided on the front of the housing. The response delay may be selected. Relay contacts provide for potential-free signalization. Relay status and adjustment error is indicated by LEDs. ● E-T-A Current Protector E-1078 is designed for low voltage lighting systems. It monitors the lighting system rated current that is stored, when it is switched on, in the primary circuit of the low-voltage transformer. The rated load is stored either by operation of the push button on the device or via the light switch. A shortcircuit in the lamp circuit or an overload will cause the Current Protector to immediately disconnect the system. The product is available with a rail mounted housing (for consumer unit installation) or in a housing for surface mounting at or in the transformer. ● E-T-A Combi Safety Protection E-1078-911 allows the simultaneous connection of two powerful loads such as a washing machine and a dryer to a 16 A socket with earthing contact. One of the two sockets has priority and is connected to the washing machine. When the current required by the washing machine exceeds a set limit of approx. 15.5 A (during heating), the second socket is disconnected, and reconnected only when the current falls to the set lower limit. Appliance combinations such as dishwasher and hot-water heater may also be operated this way. ● E-T-A Voltage Monitor E-1079 monitors set MAX and/or MIN voltage limits in a circuit. Limit value setting is by means of the digital switches provided on the front of the housing. Additional features are relay outputs, selectable response delay, LED status indication, and rail mounted housings. ● E-T-A Voltage Monitor E-1079-600 is available in a 12 mm wide housing for plug-in mounting utilising E-T-A socket 17-P10-Si. It is designed to monitor typical AC and DC supply voltages with set tolerances, e.g. DC 24 V ±25 %. The actual voltage is indicated by two LEDs and a MOS output. This system, too, saves additional wiring by taking its internal power supply from the input signal. 7 All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. Issue C ☎ Overview E-T-A Current and Voltage Monitors Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 335 Current Monitors Overview Type No. 7 E-1076-SR-... E-1077-51-... Description monitors a MIN limit value in an AC circuit via a current transformer. If a set value is exceeded, the triac or transistor will enable the output, and the status is indicated by LED. The low power required by the Zero Current Monitor is taken from the input signal. monitors a circuit by adjustable MIN and/or MAX limit values.The response values may be directly preset by means of digital switches in the front of the housing. When set values are exceeded, the applicable relay (change over) will switch off. The response delay may be set between 0.2 and 30 sec. Relay status, operating voltage and adjustment error are indicated by LED. Version MIN limit value (Zero Current Monitor) - 31: - 41: - 51: Setting range (measuring range) AC 5 A (response threshold: 100 mA) AC 16 A (response threshold: 1 A) Values cannot be set AC 0.1 ... 19.9 A AC 0.01 ... 1.99 A DC 0.1 ... 19.9 mA Internal resistance – approx. 1 mΩ (with AC 19.9 A) approx. 10 mΩ (with AC 1.99 A) 1Ω (with DC 19.9 mA) Accuracy – 1 % ± 2 digits Switching hysteresis – ≤ 0.1 A ≤ 0.01 A ≤ 0.1 mA Response delay – adjustable between 0.2...30 s Supply voltage AC 0...250 V rated voltage (= supply voltage) AC 115 V AC 230 V Output AC: triac DC: transistor relay with change over contact AC 250 V/5 A Temperature range 0 ... +60 °C 0 ... +50 °C Degree of potection housing: IP 20 terminals: IP 20 housing: IP 50 terminals: IP 20 Mounting method rail mounted on 35 mm symmetric rail to DIN 50 022 and DIN 50 035 rail mounted on 35 mm symmetric rail to DIN 50022 Dimensions 17 x 63 x 64 mm 74 x 45 x 124 mm Technical data see CPI cat. pages 135 - 136 see CPI cat. pages 137 - 138 336 ☎ 250 V/200 mA 60 V/ 50 mA MAX limit value MIN limit value MAX and MIN limit value (with AC 19.9 A) (with AC 1.99 A) (with DC 19.9 mA) ( 90 ... 135 V) (200 ... 244 V) Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Current Protectors E 1078-421-/ 431-... Type No. The Current Protector is connected in the primary circuit before the low-voltage transformer (e.g. AC 230 V/12 V). Irregularities in the secondary circuit, such as overloads or short-circuits, will cause the Protector to immediately disconnect the system. Underload (e.g. defective terminal connections) also causes system disconnection. Error indication by red LED. After removal of the fault, the system can be reconnected by operation of the storage push button on the Protector or by operating the light switch. Protection of lighting systems Variants E 1078-421 (up to 400 W) E 1078-431 (up to 600 W) E 1078-422 (up to 400 W) E 1078-432 (up to 600 W) E 1078-482 (up to 600 W) load storage via light switch Protection from short-circuit, overload, underload short-circuit, overload, underload Lamp capacity 60 - 300 W 100 - 400 W 300 - 600 W 60 - 300 W 100 - 400 W 300 - 600 W Voltage rating AC 230 V ± 10 %/ 50 Hz AC 230 V ± 10 % / 50 Hz AC 120 V ± 10 % / 60 Hz Suitable for lighting systems with dimmers yes yes Temperature range 0 ... +45 °C 0 ... +60 °C Overload response steplessly adjustable steplessly adjustable Typical trip times overload short-circuit underload 200 ms to 2 s (depending on overload) 200 ms 3s 200 ms to 2 s (depending on overload) 200 ms 3s Technical data see CPI cat. pages 139 - 140 see CPI cat. pages 141 - 142 Overview Dimensions ● Available housing variants: - track mountable on 35 mm EN rails - housing for surface mounting in transformers Suitable for dimmer systems. ● Detecting defective terminal connections ● Line resistances, transformer and lamp tolerances are compensated for by the adjustment. ● VDE approval in place ● Option: load storage via light switch. Surface housing Track-mountable housing NV-STROMWÄCHTER R 1078-421 Error AC 230V 100-400VA 45 70 68 Bei Fehlersignal zuerst Störung beheben. 8319 Storage R 1/N 2/N 3/L 4/Tr 35 5 22 45 67 Issue C ☎ 57 Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com CURRENT PROTECTOR Fehler Error 40 1 Tr 2 N 3 L 4 Tr 7 STROMWÄCHTER 1078-422 AC 230V 100-400VA NV-STROMWÄCHTER 54 Description E 1078-422-/ 432-/ 482-... Speichern Setting 1.5 22.5 337 Combi Safety Protection Type No. E-1078-911 Two powerful appliances such as a washing machine and a dryer may be connected to a European style 16 A household socket without overloading the circuit. The E-T-A Combi Safety Protector E-1078-911 connects one of the appliances continuously to power. The second appliance is disconnected from the supply for a short time when the total current consumption reaches approx. 15.5 A - during water haeating for example. Upon completion of the heating cycle of the first appliance, the second one will be automatically reconnected. Upper response threshold typically 15.5 A ± 1 A Lower response threshold typically 2.0 A ± 1 A Supply voltage N/A Temperature range 0 ... +45 ° C Environmental duty for normal dry, clean domestic conditions Dimensions 255 x 60 x 40 mm Technical data see CPI cat. page 143 Overview Description 7 338 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Voltage Monitors E-1079-51-... E-1079-60.-... Description Voltage Monitor E-1079-... monitors set MAX and/or MIN voltage limits. The response can be directly preset by the digital switches on the front of the housing. When the set limits are exceeded, the applicable relay (change over) will switch off. The response delay may be set between 0.2 and 30 s. Relay status, operating voltage and adjustment error are indicated by LEDs. Voltage Monitor E-1079-600 monitors DC or AC voltages with set tolerances. Two LEDs indicate the operating status and over limits, with an opto coupler providing a physically isolated output signal. The power requirement of the Monitor is taken from the input signal. Variants -31: -41: -51: MAX limit value MIN limit value MAX and MIN limit values MIN and MAX limit value (not adjustable) Setting range (measuring range) DC DC DC 1... 199 mV 0.01... 1.99 V 0.1 ... 19.9 V DC 12 V ±25 % DC 24 V ±25 % DC 48 V ±25 % DC 110 V +10 %/-15 % DC 220 V +10 %/-15 % AC 115 V +10 %/-15 % AC 230 V +10 %/-15 % Internal resistance DC: Ri = DC: Ri = Accuracy 1 % ± 2 digits Umin -10 % Un ... Umin Umax ... Umax +10 % Un Switching hysteresis 1 digit with -51: setting distance between MIN and MAX limit value ≥ 5 digits – Response delay 0.2 ... 30 sec, adjustable – Supply voltage AC 115 V ( 90 ... 135 V) AC 230 V (200 ... 244 V) N/A Output relay with change over contact AC 250 V/5 A MOS output AC/DC 250 V/80 mA Temperature range 0 ... +50 °C 0 ... +60 °C Degree of protection housing: IP 50 terminals: IP 20 housing: IP 50 terminals: IP 20 Mounting rail mounted on 35 mm rail to DIN EN 50022 socket-mounted on E-T-A socket 17-P10-Si Overview Type No. Dimensions 74 x 45 x 124 mm 50 x 56 x 12 mm (without socket) 7 Technical data see CPI cat. pages 145 - 146 see CPI cat. pages 147 - 150 Issue C ☎ 20 kΩ (with 199 mV) 100 kΩ (with 1.99 V and 19.9 V) ( 9... 15 V) (18... 30 V) (36... 60 V) (93.5... 121 V) (187 ... 242 V) (97.8...126.5 V) (195.5... 253 V) 3 mA (DC/AC) load current Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 339 Current and Voltage Monitors ● ● Voltage Monitor MIN limit value ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● MAX limit value ● ● ● ● MIN and MAX limit value ● Limit value adjustment digital switches ● ● ● ● button ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● light switch Measuring ranges ● ● Combi Safety Protector Function E-1079-600 ● E-1079-51 ● E-1079-41 ● E-1079-31 ● E-1078-911 ● E-1078-482 E-1077-51 ● E-1078-432 E-1077-41 ● Current Protector E-1078-422 E-1077-31 Current Monitor E-1078-431 Description E-1076-SR Type E-1078-421 Current and Voltage Monitors - Selector chart factory preset ● AC 0... 5 A ● AC 0... 16 A ● ● ● ● AC 0... 1.99 A ● ● ● AC 0... 19.99 A ● ● ● DC 0... 19.9 mA ● ● ● DC 0... 199.9 mV ● ● ● DC 0... 1.99 V ● ● ● DC 0... 19.9 V ● ● ● DC 12 V ± 25 % ● DC 24 V ± 25 % ● DC 48 V ± 25 % ● DC 110 V +10 % / -15 % ● DC 220 V +10 % / -15 % ● AC 115 V +10 % / -15 % ● ● AC 230 V +10 % / -15 % Low voltage lamp load 60... 300 W ● ● ● ● ● 100... 400 W ● ● ● ● ● 300... 600 W ● ● ● ● ● Priority circuit I > 15.5 A AC Outputs relay transistor ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● MOS triac Supply voltage ● AC 230 V Overview AC 115 V = input signal ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● 7 340 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Approvals VDE ● ● ● ● ● DEMKO ● ● ● NEMKO ● ● ● ● ● ● ● SEMKO ● ● ● FIMKO ● ● ● KEMA ● ● ● SEV ● ● ● ÖVE ● ● ● IMQ UTE ● UL ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● CSA ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● BWB (VG) BV ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● LRoS ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Overview Type 104 105 106 110 111 120 127 129 157 158 201 410 412 413 428 433 434 437 449 452 482 483 520 530 583 683 808 809 921 922 1110 1140 1410 2210 2215 3120 3130 3200 3300 3400 3500 3600 3900 4000 4201 2-4100 2-5000 2-5200 2-5700 6110 2-6200 2-6400 2-6500 6510 2-6700 2-7000 8330 8340 8350 8 Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 341 Approvals VDE UL CSA ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● LRoS ● BV ● E-T-A Electronic Flow Monitors, Level Sensors etc. Type PTB GL FM1-Ex ● BSFW 120 ● NR 100 GL ● NR 150 GL ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Overview Type 41-0 41-04 41-05 41-06 41-10 41-11 41-20 41-27 41-29 41-57 41-58 42-01 41-2 41-3 42-8 43-3 43-4 45-2 45-20 45-30 43-200 43-300 43-400 43-500 43-600 43-900 44-000 44-201 44-100 45-000 45-200 45-700 46-200 46-400 46-500 8 All dimensions without tolerances are for reference only. In the interest of improved design, performance and cost effectiveness the right to make changes in these specifications without notice is reserved. Product markings may not be exactly as the ordering codes. 342 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336- www.etacbe.com Issue C Worldwide Service Network Corporate Headquarters Germany E-T-A Elektrotechnische Apparate GmbH P.O. Box 1061 D-90514 Altdorf ☎ ++49 (+9187) 10 -0 Facsimile ++49 (+9187) 1 03 97 www.etacbe.com Order Form Europe Austria Herndl Electric-Handelsgesellschaft m. b. H. Südstadtzentrum 1/20 A-2344 Maria Enzersdorf ☎ ++43 (+22 36) 2 41 23 Facsimile ++43 (+22 36) 2 41 23 - 40 Greece Panagiotis Sp. Dimoulas ”Biomat“ Kritis Str. 26 GR-10439 Athen ☎ ++30 (1) 8 83 33 37 Telex 21 85 29 Facsimile ++30 (1) 8 83 44 36 Belgium / Luxemburg E-T-A Elektro Technik s. a./n.v. Avenue G. Stassart Iaan, 109 B-1070 Bruxelles ☎ ++32 (+2) 523 30 97 Facsimile ++32 (+2) 523 99 06 Holland / Netherlands Jacs. Koopman B. V. Postbus 150 NL-3960 BD Wijk bij Duurstede ☎ ++31 (+3 43) 59 22 22 Facsimile ++31 (+3 43) 59 23 33 Bulgaria / Croatia Slovenia / Romania H. Balla Breitenfurter Str. 382 a A-1235 Wien ☎ ++43 (1) 8 88 52 51 Facsimile ++43 (1) 8 88 51 51 51 Italy E-T-A Apparecchi Elettrotecnici s.r.l. Via Giulio Cesare Procaccini Nr. 7 I-20154 Milano ☎ ++39 (02) 31 41 56 Facsimile ++39 (02) 31 41 81 Abteilungsverkauf: C.so Buenos Aires, 75 I-20129 Milano ☎ ++39 (02)66 98 81 23 Facsimile ++39 (02) 66 98 44 70 e-mail: [email protected] Czech Republic Slovakian Republic E-T-A Elektrotechnische Apparate GmbH Ladislav Bojarsky Industriestr. 2-8, D-90518 Altdorf, Postfach 1061, D-90514 Altdorf ☎ ++49(+9187) 10 423 Facsimile ++49(+9187) 10 222 Denmark H. Jørgensen & Co ApS Præstemarksvej 8 B DK-4000 Roskilde ☎ ++45 (46) 75 63 22 Facsimile ++45(46) 75 61 40 e-mail: [email protected] Finland Suomen Elektrolind Oy Jan Barck Vesitorninpolku 5b FIN-02700 Kauniainen ☎/Facsimile ++358 (+9) -5 05 01 10 Mobiltelefon ++358 (40) 5 43 78 98 e-mail: [email protected] France ETA Appareils électrotechniques S.A.R.L. 40-62, Rue du Général Malleret-Joinville F-94400 Vitry-sur-Seine ☎ ++33 (+1) 46 81 02 73 Facsimile ++33 (+1) 46 82 65 69 e-mail: [email protected] Norway Elis Elektro A/S Postboks 38 Lindeberg Gr. N-1007 Oslo ☎ ++47 (+2) 2 90 56 70 Facsimile ++47 (+2) 2 90 56 71 e-mail: [email protected] Poland Electronics & Cable Sp. zo. o. ul. Przemyslowa 12 62-095 Murowana Goslina ☎ ++48 (61) 8 11 20 64 ++48 (61) 8 11 20 65 Facsimile ++48 (61) 8 11 20 66 Portugal AUTOMA Av. Vasco da Gama, 652-660 P-4100 Porto ☎ ++351(+2 ) 6 17 42 39 Facsimile ++351(+2 ) 6 17 19 87 Telex 2 68 1 Spain ELPO-ELECTRIC S.A. José Lobo Apartado 2503 28080 Madrid ☎ ++34 (91) 4 15 13 48-4 15 39 11 Facsimile ++34 (91) 4 13 02 38 Sweden Österlinds El-Agentur AB Gribbylundvägen 11-13 S-18762 Täby Box 96 S-18321 Täby ☎ ++46 (+8) 7 32 80 75 Facsimile ++46 (+8) 7 32 60 30 Switzerland E-T-A general agents: Henri Grandjean AG Niederbergstr. 1 Postfach 677 CH-4153 Reinach BL ☎ ++41 (+61) 711 02 02 Facsimile ++41 (+61) 711 04 11 e-mail: [email protected] Switzerland For E-T-A Electronic devices: Rudolf Flach Elektronik AG Emil Frey-Strasse 166 CH-4142 Münchenstein ☎ ++41 (+61) 417 94 94 Facsimile ++41 (+61) 417 94 95 Switzerland For Pressure and Level Sensors and Flow Monitors: Vögtlin Instruments AG Langenhagstr. 1 CH-4147 Aesch BL ☎ ++41 (+61) 756 63 00 Facsimile ++41 (+61) 756 63 01 Turkey MESAN Elektrik Müm. ve Sanayi Ltd. Sti. Refik Saydam Caddesi No.: 167 Dilber Apartmani Kat: 4-5 Daire: 12-14 TR-80020 Sishane-Istanbul ☎ ++90 (2 12) 292 5849 Facsimile ++90 (2 12) 251 6030 e-mail: [email protected] United Kingdom / Ireland E-T-A Circuit Breakers Ltd. Telford Close GB-Aylesbury, Bucks HP 19 3 DG ☎ ++44 (+12 96) 420336 Facsimile ++44 (+12 96) 488497 e-mail: [email protected] For E-T-A Electronic devices: E-T-A Electronic a division of E-T-A Circuit Breakers Ltd. Address as above 8 (...) = area code Issue C ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com 343 Worldwide Service Network America Asia Brazil Paulo Viehmann Representaçoes Rua Olavo, 450 Praia Vermelha Eldorado BR 09971-500 Diadema - SP ☎ / Facsimile ++55 (+11) 713 - 5294 ☎ ++55 (+11) 713 - 5512 e-mail: [email protected] India M/s. R. G. Keswani Post Box No. 16552 WORLI IND-Bombay-400 018 ☎ (022) 4 93 28 05 ☎ ++91 (+22) 4 93 92 46 Facsimile ++91 (+22) 4 93 84 74 Canada E-T-A Circuit Breakers Ltd. 236 Hood Road CDN-Markham Ontario L 3R 3K8 ☎ ++1 (905) 475 - 5886 Facsimile ++1 (905) 475 - 5889 Japan E-T-A Components K.K. Suzushoo Bldg. 4 F No. 6-13-9, Shinbashi Minato-ku Tokyo 105 ☎ ++81 (+3) 34 34 - 16 26 Facsimile ++81 (+3) 34 34 - 16 27 e-mail: [email protected] Chile Electrónica Industrial Schädler y Cia Ltda Antonio Varas 1871 RCH-Providencia.-Santiago ☎ ++56 (+2) 274 7430 Facsimile ++56 (+2) 204 9338 United States of America ETA Circuit Breakers 1551 Bishop Court USA-Mount Prospect, IL 60056 ☎ ++1(847) 827-7600 Facsimile ++1(847) 827-7655 e-mail: [email protected] Singapur / Singapore Malaysien / Malaysia Hongkong / Hong Kong Indonesien / Indonesia Brunei, Thailand, Korea, Taiwan, Mainland China, Philippinen E-T-A Asia Pacific Pte Ltd No. 46 Lorong 17 Geylang #08-01 Enterprise Industrial Building SGP-Singapore 388568 ☎ ++65 / 841 4484 Facsimile ++65 / 841 4474 e-mail: [email protected] Africa South Africa RADEL Electrical and Electronic Components cc P.O.Box 4364 ZA-Cresta 21 18 ☎ ++27 (+11) 888-6696 Facsimile ++27 (+11) 888-2390 e-mail: [email protected] Australia Australia / New Zealand RUBIN GROUP PTY. LIMITED 73-77 Whiting Street AUS-Artarmon, N. S. W. 2064 P.O. Box 82 ☎ ++61 (+2) 9906 5608 Facsimile ++61 (+2) 9439 2278 e-mail: [email protected] 8 (...) = area code 344 ☎ Germany (0 91 87) 10-0 - USA (847) 827-7600 - UK (01296) 420336 - www.etacbe.com Issue C Circuit Protection and Control Circuit Breakers and Control Products